gdb: New maintenance command to disable bfd sharing.
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 2 goodbye
2795 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2796 * 1 hello
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @quotation
2848 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2849 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2850 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2851 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2852 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2853 like this:
2854
2855 @smallexample
2856 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2857 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2858 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2859 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2860 @end smallexample
2861 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2862 @c doesn't support threads"?
2863 @end quotation
2864
2865 @cindex focus of debugging
2866 @cindex current thread
2867 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2868 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2869 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2870 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2871 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2872
2873 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2874 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2875 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2876 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2877 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2878 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2879 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2880 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2881 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2882 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2883
2884 @smallexample
2885 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2890 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2891 further qualifier.
2892
2893 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2894 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2895 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2896 @c program?
2897 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2898 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2899 @c threads ab initio?
2900
2901 @cindex thread number
2902 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2903 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2904 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2905
2906 @table @code
2907 @kindex info threads
2908 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2909 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2910 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2911 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2912 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2913
2914 @enumerate
2915 @item
2916 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2917
2918 @item
2919 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2920
2921 @item
2922 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2923 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2924 program itself.
2925
2926 @item
2927 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2928 @end enumerate
2929
2930 @noindent
2931 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2932 indicates the current thread.
2933
2934 For example,
2935 @end table
2936 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2937
2938 @smallexample
2939 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2940 Id Target Id Frame
2941 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2942 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2943 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2944 at threadtest.c:68
2945 @end smallexample
2946
2947 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2948 Solaris-specific command:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item maint info sol-threads
2952 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2953 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2954 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2959 @item thread @var{threadno}
2960 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2961 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2962 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2963 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2964 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2968 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2969 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2970 8 printf ("hello\n");
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @noindent
2974 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2975 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2976 threads.
2977
2978 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2979 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2980 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2981 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2982 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2983 information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 @kindex thread apply
2986 @cindex apply command to several threads
2987 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2988 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2989 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2990 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2991 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2992 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2993 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2994 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2995 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2996 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2997
2998
2999 @kindex thread name
3000 @cindex name a thread
3001 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3002 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3003 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3004 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3005
3006 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3007 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3008 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3009 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3010 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3011
3012 @kindex thread find
3013 @cindex search for a thread
3014 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3015 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3016 matches the supplied regular expression.
3017
3018 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3019 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3020 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3021 is the LWP id.
3022
3023 @smallexample
3024 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3025 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3026 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3027 Id Target Id Frame
3028 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 @kindex set print thread-events
3032 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3033 @item set print thread-events
3034 @itemx set print thread-events on
3035 @itemx set print thread-events off
3036 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3037 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3038 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3039 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3040 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3041
3042 @kindex show print thread-events
3043 @item show print thread-events
3044 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3045 have started and exited.
3046 @end table
3047
3048 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3049 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3050 programs with multiple threads.
3051
3052 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3053 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3054
3055 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3056 @table @code
3057 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3058 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3059 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3061 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3062 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3063 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3064 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3065 macro.
3066
3067 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3068 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3069 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3070 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3071 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3072 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3073
3074 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3075 refers to the default system directories that are
3076 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3077 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3078 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3079
3080 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3081 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3082 was loaded in the inferior process.
3083
3084 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3085 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3086 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3087 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3088 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3089 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3090 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3091
3092 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3093 only on some platforms.
3094
3095 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3096 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3097 Display current libthread_db search path.
3098
3099 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3100 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3101 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3102 @item set debug libthread-db
3103 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3104 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3105 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3106 @end table
3107
3108 @node Forks
3109 @section Debugging Forks
3110
3111 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3112 @cindex multiple processes
3113 @cindex processes, multiple
3114 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3115 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3116 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3117 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3118 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3119 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3120 will cause it to terminate.
3121
3122 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3123 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3124 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3125 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3126 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3127 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3128 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3129 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3130 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3131 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3132
3133 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3134 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3135 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3136 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3137
3138 The fork debugging commands are supported in both native mode and when
3139 connected to @code{gdbserver} using @kbd{target extended-remote}.
3140
3141 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3142 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3143
3144 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3145 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3146
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3149 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3150 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3151 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3152 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3153
3154 @table @code
3155 @item parent
3156 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3157 unimpeded. This is the default.
3158
3159 @item child
3160 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3161 unimpeded.
3162
3163 @end table
3164
3165 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3166 @item show follow-fork-mode
3167 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3168 @end table
3169
3170 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3171 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3172 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3173
3174 @table @code
3175 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3176 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3177 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3178 retain debugger control over them both.
3179
3180 @table @code
3181 @item on
3182 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3183 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3184 independently. This is the default.
3185
3186 @item off
3187 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3188 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3189 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3190 is held suspended.
3191
3192 @end table
3193
3194 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3195 @item show detach-on-fork
3196 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3200 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3201 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3202 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3203 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3204 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3205
3206 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3207 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3208 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3209 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3210 and Programs}.
3211
3212 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3213 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3214 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3215 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3216 the child process's @code{main}.
3217
3218 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3219 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3220
3221 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3222 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3223 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3224 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3225 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3226 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3227 command.
3228
3229 @table @code
3230 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3231 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3232
3233 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3234 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3235
3236 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3237
3238 @table @code
3239 @item new
3240 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3241 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3242 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3243 original inferior.
3244
3245 For example:
3246
3247 @smallexample
3248 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3249 (gdb) info inferior
3250 Id Description Executable
3251 * 1 <null> prog1
3252 (@value{GDBP}) run
3253 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3254 Program exited normally.
3255 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3256 Id Description Executable
3257 * 2 <null> prog2
3258 1 <null> prog1
3259 @end smallexample
3260
3261 @item same
3262 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3263 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3264 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3265 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3266 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3267
3268 For example:
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3272 Id Description Executable
3273 * 1 <null> prog1
3274 (@value{GDBP}) run
3275 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3276 Program exited normally.
3277 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3278 Id Description Executable
3279 * 1 <null> prog2
3280 @end smallexample
3281
3282 @end table
3283 @end table
3284
3285 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3286 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3287 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3288
3289 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3290 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3291
3292 @cindex checkpoint
3293 @cindex restart
3294 @cindex bookmark
3295 @cindex snapshot of a process
3296 @cindex rewind program state
3297
3298 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3299 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3300 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3301 later.
3302
3303 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3304 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3305 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3306 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3307 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3308
3309 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3310 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3311 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3312 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3313 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3314 start again from there.
3315
3316 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3317 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3318
3319 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex checkpoint
3323 @item checkpoint
3324 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3325 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3326 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3327
3328 @kindex info checkpoints
3329 @item info checkpoints
3330 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3331 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3332 listed:
3333
3334 @table @code
3335 @item Checkpoint ID
3336 @item Process ID
3337 @item Code Address
3338 @item Source line, or label
3339 @end table
3340
3341 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3342 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3343 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3344 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3345 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3346 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3347 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3348
3349 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3350 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3351 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3352 the debugger.
3353
3354 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3355 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3356 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3357
3358 @end table
3359
3360 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3361 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3362 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3363 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3364 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3365 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3366 previously read data can be read again.
3367
3368 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3369 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3370 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3371 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3372 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3373 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3374
3375 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3376 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3377 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3378 different execution path this time.
3379
3380 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3381 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3382 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3383 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3384 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3385 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3386 potentially pose a problem.
3387
3388 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3389
3390 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3391 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3392 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3393 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3394 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3395 next.
3396
3397 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3398 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3399 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3400 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3401 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3402
3403 @node Stopping
3404 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3405
3406 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3407 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3408 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3409
3410 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3411 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3412 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3413 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3414 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3415 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3416 explicitly request this information at any time.
3417
3418 @table @code
3419 @kindex info program
3420 @item info program
3421 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3422 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3423 @end table
3424
3425 @menu
3426 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3427 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3428 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3429 Skipping over functions and files
3430 * Signals:: Signals
3431 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3432 @end menu
3433
3434 @node Breakpoints
3435 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3436
3437 @cindex breakpoints
3438 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3439 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3440 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3441 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3442 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3443 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3444 program.
3445
3446 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3447 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3448 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3449 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3450 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3451 call).
3452
3453 @cindex watchpoints
3454 @cindex data breakpoints
3455 @cindex memory tracing
3456 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3457 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3458 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3459 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3460 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3461 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3462 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3463 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3464 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3465 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3466 same commands.
3467
3468 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3469 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3470 Automatic Display}.
3471
3472 @cindex catchpoints
3473 @cindex breakpoint on events
3474 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3475 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3476 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3477 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3478 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3479 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3480 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3481
3482 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3483 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3484 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3485 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3486 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3487 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3488 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3489 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3490 enable it again.
3491
3492 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3493 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3494 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3495 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3496 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3497 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3498 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3499
3500 @menu
3501 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3502 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3503 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3504 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3505 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3506 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3507 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3508 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3509 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3510 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3511 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3512 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3513 @end menu
3514
3515 @node Set Breaks
3516 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3517
3518 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3519 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3520 @c
3521 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3522
3523 @kindex break
3524 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3525 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3526 @cindex latest breakpoint
3527 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3528 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3529 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3530 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3531 convenience variables.
3532
3533 @table @code
3534 @item break @var{location}
3535 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3536 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3537 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3538 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3539 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3540
3541 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3542 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3543 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3544 that situation.
3545
3546 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3547 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3548 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3549
3550 @item break
3551 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3552 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3553 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3554 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3555 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3556 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3557 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3558 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3559 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3560 inside loops.
3561
3562 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3563 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3564 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3565 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3566 existed when your program stopped.
3567
3568 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3569 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3570 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3571 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3572 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3573 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3574 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3575
3576 @kindex tbreak
3577 @item tbreak @var{args}
3578 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3579 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3580 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3581 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3582
3583 @kindex hbreak
3584 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3585 @item hbreak @var{args}
3586 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3587 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3588 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3589 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3590 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3591 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3592 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3593 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3594 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3595 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3596 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3597 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3598 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3599 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3600 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3601 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3602 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3603 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3604
3605 @kindex thbreak
3606 @item thbreak @var{args}
3607 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3608 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3609 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3610 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3611 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3612 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3613 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3614 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3615
3616 @kindex rbreak
3617 @cindex regular expression
3618 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3619 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3620 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3621 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3622 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3623 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3624 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3625 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3626 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3627
3628 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3629 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3630 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3631 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3632 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3633 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3634
3635 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3636 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3637 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3638 classes.
3639
3640 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3641 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3642 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3643
3644 @smallexample
3645 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3646 @end smallexample
3647
3648 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3649 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3650 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3651 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3652 every function in a given file:
3653
3654 @smallexample
3655 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3656 @end smallexample
3657
3658 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3659 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3660
3661 @kindex info breakpoints
3662 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3663 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3664 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3665 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3666 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3667 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3668 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3669
3670 @table @emph
3671 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3672 @item Type
3673 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3674 @item Disposition
3675 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3676 @item Enabled or Disabled
3677 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3678 that are not enabled.
3679 @item Address
3680 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3681 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3682 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3683 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3684 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3685 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3686 @item What
3687 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3688 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3689 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3690 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3691 @end table
3692
3693 @noindent
3694 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3695 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3696 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3697 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3698 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3699 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3700
3701 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3702 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3703 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3704 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3705
3706 @noindent
3707 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3708 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3709 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3710 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3711 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3712
3713 @noindent
3714 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3715 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3716 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3717 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3718 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3719 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3720
3721 @noindent
3722 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3723 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3724
3725 @end table
3726
3727 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3728 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3729 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3730 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3731
3732 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3733 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3734 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3735 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3736
3737 @itemize @bullet
3738 @item
3739 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3740
3741 @item
3742 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3743 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3744
3745 @item
3746 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3747 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3748
3749 @item
3750 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3751 several places where that function is inlined.
3752 @end itemize
3753
3754 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3755 the relevant locations.
3756
3757 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3758 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3759 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3760 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3761 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3762 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3763 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3764
3765 For example:
3766
3767 @smallexample
3768 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3769 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3770 stop only if i==1
3771 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3772 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3773 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3774 @end smallexample
3775
3776 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3777 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3778 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3779 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3780 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3781 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3782 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3783 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3784 that belong to that breakpoint.
3785
3786 @cindex pending breakpoints
3787 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3788 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3789 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3790 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3791 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3792 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3793 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3794 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3795 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3796 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3797 is not yet resolved.
3798
3799 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3800 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3801 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3802 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3803 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3804 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3805
3806 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3807 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3808 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3809 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3810
3811 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3812 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3813 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3814
3815 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3816 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3817 address specification to an address:
3818
3819 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3820 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3821 @table @code
3822 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3823 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3824 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3825
3826 @item set breakpoint pending on
3827 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3828 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3829
3830 @item set breakpoint pending off
3831 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3832 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3833 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3834
3835 @item show breakpoint pending
3836 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3837 @end table
3838
3839 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3840 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3841 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3842
3843 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3844 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3845 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3846 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3847 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3848 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3849 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3850 breakpoints.
3851
3852 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3853
3854 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3855 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3856 @table @code
3857 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3858 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3859 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3860 breakpoint must be used.
3861
3862 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3863 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3864 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3865 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3866 @end table
3867
3868 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3869 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3870 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3871 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3872 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3873 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3874 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3875 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3876 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3877
3878 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3879 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3880 @table @code
3881 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3882 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3883 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3884 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3885
3886 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3887 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3888 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3889 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3890 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3894 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3895 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3896
3897 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3898 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3899
3900 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3901
3902 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3903 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3904 @table @code
3905 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3906 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3907 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3908 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3909 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3910
3911 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3912 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3913 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3914 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3915 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3916 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3917 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3918 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3919 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3920 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3921 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3922 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3923 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3924
3925 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3926 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3927 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3928 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3929 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3930 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3931 @end table
3932
3933
3934 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3935 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3936 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3937 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3938 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3939 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3940 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3941 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3942
3943
3944 @node Set Watchpoints
3945 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3946
3947 @cindex setting watchpoints
3948 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3949 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3950 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3951 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3952 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3953
3954 @itemize @bullet
3955 @item
3956 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3957
3958 @item
3959 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3960 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3961 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3962
3963 @item
3964 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3965 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3966 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3967 @end itemize
3968
3969 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3970 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3971 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3972 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3973 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3974 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3975 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3976 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3977 the expression changes.
3978
3979 @cindex software watchpoints
3980 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3981 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3982 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3983 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3984 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3985 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3986 culprit.)
3987
3988 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3989 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3990 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3991
3992 @table @code
3993 @kindex watch
3994 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3995 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3996 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3997 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3998 to watch the value of a single variable:
3999
4000 @smallexample
4001 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4002 @end smallexample
4003
4004 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4005 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4006 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4007 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4008 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4009 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4010
4011 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4012 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4013 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4014 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4015 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4016 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4017 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4018 error.
4019
4020 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4021 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4022 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4023 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4024 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4025 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4026 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4027 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4028 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4029 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4030 Examples:
4031
4032 @smallexample
4033 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4034 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4035 @end smallexample
4036
4037 @kindex rwatch
4038 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4039 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4040 by the program.
4041
4042 @kindex awatch
4043 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4044 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4045 or written into by the program.
4046
4047 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4048 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4049 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4050 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4051 @end table
4052
4053 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4054 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4055 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4056 a never-changing value:
4057
4058 @smallexample
4059 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4060 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4061 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4062 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4063 @end smallexample
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4066 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4067 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4068 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4069 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4070 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4071
4072 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4073 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4074 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4075 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4076 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4077 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4078 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4079 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4080
4081 @table @code
4082 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4083 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4084 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4085
4086 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4087 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4088 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4089 @end table
4090
4091 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4092 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4093 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4094
4095 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4096
4097 @smallexample
4098 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4099 @end smallexample
4100
4101 @noindent
4102 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4103
4104 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4105 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4106 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4107 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4108 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4109 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4110 will print a message like this:
4111
4112 @smallexample
4113 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4114 @end smallexample
4115
4116 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4117 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4118 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4119 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4120 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4121 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4122 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4123 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4124
4125 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4126 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4127 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4128 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4129 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4130 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4131
4132 @smallexample
4133 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4138
4139 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4140 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4141 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4142 expression with separately allocated resources.
4143
4144 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4145 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4146 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4147
4148 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4149 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4150 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4151 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4152 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4153 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4154 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4155 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4156 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4157
4158 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4159 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4160 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4161 watched expression from every thread.
4162
4163 @quotation
4164 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4165 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4166 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4167 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4168 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4169 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4170 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4171 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4172 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4173 @end quotation
4174
4175 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4176
4177 @node Set Catchpoints
4178 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4179 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4180 @cindex exception handlers
4181 @cindex event handling
4182
4183 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4184 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4185 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4186
4187 @table @code
4188 @kindex catch
4189 @item catch @var{event}
4190 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4191
4192 @table @code
4193 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4194 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4195 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4196 @kindex catch throw
4197 @kindex catch rethrow
4198 @kindex catch catch
4199 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4200 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4201
4202 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4203 regular expression will be caught.
4204
4205 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4206 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4207 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4208 exception being thrown.
4209
4210 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4211 @value{GDBN}:
4212
4213 @itemize @bullet
4214 @item
4215 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4216 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4217 supported.
4218
4219 @item
4220 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4221 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4222 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4223 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4224 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4225 built.
4226
4227 @item
4228 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4229 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4230
4231 @item
4232 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4233 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4234 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4235 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4236
4237 @item
4238 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4239 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4240 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4241 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4242 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4243 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4244 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4245 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4246 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4247
4248 @item
4249 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4250
4251 @item
4252 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4253 @end itemize
4254
4255 @item exception
4256 @kindex catch exception
4257 @cindex Ada exception catching
4258 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4259 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4260 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4261 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4262 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4263
4264 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4265 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4266 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4267 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4268 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4269 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4270 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4271 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4272
4273 @item exception unhandled
4274 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4275 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4276
4277 @item assert
4278 @kindex catch assert
4279 A failed Ada assertion.
4280
4281 @item exec
4282 @kindex catch exec
4283 @cindex break on fork/exec
4284 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4285 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4286
4287 @item syscall
4288 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4289 @kindex catch syscall
4290 @cindex break on a system call.
4291 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4292 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4293 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4294 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4295 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4296 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4297 will be caught.
4298
4299 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4300 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4301 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4302 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4303
4304 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4305 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4306 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4307 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4308
4309 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4310 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4311 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4312 available choices.
4313
4314 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4315 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4316 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4317 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4318 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4319 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4320 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4321 behind the OS upgrades).
4322
4323 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4324 arguments to it:
4325
4326 @smallexample
4327 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4328 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4329 (@value{GDBP}) r
4330 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4331
4332 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4333 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4334 (@value{GDBP}) c
4335 Continuing.
4336
4337 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4338 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4339 (@value{GDBP})
4340 @end smallexample
4341
4342 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4343
4344 @smallexample
4345 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4346 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4347 (@value{GDBP}) r
4348 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4349
4350 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4351 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4352 (@value{GDBP}) c
4353 Continuing.
4354
4355 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4356 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4357 (@value{GDBP})
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4361 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4362 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4366 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4367 (@value{GDBP}) r
4368 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4369
4370 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4371 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4372 (@value{GDBP}) c
4373 Continuing.
4374
4375 Program exited normally.
4376 (@value{GDBP})
4377 @end smallexample
4378
4379 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4380 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4381 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4382 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4383
4384 @smallexample
4385 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4386 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4387 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4388 (@value{GDBP})
4389 @end smallexample
4390
4391 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4392 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4393 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4394 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4395 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4396 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4397
4398 @smallexample
4399 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4400 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4401 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4402 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4403 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4404 (@value{GDBP})
4405 @end smallexample
4406
4407 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4408
4409 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4410 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4411
4412 @smallexample
4413 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4414 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4415 @end smallexample
4416
4417 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4418
4419 @item fork
4420 @kindex catch fork
4421 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4422 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4423
4424 @item vfork
4425 @kindex catch vfork
4426 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4427 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4428
4429 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4430 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4431 @kindex catch load
4432 @kindex catch unload
4433 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4434 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4435 matches one of the affected libraries.
4436
4437 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4438 @kindex catch signal
4439 The delivery of a signal.
4440
4441 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4442 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4443 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4444
4445 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4446 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4447 signal names.
4448
4449 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4450 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4451 will be caught.
4452
4453 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4454 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4455 catchpoint.
4456
4457 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4458 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4459 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4460 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4461 commands.
4462
4463 @end table
4464
4465 @item tcatch @var{event}
4466 @kindex tcatch
4467 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4468 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4469
4470 @end table
4471
4472 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4473
4474
4475 @node Delete Breaks
4476 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4477
4478 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4479 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4480 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4481 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4482 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4483 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4484
4485 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4486 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4487 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4488 their breakpoint numbers.
4489
4490 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4491 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4492 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4493
4494 @table @code
4495 @kindex clear
4496 @item clear
4497 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4498 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4499 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4500 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4501
4502 @item clear @var{location}
4503 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4504 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4505 most useful ones are listed below:
4506
4507 @table @code
4508 @item clear @var{function}
4509 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4510 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4511
4512 @item clear @var{linenum}
4513 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4514 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4515 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4516 @end table
4517
4518 @cindex delete breakpoints
4519 @kindex delete
4520 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4521 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4522 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4523 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4524 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4525 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4526 @end table
4527
4528 @node Disabling
4529 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4530
4531 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4532 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4533 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4534 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4535 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4536
4537 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4538 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4539 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4540 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4541 do not know which numbers to use.
4542
4543 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4544 affects all of its locations.
4545
4546 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4547 different states of enablement:
4548
4549 @itemize @bullet
4550 @item
4551 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4552 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4553 @item
4554 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4555 @item
4556 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4557 disabled.
4558 @item
4559 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4560 N times, then becomes disabled.
4561 @item
4562 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4563 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4564 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4565 @end itemize
4566
4567 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4568 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4569
4570 @table @code
4571 @kindex disable
4572 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4573 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4574 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4575 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4576 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4577 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4578 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4579
4580 @kindex enable
4581 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4582 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4583 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4584
4585 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4586 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4587 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4588
4589 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4590 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4591 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4592 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4593 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4594 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4595 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4596
4597 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4598 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4599 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4600 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4601 @end table
4602
4603 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4604 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4605 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4606 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4607 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4608 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4609 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4610 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4611 Stepping}.)
4612
4613 @node Conditions
4614 @subsection Break Conditions
4615 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4616 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4617
4618 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4619 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4620 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4621 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4622 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4623 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4624 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4625 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4626
4627 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4628 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4629 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4630 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4631 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4632
4633 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4634 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4635 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4636 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4637 one.
4638
4639 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4640 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4641 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4642 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4643 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4644 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4645 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4646 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4647 conditions for the
4648 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4649 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4650
4651 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4652 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4653 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4654 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4655 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4656 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4657
4658 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4659 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4660 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4661 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4662 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4663
4664 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4665 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4666 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4667 with the @code{condition} command.
4668
4669 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4670 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4671 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4672 catchpoint.
4673
4674 @table @code
4675 @kindex condition
4676 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4677 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4678 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4679 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4680 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4681 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4682 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4683 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4684 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4685 prints an error message:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4689 @end smallexample
4690
4691 @noindent
4692 @value{GDBN} does
4693 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4694 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4695 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4696
4697 @item condition @var{bnum}
4698 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4699 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4700 @end table
4701
4702 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4703 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4704 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4705 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4706 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4707 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4708 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4709 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4710 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4711 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4712 your program reaches it.
4713
4714 @table @code
4715 @kindex ignore
4716 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4717 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4718 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4719 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4720 takes no action.
4721
4722 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4723 a count of zero.
4724
4725 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4726 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4727 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4728 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4729
4730 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4731 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4732 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4733
4734 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4735 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4736 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4737 Variables}.
4738 @end table
4739
4740 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4741
4742
4743 @node Break Commands
4744 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4745
4746 @cindex breakpoint commands
4747 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4748 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4749 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4750 enable other breakpoints.
4751
4752 @table @code
4753 @kindex commands
4754 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4755 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4756 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4757 @itemx end
4758 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4759 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4760 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4761
4762 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4763 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4764
4765 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4767 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4768 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4769 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4770 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4771 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4772 Expressions}).
4773 @end table
4774
4775 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4776 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4777
4778 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4779 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4780 that resumes execution.
4781
4782 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4783 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4784 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4785 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4786 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4787
4788 @kindex silent
4789 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4790 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4791 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4792 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4793 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4794 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4795
4796 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4797 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4798 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4799
4800 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4801 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4802
4803 @smallexample
4804 break foo if x>0
4805 commands
4806 silent
4807 printf "x is %d\n",x
4808 cont
4809 end
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4813 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4814 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4815 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4816 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4817 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4818 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4819
4820 @smallexample
4821 break 403
4822 commands
4823 silent
4824 set x = y + 4
4825 cont
4826 end
4827 @end smallexample
4828
4829 @node Dynamic Printf
4830 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4831
4832 @cindex dynamic printf
4833 @cindex dprintf
4834 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4835 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4836 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4837 having to recompile it.
4838
4839 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4840 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4841 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4842 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4843 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4844 redirects to files and so forth.
4845
4846 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4847 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4848 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4849 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4850 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4851 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4852 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4853
4854 @table @code
4855 @kindex dprintf
4856 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4857 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4858 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4859 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4860
4861 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4862 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4863 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4864 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4865 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4866 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4867
4868 @item gdb
4869 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4870 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4871
4872 @item call
4873 @kindex dprintf-style call
4874 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4875 @code{printf}).
4876
4877 @item agent
4878 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4879 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4880 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4881 support running commands on the target.
4882
4883 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4884 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4885 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4886 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4887 command.
4888
4889 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4890 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4891 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4892 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4893 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4894 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4895
4896 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4897 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4898 you could do the following:
4899
4900 @example
4901 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4902 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4903 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4904 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4905 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4906 (gdb) info break
4907 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4908 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4909 continue
4910 (gdb)
4911 @end example
4912
4913 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4914 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4915 the variable settings.
4916
4917 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4918 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4919 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4920 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4921 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4922 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4923
4924 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4925 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4926 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4927
4928 @end table
4929
4930 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4931 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4932 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4933 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4934 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4935 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4936
4937 @node Save Breakpoints
4938 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4939
4940 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4941 breakpoints}} command.
4942
4943 @table @code
4944 @kindex save breakpoints
4945 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4946 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4947 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4948 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4949 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4950 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4951 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4952 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4953 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4954 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4955 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4956 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4957 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4958 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4959 that can no longer be recreated.
4960 @end table
4961
4962 @node Static Probe Points
4963 @subsection Static Probe Points
4964
4965 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4966 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4967 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4968 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4969 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4970
4971 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4972 ELF-compatible systems:
4973
4974 @itemize @bullet
4975
4976 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4977 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4978 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4979 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4980 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4981 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4982 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4983 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4984
4985 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4986 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4987 C@t{++} languages.
4988 @end itemize
4989
4990 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4991 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4992 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4993 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4994 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4995 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4996 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4997 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4998 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4999
5000 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5001 probes}, with optional arguments:
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @kindex info probes
5005 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5006 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5007 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5008 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5009
5010 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5011 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5012 probes from all providers are listed.
5013
5014 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5015 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5016 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5017
5018 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5019 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5020 given, all object files are considered.
5021
5022 @item info probes all
5023 List the available static probes, from all types.
5024 @end table
5025
5026 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5027 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5028 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5029 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5030 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5031
5032 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5033 commands, with optional arguments:
5034
5035 @table @code
5036 @kindex enable probes
5037 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5038 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5039 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5040 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5041
5042 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5043 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5044 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5045
5046 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5047 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5048 given, all object files are considered.
5049
5050 @kindex disable probes
5051 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5052 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5053 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5054 @end table
5055
5056 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5057 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5058 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5059 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5060 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5061 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5062 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5063 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5064 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5065 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5066 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5067 at the current probe point.
5068
5069 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5070 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5071 an error message.
5072
5073
5074 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5075 @node Error in Breakpoints
5076 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5077
5078 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5079 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5080
5081 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5082 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5083 @smallexample
5084 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5085 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5086 @end smallexample
5087
5088 @noindent
5089 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5090 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5091 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5092
5093 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5094 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5095
5096 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5097 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5098 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5099
5100 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5101 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5102 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5103 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5104
5105 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5106 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5107 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5108 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5109 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5110 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5111 first in the bundle.
5112
5113 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5114 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5115 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5116 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5117 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5118 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5119 is hit.
5120
5121 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5122 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5123
5124 @smallexample
5125 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5129 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5130 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5131 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5132 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5133 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5134 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5135 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5136
5137 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5138 adjusted breakpoints:
5139
5140 @smallexample
5141 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5142 to 0x00010410.
5143 @end smallexample
5144
5145 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5146 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5147 frequently than expected.
5148
5149 @node Continuing and Stepping
5150 @section Continuing and Stepping
5151
5152 @cindex stepping
5153 @cindex continuing
5154 @cindex resuming execution
5155 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5156 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5157 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5158 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5159 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5160 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5161 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5162 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5163 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5164 handlers}).)
5165
5166 @table @code
5167 @kindex continue
5168 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5169 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5170 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5171 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5172 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5173 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5174 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5175 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5176 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5177 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5178
5179 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5180 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5181 @code{continue} is ignored.
5182
5183 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5184 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5185 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5186 @code{continue}.
5187 @end table
5188
5189 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5190 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5191 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5192 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5193
5194 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5195 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5196 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5197 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5198 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5199 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5200
5201 @table @code
5202 @kindex step
5203 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5204 @item step
5205 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5206 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5207 abbreviated @code{s}.
5208
5209 @quotation
5210 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5211 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5212 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5213 @c distinction here.
5214 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5215 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5216 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5217 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5218 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5219 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5220 below.
5221 @end quotation
5222
5223 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5224 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5225 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5226 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5227 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5228 called within the line.
5229
5230 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5231 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5232 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5233 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5234 was any debugging information about the routine.
5235
5236 @item step @var{count}
5237 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5238 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5239 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5240
5241 @kindex next
5242 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5243 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5244 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5245 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5246 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5247 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5248 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5249 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5250
5251 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5252
5253
5254 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5255 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5256 @c
5257 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5258 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5259 @c function are executed without stopping.
5260
5261 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5262 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5263 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5264
5265 @kindex set step-mode
5266 @item set step-mode
5267 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5268 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5269 @itemx set step-mode on
5270 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5271 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5272 information rather than stepping over it.
5273
5274 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5275 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5276 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5277
5278 @item set step-mode off
5279 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5280 debug information. This is the default.
5281
5282 @item show step-mode
5283 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5284 source line debug information.
5285
5286 @kindex finish
5287 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5288 @item finish
5289 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5290 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5291 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5292
5293 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5294 ,Returning from a Function}).
5295
5296 @kindex until
5297 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5298 @cindex run until specified location
5299 @item until
5300 @itemx u
5301 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5302 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5303 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5304 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5305 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5306 than the address of the jump.
5307
5308 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5309 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5310 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5311 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5312 through the next iteration.
5313
5314 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5315 stack frame.
5316
5317 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5318 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5319 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5320 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5321 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5322
5323 @smallexample
5324 (@value{GDBP}) f
5325 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5326 206 expand_input();
5327 (@value{GDBP}) until
5328 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5329 @end smallexample
5330
5331 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5332 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5333 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5334 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5335 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5336 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5337 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5338
5339 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5340 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5341 argument.
5342
5343 @item until @var{location}
5344 @itemx u @var{location}
5345 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5346 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5347 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5348 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5349 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5350 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5351 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5352 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5353 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5354 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5355 invocations have returned.
5356
5357 @smallexample
5358 94 int factorial (int value)
5359 95 @{
5360 96 if (value > 1) @{
5361 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5362 98 @}
5363 99 return (value);
5364 100 @}
5365 @end smallexample
5366
5367
5368 @kindex advance @var{location}
5369 @item advance @var{location}
5370 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5371 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5372 @ref{Specify Location}.
5373 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5374 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5375 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5376 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5377
5378
5379 @kindex stepi
5380 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5381 @item stepi
5382 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5383 @itemx si
5384 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5385
5386 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5387 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5388 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5389 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5390
5391 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5392
5393 @need 750
5394 @kindex nexti
5395 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5396 @item nexti
5397 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5398 @itemx ni
5399 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5400 proceed until the function returns.
5401
5402 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5403
5404 @end table
5405
5406 @anchor{range stepping}
5407 @cindex range stepping
5408 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5409 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5410 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5411 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5412 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5413 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5414 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5415 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5416 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5417 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5418 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5419 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5420 if necessary:
5421
5422 @table @code
5423 @kindex set range-stepping
5424 @kindex show range-stepping
5425 @item set range-stepping
5426 @itemx show range-stepping
5427 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5428
5429 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5430 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5431 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5432 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5433 default is @code{on}.
5434
5435 @end table
5436
5437 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5438 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5439 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5440
5441 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5442 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5443 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5444
5445 For example, consider the following C function:
5446
5447 @smallexample
5448 101 int func()
5449 102 @{
5450 103 foo(boring());
5451 104 bar(boring());
5452 105 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 @noindent
5456 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5457 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5458 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5459 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5460
5461 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5462 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5463 is called from many places.
5464
5465 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5466 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5467 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5468 @code{foo}.
5469
5470 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5471 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5472
5473 @table @code
5474 @kindex skip function
5475 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5476 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5477 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5478 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5479 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5480
5481 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5482 will be skipped.
5483
5484 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5485 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5486
5487 @kindex skip file
5488 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5489 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5490 will be skipped over when stepping.
5491
5492 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5493 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5494 @end table
5495
5496 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5497 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5498
5499 @table @code
5500 @kindex info skip
5501 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5502 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5503 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5504 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5505
5506 @table @emph
5507 @item Identifier
5508 A number identifying this skip.
5509 @item Type
5510 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5511 @item Enabled or Disabled
5512 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5513 @item Address
5514 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5515 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5516 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5517 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5518 address here.
5519 @item What
5520 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5521 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5522 where it is defined.
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @kindex skip delete
5526 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5527 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5528 skips.
5529
5530 @kindex skip enable
5531 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5532 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5533 skips.
5534
5535 @kindex skip disable
5536 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5537 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5538 skips.
5539
5540 @end table
5541
5542 @node Signals
5543 @section Signals
5544 @cindex signals
5545
5546 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5547 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5548 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5549 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5550 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5551 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5552 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5553 requested an alarm).
5554
5555 @cindex fatal signals
5556 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5557 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5558 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5559 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5560 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5561 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5562
5563 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5564 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5565 signal.
5566
5567 @cindex handling signals
5568 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5569 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5570 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5571 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5572 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5573
5574 @table @code
5575 @kindex info signals
5576 @kindex info handle
5577 @item info signals
5578 @itemx info handle
5579 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5580 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5581 the defined types of signals.
5582
5583 @item info signals @var{sig}
5584 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5585
5586 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5587
5588 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5589 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5590 for details about this command.
5591
5592 @kindex handle
5593 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5594 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5595 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5596 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5597 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5598 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5599 say what change to make.
5600 @end table
5601
5602 @c @group
5603 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5604 Their full names are:
5605
5606 @table @code
5607 @item nostop
5608 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5609 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5610
5611 @item stop
5612 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5613 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5614
5615 @item print
5616 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5617
5618 @item noprint
5619 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5620 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5621
5622 @item pass
5623 @itemx noignore
5624 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5625 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5626 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5627
5628 @item nopass
5629 @itemx ignore
5630 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5631 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5632 @end table
5633 @c @end group
5634
5635 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5636 program until you
5637 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5638 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5639 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5640 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5641 program sees that signal when you continue.
5642
5643 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5644 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5645 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5646 erroneous signals.
5647
5648 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5649 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5650 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5651 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5652 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5653 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5654 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5655 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5656 Program a Signal}.
5657
5658 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5659 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5660
5661 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5662 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5663 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5664 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5665 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5666 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5667 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5668 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5669 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5670 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5671 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5672 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5673 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5674
5675 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5676
5677 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5678 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5679 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5680 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5681
5682 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5683 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5684 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5685 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5686
5687 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5688 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5689
5690 @smallexample
5691 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5692 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5693 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5694 (@value{GDBP}) c
5695 Continuing.
5696
5697 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5698 main () sigusr1.c:28
5699 28 p = 0;
5700 (@value{GDBP}) si
5701 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5702 9 @{
5703 @end smallexample
5704
5705 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5706 program to receive the signal first:
5707
5708 @smallexample
5709 (@value{GDBP}) n
5710 28 p = 0;
5711 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5712 (@value{GDBP}) si
5713 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5714 9 @{
5715 (@value{GDBP})
5716 @end smallexample
5717
5718 @cindex extra signal information
5719 @anchor{extra signal information}
5720
5721 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5722 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5723 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5724 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5725 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5726 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5727 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5728 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5729 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5730 system header.
5731
5732 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5733 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5734
5735 @smallexample
5736 @group
5737 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5738 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5739 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5740 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5741 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5742 type = struct @{
5743 int si_signo;
5744 int si_errno;
5745 int si_code;
5746 union @{
5747 int _pad[28];
5748 struct @{...@} _kill;
5749 struct @{...@} _timer;
5750 struct @{...@} _rt;
5751 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5752 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5753 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5754 @} _sifields;
5755 @}
5756 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5757 type = struct @{
5758 void *si_addr;
5759 @}
5760 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5761 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5762 @end group
5763 @end smallexample
5764
5765 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5766
5767 @node Thread Stops
5768 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5769
5770 @cindex stopped threads
5771 @cindex threads, stopped
5772
5773 @cindex continuing threads
5774 @cindex threads, continuing
5775
5776 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5777 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5778 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5779 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5780 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5781 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5782 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5783 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5784 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5785
5786 @menu
5787 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5788 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5789 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5790 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5791 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5792 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5793 @end menu
5794
5795 @node All-Stop Mode
5796 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5797
5798 @cindex all-stop mode
5799
5800 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5801 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5802 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5803 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5804 underfoot.
5805
5806 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5807 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5808 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5809
5810 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5811 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5812 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5813 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5814 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5815 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5816 stops.
5817
5818 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5819 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5820 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5821 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5822
5823 @cindex automatic thread selection
5824 @cindex switching threads automatically
5825 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5826 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5827 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5828 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5829 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5830 thread.
5831
5832 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5833 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5834
5835 @table @code
5836 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5837 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5838 @cindex lock scheduler
5839 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5840 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5841 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5842 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5843 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5844 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5845 Other threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5846 completely free to run when you use commands
5847 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5848 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5849 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5850
5851 @item show scheduler-locking
5852 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5853 @end table
5854
5855 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5856 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5857 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5858 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5859 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5860 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5861 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5862 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5863 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5864 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5865 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5866 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5867 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5868 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5872 @item set schedule-multiple
5873 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5874 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5875 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5876 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5877 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5878 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5879
5880 @item show schedule-multiple
5881 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5882 multiple processes.
5883 @end table
5884
5885 @node Non-Stop Mode
5886 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5887
5888 @cindex non-stop mode
5889
5890 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5891 @c with more details.
5892
5893 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5894 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5895 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5896 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5897 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5898 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5899
5900 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5901 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5902 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5903 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5904 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5905 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5906 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5907 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5908 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5909 independently and simultaneously.
5910
5911 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5912 or attach to your program:
5913
5914 @smallexample
5915 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5916 set pagination off
5917
5918 # Finally, turn it on!
5919 set non-stop on
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5923
5924 @table @code
5925 @kindex set non-stop
5926 @item set non-stop on
5927 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5928 @item set non-stop off
5929 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5930 @kindex show non-stop
5931 @item show non-stop
5932 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5933 @end table
5934
5935 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5936 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5937 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5938 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5939 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5940 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5941 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5942 default.
5943
5944 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5945 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5946 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5947
5948 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5949 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5950 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5951 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5952 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5953
5954 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5955 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5956 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5957 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5958 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5959
5960 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5961
5962 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5963 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5964 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5965 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5966 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5967 previously current thread.
5968
5969 @node Background Execution
5970 @subsection Background Execution
5971
5972 @cindex foreground execution
5973 @cindex background execution
5974 @cindex asynchronous execution
5975 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5976
5977 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5978 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5979 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5980 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5981 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5982 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5983
5984 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5985 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5986
5987 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5988 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5989 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5990 are:
5991
5992 @table @code
5993 @kindex run&
5994 @item run
5995 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5996
5997 @item attach
5998 @kindex attach&
5999 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6000
6001 @item step
6002 @kindex step&
6003 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6004
6005 @item stepi
6006 @kindex stepi&
6007 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6008
6009 @item next
6010 @kindex next&
6011 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6012
6013 @item nexti
6014 @kindex nexti&
6015 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6016
6017 @item continue
6018 @kindex continue&
6019 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6020
6021 @item finish
6022 @kindex finish&
6023 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6024
6025 @item until
6026 @kindex until&
6027 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6028
6029 @end table
6030
6031 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6032 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6033 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6034 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6035 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6036 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6037
6038 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6039 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6040
6041 @table @code
6042 @kindex interrupt
6043 @item interrupt
6044 @itemx interrupt -a
6045
6046 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6047 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6048 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6049 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6050 @end table
6051
6052 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6053 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6054
6055 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6056 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6057 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6058
6059 @table @code
6060 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6061 @cindex thread breakpoints
6062 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6063 @item break @var{location} thread @var{threadno}
6064 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6065 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6066 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6067 specify some source line.
6068
6069 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6070 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6071 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6072 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6073 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6074
6075 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6076 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6077 program.
6078
6079 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6080 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6081 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6082
6083 @smallexample
6084 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6085 @end smallexample
6086
6087 @end table
6088
6089 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6090 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6091 thread list. For example:
6092
6093 @smallexample
6094 (@value{GDBP}) c
6095 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6099 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6100 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6101 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6102 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6103 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6104 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6105 command.
6106
6107 @node Interrupted System Calls
6108 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6109
6110 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6111 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6112 @cindex premature return from system calls
6113 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6114 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6115 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6116 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6117 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6118 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6119 stop execution.
6120
6121 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6122 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6123 style anyways.
6124
6125 For example, do not write code like this:
6126
6127 @smallexample
6128 sleep (10);
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6132 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6133
6134 Instead, write this:
6135
6136 @smallexample
6137 int unslept = 10;
6138 while (unslept > 0)
6139 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6140 @end smallexample
6141
6142 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6143 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6144 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6145 @value{GDBN}.
6146
6147 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6148 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6149 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6150 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6151
6152 @node Observer Mode
6153 @subsection Observer Mode
6154
6155 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6156 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6157 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6158 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6159 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6160
6161 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6162 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6163 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6164 mode.
6165
6166 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6167 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6168 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6169 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6170 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6171
6172 @table @code
6173
6174 @kindex observer
6175 @item set observer on
6176 @itemx set observer off
6177 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6178 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6179 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6180 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6181
6182 @item show observer
6183 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6184
6185 @kindex may-write-registers
6186 @item set may-write-registers on
6187 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6188 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6189 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6190 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6191
6192 @item show may-write-registers
6193 Show the current permission to write registers.
6194
6195 @kindex may-write-memory
6196 @item set may-write-memory on
6197 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6198 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6199 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6200 defaults to @code{on}.
6201
6202 @item show may-write-memory
6203 Show the current permission to write memory.
6204
6205 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6206 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6207 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6208 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6209 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6210 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6211
6212 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6213 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6214
6215 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6216 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6217 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6218 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6219 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6220 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6221 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6222
6223 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6224 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6225
6226 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6227 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6228 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6229 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6230 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6231 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6232 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6233
6234 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6235 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6236
6237 @kindex may-interrupt
6238 @item set may-interrupt on
6239 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6240 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6241 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6242 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6243 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6244
6245 @item show may-interrupt
6246 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6247
6248 @end table
6249
6250 @node Reverse Execution
6251 @chapter Running programs backward
6252 @cindex reverse execution
6253 @cindex running programs backward
6254
6255 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6256 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6257 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6258 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6259
6260 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6261 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6262 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6263 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6264 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6265 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6266
6267 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6268 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6269 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6270 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6271 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6272 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6273 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6274 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6275 prior values@footnote{
6276 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6277 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6278 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6279
6280 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6281 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6282 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6283 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6284 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6285 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6286 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6287 }.
6288
6289 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6290 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6291
6292 @table @code
6293 @kindex reverse-continue
6294 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6295 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6296 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6297 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6298 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6299 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6300 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6301
6302 @kindex reverse-step
6303 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6304 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6305 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6306 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6307
6308 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6309 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6310 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6311 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6312 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6313 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6314
6315 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6316 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6317
6318 @kindex reverse-stepi
6319 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6320 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6321 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6322 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6323 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6324 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6325 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6326
6327 @kindex reverse-next
6328 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6329 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6330 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6331 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6332 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6333 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6334 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6335 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6336 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6337 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6338
6339 @kindex reverse-nexti
6340 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6341 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6342 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6343 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6344 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6345 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6346 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6347 frame) is reached.
6348
6349 @kindex reverse-finish
6350 @item reverse-finish
6351 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6352 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6353 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6354 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6355
6356 @kindex set exec-direction
6357 @item set exec-direction
6358 Set the direction of target execution.
6359 @item set exec-direction reverse
6360 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6361 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6362 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6363 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6364 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6365 @item set exec-direction forward
6366 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6367 This is the default.
6368 @end table
6369
6370
6371 @node Process Record and Replay
6372 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6373 @cindex process record and replay
6374 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6375
6376 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6377 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6378 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6379
6380 @cindex replay mode
6381 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6382 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6383 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6384 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6385 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6386 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6387 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6388 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6389 execution log.
6390
6391 @cindex record mode
6392 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6393 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6394 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6395 for future replay.
6396
6397 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6398 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6399 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6400 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6401 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6402 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6403
6404 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6405 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6406 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6407 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6408
6409 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6410 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6411
6412 @table @code
6413 @kindex target record
6414 @kindex target record-full
6415 @kindex target record-btrace
6416 @kindex record
6417 @kindex record full
6418 @kindex record btrace
6419 @kindex record btrace bts
6420 @kindex record btrace pt
6421 @kindex record bts
6422 @kindex record pt
6423 @kindex rec
6424 @kindex rec full
6425 @kindex rec btrace
6426 @kindex rec btrace bts
6427 @kindex rec btrace pt
6428 @kindex rec bts
6429 @kindex rec pt
6430 @item record @var{method}
6431 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6432 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6433 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6434 recording methods are available:
6435
6436 @table @code
6437 @item full
6438 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6439 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6440 execution.
6441
6442 @item btrace @var{format}
6443 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6444 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6445 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6446 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6447 execution.
6448
6449 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6450 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6451 formats are available:
6452
6453 @table @code
6454 @item bts
6455 @cindex branch trace store
6456 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6457 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6458 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6459
6460 @item pt
6461 @cindex Intel(R) Processor Trace
6462 Use the @dfn{Intel(R) Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6463 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6464 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6465
6466 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6467 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6468 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6469
6470 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6471 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6472 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6473 buffer-size with care.
6474 @end table
6475
6476 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6477 @end table
6478
6479 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6480 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6481 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6482 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6483
6484 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6485 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6486 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6487 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6488 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6489
6490 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6491 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6492 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6493 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6494 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6495 does not support these two modes.
6496
6497 @kindex record stop
6498 @kindex rec s
6499 @item record stop
6500 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6501 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6502 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6503
6504 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6505 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6506 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6507 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6508 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6509
6510 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6511 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6512 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6513 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6514 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6515
6516 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6517 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6518
6519 @kindex record goto
6520 @item record goto
6521 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6522 ways to specify the location to go to:
6523
6524 @table @code
6525 @item record goto begin
6526 @itemx record goto start
6527 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6528
6529 @item record goto end
6530 Go to the end of the execution log.
6531
6532 @item record goto @var{n}
6533 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6534 @end table
6535
6536 @kindex record save
6537 @item record save @var{filename}
6538 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6539 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6540 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6541
6542 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6543
6544 @kindex record restore
6545 @item record restore @var{filename}
6546 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6547 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6548
6549 @kindex set record full
6550 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6551 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6552 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6553 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6554
6555 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6556 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6557 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6558 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6559 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6560 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6561 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6562 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6563
6564 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6565 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6566 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6567
6568 @kindex show record full
6569 @item show record full insn-number-max
6570 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6571 recording method.
6572
6573 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6574 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6575 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6576 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6577 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6578 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6579 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6580 oldest one to be deleted.
6581
6582 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6583 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6584
6585 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6586 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6587
6588 @item set record full memory-query
6589 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6590 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6591 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6592 case.
6593
6594 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6595 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6596 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6597 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6598 results.
6599
6600 @item show record full memory-query
6601 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6602
6603 @kindex set record btrace
6604 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6605 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6606 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6607 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6608 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6609 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6610 You can use the following command for that:
6611
6612 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6613 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6614 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6615 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6616 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6617 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6618 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6619 position.
6620
6621 @kindex show record btrace
6622 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6623 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6624
6625 @kindex set record btrace bts
6626 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6627 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6628 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6629 format. Default is 64KB.
6630
6631 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6632 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6633 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6634 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6635 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6636 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6637 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6638
6639 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6640 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6641
6642 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6643 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6644
6645 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6646 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6647 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6648
6649 @kindex set record btrace pt
6650 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6651 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6652 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel(R)
6653 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6654
6655 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6656 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6657 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel(R) Processor Trace
6658 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6659 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6660 actual buffer size for each thread.
6661
6662 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6663 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6664
6665 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6666 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6667
6668 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6669 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6670 tracing in Intel(R) Processor Trace format.
6671
6672 @kindex info record
6673 @item info record
6674 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6675 method:
6676
6677 @table @code
6678 @item full
6679 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6680 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6681
6682 @itemize @bullet
6683 @item
6684 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6685 @item
6686 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6687 @item
6688 Highest recorded instruction number.
6689 @item
6690 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6691 @item
6692 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6693 @item
6694 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6695 @end itemize
6696
6697 @item btrace
6698 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6699
6700 @itemize @bullet
6701 @item
6702 Recording format.
6703 @item
6704 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6705 @item
6706 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6707 instructions.
6708 @item
6709 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6710 @end itemize
6711
6712 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6713 @itemize @bullet
6714 @item
6715 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6716 @end itemize
6717
6718 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6719 @itemize @bullet
6720 @item
6721 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6722 @end itemize
6723 @end table
6724
6725 @kindex record delete
6726 @kindex rec del
6727 @item record delete
6728 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6729 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6730 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6731 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6732
6733 @kindex record instruction-history
6734 @kindex rec instruction-history
6735 @item record instruction-history
6736 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6737 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6738 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6739 are printed in execution order.
6740
6741 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6742 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6743
6744 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6745 disassemble:
6746
6747 @table @code
6748 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6749 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6750 @var{insn}.
6751
6752 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6753 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6754 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6755 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6756 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6757 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6758
6759 @item record instruction-history
6760 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6761
6762 @item record instruction-history -
6763 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6764
6765 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6766 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6767 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6768 number @var{end} is included.
6769 @end table
6770
6771 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6772
6773 @kindex set record
6774 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6775 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6776 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6777 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6778 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6779
6780 @kindex show record
6781 @item show record instruction-history-size
6782 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6783 instruction-history} command.
6784
6785 @kindex record function-call-history
6786 @kindex rec function-call-history
6787 @item record function-call-history
6788 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6789 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6790 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6791 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6792 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6793 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6794 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6795 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6796 given together.
6797
6798 @smallexample
6799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6800 1 void foo (void)
6801 2 @{
6802 3 @}
6803 4
6804 5 void bar (void)
6805 6 @{
6806 7 ...
6807 8 foo ();
6808 9 ...
6809 10 @}
6810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6811 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6812 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6813 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6814 @end smallexample
6815
6816 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6817 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6818 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6819 to print:
6820
6821 @table @code
6822 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6823 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6824
6825 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6826 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6827 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6828 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6829 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6830
6831 @item record function-call-history
6832 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6833
6834 @item record function-call-history -
6835 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6836
6837 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6838 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6839 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6840 @end table
6841
6842 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6843
6844 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6845 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6846 Define how many lines to print in the
6847 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6848 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6849
6850 @item show record function-call-history-size
6851 Show how many lines to print in the
6852 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6853 @end table
6854
6855
6856 @node Stack
6857 @chapter Examining the Stack
6858
6859 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6860 stopped and how it got there.
6861
6862 @cindex call stack
6863 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6864 is generated.
6865 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6866 the arguments of the call,
6867 and the local variables of the function being called.
6868 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6869 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6870 stack}.
6871
6872 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6873 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6874
6875 @cindex selected frame
6876 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6877 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6878 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6879 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6880 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6881 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6882
6883 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6884 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6885 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6886
6887 @menu
6888 * Frames:: Stack frames
6889 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6890 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6891 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6892 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6893
6894 @end menu
6895
6896 @node Frames
6897 @section Stack Frames
6898
6899 @cindex frame, definition
6900 @cindex stack frame
6901 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6902 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6903 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6904 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6905 which the function is executing.
6906
6907 @cindex initial frame
6908 @cindex outermost frame
6909 @cindex innermost frame
6910 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6911 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6912 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6913 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6914 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6915 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6916 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6917 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6918
6919 @cindex frame pointer
6920 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6921 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6922 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6923 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6924 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6925 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6926
6927 @cindex frame number
6928 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6929 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6930 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6931 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6932 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6933
6934 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6935 @c underflow problems.
6936 @cindex frameless execution
6937 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6938 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6939 @smallexample
6940 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6941 @end smallexample
6942 generates functions without a frame.)
6943 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6944 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6945 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6946 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6947 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6948 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6949 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6950
6951 @table @code
6952 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6953 @cindex current stack frame
6954 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6955 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6956 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6957 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6958 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6959
6960 @kindex select-frame
6961 @cindex selecting frame silently
6962 @item select-frame
6963 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6964 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6965 @code{frame}.
6966 @end table
6967
6968 @node Backtrace
6969 @section Backtraces
6970
6971 @cindex traceback
6972 @cindex call stack traces
6973 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6974 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6975 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6976 stack.
6977
6978 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6979 @table @code
6980 @kindex backtrace
6981 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6982 @item backtrace
6983 @itemx bt
6984 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6985 frames in the stack.
6986
6987 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6988 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6989
6990 @item backtrace @var{n}
6991 @itemx bt @var{n}
6992 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6993
6994 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6995 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6996 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6997
6998 @item backtrace full
6999 @itemx bt full
7000 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7001 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7002 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7003 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7004
7005 @item backtrace no-filters
7006 @itemx bt no-filters
7007 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7008 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7009 @itemx bt no-filters full
7010 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7011 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7012 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7013 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7014 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7015 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7016 support.
7017 @end table
7018
7019 @kindex where
7020 @kindex info stack
7021 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7022 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7023
7024 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7025 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7026 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7027 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7028 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7029 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7030 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7031 multi-threaded program.
7032
7033 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7034 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7035 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7036 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7037 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7038 line number.
7039
7040 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7041 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7042
7043 @smallexample
7044 @group
7045 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7046 at builtin.c:993
7047 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7048 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7049 at macro.c:71
7050 (More stack frames follow...)
7051 @end group
7052 @end smallexample
7053
7054 @noindent
7055 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7056 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7057 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7058
7059 @noindent
7060 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7061 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7062 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7063 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7064 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7065
7066 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7067 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7068 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7069 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7070 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7071 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7072 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7073 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7074 such a backtrace might look like:
7075
7076 @smallexample
7077 @group
7078 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7079 at builtin.c:993
7080 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7081 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7082 at macro.c:71
7083 (More stack frames follow...)
7084 @end group
7085 @end smallexample
7086
7087 @noindent
7088 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7089 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7090
7091 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7092 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7093 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7094
7095 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7096 @cindex program entry point
7097 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7098 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7099 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7100 @code{main}@footnote{
7101 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7102 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7103 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7104 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7105 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7106 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7107
7108 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7109 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7110
7111 @table @code
7112 @item set backtrace past-main
7113 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7114 @kindex set backtrace
7115 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7116
7117 @item set backtrace past-main off
7118 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7119 default.
7120
7121 @item show backtrace past-main
7122 @kindex show backtrace
7123 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7124
7125 @item set backtrace past-entry
7126 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7127 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7128 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7129 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7130
7131 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7132 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7133 application. This is the default.
7134
7135 @item show backtrace past-entry
7136 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7137
7138 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7139 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7140 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7141 @cindex backtrace limit
7142 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7143 or zero means unlimited levels.
7144
7145 @item show backtrace limit
7146 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7147 @end table
7148
7149 You can control how file names are displayed.
7150
7151 @table @code
7152 @item set filename-display
7153 @itemx set filename-display relative
7154 @cindex filename-display
7155 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7156
7157 @item set filename-display basename
7158 Display only basename of a filename.
7159
7160 @item set filename-display absolute
7161 Display an absolute filename.
7162
7163 @item show filename-display
7164 Show the current way to display filenames.
7165 @end table
7166
7167 @node Frame Filter Management
7168 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7169 @cindex managing frame filters
7170
7171 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7172 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7173
7174 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7175 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7176
7177 @table @code
7178 @kindex info frame-filter
7179 @item info frame-filter
7180 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7181 their name, priority and enabled status.
7182
7183 @kindex disable frame-filter
7184 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7185 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7186 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7187 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7188 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7189 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7190 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7191 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7192 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7193 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7194 may be enabled again later.
7195
7196 @kindex enable frame-filter
7197 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7198 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7199 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7200 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7201 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7202 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7203 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7204 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7205 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7206
7207 Example:
7208
7209 @smallexample
7210 (gdb) info frame-filter
7211
7212 global frame-filters:
7213 Priority Enabled Name
7214 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7215 100 Yes Reverse
7216
7217 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7218 Priority Enabled Name
7219 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7220
7221 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7222 Priority Enabled Name
7223 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7224
7225 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7226 (gdb) info frame-filter
7227
7228 global frame-filters:
7229 Priority Enabled Name
7230 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7231 100 Yes Reverse
7232
7233 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7234 Priority Enabled Name
7235 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7236
7237 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7238 Priority Enabled Name
7239 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7240
7241 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7242 (gdb) info frame-filter
7243
7244 global frame-filters:
7245 Priority Enabled Name
7246 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7247 100 Yes Reverse
7248
7249 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7250 Priority Enabled Name
7251 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7252
7253 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7254 Priority Enabled Name
7255 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7256 @end smallexample
7257
7258 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7259 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7260 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7261 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7262 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7263 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7264 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7265
7266 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7267 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7268 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7269 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7270 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7271 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7272 dictionary resides.
7273
7274 Example:
7275
7276 @smallexample
7277 (gdb) info frame-filter
7278
7279 global frame-filters:
7280 Priority Enabled Name
7281 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7282 100 Yes Reverse
7283
7284 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7285 Priority Enabled Name
7286 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7287
7288 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7289 Priority Enabled Name
7290 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7291
7292 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7293 (gdb) info frame-filter
7294
7295 global frame-filters:
7296 Priority Enabled Name
7297 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7298 50 Yes Reverse
7299
7300 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7301 Priority Enabled Name
7302 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7303
7304 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7305 Priority Enabled Name
7306 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7307 @end smallexample
7308 @end table
7309
7310 @node Selection
7311 @section Selecting a Frame
7312
7313 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7314 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7315 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7316 of the stack frame just selected.
7317
7318 @table @code
7319 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7320 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7321 @item frame @var{n}
7322 @itemx f @var{n}
7323 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7324 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7325 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7326 @code{main}.
7327
7328 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7329 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7330 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7331 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7332 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7333 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7334 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7335 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7336
7337 @kindex up
7338 @item up @var{n}
7339 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7340 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7341 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7342
7343 @kindex down
7344 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7345 @item down @var{n}
7346 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7347 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7348 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7349 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7350 @end table
7351
7352 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7353 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7354 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7355 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7356
7357 @need 1000
7358 For example:
7359
7360 @smallexample
7361 @group
7362 (@value{GDBP}) up
7363 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7364 at env.c:10
7365 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7366 @end group
7367 @end smallexample
7368
7369 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7370 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7371 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7372 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7373 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7374 for details.
7375
7376 @table @code
7377 @kindex down-silently
7378 @kindex up-silently
7379 @item up-silently @var{n}
7380 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7381 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7382 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7383 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7384 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7385 distracting.
7386 @end table
7387
7388 @node Frame Info
7389 @section Information About a Frame
7390
7391 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7392 stack frame.
7393
7394 @table @code
7395 @item frame
7396 @itemx f
7397 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7398 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7399 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7400 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7401 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7402
7403 @kindex info frame
7404 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7405 @item info frame
7406 @itemx info f
7407 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7408 including:
7409
7410 @itemize @bullet
7411 @item
7412 the address of the frame
7413 @item
7414 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7415 @item
7416 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7417 @item
7418 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7419 @item
7420 the address of the frame's arguments
7421 @item
7422 the address of the frame's local variables
7423 @item
7424 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7425 @item
7426 which registers were saved in the frame
7427 @end itemize
7428
7429 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7430 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7431 the usual conventions.
7432
7433 @item info frame @var{addr}
7434 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7435 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7436 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7437 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7438 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7439 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7440
7441 @kindex info args
7442 @item info args
7443 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7444
7445 @item info locals
7446 @kindex info locals
7447 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7448 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7449 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7450
7451 @end table
7452
7453
7454 @node Source
7455 @chapter Examining Source Files
7456
7457 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7458 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7459 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7460 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7461 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7462 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7463 source files by explicit command.
7464
7465 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7466 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7467 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7468
7469 @menu
7470 * List:: Printing source lines
7471 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7472 * Edit:: Editing source files
7473 * Search:: Searching source files
7474 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7475 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7476 @end menu
7477
7478 @node List
7479 @section Printing Source Lines
7480
7481 @kindex list
7482 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7483 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7484 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7485 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7486 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7487
7488 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7489
7490 @table @code
7491 @item list @var{linenum}
7492 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7493 current source file.
7494
7495 @item list @var{function}
7496 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7497 @var{function}.
7498
7499 @item list
7500 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7501 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7502 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7503 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7504 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7505
7506 @item list -
7507 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7508 @end table
7509
7510 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7511 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7512 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7513
7514 @table @code
7515 @kindex set listsize
7516 @item set listsize @var{count}
7517 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7518 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7519 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7520 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7521
7522 @kindex show listsize
7523 @item show listsize
7524 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7525 @end table
7526
7527 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7528 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7529 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7530 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7531 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7532
7533 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7534 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7535 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7536 to specify some source line.
7537
7538 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7539
7540 @table @code
7541 @item list @var{location}
7542 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7543
7544 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7545 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7546 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7547 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7548 the same source file as the first location.
7549
7550 @item list ,@var{last}
7551 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7552
7553 @item list @var{first},
7554 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7555
7556 @item list +
7557 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7558
7559 @item list -
7560 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7561
7562 @item list
7563 As described in the preceding table.
7564 @end table
7565
7566 @node Specify Location
7567 @section Specifying a Location
7568 @cindex specifying location
7569 @cindex location
7570 @cindex source location
7571
7572 @menu
7573 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7574 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7575 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7576 @end menu
7577
7578 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7579 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7580 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7581 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7582 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7583
7584 @node Linespec Locations
7585 @subsection Linespec Locations
7586 @cindex linespec locations
7587
7588 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7589 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7590 specifying a linespec:
7591
7592 @table @code
7593 @item @var{linenum}
7594 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7595
7596 @item -@var{offset}
7597 @itemx +@var{offset}
7598 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7599 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7600 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7601 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7602 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7603 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7604 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7605 linespec.
7606
7607 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7608 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7609 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7610 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7611 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7612 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7613 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7614
7615 @item @var{function}
7616 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7617 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7618
7619 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7620 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7621
7622 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7623 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7624 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7625 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7626 functions in different source files.
7627
7628 @item @var{label}
7629 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7630 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7631 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7632 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7633
7634 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7635 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7636 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7637 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7638 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7639 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7640
7641 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7642 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7643 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7644 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7645 each one of those probes.
7646 @end table
7647
7648 @node Explicit Locations
7649 @subsection Explicit Locations
7650 @cindex explicit locations
7651
7652 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7653 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7654
7655 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7656 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7657 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7658 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7659 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7660
7661 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7662 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7663 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7664 the symbol table to know.
7665
7666 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7667 following table:
7668
7669 @table @code
7670 @item -source @var{filename}
7671 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7672 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7673 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7674 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7675 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7676
7677 @item -function @var{function}
7678 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7679 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7680 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7681 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7682
7683 @item -label @var{label}
7684 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7685 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7686 selected stack frame.
7687
7688 @item -line @var{number}
7689 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7690 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7691 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7692 relative to the current line.
7693 @end table
7694
7695 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7696 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7697
7698 @node Address Locations
7699 @subsection Address Locations
7700 @cindex address locations
7701
7702 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7703 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7704
7705 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7706 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7707 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7708 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7709 source files.
7710
7711 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7712 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7713 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7714 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7715 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7716 of @var{address}:
7717
7718 @table @code
7719 @item @var{expression}
7720 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7721
7722 @item @var{funcaddr}
7723 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7724 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7725 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7726 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7727 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7728 (although the Pascal form also works).
7729
7730 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7731 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7732
7733 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7734 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7735 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7736 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7737 functions with identical names in different source files.
7738 @end table
7739
7740 @node Edit
7741 @section Editing Source Files
7742 @cindex editing source files
7743
7744 @kindex edit
7745 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7746 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7747 The editing program of your choice
7748 is invoked with the current line set to
7749 the active line in the program.
7750 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7751 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7752
7753 @table @code
7754 @item edit @var{location}
7755 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7756 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7757 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7758 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7759 command most commonly used:
7760
7761 @table @code
7762 @item edit @var{number}
7763 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7764
7765 @item edit @var{function}
7766 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7767 @end table
7768
7769 @end table
7770
7771 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7772 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7773 @footnote{
7774 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7775 following command-line syntax:
7776 @smallexample
7777 ex +@var{number} file
7778 @end smallexample
7779 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7780 the file where to start editing.}.
7781 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7782 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7783 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7784 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7785 @smallexample
7786 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7787 export EDITOR
7788 gdb @dots{}
7789 @end smallexample
7790 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7791 @smallexample
7792 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7793 gdb @dots{}
7794 @end smallexample
7795
7796 @node Search
7797 @section Searching Source Files
7798 @cindex searching source files
7799
7800 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7801 regular expression.
7802
7803 @table @code
7804 @kindex search
7805 @kindex forward-search
7806 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7807 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7808 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7809 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7810 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7811 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7812 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7813 @code{fo}.
7814
7815 @kindex reverse-search
7816 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7817 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7818 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7819 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7820 this command as @code{rev}.
7821 @end table
7822
7823 @node Source Path
7824 @section Specifying Source Directories
7825
7826 @cindex source path
7827 @cindex directories for source files
7828 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7829 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7830 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7831 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7832 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7833 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7834 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7835
7836 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7837 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7838 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7839 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7840 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7841 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7842 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7843 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7844 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7845 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7846 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7847
7848 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7849 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7850 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7851 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7852 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7853 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7854
7855 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7856 source files.
7857
7858 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7859 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7860 each line is in the file.
7861
7862 @kindex directory
7863 @kindex dir
7864 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7865 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7866 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7867
7868 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7869 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7870
7871 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7872 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7873 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7874 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7875 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7876 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7877 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7878 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7879 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7880 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7881 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7882 name to look up the sources.
7883
7884 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7885 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7886 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7887 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7888 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7889 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7890 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7891 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7892
7893 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7894 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7895 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7896 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7897 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7898 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7899 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7900
7901 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7902 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7903 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7904 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7905 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7906 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7907 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7908 command.
7909
7910 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7911 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7912 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7913 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7914 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7915 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7916 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7917
7918 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7919 @cindex default source path substitution
7920 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7921 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7922 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7923 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7924 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7925 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7926 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7927 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7928 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7929 together.
7930
7931 @table @code
7932 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7933 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7934 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7935 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7936 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7937 part of absolute file names) or
7938 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7939 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7940
7941 @kindex cdir
7942 @kindex cwd
7943 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7944 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7945 @cindex compilation directory
7946 @cindex current directory
7947 @cindex working directory
7948 @cindex directory, current
7949 @cindex directory, compilation
7950 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7951 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7952 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7953 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7954 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7955 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7956
7957 @item directory
7958 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7959
7960 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7961 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7962
7963 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7964 @kindex set directories
7965 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7966 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7967
7968 @item show directories
7969 @kindex show directories
7970 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7971
7972 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7973 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7974 @kindex set substitute-path
7975 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7976 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7977 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7978
7979 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7980 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7981
7982 @smallexample
7983 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986 @noindent
7987 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7988 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7989 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7990
7991 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7992 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7993 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7994 the substitution.
7995
7996 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7997
7998 @smallexample
7999 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8000 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8001 @end smallexample
8002
8003 @noindent
8004 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8005 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8006 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8007 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8008
8009
8010 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8011 @kindex unset substitute-path
8012 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8013 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8014 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8015
8016 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8017
8018 @item show substitute-path [path]
8019 @kindex show substitute-path
8020 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8021 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8022
8023 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8024 rules.
8025
8026 @end table
8027
8028 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8029 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8030 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8031
8032 @enumerate
8033 @item
8034 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8035
8036 @item
8037 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8038 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8039 directories in one command.
8040 @end enumerate
8041
8042 @node Machine Code
8043 @section Source and Machine Code
8044 @cindex source line and its code address
8045
8046 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8047 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8048 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8049 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8050 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8051 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8052 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8053 well as hex.
8054
8055 @table @code
8056 @kindex info line
8057 @item info line @var{location}
8058 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8059 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8060 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8061 @end table
8062
8063 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8064 the object code for the first line of function
8065 @code{m4_changequote}:
8066
8067 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8068 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8069 @smallexample
8070 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8071 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8072 @end smallexample
8073
8074 @noindent
8075 @cindex code address and its source line
8076 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8077 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8078 @smallexample
8079 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8080 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8081 @end smallexample
8082
8083 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8084 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8085 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8086 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8087 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8088 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8089 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8090 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8091 Variables}).
8092
8093 @table @code
8094 @kindex disassemble
8095 @cindex assembly instructions
8096 @cindex instructions, assembly
8097 @cindex machine instructions
8098 @cindex listing machine instructions
8099 @item disassemble
8100 @itemx disassemble /m
8101 @itemx disassemble /s
8102 @itemx disassemble /r
8103 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8104 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8105 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8106 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8107 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8108 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8109 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8110 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8111 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8112 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8113
8114 @table @code
8115 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8116 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8117 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8118 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8119 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8120 @end table
8121
8122 @noindent
8123 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8124 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8125
8126 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8127 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8128
8129 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8130 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8131 @end table
8132
8133 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8134 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8135
8136 @smallexample
8137 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8138 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8139 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8140 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8141 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8142 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8143 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8144 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8145 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8146 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8147 End of assembler dump.
8148 @end smallexample
8149
8150 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8151 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8152 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8153
8154 @smallexample
8155 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8156 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8157 5 @{
8158 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8159 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8160 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8161 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8162 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8163
8164 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8165 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8166 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8167
8168 7 return 0;
8169 8 @}
8170 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8171 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8172 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8173
8174 End of assembler dump.
8175 @end smallexample
8176
8177 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8178 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8179 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8180 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8181 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8182 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8183 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8184 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8185 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8186
8187 @file{foo.h}:
8188
8189 @smallexample
8190 int
8191 foo (int a)
8192 @{
8193 if (a < 0)
8194 return a * 2;
8195 if (a == 0)
8196 return 1;
8197 return a + 10;
8198 @}
8199 @end smallexample
8200
8201 @file{foo.c}:
8202
8203 @smallexample
8204 #include "foo.h"
8205 volatile int x, y;
8206 int
8207 main ()
8208 @{
8209 x = foo (y);
8210 return 0;
8211 @}
8212 @end smallexample
8213
8214 @smallexample
8215 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8216 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8217 5 @{
8218
8219 6 x = foo (y);
8220 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8221 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8222
8223 7 return 0;
8224 8 @}
8225 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8226 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8227 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8228 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8229
8230 End of assembler dump.
8231 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8232 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8233 foo.c:
8234 5 @{
8235 6 x = foo (y);
8236 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8237
8238 foo.h:
8239 4 if (a < 0)
8240 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8241 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8242
8243 6 if (a == 0)
8244 7 return 1;
8245 8 return a + 10;
8246 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8247 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8248 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8249 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8250
8251 foo.c:
8252 6 x = foo (y);
8253 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8254
8255 7 return 0;
8256 8 @}
8257 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8258 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8259
8260 foo.h:
8261 5 return a * 2;
8262 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8263 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8264 End of assembler dump.
8265 @end smallexample
8266
8267 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8268
8269 @smallexample
8270 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8271 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8272 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8273 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8274 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8275 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8276 End of assembler dump.
8277 @end smallexample
8278
8279 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8280 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8281 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8282 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8283
8284 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8285 mnemonics or other syntax.
8286
8287 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8288 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8289 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8290 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8291 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8292
8293 @table @code
8294 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8295 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8296 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8297 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8298 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8299 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8300
8301 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8302 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8303 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8304 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8305
8306 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8307 @item show disassembly-flavor
8308 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8309 @end table
8310
8311 @table @code
8312 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8313 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8314 @item set disassemble-next-line
8315 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8316 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8317 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8318 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8319 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8320 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8321 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8322 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8323 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8324 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8325 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8326 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8327 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8328 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8329 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8330 instruction.
8331 @end table
8332
8333
8334 @node Data
8335 @chapter Examining Data
8336
8337 @cindex printing data
8338 @cindex examining data
8339 @kindex print
8340 @kindex inspect
8341 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8342 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8343 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8344 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8345 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8346 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8347
8348 @table @code
8349 @item print @var{expr}
8350 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8351 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8352 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8353 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8354 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8355 Formats}.
8356
8357 @item print
8358 @itemx print /@var{f}
8359 @cindex reprint the last value
8360 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8361 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8362 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8363 @end table
8364
8365 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8366 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8367 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8368
8369 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8370 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8371 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8372 Table}.
8373
8374 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8375 @kindex explore
8376 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8377 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8378 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8379 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8380 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8381 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8382 embedded in the higher level data types.
8383
8384 @table @code
8385 @item explore @var{arg}
8386 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8387 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8388 @end table
8389
8390 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8391 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8392 C program as
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 struct SimpleStruct
8396 @{
8397 int i;
8398 double d;
8399 @};
8400
8401 struct ComplexStruct
8402 @{
8403 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8404 int arr[10];
8405 @};
8406 @end smallexample
8407
8408 @noindent
8409 followed by variable declarations as
8410
8411 @smallexample
8412 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8413 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8414 @end smallexample
8415
8416 @noindent
8417 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8418 @code{explore} command as follows.
8419
8420 @smallexample
8421 (gdb) explore cs
8422 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8423 the following fields:
8424
8425 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8426 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8427
8428 Enter the field number of choice:
8429 @end smallexample
8430
8431 @noindent
8432 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8433 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8434 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8435 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8436 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8437 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8438 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8439 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8440
8441 @smallexample
8442 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8443 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8444 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8445 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8446
8447 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8448 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8449
8450 Press enter to return to parent value:
8451 @end smallexample
8452
8453 @noindent
8454 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8455 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8456 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8457 to explore.
8458
8459 @smallexample
8460 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8461 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8462
8463 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8464
8465 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8466
8467 Press enter to return to parent value:
8468 @end smallexample
8469
8470 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8471 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8472 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8473 level data structure).
8474
8475 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8476 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8477 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8478 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8479 same example as above, your can explore the type
8480 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8481 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8482
8483 @smallexample
8484 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8485 @end smallexample
8486
8487 @noindent
8488 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8489 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8490 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8491 example.
8492
8493 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8494 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8495 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8496 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8497 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8498
8499 @table @code
8500 @item explore value @var{expr}
8501 @cindex explore value
8502 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8503 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8504 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8505 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8506 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8507
8508 @item explore type @var{arg}
8509 @cindex explore type
8510 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8511 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8512 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8513 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8514 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8515 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8516 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8517 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8518 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8519 @end table
8520
8521 @menu
8522 * Expressions:: Expressions
8523 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8524 * Variables:: Program variables
8525 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8526 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8527 * Memory:: Examining memory
8528 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8529 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8530 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8531 * Value History:: Value history
8532 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8533 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8534 * Registers:: Registers
8535 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8536 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8537 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8538 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8539 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8540 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8541 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8542 character set than GDB does
8543 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8544 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8545 @end menu
8546
8547 @node Expressions
8548 @section Expressions
8549
8550 @cindex expressions
8551 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8552 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8553 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8554 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8555 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8556 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8557 @ref{Compilation}.
8558
8559 @cindex arrays in expressions
8560 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8561 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8562 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8563 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8564 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8565 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8566
8567 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8568 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8569 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8570 languages.
8571
8572 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8573 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8574
8575 @cindex casts, in expressions
8576 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8577 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8578 at that address in memory.
8579 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8580
8581 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8582 to programming languages:
8583
8584 @table @code
8585 @item @@
8586 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8587 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8588
8589 @item ::
8590 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8591 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8592
8593 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8594 @cindex type casting memory
8595 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8596 @cindex casts, to view memory
8597 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8598 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8599 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8600 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8601 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8602 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8603 @end table
8604
8605 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8606 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8607 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8608
8609 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8610 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8611 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8612 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8613 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8614 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8615 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8616
8617 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8618 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8619 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8620 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8621 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8622 as well.
8623
8624 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8625 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8626 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8627 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8628 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8629 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8630 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8631 choices.
8632
8633 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8634 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8635 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8636
8637 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8638 @smallexample
8639 @group
8640 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8641 [0] cancel
8642 [1] all
8643 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8644 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8645 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8646 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8647 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8648 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8649 > 2 4 6
8650 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8651 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8652 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8653 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8654 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8655 breakpoints.
8656 (@value{GDBP})
8657 @end group
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 @table @code
8661 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8662 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8663 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8664
8665 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8666 is ambiguous.
8667
8668 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8669 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8670 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8671 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8672 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8673 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8674 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8675 in the use of the menu.
8676
8677 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8678 when an ambiguity is detected.
8679
8680 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8681 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8682
8683 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8684 @item show multiple-symbols
8685 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8686 @end table
8687
8688 @node Variables
8689 @section Program Variables
8690
8691 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8692 in your program.
8693
8694 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8695 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8696
8697 @itemize @bullet
8698 @item
8699 global (or file-static)
8700 @end itemize
8701
8702 @noindent or
8703
8704 @itemize @bullet
8705 @item
8706 visible according to the scope rules of the
8707 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8708 @end itemize
8709
8710 @noindent This means that in the function
8711
8712 @smallexample
8713 foo (a)
8714 int a;
8715 @{
8716 bar (a);
8717 @{
8718 int b = test ();
8719 bar (b);
8720 @}
8721 @}
8722 @end smallexample
8723
8724 @noindent
8725 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8726 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8727 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8728 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8729
8730 @cindex variable name conflict
8731 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8732 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8733 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8734 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8735 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8736 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8737 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8738
8739 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8740 @ifnotinfo
8741 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8742 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8743 @end ifnotinfo
8744 @smallexample
8745 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8746 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8747 @end smallexample
8748
8749 @noindent
8750 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8751 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8752 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8753 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8754
8755 @smallexample
8756 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8757 @end smallexample
8758
8759 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8760 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8761 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8762 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8763 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8764
8765 @smallexample
8766 void
8767 foo (int a)
8768 @{
8769 if (a < 10)
8770 bar (a);
8771 else
8772 process (a); /* Stop here */
8773 @}
8774
8775 int
8776 bar (int a)
8777 @{
8778 foo (a + 5);
8779 @}
8780 @end smallexample
8781
8782 @noindent
8783 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8784 here is what you might see
8785 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8786
8787 @smallexample
8788 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8789 $1 = 10
8790 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8791 $2 = 5
8792 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8793 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8794 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8795 $3 = 5
8796 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8797 $4 = 0
8798 @end smallexample
8799
8800 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8801 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8802 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8803 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8804 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8805
8806 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8807 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8808 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8809 @code{some_global}.
8810
8811 @smallexample
8812 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8813 $1 = 23
8814 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8815 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8816 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8817 $2 = 27
8818 @end smallexample
8819
8820 @cindex wrong values
8821 @cindex variable values, wrong
8822 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8823 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8824 @quotation
8825 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8826 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8827 scope, and just before exit.
8828 @end quotation
8829 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8830 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8831 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8832 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8833 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8834 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8835 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8836 variable definitions may be gone.
8837
8838 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8839 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8840 when compiling.
8841
8842 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8843 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8844 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8845 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8846 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8847 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8848 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8849
8850 @smallexample
8851 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8852 @end smallexample
8853
8854 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8855 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8856 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8857 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8858 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8859
8860 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8861 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8862 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8863 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8864
8865 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8866 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8867 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8868 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8869 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8870
8871 @smallexample
8872 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8873 29 i++;
8874 (gdb) next
8875 30 e (i);
8876 (gdb) print i
8877 $1 = 31
8878 (gdb) print i@@entry
8879 $2 = 30
8880 @end smallexample
8881
8882 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8883 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8884 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8885 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8886 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8887 For program code
8888
8889 @smallexample
8890 char var0[] = "A";
8891 signed char var1[] = "A";
8892 @end smallexample
8893
8894 You get during debugging
8895 @smallexample
8896 (gdb) print var0
8897 $1 = "A"
8898 (gdb) print var1
8899 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8900 @end smallexample
8901
8902 @node Arrays
8903 @section Artificial Arrays
8904
8905 @cindex artificial array
8906 @cindex arrays
8907 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8908 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8909 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8910 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8911 program.
8912
8913 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8914 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8915 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8916 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8917 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8918 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8919 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8920 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8921 example. If a program says
8922
8923 @smallexample
8924 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8925 @end smallexample
8926
8927 @noindent
8928 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8929
8930 @smallexample
8931 p *array@@len
8932 @end smallexample
8933
8934 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8935 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8936 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8937 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8938 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8939
8940 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8941 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8942 The value need not be in memory:
8943 @smallexample
8944 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8945 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8946 @end smallexample
8947
8948 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8949 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8950 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8951 @smallexample
8952 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8953 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8954 @end smallexample
8955
8956 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8957 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8958 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8959 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8960 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8961 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8962 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8963 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8964 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8965 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8966
8967 @smallexample
8968 set $i = 0
8969 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8970 @key{RET}
8971 @key{RET}
8972 @dots{}
8973 @end smallexample
8974
8975 @node Output Formats
8976 @section Output Formats
8977
8978 @cindex formatted output
8979 @cindex output formats
8980 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8981 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8982 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8983 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8984 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8985
8986 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8987 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8988 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8989 letters supported are:
8990
8991 @table @code
8992 @item x
8993 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8994 hexadecimal.
8995
8996 @item d
8997 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8998
8999 @item u
9000 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9001
9002 @item o
9003 Print as integer in octal.
9004
9005 @item t
9006 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9007 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9008 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9009 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9010
9011 @item a
9012 @cindex unknown address, locating
9013 @cindex locate address
9014 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9015 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9016 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9017
9018 @smallexample
9019 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9020 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9021 @end smallexample
9022
9023 @noindent
9024 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9025 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9026
9027 @item c
9028 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9029 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9030 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9031 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9032
9033 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9034 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9035 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9036 data.
9037
9038 @item f
9039 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9040 using typical floating point syntax.
9041
9042 @item s
9043 @cindex printing strings
9044 @cindex printing byte arrays
9045 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9046 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9047 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9048 natural types.
9049
9050 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9051 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9052 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9053 array.
9054
9055 @item z
9056 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9057 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9058 to the size of the integer type.
9059
9060 @item r
9061 @cindex raw printing
9062 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9063 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9064 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9065 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9066 pretty-printer which might exist.
9067 @end table
9068
9069 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9070
9071 @smallexample
9072 p/x $pc
9073 @end smallexample
9074
9075 @noindent
9076 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9077 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9078
9079 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9080 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9081 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9082
9083 @node Memory
9084 @section Examining Memory
9085
9086 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9087 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9088
9089 @cindex examining memory
9090 @table @code
9091 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9092 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9093 @itemx x @var{addr}
9094 @itemx x
9095 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9096 @end table
9097
9098 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9099 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9100 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9101 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9102 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9103
9104 @table @r
9105 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9106 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9107 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
9108 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9109 @c 4.1.2.
9110
9111 @item @var{f}, the display format
9112 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9113 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9114 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9115 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9116 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9117
9118 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9119 The unit size is any of
9120
9121 @table @code
9122 @item b
9123 Bytes.
9124 @item h
9125 Halfwords (two bytes).
9126 @item w
9127 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9128 @item g
9129 Giant words (eight bytes).
9130 @end table
9131
9132 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9133 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9134 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9135 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9136 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9137 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9138 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9139 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9140 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9141 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9142 be altered.
9143
9144 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9145 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9146 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9147 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9148 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9149 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9150 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9151 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9152 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9153 a value from memory).
9154 @end table
9155
9156 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9157 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9158 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9159 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9160 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9161
9162 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9163 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9164 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9165 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9166 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9167
9168 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9169 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9170 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9171 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9172 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9173 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9174 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9175 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9176 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9177
9178 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9179 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9180 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9181 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9182 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9183 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9184 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9185
9186 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9187 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9188
9189 @smallexample
9190 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9191 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9192 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9193 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9194 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9195 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9196 @end smallexample
9197
9198 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9199 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9200 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9201 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9202 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9203 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9204 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9205 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9206 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9207
9208 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9209 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9210 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9211
9212 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9213 @cindex addressable memory unit
9214 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9215 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9216 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9217 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9218 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9219 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9220 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9221 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9222 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9223
9224 @cindex remote memory comparison
9225 @cindex target memory comparison
9226 @cindex verify remote memory image
9227 @cindex verify target memory image
9228 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9229 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9230 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9231 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9232 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9233 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9234
9235 @table @code
9236 @kindex compare-sections
9237 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9238 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9239 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9240 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9241 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9242 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9243
9244 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9245 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9246 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9247 @end table
9248
9249 @node Auto Display
9250 @section Automatic Display
9251 @cindex automatic display
9252 @cindex display of expressions
9253
9254 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9255 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9256 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9257 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9258 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9259 The automatic display looks like this:
9260
9261 @smallexample
9262 2: foo = 38
9263 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9264 @end smallexample
9265
9266 @noindent
9267 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9268 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9269 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9270 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9271 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9272 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9273
9274 @table @code
9275 @kindex display
9276 @item display @var{expr}
9277 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9278 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9279
9280 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9281
9282 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9283 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9284 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9285 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9286 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9287
9288 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9289 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9290 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9291 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9292 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9293 @end table
9294
9295 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9296 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9297 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9298
9299 @table @code
9300 @kindex delete display
9301 @kindex undisplay
9302 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9303 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9304 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9305 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9306 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9307 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9308 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9309
9310 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9311 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9312
9313 @kindex disable display
9314 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9315 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9316 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9317 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9318 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9319 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9320 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9321 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9322
9323 @kindex enable display
9324 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9325 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9326 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9327 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9328 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9329 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9330 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9331
9332 @item display
9333 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9334 done when your program stops.
9335
9336 @kindex info display
9337 @item info display
9338 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9339 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9340 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9341 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9342 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9343 @end table
9344
9345 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9346 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9347 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9348 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9349 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9350 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9351 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9352 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9353 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9354 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9355 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9356
9357 @node Print Settings
9358 @section Print Settings
9359
9360 @cindex format options
9361 @cindex print settings
9362 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9363 and symbols are printed.
9364
9365 @noindent
9366 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9367
9368 @table @code
9369 @kindex set print
9370 @item set print address
9371 @itemx set print address on
9372 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9373 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9374 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9375 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9376 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9377 @code{set print address on}:
9378
9379 @smallexample
9380 @group
9381 (@value{GDBP}) f
9382 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9383 at input.c:530
9384 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9385 @end group
9386 @end smallexample
9387
9388 @item set print address off
9389 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9390 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 @group
9394 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9395 (@value{GDBP}) f
9396 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9397 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9398 @end group
9399 @end smallexample
9400
9401 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9402 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9403 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9404 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9405
9406 @kindex show print
9407 @item show print address
9408 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9409 @end table
9410
9411 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9412 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9413 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9414 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9415 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9416 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9417 it prints a symbolic address:
9418
9419 @table @code
9420 @item set print symbol-filename on
9421 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9422 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9423 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9424 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9425
9426 @item set print symbol-filename off
9427 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9428 default.
9429
9430 @item show print symbol-filename
9431 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9432 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9433 @end table
9434
9435 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9436 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9437 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9438
9439 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9440 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9441
9442 @table @code
9443 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9444 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9445 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9446 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9447 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9448 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9449 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9450 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9451
9452 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9453 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9454 symbolic address.
9455 @end table
9456
9457 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9458 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9459 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9460 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9461 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9462 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9463 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9464 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9465
9466 @smallexample
9467 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9468 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9469 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9470 @end smallexample
9471
9472 @quotation
9473 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9474 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9475 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9476 @end quotation
9477
9478 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9479 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9480
9481 @table @code
9482 @item set print symbol on
9483 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9484 one exists.
9485
9486 @item set print symbol off
9487 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9488 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9489 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9490
9491 @item show print symbol
9492 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9493 address.
9494 @end table
9495
9496 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9497
9498 @table @code
9499 @item set print array
9500 @itemx set print array on
9501 @cindex pretty print arrays
9502 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9503 but uses more space. The default is off.
9504
9505 @item set print array off
9506 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9507
9508 @item show print array
9509 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9510 arrays.
9511
9512 @cindex print array indexes
9513 @item set print array-indexes
9514 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9515 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9516 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9517 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9518
9519 @item set print array-indexes off
9520 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9521
9522 @item show print array-indexes
9523 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9524 arrays.
9525
9526 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9527 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9528 @cindex number of array elements to print
9529 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9530 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9531 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9532 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9533 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9534 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9535 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9536 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9537
9538 @item show print elements
9539 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9540 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9541
9542 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9543 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9544 @cindex printing frame argument values
9545 @cindex print all frame argument values
9546 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9547 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9548 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9549 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9550 values are:
9551
9552 @table @code
9553 @item all
9554 The values of all arguments are printed.
9555
9556 @item scalars
9557 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9558 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9559 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9560 only scalar arguments are shown:
9561
9562 @smallexample
9563 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9564 at frame-args.c:23
9565 @end smallexample
9566
9567 @item none
9568 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9569 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9570
9571 @smallexample
9572 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9573 at frame-args.c:23
9574 @end smallexample
9575 @end table
9576
9577 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9578 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9579 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9580 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9581 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9582 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9583 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9584 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9585 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9586 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9587
9588 @item show print frame-arguments
9589 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9590
9591 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9592 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9593
9594 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9595 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9596 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9597 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9598 This is the default.
9599
9600 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9601 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9602
9603 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9604 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9605 @kindex set print entry-values
9606 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9607 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9608 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9609 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9610 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9611
9612 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9613 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9614 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9615 @code{no} setting.
9616
9617 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9618 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9619 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9620 this information.
9621
9622 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9623
9624 @table @code
9625 @item no
9626 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9627 point.
9628 @smallexample
9629 #0 equal (val=5)
9630 #0 different (val=6)
9631 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9632 #0 born (val=10)
9633 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9634 @end smallexample
9635
9636 @item only
9637 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9638 values are never printed.
9639 @smallexample
9640 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9641 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9642 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9643 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9644 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9645 @end smallexample
9646
9647 @item preferred
9648 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9649 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9650 value for such parameter.
9651 @smallexample
9652 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9653 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9654 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9655 #0 born (val=10)
9656 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9657 @end smallexample
9658
9659 @item if-needed
9660 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9661 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9662 parameter.
9663 @smallexample
9664 #0 equal (val=5)
9665 #0 different (val=6)
9666 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9667 #0 born (val=10)
9668 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9669 @end smallexample
9670
9671 @item both
9672 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9673 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9674 optimizations.
9675 @smallexample
9676 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9677 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9678 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9679 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9680 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9681 @end smallexample
9682
9683 @item compact
9684 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9685 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9686 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9687 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9688 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9689 @smallexample
9690 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9691 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9692 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9693 #0 born (val=10)
9694 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9695 @end smallexample
9696
9697 @item default
9698 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9699 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9700 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9701 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9702 @smallexample
9703 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9704 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9705 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9706 #0 born (val=10)
9707 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9708 @end smallexample
9709 @end table
9710
9711 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9712 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9713
9714 @item show print entry-values
9715 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9716 entry.
9717
9718 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9719 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9720 @cindex repeated array elements
9721 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9722 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9723 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9724 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9725 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9726 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9727 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9728 is 10.
9729
9730 @item show print repeats
9731 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9732 elements.
9733
9734 @item set print null-stop
9735 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9736 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9737 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9738 contain only short strings.
9739 The default is off.
9740
9741 @item show print null-stop
9742 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9743 @sc{null} character.
9744
9745 @item set print pretty on
9746 @cindex print structures in indented form
9747 @cindex indentation in structure display
9748 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9749 per line, like this:
9750
9751 @smallexample
9752 @group
9753 $1 = @{
9754 next = 0x0,
9755 flags = @{
9756 sweet = 1,
9757 sour = 1
9758 @},
9759 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9760 @}
9761 @end group
9762 @end smallexample
9763
9764 @item set print pretty off
9765 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9766
9767 @smallexample
9768 @group
9769 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9770 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9771 @end group
9772 @end smallexample
9773
9774 @noindent
9775 This is the default format.
9776
9777 @item show print pretty
9778 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9779
9780 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9781 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9782 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9783 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9784 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9785 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9786 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9787 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9788
9789 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9790 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9791 international character sets, and is the default.
9792
9793 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9794 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9795
9796 @item set print union on
9797 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9798 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9799 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9800
9801 @item set print union off
9802 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9803 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9804 instead.
9805
9806 @item show print union
9807 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9808 structures and other unions.
9809
9810 For example, given the declarations
9811
9812 @smallexample
9813 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9814 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9815 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9816 Bug_forms;
9817
9818 struct thing @{
9819 Species it;
9820 union @{
9821 Tree_forms tree;
9822 Bug_forms bug;
9823 @} form;
9824 @};
9825
9826 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9827 @end smallexample
9828
9829 @noindent
9830 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9831
9832 @smallexample
9833 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9834 @end smallexample
9835
9836 @noindent
9837 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9838
9839 @smallexample
9840 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9841 @end smallexample
9842
9843 @noindent
9844 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9845 and in Pascal.
9846 @end table
9847
9848 @need 1000
9849 @noindent
9850 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9851
9852 @table @code
9853 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9854 @item set print demangle
9855 @itemx set print demangle on
9856 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9857 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9858 linkage. The default is on.
9859
9860 @item show print demangle
9861 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9862
9863 @item set print asm-demangle
9864 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9865 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9866 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9867 The default is off.
9868
9869 @item show print asm-demangle
9870 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9871 or demangled form.
9872
9873 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9874 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9875 @kindex set demangle-style
9876 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9877 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9878 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9879
9880 @table @code
9881 @item auto
9882 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9883 This is the default.
9884
9885 @item gnu
9886 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9887
9888 @item hp
9889 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9890
9891 @item lucid
9892 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9893
9894 @item arm
9895 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9896 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9897 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9898 require further enhancement to permit that.
9899
9900 @end table
9901 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9902
9903 @item show demangle-style
9904 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9905
9906 @item set print object
9907 @itemx set print object on
9908 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9909 @cindex display derived types
9910 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9911 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9912 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9913 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9914 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9915 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9916 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9917
9918 @item set print object off
9919 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9920 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9921
9922 @item show print object
9923 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9924
9925 @item set print static-members
9926 @itemx set print static-members on
9927 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9928 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9929
9930 @item set print static-members off
9931 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9932
9933 @item show print static-members
9934 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9935
9936 @item set print pascal_static-members
9937 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9938 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9939 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9940 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9941
9942 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9943 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9944
9945 @item show print pascal_static-members
9946 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9947
9948 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9949 @item set print vtbl
9950 @itemx set print vtbl on
9951 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9952 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9953 @cindex VTBL display
9954 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9955 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9956 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9957
9958 @item set print vtbl off
9959 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9960
9961 @item show print vtbl
9962 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9963 @end table
9964
9965 @node Pretty Printing
9966 @section Pretty Printing
9967
9968 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9969 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9970 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9971
9972 @menu
9973 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9974 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9975 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9976 @end menu
9977
9978 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9979 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9980
9981 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9982 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9983 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9984
9985 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9986 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9987 pretty-printers with their names.
9988 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9989 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9990 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9991 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9992
9993 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9994 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9995 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9996 do anything special.
9997
9998 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9999
10000 @itemize @bullet
10001 @item
10002 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10003 all inferiors.
10004
10005 @item
10006 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10007 when debugging that program.
10008 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10009
10010 @item
10011 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10012 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10013 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10014 @end itemize
10015
10016 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10017 pretty-printers are selected,
10018
10019 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10020 for new types.
10021
10022 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10023 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10024
10025 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10026
10027 @smallexample
10028 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10029 $1 = @{
10030 static npos = 4294967295,
10031 _M_dataplus = @{
10032 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10033 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10034 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10035 @},
10036 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10037 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10038 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10039 @}
10040 @}
10041 @end smallexample
10042
10043 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10044
10045 @smallexample
10046 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10047 $2 = "abcd"
10048 @end smallexample
10049
10050 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10051 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10052 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10053
10054 @table @code
10055 @kindex info pretty-printer
10056 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10057 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10058 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10059
10060 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10061 whose pretty-printers to list.
10062 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10063 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10064 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10065 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10066 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10067
10068 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10069 to list.
10070
10071 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10072 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10073 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10074 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10075
10076 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10077 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10078 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10079 @end table
10080
10081 Example:
10082
10083 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10084 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10085 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10086 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10087
10088 @smallexample
10089 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10090 library1.so:
10091 foo
10092 library2.so:
10093 bar
10094 bar1
10095 bar2
10096 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10097 library2.so:
10098 bar
10099 bar1
10100 bar2
10101 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10102 1 printer disabled
10103 2 of 3 printers enabled
10104 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10105 library1.so:
10106 foo [disabled]
10107 library2.so:
10108 bar
10109 bar1
10110 bar2
10111 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10112 1 printer disabled
10113 1 of 3 printers enabled
10114 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10115 library1.so:
10116 foo [disabled]
10117 library2.so:
10118 bar
10119 bar1 [disabled]
10120 bar2
10121 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10122 1 printer disabled
10123 0 of 3 printers enabled
10124 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10125 library1.so:
10126 foo [disabled]
10127 library2.so:
10128 bar [disabled]
10129 bar1 [disabled]
10130 bar2
10131 @end smallexample
10132
10133 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10134 as can each individual subprinter.
10135
10136 @node Value History
10137 @section Value History
10138
10139 @cindex value history
10140 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10141 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10142 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10143 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10144 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10145 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10146 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10147 symbol table.
10148
10149 @cindex @code{$}
10150 @cindex @code{$$}
10151 @cindex history number
10152 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10153 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10154 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10155 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10156 history number.
10157
10158 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10159 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10160 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10161 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10162 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10163 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10164 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10165
10166 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10167 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10168
10169 @smallexample
10170 p *$
10171 @end smallexample
10172
10173 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10174 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10175
10176 @smallexample
10177 p *$.next
10178 @end smallexample
10179
10180 @noindent
10181 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10182 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10183
10184 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10185 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10186
10187 @smallexample
10188 print x
10189 set x=5
10190 @end smallexample
10191
10192 @noindent
10193 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10194 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10195
10196 @table @code
10197 @kindex show values
10198 @item show values
10199 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10200 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10201 values} does not change the history.
10202
10203 @item show values @var{n}
10204 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10205
10206 @item show values +
10207 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10208 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10209 @end table
10210
10211 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10212 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10213
10214 @node Convenience Vars
10215 @section Convenience Variables
10216
10217 @cindex convenience variables
10218 @cindex user-defined variables
10219 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10220 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10221 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10222 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10223 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10224
10225 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10226 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10227 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10228 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10229 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10230
10231 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10232 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10233 For example:
10234
10235 @smallexample
10236 set $foo = *object_ptr
10237 @end smallexample
10238
10239 @noindent
10240 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10241 @code{object_ptr}.
10242
10243 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10244 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10245 value with another assignment at any time.
10246
10247 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10248 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10249 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10250 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10251
10252 @table @code
10253 @kindex show convenience
10254 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10255 @item show convenience
10256 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10257 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10258 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10259
10260 @kindex init-if-undefined
10261 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10262 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10263 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10264 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10265 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10266 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10267 override default values used in a command script.
10268
10269 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10270 any side-effects do not occur.
10271 @end table
10272
10273 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10274 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10275 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10276
10277 @smallexample
10278 set $i = 0
10279 print bar[$i++]->contents
10280 @end smallexample
10281
10282 @noindent
10283 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10284
10285 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10286 values likely to be useful.
10287
10288 @table @code
10289 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10290 @item $_
10291 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10292 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10293 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10294 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10295 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10296 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10297 to the type of @code{$__}.
10298
10299 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10300 @item $__
10301 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10302 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10303 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10304
10305 @item $_exitcode
10306 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10307 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10308 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10309 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10310
10311 @item $_exitsignal
10312 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10313 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10314 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10315 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10316
10317 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10318 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10319 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10320 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10321 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10322
10323 @smallexample
10324 #include <signal.h>
10325
10326 int
10327 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10328 @{
10329 raise (SIGALRM);
10330 return 0;
10331 @}
10332 @end smallexample
10333
10334 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10335 or signalled would be:
10336
10337 @smallexample
10338 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10339 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10340 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10341 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10342 >echo The program has exited\n
10343 >else
10344 >echo The program has signalled\n
10345 >end
10346 >end
10347 (@value{GDBP}) run
10348 Starting program:
10349
10350 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10351 The program no longer exists.
10352 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10353 The program has signalled
10354 @end smallexample
10355
10356 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10357 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10358 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10359 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10360
10361 @smallexample
10362 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10363 The program has exited
10364 @end smallexample
10365
10366 @item $_exception
10367 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10368 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10369
10370 @item $_probe_argc
10371 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10372 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10373
10374 @item $_sdata
10375 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10376 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10377 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10378 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10379 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10380
10381 @item $_siginfo
10382 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10383 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10384 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10385 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10386 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10387
10388 @item $_tlb
10389 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10390 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10391 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10392 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10393 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10394 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10395
10396 @end table
10397
10398 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10399 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10400 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10401
10402 @node Convenience Funs
10403 @section Convenience Functions
10404
10405 @cindex convenience functions
10406 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10407 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10408 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10409 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10410 @value{GDBN}.
10411
10412 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10413 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10414
10415 @table @code
10416
10417 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10418 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10419 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10420 returns zero.
10421
10422 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10423 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10424 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10425 it is @code{void}:
10426
10427 @smallexample
10428 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10429 $1 = void
10430 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10431 $2 = 1
10432 (@value{GDBP}) run
10433 Starting program: ./a.out
10434 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10435 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10436 $3 = 0
10437 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10438 $4 = 0
10439 @end smallexample
10440
10441 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10442 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10443 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10444 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10445 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10446 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10447 anymore.
10448
10449 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10450 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10451
10452 @smallexample
10453 void
10454 foo (void)
10455 @{
10456 @}
10457 @end smallexample
10458
10459 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10460
10461 @smallexample
10462 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10463 $1 = void
10464 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10465 $2 = 1
10466 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10467 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10468 $3 = void
10469 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10470 $4 = 1
10471 @end smallexample
10472
10473 @end table
10474
10475 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10476 @code{Python} support.
10477
10478 @table @code
10479
10480 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10481 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10482 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10483 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10484 Otherwise it returns zero.
10485
10486 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10487 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10488 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10489 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10490 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10491 regular expression support.
10492
10493 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10494 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10495 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10496 Otherwise it returns zero.
10497
10498 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10499 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10500 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10501
10502 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10503 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10504 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10505 Otherwise it returns zero.
10506
10507 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10508 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10509 The default is 1.
10510
10511 Example:
10512
10513 @smallexample
10514 (gdb) backtrace
10515 #0 bottom_func ()
10516 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10517 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10518 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10519 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10520 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10521 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10522 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10523 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10524 $1 = 1
10525 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10526 $1 = 1
10527 @end smallexample
10528
10529 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10530 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10531 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10532 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10533
10534 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10535 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10536 The default is 1.
10537
10538 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10539 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10540 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10541 Otherwise it returns zero.
10542
10543 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10544 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10545 The default is 1.
10546
10547 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10548 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10549 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10550 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10551
10552 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10553 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10554 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10555 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10556
10557 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10558 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10559 The default is 1.
10560
10561 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10562 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10563 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10564 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10565
10566 @end table
10567
10568 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10569 convenience functions.
10570
10571 @table @code
10572 @item help function
10573 @kindex help function
10574 @cindex show all convenience functions
10575 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10576 @end table
10577
10578 @node Registers
10579 @section Registers
10580
10581 @cindex registers
10582 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10583 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10584 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10585 your machine.
10586
10587 @table @code
10588 @kindex info registers
10589 @item info registers
10590 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10591 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10592
10593 @kindex info all-registers
10594 @cindex floating point registers
10595 @item info all-registers
10596 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10597 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10598
10599 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10600 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10601 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10602 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10603 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10604 @end table
10605
10606 @anchor{standard registers}
10607 @cindex stack pointer register
10608 @cindex program counter register
10609 @cindex process status register
10610 @cindex frame pointer register
10611 @cindex standard registers
10612 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10613 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10614 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10615 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10616 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10617 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10618 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10619 you could print the program counter in hex with
10620
10621 @smallexample
10622 p/x $pc
10623 @end smallexample
10624
10625 @noindent
10626 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10627
10628 @smallexample
10629 x/i $pc
10630 @end smallexample
10631
10632 @noindent
10633 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10634 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10635 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10636 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10637 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10638 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10639 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 set $sp += 4
10643 @end smallexample
10644
10645 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10646 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10647 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10648 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10649 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10650 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10651 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10652
10653 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10654 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10655 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10656 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10657 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10658 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10659 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10660
10661 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10662 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10663 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10664 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10665 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10666 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10667 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10668 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10669 prints the data in both formats.
10670
10671 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10672 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10673 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10674 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10675 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10676 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10677 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10678
10679 @smallexample
10680 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10681 $1 = @{
10682 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10683 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10684 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10685 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10686 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10687 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10688 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10689 @}
10690 @end smallexample
10691
10692 @noindent
10693 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10694 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10695 value to a @code{struct} member:
10696
10697 @smallexample
10698 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10699 @end smallexample
10700
10701 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10702 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10703 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10704 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10705 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10706 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10707
10708 @cindex caller-saved registers
10709 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10710 @cindex volatile registers
10711 @cindex <not saved> values
10712 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10713 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10714 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10715 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10716 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10717 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10718 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10719 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10720 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10721 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10722 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10723 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10724 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10725 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10726 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10727 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10728 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10729 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10730 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10731 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10732 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10733 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10734 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10735
10736 @node Floating Point Hardware
10737 @section Floating Point Hardware
10738 @cindex floating point
10739
10740 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10741 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10742
10743 @table @code
10744 @kindex info float
10745 @item info float
10746 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10747 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10748 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10749 the ARM and x86 machines.
10750 @end table
10751
10752 @node Vector Unit
10753 @section Vector Unit
10754 @cindex vector unit
10755
10756 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10757 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10758
10759 @table @code
10760 @kindex info vector
10761 @item info vector
10762 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10763 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10764 @end table
10765
10766 @node OS Information
10767 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10768 @cindex OS information
10769
10770 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10771 you debug your program.
10772
10773 @cindex auxiliary vector
10774 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10775 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10776 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10777 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10778 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10779 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10780 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10781 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10782 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10783 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10784 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10785 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10786
10787 @table @code
10788 @kindex info auxv
10789 @item info auxv
10790 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10791 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10792 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10793 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10794 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10795 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10796 an unrecognized tag.
10797 @end table
10798
10799 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10800 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10801 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10802 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10803 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10804 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10805 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10806
10807 @table @code
10808 @kindex info os
10809 @item info os @var{infotype}
10810
10811 Display OS information of the requested type.
10812
10813 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10814
10815 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10816 @table @code
10817 @kindex info os cpus
10818 @item cpus
10819 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10820 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10821 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10822 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10823 kernel initialization.
10824
10825 @kindex info os files
10826 @item files
10827 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10828 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10829 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10830 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10831
10832 @kindex info os modules
10833 @item modules
10834 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10835 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10836 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10837 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10838 in memory.
10839
10840 @kindex info os msg
10841 @item msg
10842 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10843 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10844 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10845 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10846 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10847 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10848 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10849 the message queue was last changed.
10850
10851 @kindex info os processes
10852 @item processes
10853 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10854 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10855 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10856 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10857 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10858 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10859
10860 @kindex info os procgroups
10861 @item procgroups
10862 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10863 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10864 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10865 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10866 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10867 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10868 and the process group leader is listed first.
10869
10870 @kindex info os semaphores
10871 @item semaphores
10872 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10873 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10874 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10875 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10876 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10877
10878 @kindex info os shm
10879 @item shm
10880 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10881 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10882 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10883 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10884 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10885 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10886 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10887
10888 @kindex info os sockets
10889 @item sockets
10890 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10891 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10892 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10893 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10894 connection.
10895
10896 @kindex info os threads
10897 @item threads
10898 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10899 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10900 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10901 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10902 process is not listed.
10903 @end table
10904
10905 @item info os
10906 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10907 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10908 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10909 types, this command will report an error.
10910 @end table
10911
10912 @node Memory Region Attributes
10913 @section Memory Region Attributes
10914 @cindex memory region attributes
10915
10916 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10917 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10918 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10919 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10920 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10921 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10922 user can override the fetched regions.
10923
10924 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10925 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10926 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10927 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10928 all memory.
10929
10930 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10931 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10932
10933 @table @code
10934 @kindex mem
10935 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10936 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10937 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10938 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10939 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10940 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10941
10942 @item mem auto
10943 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10944 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10945
10946 @kindex delete mem
10947 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10948 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10949 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10950
10951 @kindex disable mem
10952 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10953 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10954 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10955 It may be enabled again later.
10956
10957 @kindex enable mem
10958 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10959 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10960
10961 @kindex info mem
10962 @item info mem
10963 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10964 for each region:
10965
10966 @table @emph
10967 @item Memory Region Number
10968 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10969 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10970 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10971
10972 @item Lo Address
10973 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10974
10975 @item Hi Address
10976 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10977
10978 @item Attributes
10979 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10980 @end table
10981 @end table
10982
10983
10984 @subsection Attributes
10985
10986 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10987 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10988 write accesses to a memory region.
10989
10990 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10991 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10992 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10993
10994 @table @code
10995 @item ro
10996 Memory is read only.
10997 @item wo
10998 Memory is write only.
10999 @item rw
11000 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11001 @end table
11002
11003 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11004 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11005 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11006 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11007 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11008
11009 @table @code
11010 @item 8
11011 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11012 @item 16
11013 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11014 @item 32
11015 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11016 @item 64
11017 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11018 @end table
11019
11020 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11021 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11022 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11023 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11024 @c
11025 @c @table @code
11026 @c @item hwbreak
11027 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11028 @c @item swbreak (default)
11029 @c @end table
11030
11031 @subsubsection Data Cache
11032 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11033 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11034 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11035 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11036 registers.
11037
11038 @table @code
11039 @item cache
11040 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11041 @item nocache
11042 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11043 @end table
11044
11045 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11046 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11047 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11048 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11049 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11050
11051 @table @code
11052 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11053 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11054 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11055 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11056 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11057 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11058 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11059 The default value is @code{on}.
11060 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11061 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11062 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11063 @end table
11064
11065
11066 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11067 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11068 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11069 @c
11070 @c @table @code
11071 @c @item verify
11072 @c @item noverify (default)
11073 @c @end table
11074
11075 @node Dump/Restore Files
11076 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11077 @cindex dump/restore files
11078 @cindex append data to a file
11079 @cindex dump data to a file
11080 @cindex restore data from a file
11081
11082 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11083 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11084 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11085 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11086 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11087 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11088 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11089
11090 @table @code
11091
11092 @kindex dump
11093 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11094 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11095 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11096 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11097
11098 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11099 @table @code
11100 @item binary
11101 Raw binary form.
11102 @item ihex
11103 Intel hex format.
11104 @item srec
11105 Motorola S-record format.
11106 @item tekhex
11107 Tektronix Hex format.
11108 @item verilog
11109 Verilog Hex format.
11110 @end table
11111
11112 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11113 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11114 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11115 form.
11116
11117 @kindex append
11118 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11119 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11120 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11121 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11122 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11123
11124 @kindex restore
11125 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11126 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11127 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11128 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11129 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11130
11131 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11132 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11133 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11134 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11135 from that location.
11136
11137 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11138 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11139 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11140 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11141
11142 @end table
11143
11144 @node Core File Generation
11145 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11146 @cindex dump core from inferior
11147
11148 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11149 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11150 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11151 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11152 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11153 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11154 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11155
11156 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11157 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11158 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11159
11160 @table @code
11161 @kindex gcore
11162 @kindex generate-core-file
11163 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11164 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11165 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11166 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11167 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11168 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11169
11170 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11171 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11172
11173 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11174 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11175 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11176
11177 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11178 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11179 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11180 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11181 Enable or disable the use of the file
11182 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11183 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11184 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11185 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11186
11187 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11188 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11189 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11190 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11191 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11192 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11193 about the bits that can be set in the
11194 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11195 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11196
11197 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11198 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11199 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11200 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11201 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11202 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11203 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11204 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11205 @end table
11206
11207 @node Character Sets
11208 @section Character Sets
11209 @cindex character sets
11210 @cindex charset
11211 @cindex translating between character sets
11212 @cindex host character set
11213 @cindex target character set
11214
11215 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11216 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11217 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11218 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11219 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11220 @dfn{target character set}.
11221
11222 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11223 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11224 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11225 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11226 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11227 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11228 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11229 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11230 character and string literals in expressions.
11231
11232 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11233 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11234 target-charset} command, described below.
11235
11236 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11237 support:
11238
11239 @table @code
11240 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11241 @kindex set target-charset
11242 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11243 list of supported target character sets, type
11244 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11245
11246 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11247 @kindex set host-charset
11248 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11249
11250 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11251 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11252 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11253 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11254 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11255
11256 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11257 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11258 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11259
11260 @item set charset @var{charset}
11261 @kindex set charset
11262 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11263 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11264 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11265 for both host and target.
11266
11267 @item show charset
11268 @kindex show charset
11269 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11270
11271 @item show host-charset
11272 @kindex show host-charset
11273 Show the name of the current host character set.
11274
11275 @item show target-charset
11276 @kindex show target-charset
11277 Show the name of the current target character set.
11278
11279 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11280 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11281 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11282 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11283 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11284 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11285
11286 @item show target-wide-charset
11287 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11288 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11289 @end table
11290
11291 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11292 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11293 @file{charset-test.c}:
11294
11295 @smallexample
11296 #include <stdio.h>
11297
11298 char ascii_hello[]
11299 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11300 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11301 char ibm1047_hello[]
11302 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11303 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11304
11305 main ()
11306 @{
11307 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11308 @}
11309 @end smallexample
11310
11311 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11312 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11313 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11314
11315 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11316
11317 @smallexample
11318 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11319 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11320 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11321 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11322 @dots{}
11323 (@value{GDBP})
11324 @end smallexample
11325
11326 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11327 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11328 strings:
11329
11330 @smallexample
11331 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11332 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11333 (@value{GDBP})
11334 @end smallexample
11335
11336 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11337 initial character set:
11338 @smallexample
11339 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11340 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11341 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11342 (@value{GDBP})
11343 @end smallexample
11344
11345 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11346 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11347 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11348 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11349 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11350
11351 @smallexample
11352 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11353 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11354 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11355 $2 = 72 'H'
11356 (@value{GDBP})
11357 @end smallexample
11358
11359 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11360 literals you use in expressions:
11361
11362 @smallexample
11363 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11364 $3 = 43 '+'
11365 (@value{GDBP})
11366 @end smallexample
11367
11368 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11369 character.
11370
11371 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11372 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11373 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11374
11375 @smallexample
11376 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11377 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11378 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11379 $5 = 200 '\310'
11380 (@value{GDBP})
11381 @end smallexample
11382
11383 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11384 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11385
11386 @smallexample
11387 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11388 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11389 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11390 @end smallexample
11391
11392 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11393 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11394 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11395 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11396 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11397
11398 @smallexample
11399 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11400 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11401 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11402 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11403 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11404 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11405 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11406 $7 = 72 '\110'
11407 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11408 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11409 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11410 $9 = 200 'H'
11411 (@value{GDBP})
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11415 string literals you use in expressions:
11416
11417 @smallexample
11418 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11419 $10 = 78 '+'
11420 (@value{GDBP})
11421 @end smallexample
11422
11423 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11424 character.
11425
11426 @node Caching Target Data
11427 @section Caching Data of Targets
11428 @cindex caching data of targets
11429
11430 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11431 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11432 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11433 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11434 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11435 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11436 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11437 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11438 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11439 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11440 is executing.
11441 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11442 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11443 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11444 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11445 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11446 in the code segment.
11447 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11448 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11449
11450 @table @code
11451 @kindex set remotecache
11452 @item set remotecache on
11453 @itemx set remotecache off
11454 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11455 with old scripts.
11456
11457 @kindex show remotecache
11458 @item show remotecache
11459 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11460
11461 @kindex set stack-cache
11462 @item set stack-cache on
11463 @itemx set stack-cache off
11464 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11465 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11466
11467 @kindex show stack-cache
11468 @item show stack-cache
11469 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11470
11471 @kindex set code-cache
11472 @item set code-cache on
11473 @itemx set code-cache off
11474 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11475 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11476 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11477
11478 @kindex show code-cache
11479 @item show code-cache
11480 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11481 accesses.
11482
11483 @kindex info dcache
11484 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11485 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11486 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11487 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11488 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11489 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11490
11491 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11492 printed in hex.
11493
11494 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11495 @cindex dcache size
11496 @kindex set dcache size
11497 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11498
11499 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11500 @cindex dcache line-size
11501 @kindex set dcache line-size
11502 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11503 Must be a power of 2.
11504
11505 @item show dcache size
11506 @kindex show dcache size
11507 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11508
11509 @item show dcache line-size
11510 @kindex show dcache line-size
11511 Show default size of dcache lines.
11512
11513 @end table
11514
11515 @node Searching Memory
11516 @section Search Memory
11517 @cindex searching memory
11518
11519 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11520 @code{find} command.
11521
11522 @table @code
11523 @kindex find
11524 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11525 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11526 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11527 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11528 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11529 @end table
11530
11531 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11532 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11533
11534 @table @r
11535 @item @var{s}, search query size
11536 The size of each search query value.
11537
11538 @table @code
11539 @item b
11540 bytes
11541 @item h
11542 halfwords (two bytes)
11543 @item w
11544 words (four bytes)
11545 @item g
11546 giant words (eight bytes)
11547 @end table
11548
11549 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11550 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11551 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11552
11553 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11554 value's type in the current language.
11555 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11556 pattern as a mixture of types.
11557 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11558 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11559 which is typically four bytes.
11560
11561 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11562 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11563 @end table
11564
11565 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11566 (@code{"}).
11567 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11568 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11569
11570 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11571 number of matches found.
11572
11573 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11574 @samp{$_}.
11575 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11576
11577 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11578
11579 @smallexample
11580 void
11581 hello ()
11582 @{
11583 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11584 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11585 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11586 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11587 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11588 @}
11589 @end smallexample
11590
11591 @noindent
11592 you get during debugging:
11593
11594 @smallexample
11595 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11596 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11597 1 pattern found
11598 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11599 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11600 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11601 2 patterns found
11602 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11603 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11604 1 pattern found
11605 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11606 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11607 1 pattern found
11608 (gdb) print $numfound
11609 $1 = 1
11610 (gdb) print $_
11611 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11612 @end smallexample
11613
11614 @node Optimized Code
11615 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11616 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11617 @cindex debugging optimized code
11618
11619 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11620 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11621 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11622 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11623 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11624 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11625 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11626
11627 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11628 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11629 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11630 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11631
11632 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11633 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11634 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11635 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11636 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11637 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11638
11639 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11640 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11641 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11642 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11643 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11644
11645 @menu
11646 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11647 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11648 @end menu
11649
11650 @node Inline Functions
11651 @section Inline Functions
11652 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11653
11654 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11655 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11656 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11657 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11658 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11659 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11660 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11661 @code{info frame} command.
11662
11663 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11664 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11665 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11666 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11667 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11668 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11669 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11670 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11671 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11672 local variables in the caller.
11673
11674 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11675 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11676 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11677 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11678 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11679 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11680 instructions are executed.
11681
11682 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11683 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11684 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11685 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11686
11687 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11688 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11689
11690 @itemize @bullet
11691 @item
11692 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11693 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11694 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11695 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11696 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11697 or inside the inlined function instead.
11698
11699 @item
11700 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11701 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11702 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11703 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11704
11705 @end itemize
11706
11707 @node Tail Call Frames
11708 @section Tail Call Frames
11709 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11710
11711 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11712 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11713 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11714 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11715 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11716
11717 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11718 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11719 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11720 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11721 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11722 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11723 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11724
11725 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11726 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11727 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11728 this information.
11729
11730 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11731 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11732
11733 @smallexample
11734 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11735 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11736 (gdb) info frame
11737 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11738 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11739 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11740 source language c++.
11741 Arglist at unknown address.
11742 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11743 @end smallexample
11744
11745 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11746 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11747 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11748 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11749 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11750 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11751
11752 @table @code
11753 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11754 @item set debug entry-values
11755 @kindex set debug entry-values
11756 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11757 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11758 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11759 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11760 result.
11761
11762 @item show debug entry-values
11763 @kindex show debug entry-values
11764 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11765 values at function entry and tail calls.
11766 @end table
11767
11768 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11769 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11770 reference by variable @code{x}):
11771
11772 @smallexample
11773 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11774 void (*x) (void) = c;
11775 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11776 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11777 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11778
11779 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11780 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11781 a () at t.c:3
11782 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11783 (gdb) bt
11784 #0 a () at t.c:3
11785 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11786 @end smallexample
11787
11788 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11789
11790 @smallexample
11791 int i;
11792 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11793 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11794 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11795 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11796 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11797 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11798 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11799 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11800
11801 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11802 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11803 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11804 (gdb) bt
11805 #0 f () at t.c:2
11806 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11807 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11808 @end smallexample
11809
11810 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11811 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11812
11813 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11814 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11815 @set ARROW @click{}
11816 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11817 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11818 @end ifset
11819 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11820 @set ARROW ->
11821 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11822 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11823 @end ifclear
11824
11825 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11826 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11827 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11828
11829 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11830 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11831 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11832 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11833 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11834 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11835
11836 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11837 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11838 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11839 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11840 omitted.
11841
11842 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11843 entry may fail:
11844
11845 @smallexample
11846 int v;
11847 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11848 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11849 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11850 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11851 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11852 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11853
11854 (gdb) bt
11855 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11856 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11857 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11858 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11859 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11860 @end smallexample
11861
11862 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11863 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11864 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11865 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11866 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11867
11868 @node Macros
11869 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11870
11871 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11872 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11873 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11874 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11875 where it was defined.
11876
11877 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11878 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11879 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11880 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11881
11882 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11883 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11884 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11885 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11886 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11887 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11888 see @ref{List}.
11889
11890 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11891 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11892 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11893
11894 @table @code
11895
11896 @kindex macro expand
11897 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11898 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11899 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11900 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11901 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11902 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11903 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11904 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11905 it can be any string of tokens.
11906
11907 @kindex macro exp1
11908 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11909 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11910 @cindex expand macro once
11911 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11912 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11913 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11914 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11915 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11916 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11917 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11918 can be any string of tokens.
11919
11920 @kindex info macro
11921 @cindex macro definition, showing
11922 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11923 @cindex macros, from debug info
11924 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11925 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11926 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11927 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11928 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11929 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11930
11931 @kindex info macros
11932 @item info macros @var{location}
11933 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11934 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
11935 command-line where those definitions were established.
11936
11937 @kindex macro define
11938 @cindex user-defined macros
11939 @cindex defining macros interactively
11940 @cindex macros, user-defined
11941 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11942 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11943 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11944 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11945 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11946 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11947 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11948 @var{arglist}.
11949
11950 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11951 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11952 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11953 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11954 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11955
11956 @kindex macro undef
11957 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11958 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11959 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11960 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11961 in the program being debugged.
11962
11963 @kindex macro list
11964 @item macro list
11965 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11966 @end table
11967
11968 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11969 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11970 show our source files:
11971
11972 @smallexample
11973 $ cat sample.c
11974 #include <stdio.h>
11975 #include "sample.h"
11976
11977 #define M 42
11978 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11979
11980 main ()
11981 @{
11982 #define N 28
11983 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11984 #undef N
11985 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11986 #define N 1729
11987 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11988 @}
11989 $ cat sample.h
11990 #define Q <
11991 $
11992 @end smallexample
11993
11994 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11995 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11996 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11997 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11998 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11999 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12000 information.
12001
12002 @smallexample
12003 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12004 $
12005 @end smallexample
12006
12007 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12008
12009 @smallexample
12010 $ gdb -nw sample
12011 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12012 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12013 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12014 (@value{GDBP})
12015 @end smallexample
12016
12017 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12018 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12019 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12020
12021 @smallexample
12022 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12023 3
12024 4 #define M 42
12025 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12026 6
12027 7 main ()
12028 8 @{
12029 9 #define N 28
12030 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12031 11 #undef N
12032 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12033 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12034 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12035 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12036 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12037 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12038 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12039 #define Q <
12040 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12041 expands to: (42 + 1)
12042 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12043 expands to: once (M + 1)
12044 (@value{GDBP})
12045 @end smallexample
12046
12047 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12048 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12049 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12050 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12051
12052 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12053 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12054
12055 @smallexample
12056 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12057 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12058 (@value{GDBP}) run
12059 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12060
12061 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12062 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12063 (@value{GDBP})
12064 @end smallexample
12065
12066 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12067
12068 @smallexample
12069 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12070 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12071 #define N 28
12072 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12073 expands to: 28 < 42
12074 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12075 $1 = 1
12076 (@value{GDBP})
12077 @end smallexample
12078
12079 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12080 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12081 thereof) in force at each point:
12082
12083 @smallexample
12084 (@value{GDBP}) next
12085 Hello, world!
12086 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12087 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12088 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12089 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12090 (@value{GDBP}) next
12091 We're so creative.
12092 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12093 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12094 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12095 #define N 1729
12096 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12097 expands to: 1729 < 42
12098 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12099 $2 = 0
12100 (@value{GDBP})
12101 @end smallexample
12102
12103 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12104 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12105 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12106 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12107
12108 @smallexample
12109 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12110 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12111 -D__STDC__=1
12112 (@value{GDBP})
12113 @end smallexample
12114
12115
12116 @node Tracepoints
12117 @chapter Tracepoints
12118 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12119 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12120
12121 @cindex tracepoints
12122 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12123 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12124 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12125 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12126 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12127 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12128 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12129
12130 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12131 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12132 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12133 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12134 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12135 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12136 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12137 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12138 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12139 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12140 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12141
12142 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12143 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12144 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12145 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12146 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12147 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12148 Packets}.
12149
12150 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12151 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12152 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12153
12154 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12155
12156 @menu
12157 * Set Tracepoints::
12158 * Analyze Collected Data::
12159 * Tracepoint Variables::
12160 * Trace Files::
12161 @end menu
12162
12163 @node Set Tracepoints
12164 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12165
12166 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12167 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12168 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12169 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12170 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12171 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12172 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12173
12174 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12175 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12176 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12177 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12178 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12179 tracepoint was hit.
12180
12181 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12182 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12183 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12184 either.
12185
12186 @cindex fast tracepoints
12187 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12188 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12189 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12190
12191 @cindex static tracepoints
12192 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12193 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12194 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12195 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12196 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12197 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12198 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12199 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12200 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12201 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12202 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12203 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12204 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12205 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12206 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12207 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12208 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12209 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12210 static tracepoint marker.
12211
12212 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12213 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12214
12215 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12216 conditions and actions.
12217
12218 @menu
12219 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12220 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12221 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12222 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12223 * Trace State Variables::
12224 * Tracepoint Actions::
12225 * Listing Tracepoints::
12226 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12227 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12228 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12229 @end menu
12230
12231 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12232 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12233
12234 @table @code
12235 @cindex set tracepoint
12236 @kindex trace
12237 @item trace @var{location}
12238 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12239 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12240 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12241 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12242 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12243 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12244 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12245 in tracing}).
12246 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12247 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12248 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12249 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12250 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12251 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12252 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12253 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12254 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12255 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12256 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12257 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12258
12259 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12260
12261 @smallexample
12262 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12263
12264 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12265
12266 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12267
12268 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12269
12270 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12271 @end smallexample
12272
12273 @noindent
12274 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12275
12276 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12277 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12278 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12279 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12280 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12281 information on tracepoint conditions.
12282
12283 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12284 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12285 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12286 @kindex ftrace
12287 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12288 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12289 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12290 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12291 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12292 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12293 message.
12294
12295 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12296 @code{trace}.
12297
12298 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12299 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12300 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12301 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12302 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12303 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12304 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12305 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12306
12307 @example
12308 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12309 @end example
12310
12311 @noindent
12312 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12313 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12314
12315 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12316 @cindex set static tracepoint
12317 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12318 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12319 @kindex strace
12320 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12321 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12322 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12323 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12324 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12325
12326 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12327 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12328 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12329 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12330 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12331 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12332 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12333 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12334 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12335 tracing engine:
12336
12337 @smallexample
12338 main ()
12339 @{
12340 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12341 @}
12342 @end smallexample
12343
12344 @noindent
12345 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12346 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12347
12348 @smallexample
12349 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12350 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12351 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12352 Data: "str %s"
12353 [etc...]
12354 @end smallexample
12355
12356 @noindent
12357 so you may probe the marker above with:
12358
12359 @smallexample
12360 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12361 @end smallexample
12362
12363 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12364 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12365 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12366 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12367 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12368 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12369 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12370 the @samp{Data:} field.
12371
12372 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12373 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12374 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12375
12376 @vindex $tpnum
12377 @cindex last tracepoint number
12378 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12379 @cindex tracepoint number
12380 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12381 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12382
12383 @kindex delete tracepoint
12384 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12385 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12386 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12387 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12388 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12389
12390 Examples:
12391
12392 @smallexample
12393 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12394
12395 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12396 @end smallexample
12397
12398 @noindent
12399 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12400 @end table
12401
12402 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12403 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12404
12405 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12406
12407 @table @code
12408 @kindex disable tracepoint
12409 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12410 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12411 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12412 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12413 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12414 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12415 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12416 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12417 next trace experiment.
12418
12419 @kindex enable tracepoint
12420 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12421 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12422 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12423 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12424 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12425 next time a trace experiment is run.
12426 @end table
12427
12428 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12429 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12430
12431 @table @code
12432 @kindex passcount
12433 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12434 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12435 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12436 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12437 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12438 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12439 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12440 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12441 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12442 user.
12443
12444 Examples:
12445
12446 @smallexample
12447 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12448 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12449
12450 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12451 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12452 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12453 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12454 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12455 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12456 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12457 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12458 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12459 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12460 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12461 @end smallexample
12462 @end table
12463
12464 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12465 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12466 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12467 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12468
12469 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12470 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12471 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12472 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12473 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12474 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12475 is true.
12476
12477 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12478 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12479 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12480 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12481 just as with breakpoints.
12482
12483 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12484 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12485 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12486 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12487 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12488 accesses, and so forth.
12489
12490 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12491 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12492 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12493 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12494 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12495 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12496 search through.
12497
12498 @smallexample
12499 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12500 @end smallexample
12501
12502 @node Trace State Variables
12503 @subsection Trace State Variables
12504 @cindex trace state variables
12505
12506 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12507 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12508 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12509 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12510 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12511 integers.
12512
12513 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12514 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12515 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12516 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12517
12518 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12519 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12520 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12521 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12522 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12523 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12524 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12525 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12526 variable with the same name.
12527
12528 @table @code
12529
12530 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12531 @kindex tvariable
12532 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12533 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12534 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12535 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12536 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12537 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12538 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12539 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12540 value. The default initial value is 0.
12541
12542 @item info tvariables
12543 @kindex info tvariables
12544 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12545 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12546 currently running.
12547
12548 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12549 @kindex delete tvariable
12550 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12551 are specified.
12552
12553 @end table
12554
12555 @node Tracepoint Actions
12556 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12557
12558 @table @code
12559 @kindex actions
12560 @cindex tracepoint actions
12561 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12562 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12563 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12564 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12565 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12566 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12567 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12568 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12569 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12570 @code{while-stepping}.
12571
12572 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12573 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12574 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12575
12576 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12577 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12578 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12579
12580 @smallexample
12581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12582
12583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12584
12585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12586 @end smallexample
12587
12588 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12589 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12590 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12591 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12592 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12593 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12594 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12595 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12596
12597 @smallexample
12598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12599 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12600 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12601 > collect bar,baz
12602 > collect $regs
12603 > while-stepping 12
12604 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12605 > end
12606 end
12607 @end smallexample
12608
12609 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12610 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12611 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12612 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12613 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12614 special arguments are supported:
12615
12616 @table @code
12617 @item $regs
12618 Collect all registers.
12619
12620 @item $args
12621 Collect all function arguments.
12622
12623 @item $locals
12624 Collect all local variables.
12625
12626 @item $_ret
12627 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12628 of a backtrace.
12629
12630 @item $_probe_argc
12631 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12632 tracepoint is located.
12633 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12634
12635 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12636 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12637 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12638 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12639
12640 @item $_sdata
12641 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12642 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12643 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12644 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12645 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12646 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12647 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12648 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12649 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12650
12651 @smallexample
12652 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12653 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12654 @end smallexample
12655
12656 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12657 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12658 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12659 @value{GDBN}.
12660 @end table
12661
12662 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12663 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12664 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12665
12666 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12667 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12668 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12669 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12670 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12671 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12672 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12673 @samp{mystr}.
12674
12675 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12676 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12677
12678 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12679 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12680 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12681 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12682 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12683 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12684 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12685 action were used.
12686
12687 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12688 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12689 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12690 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12691 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12692 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12693
12694 @smallexample
12695 > while-stepping 12
12696 > collect $regs, myglobal
12697 > end
12698 >
12699 @end smallexample
12700
12701 @noindent
12702 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12703 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12704 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12705 @code{stepping}.
12706
12707 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12708 @kindex set default-collect
12709 @cindex default collection action
12710 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12711 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12712 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12713 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12714 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12715 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12716
12717 @item show default-collect
12718 @kindex show default-collect
12719 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12720 tracepoint hit.
12721
12722 @end table
12723
12724 @node Listing Tracepoints
12725 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12726
12727 @table @code
12728 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12729 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12730 @cindex information about tracepoints
12731 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12732 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12733 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12734 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12735 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12736 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12737
12738 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12739 tracing:
12740
12741 @itemize @bullet
12742 @item
12743 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12744
12745 @item
12746 the state about installed on target of each location
12747 @end itemize
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12751 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12752 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12753 while-stepping 20
12754 collect globfoo, $regs
12755 end
12756 collect globfoo2
12757 end
12758 pass count 1200
12759 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12760 collect $eip
12761 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12762 installed on target
12763 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12764 installed on target
12765 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12766 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12767 not installed on target
12768 (@value{GDBP})
12769 @end smallexample
12770
12771 @noindent
12772 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12773 @end table
12774
12775 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12776 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12777
12778 @table @code
12779 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12780 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12781 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12782 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12783 program.
12784
12785 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12786
12787 @table @emph
12788 @item Count
12789 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12790 stable identifier.
12791 @item ID
12792 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12793 @item Enabled or Disabled
12794 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12795 that are not enabled.
12796 @item Address
12797 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12798 @item What
12799 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12800 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12801 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12802 will be left blank.
12803 @end table
12804
12805 @noindent
12806 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12807
12808 @table @emph
12809 @item Data
12810 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12811 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12812 marker call.
12813 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12814 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12815 @end table
12816
12817 @smallexample
12818 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12819 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12820 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12821 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12822 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12823 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12824 Data: str %s
12825 (@value{GDBP})
12826 @end smallexample
12827 @end table
12828
12829 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12830 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12831
12832 @table @code
12833 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12834 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12835 @cindex collected data discarded
12836 @item tstart
12837 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12838 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12839 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12840 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12841 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12842 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12843 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12844 information, and so forth.
12845
12846 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12847 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12848 @item tstop
12849 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12850 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12851 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12852 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12853 needs to be stopped quickly.
12854
12855 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12856 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12857 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12858
12859 @kindex tstatus
12860 @cindex status of trace data collection
12861 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12862 @item tstatus
12863 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12864 collection.
12865 @end table
12866
12867 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12868
12869 @smallexample
12870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12871 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12872 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12873 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12874 > while-stepping 11
12875 > collect $regs
12876 > end
12877 > end
12878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12879 [time passes @dots{}]
12880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12881 @end smallexample
12882
12883 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12884 @cindex disconnected tracing
12885 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12886 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12887 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12888 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12889 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12890 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12891 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12892 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12893
12894 @table @code
12895 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12896 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12897 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12898 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12899 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12900 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12901 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12902 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12903
12904 @item show disconnected-tracing
12905 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12906 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12907
12908 @end table
12909
12910 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12911 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12912 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12913 it will continue after reconnection.
12914
12915 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12916 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12917 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12918 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12919 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12920 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12921 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12922 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12923 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12924 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12925
12926 @cindex circular trace buffer
12927 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12928 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12929 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12930 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12931 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12932 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12933 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12934 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12935 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12936 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12937 the next run.
12938
12939 @table @code
12940 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12941 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12942 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12943 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12944 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12945 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12946 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12947
12948 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12949 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12950 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12951 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12952 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12953 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12954
12955 @end table
12956
12957 @table @code
12958 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12959 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12960 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12961 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12962 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12963 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12964 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12965 likes. This is also the default.
12966
12967 @item show trace-buffer-size
12968 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12969 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12970 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12971 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12972 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12973 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12974 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12975 @end table
12976
12977 @table @code
12978 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12979 @kindex set trace-user
12980
12981 @item show trace-user
12982 @kindex show trace-user
12983
12984 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12985 @kindex set trace-notes
12986 Set the trace run's notes.
12987
12988 @item show trace-notes
12989 @kindex show trace-notes
12990 Show the trace run's notes.
12991
12992 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12993 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12994 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12995 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12996 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12997
12998 @item show trace-stop-notes
12999 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13000 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13001
13002 @end table
13003
13004 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13005 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13006
13007 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13008 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13009 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13010 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13011 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13012 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13013 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13014 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13015 mentioned here.
13016
13017 @itemize @bullet
13018
13019 @item
13020 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13021 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13022 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13023 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13024 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13025 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13026 cannot be collected either.
13027
13028 @item
13029 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13030 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13031 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13032 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13033 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13034 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13035 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13036 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13037 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13038 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13039
13040 @item
13041 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13042 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13043 in a misleading way.
13044
13045 @item
13046 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13047 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13048 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13049 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13050 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13051 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13052 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13053 by @code{ptr}.
13054
13055 @item
13056 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13057 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13058 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13059 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13060 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13061 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13062 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13063 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13064 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13065 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13066 invalid address.
13067
13068 @item
13069 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13070 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13071 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13072 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13073 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13074 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13075 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13076 it to zero.
13077
13078 @end itemize
13079
13080 @node Analyze Collected Data
13081 @section Using the Collected Data
13082
13083 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13084 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13085 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13086 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13087 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13088 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13089 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13090 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13091 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13092 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13093 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13094 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13095 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13096 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13097 the buffer will fail.
13098
13099 @menu
13100 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13101 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13102 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13103 @end menu
13104
13105 @node tfind
13106 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13107
13108 @kindex tfind
13109 @cindex select trace snapshot
13110 @cindex find trace snapshot
13111 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13112 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13113 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13114 snapshot is selected.
13115
13116 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13117
13118 @table @code
13119 @item tfind start
13120 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13121 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13122
13123 @item tfind none
13124 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13125
13126 @item tfind end
13127 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13128
13129 @item tfind
13130 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
13131
13132 @item tfind -
13133 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13134 retracing earlier steps.
13135
13136 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13137 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13138 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13139 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13140 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13141
13142 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13143 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13144 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13145 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13146 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13147
13148 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13149 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13150 addresses (exclusive).
13151
13152 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13153 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13154 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13155
13156 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13157 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13158 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13159 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13160 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13161 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13162 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13163 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13164 @end table
13165
13166 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13167 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13168 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13169 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13170 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13171 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13172 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13173 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13174 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13175 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13176 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13177 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13178 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13179 tracepoint as the current one.
13180
13181 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13182 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13183 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13184 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13185 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13186
13187 @smallexample
13188 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13189 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13190 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13191 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13192 > tfind
13193 > end
13194
13195 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13196 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13197 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13198 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13199 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13200 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13201 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13202 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13203 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13204 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13205 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13206 @end smallexample
13207
13208 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13209 the buffer:
13210
13211 @smallexample
13212 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13213 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13214 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13215 > tfind line
13216 > end
13217
13218 Frame 0, X = 1
13219 Frame 7, X = 2
13220 Frame 13, X = 255
13221 @end smallexample
13222
13223 @node tdump
13224 @subsection @code{tdump}
13225 @kindex tdump
13226 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13227 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13228
13229 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13230 the current trace snapshot.
13231
13232 @smallexample
13233 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13235 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13236 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13237 > end
13238
13239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13240
13241 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13242 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13243 at gdb_test.c:444
13244 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13245
13246 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13247 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13248 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13249 d1 0x18 24
13250 d2 0x80 128
13251 d3 0x33 51
13252 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13253 d5 0x22 34
13254 d6 0xe0 224
13255 d7 0x380035 3670069
13256 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13257 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13258 a2 0x100 256
13259 a3 0x322000 3284992
13260 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13261 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13262 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13263 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13264 ps 0x0 0
13265 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13266 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13267 fpstatus 0x0 0
13268 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13269 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13270 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13271 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13272 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13273 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13274 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13275 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13276 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13277
13278 (@value{GDBP})
13279 @end smallexample
13280
13281 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13282 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13283 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13284 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13285
13286 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13287 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13288 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13289 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13290 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13291 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13292 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13293 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13294 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13295 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13296
13297 @node save tracepoints
13298 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13299 @kindex save tracepoints
13300 @kindex save-tracepoints
13301 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13302
13303 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13304 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13305 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13306 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13307 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13308 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13309
13310 @node Tracepoint Variables
13311 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13312 @cindex tracepoint variables
13313 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13314
13315 @table @code
13316 @vindex $trace_frame
13317 @item (int) $trace_frame
13318 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13319 snapshot is selected.
13320
13321 @vindex $tracepoint
13322 @item (int) $tracepoint
13323 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13324
13325 @vindex $trace_line
13326 @item (int) $trace_line
13327 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13328
13329 @vindex $trace_file
13330 @item (char []) $trace_file
13331 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13332
13333 @vindex $trace_func
13334 @item (char []) $trace_func
13335 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13336 @end table
13337
13338 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13339 use @code{output} instead.
13340
13341 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13342 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13343 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13344 which are managed by the target.
13345
13346 @smallexample
13347 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13348
13349 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13350 > output $trace_file
13351 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13352 > tfind
13353 > end
13354 @end smallexample
13355
13356 @node Trace Files
13357 @section Using Trace Files
13358 @cindex trace files
13359
13360 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13361 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13362 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13363 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13364 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13365
13366 @table @code
13367
13368 @kindex tsave
13369 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13370 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13371 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13372 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13373 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13374 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13375 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13376 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13377 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13378 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13379 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13380 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13381 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13382 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13383 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13384
13385 @kindex target tfile
13386 @kindex tfile
13387 @kindex target ctf
13388 @kindex ctf
13389 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13390 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13391 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13392 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13393 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13394 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13395 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13396 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13397 the host.
13398
13399 @smallexample
13400 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13401 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13402 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13403 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13404 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13405 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13406 i = 0
13407 a = 0
13408 b = 1 '\001'
13409 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13410 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13411 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13412 $1 = 1
13413 @end smallexample
13414
13415 @end table
13416
13417 @node Overlays
13418 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13419 @cindex overlays
13420
13421 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13422 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13423 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13424 use overlays.
13425
13426 @menu
13427 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13428 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13429 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13430 mapped by asking the inferior.
13431 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13432 @end menu
13433
13434 @node How Overlays Work
13435 @section How Overlays Work
13436 @cindex mapped overlays
13437 @cindex unmapped overlays
13438 @cindex load address, overlay's
13439 @cindex mapped address
13440 @cindex overlay area
13441
13442 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13443 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13444 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13445 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13446 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13447
13448 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13449 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13450 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13451 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13452 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13453 largest overlay as well.
13454
13455 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13456 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13457 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13458 there.
13459
13460 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13461 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13462 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13463
13464 @smallexample
13465 @group
13466 Data Instruction Larger
13467 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13468 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13469 | | | | | |
13470 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13471 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13472 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13473 | and heap | | | | | |
13474 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13475 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13476 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13477 | | | | | |
13478 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13479 address | | | | | |
13480 | overlay | <-' | | |
13481 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13482 | | <---. | | load address
13483 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13484 | | | |
13485 +-----------+ | |
13486 +-----------+
13487 | |
13488 +-----------+
13489
13490 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13491 @end group
13492 @end smallexample
13493
13494 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13495 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13496 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13497 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13498 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13499 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13500 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13501 program and the overlay area.
13502
13503 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13504 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13505 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13506 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13507 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13508 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13509 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13510
13511 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13512 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13513 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13514
13515 @itemize @bullet
13516
13517 @item
13518 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13519 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13520 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13521 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13522
13523 @item
13524 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13525 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13526 your program's performance.
13527
13528 @item
13529 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13530 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13531 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13532 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13533 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13534 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13535 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13536
13537 @item
13538 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13539 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13540 instruction and data spaces.
13541
13542 @end itemize
13543
13544 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13545 improved in many ways:
13546
13547 @itemize @bullet
13548
13549 @item
13550 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13551 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13552 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13553 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13554 area in the usual way.
13555
13556 @item
13557 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13558 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13559
13560 @item
13561 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13562 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13563 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13564 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13565 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13566 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13567 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13568
13569 @end itemize
13570
13571
13572 @node Overlay Commands
13573 @section Overlay Commands
13574
13575 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13576 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13577 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13578 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13579 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13580 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13581
13582 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13583 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13584
13585 @table @code
13586 @item overlay off
13587 @kindex overlay
13588 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13589 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13590 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13591 overlay support is disabled.
13592
13593 @item overlay manual
13594 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13595 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13596 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13597 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13598 commands described below.
13599
13600 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13601 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13602 @cindex map an overlay
13603 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13604 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13605 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13606 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13607 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13608 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13609
13610 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13611 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13612 @cindex unmap an overlay
13613 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13614 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13615 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13616 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13617
13618 @item overlay auto
13619 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13620 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13621 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13622 Overlay Debugging}.
13623
13624 @item overlay load-target
13625 @itemx overlay load
13626 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13627 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13628 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13629 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13630 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13631 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13632
13633 @item overlay list-overlays
13634 @itemx overlay list
13635 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13636 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13637 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13638
13639 @end table
13640
13641 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13642 of the function the address falls in:
13643
13644 @smallexample
13645 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13646 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13647 @end smallexample
13648 @noindent
13649 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13650 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13651 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13652 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13653
13654 @smallexample
13655 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13656 No sections are mapped.
13657 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13658 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13659 @end smallexample
13660 @noindent
13661 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13662 name normally:
13663
13664 @smallexample
13665 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13666 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13667 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13668 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13669 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13670 @end smallexample
13671
13672 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13673 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13674 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13675 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13676 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13677
13678 @itemize @bullet
13679 @item
13680 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13681 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13682 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13683 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13684 @item
13685 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13686 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13687 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13688 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13689 breakpoints properly.
13690 @end itemize
13691
13692
13693 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13694 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13695 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13696
13697 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13698 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13699 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13700 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13701 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13702 current state of the overlays.
13703
13704 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13705 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13706
13707 @table @asis
13708
13709 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13710 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13711
13712 @smallexample
13713 struct
13714 @{
13715 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13716 unsigned long vma;
13717
13718 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13719 unsigned long size;
13720
13721 /* The overlay's load address. */
13722 unsigned long lma;
13723
13724 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13725 zero otherwise. */
13726 unsigned long mapped;
13727 @}
13728 @end smallexample
13729
13730 @item @code{_novlys}:
13731 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13732 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13733
13734 @end table
13735
13736 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13737 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13738 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13739 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13740 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13741 currently mapped.
13742
13743 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13744 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13745 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13746 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13747 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13748 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13749 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13750 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13751 are not being executed.
13752
13753 @node Overlay Sample Program
13754 @section Overlay Sample Program
13755 @cindex overlay example program
13756
13757 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13758 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13759 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13760 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13761 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13762 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13763 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13764
13765 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13766 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13767 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13768 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13769
13770 @table @file
13771 @item overlays.c
13772 The main program file.
13773 @item ovlymgr.c
13774 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13775 @item foo.c
13776 @itemx bar.c
13777 @itemx baz.c
13778 @itemx grbx.c
13779 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13780 @item d10v.ld
13781 @itemx m32r.ld
13782 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13783 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13784 @end table
13785
13786 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13787 cross-compiler like this:
13788
13789 @smallexample
13790 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13791 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13792 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13793 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13794 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13795 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13796 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13797 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13798 @end smallexample
13799
13800 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13801 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13802 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13803
13804
13805 @node Languages
13806 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13807 @cindex languages
13808
13809 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13810 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13811 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13812 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13813 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13814 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13815
13816 @cindex working language
13817 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13818 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13819 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13820 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13821 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13822 language}.
13823
13824 @menu
13825 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13826 * Show:: Displaying the language
13827 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13828 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13829 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13830 @end menu
13831
13832 @node Setting
13833 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13834
13835 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13836 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13837 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13838 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13839 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13840 are printed, etc.
13841
13842 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13843 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13844 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13845 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13846 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13847 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13848 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13849 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13850 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13851 Displaying the Language}.
13852
13853 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13854 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13855 another language. In that case, make the
13856 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13857 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13858 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13859
13860 @menu
13861 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13862 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13863 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13864 @end menu
13865
13866 @node Filenames
13867 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13868
13869 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13870 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13871
13872 @table @file
13873 @item .ada
13874 @itemx .ads
13875 @itemx .adb
13876 @itemx .a
13877 Ada source file.
13878
13879 @item .c
13880 C source file
13881
13882 @item .C
13883 @itemx .cc
13884 @itemx .cp
13885 @itemx .cpp
13886 @itemx .cxx
13887 @itemx .c++
13888 C@t{++} source file
13889
13890 @item .d
13891 D source file
13892
13893 @item .m
13894 Objective-C source file
13895
13896 @item .f
13897 @itemx .F
13898 Fortran source file
13899
13900 @item .mod
13901 Modula-2 source file
13902
13903 @item .s
13904 @itemx .S
13905 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13906 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13907 @end table
13908
13909 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13910 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13911
13912 @node Manually
13913 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13914
13915 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13916 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13917 your program.
13918
13919 @kindex set language
13920 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13921 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13922 a language, such as
13923 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13924 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13925
13926 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13927 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13928 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13929 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13930 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13931 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13932 command such as:
13933
13934 @smallexample
13935 print a = b + c
13936 @end smallexample
13937
13938 @noindent
13939 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13940 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13941 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13942 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13943
13944 @node Automatically
13945 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13946
13947 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13948 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13949 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13950 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13951 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13952 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13953 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13954 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13955 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13956
13957 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13958 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13959 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13960 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13961 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13962
13963 @node Show
13964 @section Displaying the Language
13965
13966 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13967 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13968
13969 @table @code
13970 @item show language
13971 @anchor{show language}
13972 @kindex show language
13973 Display the current working language. This is the
13974 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13975 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13976
13977 @item info frame
13978 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13979 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13980 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13981 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13982 information listed here.
13983
13984 @item info source
13985 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13986 Display the source language of this source file.
13987 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13988 information listed here.
13989 @end table
13990
13991 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13992 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13993 with a language explicitly:
13994
13995 @table @code
13996 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13997 @kindex set extension-language
13998 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13999 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14000
14001 @item info extensions
14002 @kindex info extensions
14003 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14004 @end table
14005
14006 @node Checks
14007 @section Type and Range Checking
14008
14009 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14010 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14011 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14012 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14013 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14014 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14015 errors when your program is running.
14016
14017 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14018 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14019 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14020 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14021
14022 @menu
14023 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14024 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14025 @end menu
14026
14027 @cindex type checking
14028 @cindex checks, type
14029 @node Type Checking
14030 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14031
14032 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14033 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14034 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14035 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14036
14037 @smallexample
14038 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14039
14040 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14041 $1 = 2
14042 @exdent but
14043 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14044 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14045 @end smallexample
14046
14047 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14048 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14049
14050 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14051 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14052 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14053 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14054 expressions like the second example above.
14055
14056 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14057 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14058 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14059 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14060 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14061 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14062
14063 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14064
14065 @kindex set check type
14066 @kindex show check type
14067 @table @code
14068 @item set check type on
14069 @itemx set check type off
14070 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14071 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14072 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14073
14074 @item show check type
14075 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14076 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14077 @end table
14078
14079 @cindex range checking
14080 @cindex checks, range
14081 @node Range Checking
14082 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14083
14084 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14085 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14086 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14087 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14088 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14089
14090 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14091 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14092 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14093 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14094
14095 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14096 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14097 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14098 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14099 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14100 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14101
14102 @smallexample
14103 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14104 @end smallexample
14105
14106 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14107 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14108 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14109
14110 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14111
14112 @kindex set check range
14113 @kindex show check range
14114 @table @code
14115 @item set check range auto
14116 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14117 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14118 each language.
14119
14120 @item set check range on
14121 @itemx set check range off
14122 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14123 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14124 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14125 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14126
14127 @item set check range warn
14128 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14129 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14130 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14131 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14132 systems).
14133
14134 @item show range
14135 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14136 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14137 @end table
14138
14139 @node Supported Languages
14140 @section Supported Languages
14141
14142 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14143 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14144 @c This is false ...
14145 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14146 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14147 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14148 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14149 language.
14150
14151 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14152 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14153 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14154 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14155 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14156 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14157 language reference or tutorial.
14158
14159 @menu
14160 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14161 * D:: D
14162 * Go:: Go
14163 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14164 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14165 * Fortran:: Fortran
14166 * Pascal:: Pascal
14167 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14168 * Ada:: Ada
14169 @end menu
14170
14171 @node C
14172 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14173
14174 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14175 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14176
14177 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14178 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14179 together.
14180
14181 @cindex C@t{++}
14182 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14183 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14184 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14185 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14186 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14187 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14188 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14189
14190 @menu
14191 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14192 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14193 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14194 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14195 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14196 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14197 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14198 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14199 @end menu
14200
14201 @node C Operators
14202 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14203
14204 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14205
14206 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14207 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14208 often defined on groups of types.
14209
14210 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14211
14212 @itemize @bullet
14213
14214 @item
14215 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14216 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14217
14218 @item
14219 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14220 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14221
14222 @item
14223 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14224
14225 @item
14226 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14227
14228 @end itemize
14229
14230 @noindent
14231 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14232 in order of increasing precedence:
14233
14234 @table @code
14235 @item ,
14236 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14237 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14238 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14239
14240 @item =
14241 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14242 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14243
14244 @item @var{op}=
14245 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14246 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14247 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14248 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14249 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14250
14251 @item ?:
14252 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14253 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14254 should be of an integral type.
14255
14256 @item ||
14257 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14258
14259 @item &&
14260 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14261
14262 @item |
14263 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14264
14265 @item ^
14266 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14267
14268 @item &
14269 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14270
14271 @item ==@r{, }!=
14272 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14273 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14274
14275 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14276 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14277 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14278 and non-zero for true.
14279
14280 @item <<@r{, }>>
14281 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14282
14283 @item @@
14284 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14285
14286 @item +@r{, }-
14287 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14288 pointer types.
14289
14290 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14291 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14292 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14293 integral types.
14294
14295 @item ++@r{, }--
14296 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14297 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14298 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14299 operation takes place.
14300
14301 @item *
14302 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14303 @code{++}.
14304
14305 @item &
14306 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14307
14308 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14309 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14310 to examine the address
14311 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14312 stored.
14313
14314 @item -
14315 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14316 precedence as @code{++}.
14317
14318 @item !
14319 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14320 @code{++}.
14321
14322 @item ~
14323 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14324 @code{++}.
14325
14326
14327 @item .@r{, }->
14328 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14329 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14330 pointer based on the stored type information.
14331 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14332
14333 @item .*@r{, }->*
14334 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14335
14336 @item []
14337 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14338 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14339
14340 @item ()
14341 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14342
14343 @item ::
14344 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14345 and @code{class} types.
14346
14347 @item ::
14348 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14349 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14350 above.
14351 @end table
14352
14353 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14354 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14355 predefined meaning.
14356
14357 @node C Constants
14358 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14359
14360 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14361
14362 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14363 following ways:
14364
14365 @itemize @bullet
14366 @item
14367 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14368 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14369 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14370 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14371 @code{long} value.
14372
14373 @item
14374 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14375 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14376 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14377 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14378 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14379 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14380 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14381 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14382 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14383 constant.
14384
14385 @item
14386 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14387 integral equivalents.
14388
14389 @item
14390 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14391 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14392 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14393 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14394 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14395 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14396 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14397 @samp{\n} for newline.
14398
14399 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14400 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14401 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14402 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14403
14404 @item
14405 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14406 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14407 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14408 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14409 characters.
14410
14411 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14412 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14413 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14414
14415 @item
14416 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14417 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14418
14419 @item
14420 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14421 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14422 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14423 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14424 @end itemize
14425
14426 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14427 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14428
14429 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14430 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14431
14432 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14433 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14434 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14435 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14436 @quotation
14437 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14438 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14439 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14440 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14441 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14442 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14443 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14444 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14445 @end quotation
14446
14447 @enumerate
14448
14449 @cindex member functions
14450 @item
14451 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14452
14453 @smallexample
14454 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14455 @end smallexample
14456
14457 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14458 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14459 @item
14460 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14461 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14462 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14463 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14464 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14465
14466 @cindex call overloaded functions
14467 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14468 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14469 @item
14470 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14471 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14472 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14473 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14474 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14475 default arguments.
14476
14477 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14478 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14479 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14480 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14481 number of function arguments.
14482
14483 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14484 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14485 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14486
14487 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14488 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14489 @smallexample
14490 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14491 @end smallexample
14492
14493 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14494 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14495
14496 @cindex reference declarations
14497 @item
14498 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14499 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14500 dereferenced.
14501
14502 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14503 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14504 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14505 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14506 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14507
14508 @item
14509 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14510 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14511 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14512 necessary, for example in an expression like
14513 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14514 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14515 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14516
14517 @item
14518 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14519 specification.
14520 @end enumerate
14521
14522 @node C Defaults
14523 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14524
14525 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14526
14527 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14528 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14529 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14530 selects the working language.
14531
14532 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14533 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14534 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14535 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14536 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14537 for further details.
14538
14539 @node C Checks
14540 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14541
14542 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14543
14544 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14545 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14546 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14547 constants to pointers.
14548
14549 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14550 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14551 that is not itself an array.
14552
14553 @node Debugging C
14554 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14555
14556 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14557 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14558 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14559 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14560
14561 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14562 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14563 ,Expressions}.
14564
14565 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14566 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14567
14568 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14569
14570 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14571 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14572
14573 @table @code
14574 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14575 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14576 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14577 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14578 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14579 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14580
14581 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14582 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14583 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14584 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14585 classes.
14586 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14587
14588 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14589 @item catch throw
14590 @itemx catch rethrow
14591 @itemx catch catch
14592 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14593 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14594
14595 @cindex inheritance
14596 @item ptype @var{typename}
14597 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14598 @var{typename}.
14599 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14600
14601 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14602 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14603 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14604 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14605 multiple inheritance is in use.
14606
14607 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14608 @item demangle @var{name}
14609 Demangle @var{name}.
14610 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14611
14612 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14613 @item set print demangle
14614 @itemx show print demangle
14615 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14616 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14617 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14618 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14619 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14620
14621 @item set print object
14622 @itemx show print object
14623 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14624 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14625
14626 @item set print vtbl
14627 @itemx show print vtbl
14628 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14629 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14630 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14631 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14632
14633 @kindex set overload-resolution
14634 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14635 @item set overload-resolution on
14636 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14637 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14638 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14639 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14640 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14641 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14642
14643 @item set overload-resolution off
14644 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14645 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14646 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14647 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14648 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14649 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14650 argument types.
14651
14652 @kindex show overload-resolution
14653 @item show overload-resolution
14654 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14655
14656 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14657 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14658 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14659 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14660 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14661 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14662 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14663 @end table
14664
14665 @node Decimal Floating Point
14666 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14667 @cindex decimal floating point format
14668
14669 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14670 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14671 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14672 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14673
14674 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14675 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14676 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14677 configured target.
14678
14679 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14680 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14681 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14682
14683 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14684 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14685 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14686
14687 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14688 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14689 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14690
14691 @node D
14692 @subsection D
14693
14694 @cindex D
14695 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14696 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14697 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14698
14699 @node Go
14700 @subsection Go
14701
14702 @cindex Go (programming language)
14703 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14704 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14705
14706 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14707
14708 @table @code
14709 @cindex current Go package
14710 @item The current Go package
14711 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14712 specifying global variables and functions.
14713
14714 For example, given the program:
14715
14716 @example
14717 package main
14718 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14719 func main () @{
14720 // ...
14721 @}
14722 @end example
14723
14724 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14725
14726 @example
14727 (gdb) p myglob
14728 (gdb) p main.myglob
14729 @end example
14730
14731 @cindex builtin Go types
14732 @item Builtin Go types
14733 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14734 as a string.
14735
14736 @cindex builtin Go functions
14737 @item Builtin Go functions
14738 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14739 function and handles it internally.
14740
14741 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14742 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14743 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14744 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14745 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14746 @end table
14747
14748 @node Objective-C
14749 @subsection Objective-C
14750
14751 @cindex Objective-C
14752 This section provides information about some commands and command
14753 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14754 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14755 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14756
14757 @menu
14758 * Method Names in Commands::
14759 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14760 @end menu
14761
14762 @node Method Names in Commands
14763 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14764
14765 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14766 names as line specifications:
14767
14768 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14769 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14770 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14771 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14772 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14773 @itemize
14774 @item @code{clear}
14775 @item @code{break}
14776 @item @code{info line}
14777 @item @code{jump}
14778 @item @code{list}
14779 @end itemize
14780
14781 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14782
14783 @smallexample
14784 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14785 @end smallexample
14786
14787 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14788 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14789 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14790 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14791 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14792 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14793 debugged, enter:
14794
14795 @smallexample
14796 break -[Fruit create]
14797 @end smallexample
14798
14799 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14800 enter:
14801
14802 @smallexample
14803 list +[NSText initialize]
14804 @end smallexample
14805
14806 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14807 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14808 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14809 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14810
14811 @smallexample
14812 break create
14813 @end smallexample
14814
14815 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14816 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14817 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14818 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14819 none apply.
14820
14821 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14822 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14823
14824 @smallexample
14825 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14826 @end smallexample
14827
14828 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14829 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14830 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14831 @kindex print-object
14832 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14833
14834 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14835
14836 @smallexample
14837 print -[@var{object} hash]
14838 @end smallexample
14839
14840 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14841 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14842 @noindent
14843 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14844 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14845 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14846 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14847 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14848 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14849
14850 @node OpenCL C
14851 @subsection OpenCL C
14852
14853 @cindex OpenCL C
14854 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14855
14856 @menu
14857 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14858 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14859 * OpenCL C Operators::
14860 @end menu
14861
14862 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14863 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14864
14865 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14866 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14867 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14868 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14869 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14870
14871 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14872 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14873
14874 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14875 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14876 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14877 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14878
14879 @node OpenCL C Operators
14880 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14881
14882 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14883 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14884 vector data types.
14885
14886 @node Fortran
14887 @subsection Fortran
14888 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14889
14890 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14891 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14892
14893 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14894 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14895 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14896 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14897 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14898 underscore.
14899
14900 @menu
14901 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14902 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14903 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14904 @end menu
14905
14906 @node Fortran Operators
14907 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14908
14909 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14910
14911 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14912 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14913 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14914
14915 @table @code
14916 @item **
14917 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14918 of the second one.
14919
14920 @item :
14921 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14922 represent a section of array.
14923
14924 @item %
14925 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14926 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14927 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14928 union type.
14929 @end table
14930
14931 @node Fortran Defaults
14932 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14933
14934 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14935
14936 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14937 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14938 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14939 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14940
14941 @node Special Fortran Commands
14942 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14943
14944 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14945
14946 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14947 such as displaying common blocks.
14948
14949 @table @code
14950 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14951 @kindex info common
14952 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14953 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14954 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14955 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14956 printed.
14957 @end table
14958
14959 @node Pascal
14960 @subsection Pascal
14961
14962 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14963 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14964 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14965 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14966 syntax.
14967
14968 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14969 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14970 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14971
14972 @node Modula-2
14973 @subsection Modula-2
14974
14975 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14976
14977 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14978 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14979 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14980 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14981 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14982 table.
14983
14984 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14985 @menu
14986 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14987 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14988 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14989 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14990 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14991 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14992 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14993 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14994 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14995 @end menu
14996
14997 @node M2 Operators
14998 @subsubsection Operators
14999 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15000
15001 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15002 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15003 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15004 following definitions hold:
15005
15006 @itemize @bullet
15007
15008 @item
15009 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15010 their subranges.
15011
15012 @item
15013 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15014
15015 @item
15016 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15017
15018 @item
15019 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15020 @var{type}}.
15021
15022 @item
15023 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15024
15025 @item
15026 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15027
15028 @item
15029 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15030 @end itemize
15031
15032 @noindent
15033 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15034 increasing precedence:
15035
15036 @table @code
15037 @item ,
15038 Function argument or array index separator.
15039
15040 @item :=
15041 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15042 @var{value}.
15043
15044 @item <@r{, }>
15045 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15046 types.
15047
15048 @item <=@r{, }>=
15049 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15050 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15051 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15052
15053 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15054 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15055 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15056 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15057 comment character.
15058
15059 @item IN
15060 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15061 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15062
15063 @item OR
15064 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15065
15066 @item AND@r{, }&
15067 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15068
15069 @item @@
15070 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15071
15072 @item +@r{, }-
15073 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15074 and difference on set types.
15075
15076 @item *
15077 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15078 on set types.
15079
15080 @item /
15081 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15082 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15083
15084 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15085 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15086 precedence as @code{*}.
15087
15088 @item -
15089 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15090
15091 @item ^
15092 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15093
15094 @item NOT
15095 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15096 @code{^}.
15097
15098 @item .
15099 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15100 precedence as @code{^}.
15101
15102 @item []
15103 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15104
15105 @item ()
15106 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15107 as @code{^}.
15108
15109 @item ::@r{, }.
15110 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15111 @end table
15112
15113 @quotation
15114 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15115 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15116 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15117 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15118 @end quotation
15119
15120
15121 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15122 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15123 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15124
15125 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15126 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15127
15128 @table @var
15129
15130 @item a
15131 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15132
15133 @item c
15134 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15135
15136 @item i
15137 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15138
15139 @item m
15140 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15141 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15142 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15143
15144 @item n
15145 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15146
15147 @item r
15148 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15149
15150 @item t
15151 represents a type.
15152
15153 @item v
15154 represents a variable.
15155
15156 @item x
15157 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15158 explanation of the function for details.
15159 @end table
15160
15161 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15162
15163 @table @code
15164 @item ABS(@var{n})
15165 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15166
15167 @item CAP(@var{c})
15168 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15169 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15170
15171 @item CHR(@var{i})
15172 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15173
15174 @item DEC(@var{v})
15175 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15176
15177 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15178 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15179 new value.
15180
15181 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15182 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15183 set.
15184
15185 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15186 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15187
15188 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15189 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15190
15191 @item INC(@var{v})
15192 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15193
15194 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15195 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15196 new value.
15197
15198 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15199 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15200 there. Returns the new set.
15201
15202 @item MAX(@var{t})
15203 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15204
15205 @item MIN(@var{t})
15206 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15207
15208 @item ODD(@var{i})
15209 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15210
15211 @item ORD(@var{x})
15212 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15213 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15214 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15215 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15216
15217 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15218 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15219 variable or a type.
15220
15221 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15222 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15223
15224 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15225 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15226 variable or a type.
15227
15228 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15229 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15230 @end table
15231
15232 @quotation
15233 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15234 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15235 an error.
15236 @end quotation
15237
15238 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15239 @node M2 Constants
15240 @subsubsection Constants
15241
15242 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15243 ways:
15244
15245 @itemize @bullet
15246
15247 @item
15248 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15249 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15250 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15251 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15252
15253 @item
15254 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15255 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15256 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15257 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15258 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15259 digits.
15260
15261 @item
15262 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15263 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15264 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15265 followed by a @samp{C}.
15266
15267 @item
15268 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15269 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15270 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15271 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15272 sequences.
15273
15274 @item
15275 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15276
15277 @item
15278 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15279 @code{FALSE}.
15280
15281 @item
15282 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15283
15284 @item
15285 Set constants are not yet supported.
15286 @end itemize
15287
15288 @node M2 Types
15289 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15290 @cindex Modula-2 types
15291
15292 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15293 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15294 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15295 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15296 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15297 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15298
15299 The first example contains the following section of code:
15300
15301 @smallexample
15302 VAR
15303 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15304 r: [20..40] ;
15305 @end smallexample
15306
15307 @noindent
15308 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15309 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15310
15311 @smallexample
15312 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15313 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15314 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15315 SET OF CHAR
15316 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15317 21
15318 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15319 [20..40]
15320 @end smallexample
15321
15322 @noindent
15323 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15324
15325 @smallexample
15326 VAR
15327 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15328 @end smallexample
15329
15330 @noindent
15331 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15332
15333 @smallexample
15334 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15335 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15336 @end smallexample
15337
15338 @noindent
15339 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15340 expressions using the debugger.
15341
15342 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15343 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15344
15345 @smallexample
15346 VAR
15347 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15348 @end smallexample
15349
15350 @smallexample
15351 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15352 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15353 @end smallexample
15354
15355 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15356 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15357 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15358 above.
15359
15360 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15361
15362 @smallexample
15363 TYPE
15364 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15365 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15366 VAR
15367 s: t ;
15368 BEGIN
15369 s := blue ;
15370 @end smallexample
15371
15372 @noindent
15373 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15374 and value of a variable.
15375
15376 @smallexample
15377 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15378 $1 = blue
15379 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15380 type = [blue..yellow]
15381 @end smallexample
15382
15383 @noindent
15384 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15385 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15386 their @code{C} counterparts.
15387
15388 @smallexample
15389 VAR
15390 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15391 BEGIN
15392 s[1] := 1 ;
15393 @end smallexample
15394
15395 @smallexample
15396 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15397 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15398 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15399 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15400 @end smallexample
15401
15402 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15403 pointer types as shown in this example:
15404
15405 @smallexample
15406 VAR
15407 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15408 BEGIN
15409 NEW(s) ;
15410 s^[1] := 1 ;
15411 @end smallexample
15412
15413 @noindent
15414 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15415
15416 @smallexample
15417 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15418 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15419 @end smallexample
15420
15421 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15422 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15423 types:
15424
15425 @smallexample
15426 TYPE
15427 foo = RECORD
15428 f1: CARDINAL ;
15429 f2: CHAR ;
15430 f3: myarray ;
15431 END ;
15432
15433 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15434 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15435 VAR
15436 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15437 @end smallexample
15438
15439 @noindent
15440 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15441 below.
15442
15443 @smallexample
15444 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15445 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15446 f1 : CARDINAL;
15447 f2 : CHAR;
15448 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15449 END
15450 @end smallexample
15451
15452 @node M2 Defaults
15453 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15454 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15455
15456 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15457 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15458 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15459 selected the working language.
15460
15461 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15462 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15463 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15464 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15465
15466 @node Deviations
15467 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15468 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15469
15470 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15471 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15472
15473 @itemize @bullet
15474 @item
15475 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15476 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15477 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15478 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15479 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15480 returned a pointer.)
15481
15482 @item
15483 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15484 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15485 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15486 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15487
15488 @item
15489 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15490 argument.
15491
15492 @item
15493 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15494 @end itemize
15495
15496 @node M2 Checks
15497 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15498 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15499
15500 @quotation
15501 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15502 range checking.
15503 @end quotation
15504 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15505
15506 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15507
15508 @itemize @bullet
15509 @item
15510 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15511 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15512
15513 @item
15514 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15515 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15516 @end itemize
15517
15518 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15519 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15520
15521 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15522 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15523
15524 @node M2 Scope
15525 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15526 @cindex scope
15527 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15528 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15529 @ifinfo
15530 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15531 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15532 @end ifinfo
15533 @ifnotinfo
15534 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15535 @end ifnotinfo
15536
15537 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15538 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15539 similar syntax:
15540
15541 @smallexample
15542
15543 @var{module} . @var{id}
15544 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15545 @end smallexample
15546
15547 @noindent
15548 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15549 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15550 identifier within your program, except another module.
15551
15552 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15553 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15554 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15555 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15556
15557 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15558 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15559 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15560 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15561 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15562 @var{module}.
15563
15564 @node GDB/M2
15565 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15566
15567 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15568 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15569 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15570 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15571 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15572 analogue in Modula-2.
15573
15574 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15575 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15576 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15577 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15578 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15579 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15580
15581 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15582 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15583 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15584
15585 @node Ada
15586 @subsection Ada
15587 @cindex Ada
15588
15589 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15590 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15591 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15592 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15593 to be difficult.
15594
15595
15596 @cindex expressions in Ada
15597 @menu
15598 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15599 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15600 in @value{GDBN}.
15601 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15602 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15603 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15604 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15605 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15606 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15607 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15608 Profile
15609 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15610 @end menu
15611
15612 @node Ada Mode Intro
15613 @subsubsection Introduction
15614 @cindex Ada mode, general
15615
15616 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15617 syntax, with some extensions.
15618 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15619
15620 @itemize @bullet
15621 @item
15622 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15623 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15624 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15625 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15626
15627 @item
15628 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15629 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15630
15631 @item
15632 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15633 @end itemize
15634
15635 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15636 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15637 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15638 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15639 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15640
15641 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15642 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15643 was translated from an Ada source file.
15644
15645 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15646 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15647 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15648 middle (to allow based literals).
15649
15650 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15651 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15652 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15653 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15654 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15655 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15656
15657 @node Omissions from Ada
15658 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15659 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15660
15661 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15662
15663 @itemize @bullet
15664 @item
15665 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15666
15667 @itemize @minus
15668 @item
15669 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15670 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15671
15672 @item
15673 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15674
15675 @item
15676 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15677
15678 @item
15679 @t{'Tag}.
15680
15681 @item
15682 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15683 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15684
15685 @item
15686 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15687 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15688
15689 @item
15690 @t{'Address}.
15691 @end itemize
15692
15693 @item
15694 The names in
15695 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15696 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15697 not currently available.
15698
15699 @item
15700 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15701 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15702 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15703 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15704 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15705 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15706 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15707 indeterminate values.
15708
15709 @item
15710 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15711 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15712 are not implemented.
15713
15714 @item
15715 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15716 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15717 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15718 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15719 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15720
15721 @smallexample
15722 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15723 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15724 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15725 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15726 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15727 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15728 @end smallexample
15729
15730 Changing a
15731 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15732 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15733 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15734 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15735 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15736 declared to have a type such as:
15737
15738 @smallexample
15739 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15740 Id : Integer;
15741 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15742 end record;
15743 @end smallexample
15744
15745 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15746 assignments:
15747
15748 @smallexample
15749 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15750 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15751 @end smallexample
15752
15753 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15754 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15755 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15756 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15757 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15758 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15759 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15760 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15761
15762 @item
15763 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15764
15765 @item
15766 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15767 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15768 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15769 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15770 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15771 the proper resolution.
15772
15773 @item
15774 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15775
15776 @item
15777 Entry calls are not implemented.
15778
15779 @item
15780 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15781 formats are not supported.
15782
15783 @item
15784 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15785
15786 @item
15787 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15788 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15789 context.
15790 Should your program
15791 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15792 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15793 @end itemize
15794
15795 @node Additions to Ada
15796 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15797 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15798
15799 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15800 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15801
15802 @itemize @bullet
15803 @item
15804 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15805 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15806 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15807 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15808 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15809 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15810 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15811 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15812
15813 @item
15814 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15815 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15816 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15817
15818 @item
15819 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15820 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15821
15822 @item
15823 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15824 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15825 @end itemize
15826
15827 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15828 additions specific to Ada:
15829
15830 @itemize @bullet
15831 @item
15832 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15833 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15834
15835 @smallexample
15836 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15837 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15838 @end smallexample
15839
15840 @item
15841 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15842 the value of its right-hand operand.
15843 This allows, for example,
15844 complex conditional breaks:
15845
15846 @smallexample
15847 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15848 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15849 @end smallexample
15850
15851 @item
15852 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15853 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15854 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15855 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15856 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15857 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15858 in strings. For example,
15859 @smallexample
15860 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15861 @end smallexample
15862 @noindent
15863 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15864 after each period.
15865
15866 @item
15867 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15868 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15869 to write
15870
15871 @smallexample
15872 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15873 @end smallexample
15874
15875 @item
15876 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15877 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15878 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15879 of 3 might print as
15880
15881 @smallexample
15882 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15883 @end smallexample
15884
15885 @noindent
15886 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15887 clause.
15888
15889 @item
15890 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15891 multi-character subsequence of
15892 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15893 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15894 in place of @t{a'length}.
15895
15896 @item
15897 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15898 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15899 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15900 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15901 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15902 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15903 For example,
15904 @smallexample
15905 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15906 @end smallexample
15907
15908 @item
15909 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15910 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15911 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15912 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15913 object.
15914
15915 @end itemize
15916
15917 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15918 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15919
15920 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15921 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15922 before reaching the main procedure.
15923 As defined in the Ada Reference
15924 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15925 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15926 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15927 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15928
15929 @node Ada Exceptions
15930 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15931
15932 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15933
15934 @table @code
15935 @kindex info exceptions
15936 @item info exceptions
15937 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15938 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15939 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15940 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15941 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15942 @end table
15943
15944 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15945 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15946 argument.
15947
15948 @smallexample
15949 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15950 All defined Ada exceptions:
15951 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15952 program_error: 0x613d20
15953 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15954 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15955 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15956 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15957 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15958 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15959 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15960 @end smallexample
15961
15962 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15963 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15964
15965 @node Ada Tasks
15966 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15967 @cindex Ada, tasking
15968
15969 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15970 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15971
15972 @table @code
15973 @kindex info tasks
15974 @item info tasks
15975 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15976
15977
15978 @smallexample
15979 @iftex
15980 @leftskip=0.5cm
15981 @end iftex
15982 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15983 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15984 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15985 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15986 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15987 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15988
15989 @end smallexample
15990
15991 @noindent
15992 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15993 task currently being inspected.
15994
15995 @table @asis
15996 @item ID
15997 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15998
15999 @item TID
16000 The Ada task ID.
16001
16002 @item P-ID
16003 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16004
16005 @item Pri
16006 The base priority of the task.
16007
16008 @item State
16009 Current state of the task.
16010
16011 @table @code
16012 @item Unactivated
16013 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16014 executing.
16015
16016 @item Runnable
16017 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16018 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16019
16020 @item Terminated
16021 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16022 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16023 terminated themselves.
16024
16025 @item Child Activation Wait
16026 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16027
16028 @item Accept Statement
16029 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16030
16031 @item Waiting on entry call
16032 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16033
16034 @item Async Select Wait
16035 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16036 select statement.
16037
16038 @item Delay Sleep
16039 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16040 alternative open.
16041
16042 @item Child Termination Wait
16043 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16044 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16045 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16046
16047 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16048 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16049 finish terminating.
16050
16051 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16052 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16053 @end table
16054
16055 @item Name
16056 Name of the task in the program.
16057
16058 @end table
16059
16060 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16061 @item info task @var{taskno}
16062 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16063 the following example:
16064 @smallexample
16065 @iftex
16066 @leftskip=0.5cm
16067 @end iftex
16068 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16069 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16070 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16071 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16072 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16073 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16074 Name: task_1
16075 Thread: 0x807f378
16076 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16077 Base Priority: 15
16078 State: Runnable
16079 @end smallexample
16080
16081 @item task
16082 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16083 @cindex current Ada task ID
16084 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16085
16086 @smallexample
16087 @iftex
16088 @leftskip=0.5cm
16089 @end iftex
16090 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16091 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16092 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16093 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16094 (@value{GDBP}) task
16095 [Current task is 2]
16096 @end smallexample
16097
16098 @item task @var{taskno}
16099 @cindex Ada task switching
16100 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
16101 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16102 from the current task to the given task.
16103
16104 @smallexample
16105 @iftex
16106 @leftskip=0.5cm
16107 @end iftex
16108 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16109 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16110 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16111 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16112 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16113 [Switching to task 1]
16114 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16115 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16116 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16117 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16118 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16119 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16120 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16121 @end smallexample
16122
16123 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16124 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16125 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16126 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16127 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16128 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16129 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16130 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16131 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16132
16133 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16134 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16135 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16136 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16137 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16138
16139 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16140 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16141 program.
16142
16143 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16144 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16145 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16146
16147 For example,
16148
16149 @smallexample
16150 @iftex
16151 @leftskip=0.5cm
16152 @end iftex
16153 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16154 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16155 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16156 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16157 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16158 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16159 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16160 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16161 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16162 Continuing.
16163 task # 1 running
16164 task # 2 running
16165
16166 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16167 15 flush;
16168 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16169 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16170 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16171 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16172 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16173 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16174 @end smallexample
16175 @end table
16176
16177 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16178 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16179 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16180
16181 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16182 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16183 the platform being used.
16184 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16185 switching is not supported.
16186
16187 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16188 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16189 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16190 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16191 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16192 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16193
16194 @node Ravenscar Profile
16195 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16196 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16197
16198 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16199 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16200 requirements.
16201
16202 @table @code
16203 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16204 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16205 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16206 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16207 Profile. This is the default.
16208
16209 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16210 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16211 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16212 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16213 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16214 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16215 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16216
16217 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16218 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16219 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16220 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16221
16222 @end table
16223
16224 @node Ada Glitches
16225 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16226 @cindex Ada, problems
16227
16228 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16229 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16230 @value{GDBN},
16231 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16232 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16233
16234 @itemize @bullet
16235 @item
16236 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16237 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16238
16239 @item
16240 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16241 argument lists are treated as positional).
16242
16243 @item
16244 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16245
16246 @item
16247 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16248 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16249 the host machine.
16250
16251 @item
16252 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16253 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16254 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16255 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16256 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16257 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16258 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16259 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16260 you can usually resolve the confusion
16261 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16262 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16263 @end itemize
16264
16265 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16266 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16267 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16268 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16269 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16270 enabled.
16271
16272 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16273 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16274 @table @code
16275
16276 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16277 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16278 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16279 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16280 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16281 This is the default.
16282
16283 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16284 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16285 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16286 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16287 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16288 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16289 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16290
16291 @end table
16292
16293 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16294 @cindex GNAT encoding
16295 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16296 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16297 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16298 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16299 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16300 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16301
16302 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16303 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16304 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16305 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16306 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16307 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16308 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16309 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16310
16311 @table @code
16312
16313 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16314 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16315 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16316 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16317
16318 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16319 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16320 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16321
16322 @end table
16323
16324 @node Unsupported Languages
16325 @section Unsupported Languages
16326
16327 @cindex unsupported languages
16328 @cindex minimal language
16329 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16330 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16331 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16332 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16333 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16334 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16335
16336 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16337 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16338 language.
16339
16340 @node Symbols
16341 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16342
16343 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16344 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16345 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16346 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16347 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16348 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16349 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16350
16351 @cindex symbol names
16352 @cindex names of symbols
16353 @cindex quoting names
16354 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16355 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16356 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16357 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16358 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16359 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16360 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16361 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16362
16363 @smallexample
16364 p 'foo.c'::x
16365 @end smallexample
16366
16367 @noindent
16368 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16369
16370 @table @code
16371 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16372 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16373 @kindex set case-sensitive
16374 @item set case-sensitive on
16375 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16376 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16377 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16378 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16379 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16380 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16381 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16382 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16383 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16384 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16385 case-insensitive matches.
16386
16387 @kindex show case-sensitive
16388 @item show case-sensitive
16389 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16390 lookups.
16391
16392 @kindex set print type methods
16393 @item set print type methods
16394 @itemx set print type methods on
16395 @itemx set print type methods off
16396 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16397 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16398 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16399 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16400 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16401 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16402
16403 @kindex show print type methods
16404 @item show print type methods
16405 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16406 classes.
16407
16408 @kindex set print type typedefs
16409 @item set print type typedefs
16410 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16411 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16412
16413 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16414 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16415 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16416 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16417 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16418 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16419 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16420 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16421 types.
16422
16423 @kindex show print type typedefs
16424 @item show print type typedefs
16425 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16426 printing classes.
16427
16428 @kindex info address
16429 @cindex address of a symbol
16430 @item info address @var{symbol}
16431 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16432 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16433 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16434 is always stored.
16435
16436 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16437 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16438 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16439
16440 @kindex info symbol
16441 @cindex symbol from address
16442 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16443 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16444 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16445 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16446 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16447
16448 @smallexample
16449 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16450 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16451 @end smallexample
16452
16453 @noindent
16454 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16455 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16456
16457 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16458 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16459
16460 @smallexample
16461 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16462 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16463 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16464 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16465 @end smallexample
16466
16467 @kindex demangle
16468 @cindex demangle
16469 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16470 Demangle @var{name}.
16471 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16472 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16473
16474 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16475 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16476
16477 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16478 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16479
16480 @kindex whatis
16481 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16482 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16483 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16484 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16485
16486 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16487 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16488 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16489
16490 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16491 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16492 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16493 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16494 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16495 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16496 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16497 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16498 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16499
16500 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16501 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16502 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16503 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16504 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16505 unroll it.
16506
16507 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16508 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16509 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16510
16511 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16512 Available flags are:
16513
16514 @table @code
16515 @item r
16516 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16517 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16518 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16519
16520 @item m
16521 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16522
16523 @item M
16524 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16525 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16526
16527 @item t
16528 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16529 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16530 names are substituted when printing other types.
16531
16532 @item T
16533 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16534 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16535 @end table
16536
16537 @kindex ptype
16538 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16539 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16540 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16541 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16542
16543 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16544 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16545 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16546 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16547 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16548 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16549 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16550 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16551
16552 For example, for this variable declaration:
16553
16554 @smallexample
16555 typedef double real_t;
16556 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16557 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16558 complex_t var;
16559 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16560 @end smallexample
16561
16562 @noindent
16563 the two commands give this output:
16564
16565 @smallexample
16566 @group
16567 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16568 type = complex_t
16569 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16570 type = struct complex @{
16571 real_t real;
16572 double imag;
16573 @}
16574 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16575 type = struct complex
16576 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16577 type = struct complex
16578 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16579 type = struct complex @{
16580 real_t real;
16581 double imag;
16582 @}
16583 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16584 type = real_t *
16585 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16586 type = double *
16587 @end group
16588 @end smallexample
16589
16590 @noindent
16591 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16592 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16593
16594 @cindex incomplete type
16595 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16596 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16597 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16598 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16599 given these declarations:
16600
16601 @smallexample
16602 struct foo;
16603 struct foo *fooptr;
16604 @end smallexample
16605
16606 @noindent
16607 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16608
16609 @smallexample
16610 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16611 $1 = <incomplete type>
16612 @end smallexample
16613
16614 @noindent
16615 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16616 completely specified.
16617
16618 @kindex info types
16619 @item info types @var{regexp}
16620 @itemx info types
16621 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16622 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16623 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16624 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16625 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16626 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16627 name is @code{value}.
16628
16629 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16630 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16631 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16632
16633 @kindex info type-printers
16634 @item info type-printers
16635 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16636 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16637 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16638 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16639 type printers.
16640
16641 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16642
16643 @kindex enable type-printer
16644 @kindex disable type-printer
16645 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16646 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16647 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16648
16649 @kindex info scope
16650 @cindex local variables
16651 @item info scope @var{location}
16652 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16653 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16654 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16655 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16656 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16657
16658 @smallexample
16659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16660 Scope for command_line_handler:
16661 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16662 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16663 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16664 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16665 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16666 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16667 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16668 @end smallexample
16669
16670 @noindent
16671 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16672 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16673 collect}.
16674
16675 @kindex info source
16676 @item info source
16677 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16678 the function containing the current point of execution:
16679 @itemize @bullet
16680 @item
16681 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16682 @item
16683 the directory it was compiled in,
16684 @item
16685 its length, in lines,
16686 @item
16687 which programming language it is written in,
16688 @item
16689 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16690 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16691 @item
16692 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16693 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16694 @item
16695 whether the debugging information includes information about
16696 preprocessor macros.
16697 @end itemize
16698
16699
16700 @kindex info sources
16701 @item info sources
16702 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16703 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16704 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16705
16706 @kindex info functions
16707 @item info functions
16708 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16709
16710 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16711 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16712 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16713 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16714 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16715 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16716 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16717 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16718
16719 @kindex info variables
16720 @item info variables
16721 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16722 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16723
16724 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16725 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16726 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16727 @var{regexp}.
16728
16729 @kindex info classes
16730 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16731 @item info classes
16732 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16733 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16734 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16735 expression.
16736
16737 @kindex info selectors
16738 @item info selectors
16739 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16740 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16741 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16742 expression.
16743
16744 @ignore
16745 This was never implemented.
16746 @kindex info methods
16747 @item info methods
16748 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16749 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16750 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16751 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16752 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16753 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16754 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16755 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16756 @end ignore
16757
16758 @cindex opaque data types
16759 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16760 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16761 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16762 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16763 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16764 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16765 another source file. The default is on.
16766
16767 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16768 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16769
16770 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16771 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16772 is printed as follows:
16773 @smallexample
16774 @{<no data fields>@}
16775 @end smallexample
16776
16777 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16778 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16779 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16780
16781 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16782 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16783 @item set print symbol-loading
16784 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16785 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16786 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16787 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16788 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16789 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16790 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16791 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16792 can be annoying.
16793 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16794 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16795 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16796 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16797
16798 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16799 @item show print symbol-loading
16800 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16801 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16802
16803 @kindex maint print symbols
16804 @cindex symbol dump
16805 @kindex maint print psymbols
16806 @cindex partial symbol dump
16807 @kindex maint print msymbols
16808 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16809 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16810 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16811 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16812 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16813 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16814 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16815 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16816 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16817 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16818 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16819 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16820 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16821 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16822 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16823 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16824 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16825 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16826
16827 @kindex maint info symtabs
16828 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16829 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16830 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16831 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16832 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16833 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16834 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16835
16836 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16837 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16838 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16839 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16840 structure in more detail. For example:
16841
16842 @smallexample
16843 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16844 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16845 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16846 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16847 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16848 readin no
16849 fullname (null)
16850 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16851 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16852 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16853 dependencies (none)
16854 @}
16855 @}
16856 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16857 (@value{GDBP})
16858 @end smallexample
16859 @noindent
16860 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16861 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16862 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16863 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16864 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16865
16866 @smallexample
16867 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16868 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16869 line 1574.
16870 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16871 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16872 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16873 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16874 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16875 dirname (null)
16876 fullname (null)
16877 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16878 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16879 debugformat DWARF 2
16880 @}
16881 @}
16882 (@value{GDBP})
16883 @end smallexample
16884
16885 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16886 @cindex symbol cache size
16887 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16888 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16889 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16890 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16891 with different sizes.
16892
16893 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16894 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16895 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16896
16897 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16898 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16899 @item maint print symbol-cache
16900 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16901 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16902
16903 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16904 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16905 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16906 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16907 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16908
16909 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16910 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16911 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16912 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16913 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16914 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16915
16916 @end table
16917
16918 @node Altering
16919 @chapter Altering Execution
16920
16921 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16922 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16923 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16924 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16925 program.
16926
16927 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16928 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16929 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16930
16931 @menu
16932 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16933 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16934 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16935 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16936 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16937 * Patching:: Patching your program
16938 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16939 @end menu
16940
16941 @node Assignment
16942 @section Assignment to Variables
16943
16944 @cindex assignment
16945 @cindex setting variables
16946 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16947 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16948
16949 @smallexample
16950 print x=4
16951 @end smallexample
16952
16953 @noindent
16954 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16955 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16956 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16957 information on operators in supported languages.
16958
16959 @kindex set variable
16960 @cindex variables, setting
16961 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16962 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16963 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16964 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16965 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16966
16967 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16968 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16969 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16970 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16971 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16972 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16973 command @code{set width}:
16974
16975 @smallexample
16976 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16977 type = double
16978 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16979 $4 = 13
16980 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16981 Invalid syntax in expression.
16982 @end smallexample
16983
16984 @noindent
16985 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16986 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16987
16988 @smallexample
16989 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16990 @end smallexample
16991
16992 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16993 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16994 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16995 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16996 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16997 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16998
16999 @smallexample
17000 @group
17001 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17002 type = double
17003 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17004 $1 = 1
17005 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17006 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17007 $2 = 1
17008 (@value{GDBP}) r
17009 The program being debugged has been started already.
17010 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17011 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17012 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17013 Invalid bfd target.
17014 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17015 The current BFD target is "=4".
17016 @end group
17017 @end smallexample
17018
17019 @noindent
17020 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17021 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17022 @code{g}, use
17023
17024 @smallexample
17025 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17026 @end smallexample
17027
17028 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17029 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17030 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17031 same length or shorter.
17032 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17033 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17034
17035 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17036 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17037 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17038 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17039 and representation in memory), and
17040
17041 @smallexample
17042 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17043 @end smallexample
17044
17045 @noindent
17046 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17047
17048 @node Jumping
17049 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17050
17051 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17052 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17053 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17054
17055 @table @code
17056 @kindex jump
17057 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17058 @item jump @var{location}
17059 @itemx j @var{location}
17060 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17061 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17062 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17063 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17064 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17065
17066 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17067 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17068 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17069 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17070 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17071 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17072 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17073 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17074 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17075 @end table
17076
17077 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
17078 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17079 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17080 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17081 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17082 example,
17083
17084 @smallexample
17085 set $pc = 0x485
17086 @end smallexample
17087
17088 @noindent
17089 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17090 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17091 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17092
17093 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17094 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17095 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17096 detail.
17097
17098 @c @group
17099 @node Signaling
17100 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17101 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17102
17103 @table @code
17104 @kindex signal
17105 @item signal @var{signal}
17106 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17107 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17108 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17109 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17110
17111 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17112 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17113 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17114 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17115 signal.
17116
17117 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17118 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17119 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17120 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17121 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17122 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17123 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17124 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17125
17126 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17127 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17128 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17129 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17130 passes the signal directly to your program.
17131
17132 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17133 after executing the command.
17134
17135 @kindex queue-signal
17136 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17137 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17138 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17139 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17140 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17141 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17142 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17143 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17144 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17145
17146 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17147 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17148 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17149 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17150 @code{continue} command.
17151
17152 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17153 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17154 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17155 (@pxref{Signals}).
17156 @end table
17157 @c @end group
17158
17159 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17160 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17161
17162 @node Returning
17163 @section Returning from a Function
17164
17165 @table @code
17166 @cindex returning from a function
17167 @kindex return
17168 @item return
17169 @itemx return @var{expression}
17170 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17171 command. If you give an
17172 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17173 value.
17174 @end table
17175
17176 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17177 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17178 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17179 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17180
17181 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17182 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17183 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17184 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17185 of functions.
17186
17187 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17188 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17189 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17190 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17191 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17192
17193 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17194 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17195 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17196 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17197 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17198 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17199 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17200 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17201 assignment into the right register(s).
17202
17203 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17204 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17205 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17206 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17207 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17208 into a @code{long long int}:
17209
17210 @smallexample
17211 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17212 29 return 31;
17213 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17214 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17215 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17216 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17217 (@value{GDBP})
17218 @end smallexample
17219
17220 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17221 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17222 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17223 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17224 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17225 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17226 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17227 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17228
17229 @smallexample
17230 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17231 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17232 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17233 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17234 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17235 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17236 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17237 (@value{GDBP})
17238 @end smallexample
17239
17240 @node Calling
17241 @section Calling Program Functions
17242
17243 @table @code
17244 @cindex calling functions
17245 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17246 @item print @var{expr}
17247 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17248 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17249 debugged.
17250
17251 @kindex call
17252 @item call @var{expr}
17253 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17254 returned values.
17255
17256 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17257 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17258 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17259 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17260 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17261 value history.
17262 @end table
17263
17264 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17265 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17266 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17267 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17268
17269 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17270 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17271 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17272 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17273 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17274 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17275 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17276 in that case is controlled by the
17277 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17278
17279 @table @code
17280 @item set unwindonsignal
17281 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17282 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17283 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17284 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17285 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17286 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17287 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17288 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17289 received.
17290
17291 @item show unwindonsignal
17292 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17293 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17294 @value{GDBN}.
17295
17296 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17297 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17298 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17299 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17300 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17301 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17302 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17303 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17304 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17305 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17306
17307 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17308 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17309 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17310 @value{GDBN}.
17311
17312 @end table
17313
17314 @cindex weak alias functions
17315 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17316 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17317 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17318 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17319 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17320 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17321 function instead.
17322
17323 @node Patching
17324 @section Patching Programs
17325
17326 @cindex patching binaries
17327 @cindex writing into executables
17328 @cindex writing into corefiles
17329
17330 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17331 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17332 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17333 patching your program's binary.
17334
17335 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17336 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17337 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17338 repairs.
17339
17340 @table @code
17341 @kindex set write
17342 @item set write on
17343 @itemx set write off
17344 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17345 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17346 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17347
17348 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17349 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17350 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17351
17352 @item show write
17353 @kindex show write
17354 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17355 as well as reading.
17356 @end table
17357
17358 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17359 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17360 @cindex injecting code
17361 @cindex writing into executables
17362 @cindex compiling code
17363
17364 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17365 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17366 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17367 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17368
17369 @table @code
17370 @kindex compile code
17371 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17372 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17373 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17374 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17375 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17376 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17377 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17378 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17379 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17380 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17381 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17382 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17383
17384 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17385 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17386 E.g.:
17387
17388 @smallexample
17389 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17390 @end smallexample
17391
17392 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17393 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17394 from actual source code. E.g.:
17395
17396 @smallexample
17397 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17398 @end smallexample
17399
17400 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17401 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17402 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17403 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17404 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17405 editor.
17406
17407 @smallexample
17408 compile code
17409 >printf ("hello\n");
17410 >printf ("world\n");
17411 >end
17412 @end smallexample
17413
17414 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17415 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17416 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17417 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17418 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17419 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17420 inferior symbols otherwise.
17421
17422 @kindex compile file
17423 @item compile file @var{filename}
17424 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17425 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17426
17427 @smallexample
17428 compile file /home/user/example.c
17429 @end smallexample
17430 @end table
17431
17432 @table @code
17433 @item compile print @var{expr}
17434 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17435 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17436 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17437 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17438 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17439 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17440 Formats}.
17441
17442 @item compile print
17443 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17444 @cindex reprint the last value
17445 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17446 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17447 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17448 multiple-line editor.
17449 @end table
17450
17451 @noindent
17452 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17453
17454 @table @code
17455 @anchor{set debug compile}
17456 @item set debug compile
17457 @cindex compile command debugging info
17458 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17459 injecting the code. The default is off.
17460
17461 @item show debug compile
17462 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17463 compiling and injecting the code.
17464 @end table
17465
17466 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17467
17468 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17469 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17470 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17471 injecting process.
17472
17473 @noindent
17474 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17475
17476 @table @asis
17477 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17478 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17479 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17480 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17481
17482 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17483 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17484 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17485 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17486 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17487 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17488 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17489 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17490
17491 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17492 @end table
17493
17494 @noindent
17495 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17496
17497 @table @code
17498 @item set compile-args
17499 @cindex compile command options override
17500 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17501 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17502 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17503 compilation.
17504
17505 @item show compile-args
17506 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17507 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17508 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17509 @end table
17510
17511 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17512
17513 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17514 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17515 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17516
17517 @table @asis
17518 @item C code examples and caveats
17519 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17520 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17521 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17522 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17523 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17524
17525 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17526 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17527 much like any other normal debugging session.
17528
17529 @smallexample
17530 void function1 (void)
17531 @{
17532 int i = 42;
17533 printf ("function 1\n");
17534 @}
17535
17536 void function2 (void)
17537 @{
17538 int j = 12;
17539 function1 ();
17540 @}
17541
17542 int main(void)
17543 @{
17544 int k = 6;
17545 int *p;
17546 function2 ();
17547 return 0;
17548 @}
17549 @end smallexample
17550
17551 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17552 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17553 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17554
17555 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17556 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17557 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17558 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17559 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17560
17561 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17562 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17563 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17564 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17565 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17566 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17567 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17568 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17569 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17570 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17571
17572 @smallexample
17573 compile code k = 3;
17574 @end smallexample
17575
17576 @noindent
17577 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17578 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17579 @code{compile} command changes it.
17580
17581 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17582 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17583 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17584 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17585 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17586
17587 @smallexample
17588 compile code j = 3;
17589 @end smallexample
17590
17591 @noindent
17592 will result in a compilation error message.
17593
17594 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17595 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17596 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17597
17598 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17599 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17600 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17601 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17602
17603 @smallexample
17604 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17605 @end smallexample
17606
17607 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17608 command has completed:
17609
17610 @smallexample
17611 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17612 @end smallexample
17613
17614 @noindent
17615 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17616 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17617 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17618 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17619 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17620
17621 @smallexample
17622 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17623 @end smallexample
17624
17625 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17626 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17627 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17628 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17629 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17630 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17631 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17632 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17633
17634 @smallexample
17635 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17636 @end smallexample
17637
17638 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17639 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17640 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17641 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17642 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17643 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17644 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17645
17646 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17647 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17648 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17649 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17650 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17651 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17652
17653 @smallexample
17654 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17655 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17656 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17657 Compilation failed.
17658 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17659 42
17660 @end smallexample
17661
17662 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17663 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17664 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17665 will print to the console.
17666 @end table
17667
17668 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17669
17670 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17671 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17672 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17673 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17674 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17675 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17676 target architecture and operating system.
17677
17678 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17679 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17680 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17681 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17682 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17683 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17684 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17685
17686 @node GDB Files
17687 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17688
17689 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17690 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17691 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17692 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17693
17694 @menu
17695 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17696 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17697 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17698 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17699 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17700 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17701 @end menu
17702
17703 @node Files
17704 @section Commands to Specify Files
17705
17706 @cindex symbol table
17707 @cindex core dump file
17708
17709 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17710 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17711 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17712 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17713
17714 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17715 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17716 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17717 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17718 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17719 new files are useful.
17720
17721 @table @code
17722 @cindex executable file
17723 @kindex file
17724 @item file @var{filename}
17725 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17726 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17727 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17728 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17729 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17730 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17731 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17732 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17733
17734 @cindex unlinked object files
17735 @cindex patching object files
17736 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17737 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17738 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17739 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17740 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17741 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17742 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17743 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17744
17745 @item file
17746 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17747 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17748
17749 @kindex exec-file
17750 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17751 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17752 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17753 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17754 discard information on the executable file.
17755
17756 @kindex symbol-file
17757 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17758 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17759 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17760 table and program to run from the same file.
17761
17762 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17763 program's symbol table.
17764
17765 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17766 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17767 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17768 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17769 @value{GDBN}.
17770
17771 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17772 executing it once.
17773
17774 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17775 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17776 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17777 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17778 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17779 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17780 optimized code.
17781
17782 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17783 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17784 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17785 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17786 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17787
17788 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17789 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17790 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17791 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17792 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17793 Warnings and Messages}.)
17794
17795 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17796 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17797 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17798 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17799 in stabs format.
17800
17801 @kindex readnow
17802 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17803 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17804 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17805 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17806 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17807 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17808 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17809 entire symbol table available.
17810
17811 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17812 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17813 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17814 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17815 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17816 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17817 @c files.
17818
17819 @kindex core-file
17820 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17821 @itemx core
17822 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17823 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17824 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17825 executable file itself for other parts.
17826
17827 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17828 to be used.
17829
17830 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17831 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17832 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17833 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17834 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17835
17836 @kindex add-symbol-file
17837 @cindex dynamic linking
17838 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17839 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17840 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17841 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17842 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17843 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17844 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17845 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17846 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17847 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17848 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17849 @var{address} as an expression.
17850
17851 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17852 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17853 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17854 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17855
17856 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17857
17858 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17859 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17860 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17861 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17862 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17863 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17864 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17865 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17866 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17867
17868 @itemize @bullet
17869 @item
17870 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17871 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17872 @item
17873 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17874 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17875 @item
17876 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17877 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17878 @end itemize
17879
17880 @noindent
17881 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17882 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17883 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17884 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17885 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17886 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17887 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17888 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17889 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17890 way.
17891
17892 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17893
17894 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17895 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17896 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17897 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17898 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17899 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17900
17901 @smallexample
17902 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17903 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17904 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17905 (y or n) y
17906 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17907 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17908 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17909 (gdb)
17910 @end smallexample
17911
17912
17913 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17914
17915 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17916 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17917 @cindex load symbols from memory
17918 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17919 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17920 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17921 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17922 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17923 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17924 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17925 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17926 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17927
17928 @kindex section
17929 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17930 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17931 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17932 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17933 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17934 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17935 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17936 their addresses.
17937
17938 @kindex info files
17939 @kindex info target
17940 @item info files
17941 @itemx info target
17942 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17943 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17944 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17945 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17946 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17947 current ones.
17948
17949 @kindex maint info sections
17950 @item maint info sections
17951 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17952 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17953 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17954 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17955 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17956 may be arbitrarily combined):
17957
17958 @table @code
17959 @item ALLOBJ
17960 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17961 @item @var{sections}
17962 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17963 @item @var{section-flags}
17964 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17965 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17966 @table @code
17967 @item ALLOC
17968 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17969 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17970 @item LOAD
17971 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17972 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17973 @item RELOC
17974 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17975 @item READONLY
17976 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17977 @item CODE
17978 Section contains executable code only.
17979 @item DATA
17980 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17981 @item ROM
17982 Section will reside in ROM.
17983 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17984 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17985 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17986 Section is not empty.
17987 @item NEVER_LOAD
17988 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17989 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17990 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17991 COFF shared library information.
17992 @item IS_COMMON
17993 Section contains common symbols.
17994 @end table
17995 @end table
17996 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17997 @cindex read-only sections
17998 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17999 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18000 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18001 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18002 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18003 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18004 enhancement to debugging performance.
18005
18006 The default is off.
18007
18008 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18009 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18010 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18011 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18012
18013 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18014 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18015 @end table
18016
18017 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18018 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18019 name and remembers it that way.
18020
18021 @cindex shared libraries
18022 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18023 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
18024 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
18025
18026 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18027 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18028
18029 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18030 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18031 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18032 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18033 debugging a core file).
18034
18035 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
18036 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
18037
18038 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18039 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18040 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18041
18042 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18043 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18044 particularly large or there are many of them.
18045
18046 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18047 commands:
18048
18049 @table @code
18050 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18051 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18052 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18053 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18054 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18055 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18056 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18057 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18058
18059 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18060 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18061 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18062 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18063 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18064 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18065 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18066 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18067 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18068
18069 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18070 @item show auto-solib-add
18071 Display the current autoloading mode.
18072 @end table
18073
18074 @cindex load shared library
18075 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18076 command:
18077
18078 @table @code
18079 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18080 @kindex info share
18081 @item info share @var{regex}
18082 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18083 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18084 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18085 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18086
18087 @kindex info dll
18088 @item info dll @var{regex}
18089 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18090
18091 @kindex sharedlibrary
18092 @kindex share
18093 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18094 @itemx share @var{regex}
18095 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18096 Unix regular expression.
18097 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18098 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18099 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18100 loaded.
18101
18102 @item nosharedlibrary
18103 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18104 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18105 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18106 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18107 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18108 discarded.
18109 @end table
18110
18111 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18112 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18113 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18114 Catchpoints}).
18115
18116 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18117 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18118 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18119 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18120
18121 @table @code
18122 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18123 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18124 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18125 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18126 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18127 shared library.
18128
18129 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18130 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18131 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18132 library events happen.
18133 @end table
18134
18135 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18136 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18137 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18138 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18139 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18140 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18141 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18142 not.
18143
18144 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18145 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18146 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18147 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18148 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18149
18150 @table @code
18151 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18152 @cindex system root, alternate
18153 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18154 @kindex set sysroot
18155 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18156 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18157 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18158 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18159 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18160 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18161 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18162 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18163 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18164 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18165 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18166 @var{path}.
18167
18168 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18169 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18170 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18171 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18172 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18173 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18174 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18175 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18176 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18177 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18178 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18179 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18180 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18181 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18182
18183 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18184 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18185 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18186 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18187 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18188
18189 @smallexample
18190 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18191 @end smallexample
18192
18193 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18194 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18195 system:
18196
18197 @smallexample
18198 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18199 @end smallexample
18200
18201 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18202 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18203 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18204 colons:
18205
18206 @smallexample
18207 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18208 @end smallexample
18209
18210 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18211 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18212 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18213 @samp{z}):
18214
18215 @smallexample
18216 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18217 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18218 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18219 @end smallexample
18220
18221 @noindent
18222 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18223 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18224 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18225
18226 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18227 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18228
18229 @smallexample
18230 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18231 @end smallexample
18232
18233 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18234 if you don't want or need to.
18235
18236 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18237 sysroot}.
18238
18239 @cindex default system root
18240 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18241 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18242 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18243 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18244 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18245 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18246 location.
18247
18248 @kindex show sysroot
18249 @item show sysroot
18250 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18251
18252 @kindex set solib-search-path
18253 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18254 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18255 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18256 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18257 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18258 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18259 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18260 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18261 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18262 of shared library symbols.
18263
18264 @kindex show solib-search-path
18265 @item show solib-search-path
18266 Display the current shared library search path.
18267
18268 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18269 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18270 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18271 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18272 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18273
18274 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18275 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18276 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18277 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18278 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18279 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18280 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18281 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18282 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18283 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18284 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18285 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18286 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18287 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18288 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18289 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18290 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18291 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18292 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18293 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18294 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18295 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18296
18297 @table @code
18298 @item unix
18299 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18300 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18301 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18302 the forward slash.
18303
18304 @item dos-based
18305 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18306 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18307 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18308 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18309 considered directory separators.
18310
18311 @item auto
18312 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18313 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18314 This is the default.
18315 @end table
18316 @end table
18317
18318 @cindex file name canonicalization
18319 @cindex base name differences
18320 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18321 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18322 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18323 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18324 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18325 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18326 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18327 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18328 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18329 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18330 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18331 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18332 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18333 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18334 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18335
18336 @table @code
18337 @item set basenames-may-differ
18338 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18339 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18340
18341 @item show basenames-may-differ
18342 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18343 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18344 @end table
18345
18346 @node File Caching
18347 @section File Caching
18348 @cindex caching of opened files
18349 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18350
18351 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18352 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18353 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18354 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18355
18356 @table @code
18357 @kindex maint info bfds
18358 @item maint info bfds
18359 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18360 @value{GDBN}.
18361
18362 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18363 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18364 @kindex bfd caching
18365 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18366 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18367 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18368 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18369 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18370 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18371 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18372 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18373 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18374 @end table
18375
18376 @node Separate Debug Files
18377 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18378 @cindex separate debugging information files
18379 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18380 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18381 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18382 @cindex global debugging information directories
18383 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18384 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18385
18386 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18387 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18388 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18389 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18390 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18391 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18392 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18393
18394 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18395 file:
18396
18397 @itemize @bullet
18398 @item
18399 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18400 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18401 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18402 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18403 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18404 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18405 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18406 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18407
18408 @item
18409 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18410 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18411 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18412 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18413 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18414 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18415 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18416 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18417 below.
18418 @end itemize
18419
18420 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18421 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18422
18423 @itemize @bullet
18424 @item
18425 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18426 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18427 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18428 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18429 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18430
18431 @item
18432 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18433 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18434 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18435 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18436 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18437 hex characters, not 10.)
18438 @end itemize
18439
18440 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18441 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18442 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18443 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18444 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18445 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18446
18447 @itemize @minus
18448 @item
18449 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18450 @item
18451 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18452 @item
18453 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18454 @item
18455 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18456 @end itemize
18457
18458 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18459 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18460 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18461 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18462 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18463
18464 @table @code
18465
18466 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18467 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18468 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18469 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18470 concatenating them by a path separator.
18471
18472 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18473 @item show debug-file-directory
18474 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18475 information files.
18476
18477 @end table
18478
18479 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18480 @cindex debug link sections
18481 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18482 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18483
18484 @itemize
18485 @item
18486 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18487 a zero byte,
18488 @item
18489 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18490 boundary within the section, and
18491 @item
18492 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18493 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18494 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18495 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18496 @end itemize
18497
18498 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18499 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18500 described above.
18501
18502 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18503 @cindex build ID sections
18504 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18505 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18506 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18507 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18508 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18509 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18510 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18511 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18512 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18513
18514 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18515 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18516 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18517 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18518 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18519 in an ordinary executable.
18520
18521 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18522 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18523 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18524 following commands:
18525
18526 @smallexample
18527 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18528 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18529 @end smallexample
18530
18531 @noindent
18532 These commands remove the debugging
18533 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18534 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18535 two files:
18536
18537 @itemize @bullet
18538 @item
18539 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18540 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18541
18542 @smallexample
18543 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18544 @end smallexample
18545
18546 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18547 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18548 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18549 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18550
18551 @item
18552 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18553 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18554 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18555 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18556 @end itemize
18557
18558 @noindent
18559
18560 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18561 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18562 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18563
18564 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18565 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18566 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18567 @c different ways!
18568 @ifhtml
18569 @display
18570 @html
18571 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18572 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18573 @end html
18574 @end display
18575 @end ifhtml
18576 @ifnothtml
18577 @display
18578 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18579 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18580 @end display
18581 @end ifnothtml
18582
18583 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18584 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18585 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18586 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18587 CRC.
18588
18589 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18590 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18591 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18592 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18593 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18594
18595 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18596 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18597 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18598 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18599 @code{0xffffffff}.
18600
18601 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18602 @smallexample
18603 unsigned long
18604 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18605 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18606 @{
18607 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18608 @{
18609 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18610 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18611 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18612 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18613 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18614 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18615 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18616 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18617 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18618 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18619 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18620 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18621 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18622 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18623 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18624 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18625 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18626 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18627 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18628 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18629 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18630 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18631 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18632 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18633 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18634 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18635 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18636 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18637 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18638 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18639 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18640 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18641 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18642 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18643 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18644 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18645 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18646 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18647 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18648 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18649 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18650 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18651 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18652 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18653 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18654 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18655 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18656 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18657 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18658 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18659 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18660 0x2d02ef8d
18661 @};
18662 unsigned char *end;
18663
18664 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18665 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18666 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18667 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18668 @}
18669 @end smallexample
18670
18671 @noindent
18672 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18673
18674 @node MiniDebugInfo
18675 @section Debugging information in a special section
18676 @cindex separate debug sections
18677 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18678
18679 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18680 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18681 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18682 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18683
18684 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18685 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18686 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18687 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18688 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18689 debugging information might be included in the section.
18690
18691 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18692 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18693 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18694
18695 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18696 standard utilities:
18697
18698 @smallexample
18699 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18700 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18701 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18702 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18703
18704 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18705 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18706 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18707 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18708 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18709 | sort > funcsyms
18710
18711 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18712 # table.
18713 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18714
18715 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18716 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18717
18718 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18719 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18720 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18721 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18722
18723 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18724 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18725
18726 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18727 # original binary.
18728 xz mini_debuginfo
18729 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18730 @end smallexample
18731
18732 @node Index Files
18733 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18734 @cindex index files
18735 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18736
18737 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18738 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18739 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18740 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18741 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18742 startup.
18743
18744 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18745 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18746 using @command{objcopy}.
18747
18748 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18749
18750 @table @code
18751 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18752 @kindex save gdb-index
18753 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18754 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18755 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18756 @var{directory}.
18757 @end table
18758
18759 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18760 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18761
18762 @smallexample
18763 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18764 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18765 @end smallexample
18766
18767 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18768 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18769 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18770 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18771 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18772 The default is @code{off}.
18773 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18774 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18775
18776 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18777 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18778
18779 @smallexample
18780 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18781 @end smallexample
18782
18783 Instead you must do, for example,
18784
18785 @smallexample
18786 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18787 @end smallexample
18788
18789 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18790 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18791 currently work for programs using Ada.
18792
18793 @node Symbol Errors
18794 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18795
18796 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18797 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18798 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18799 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18800 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18801 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18802 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18803 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18804 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18805 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18806 Messages}).
18807
18808 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18809
18810 @table @code
18811 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18812
18813 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18814 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18815 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18816 in its outer scope blocks.
18817
18818 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18819 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18820 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18821 function.
18822
18823 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18824
18825 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18826 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18827 do so.
18828
18829 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18830 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18831 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18832 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18833 Messages}.)
18834
18835 @item bad block start address patched
18836
18837 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18838 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18839 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18840
18841 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18842 starting on the previous source line.
18843
18844 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18845
18846 @cindex foo
18847 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18848 larger than the size of the string table.
18849
18850 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18851 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18852 with this name.
18853
18854 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18855
18856 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18857 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18858 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18859
18860 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18861 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18862 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18863 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18864 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18865 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18866
18867 @item stub type has NULL name
18868
18869 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18870
18871 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18872 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18873 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18874 it.
18875
18876 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18877
18878 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18879
18880 @end table
18881
18882 @node Data Files
18883 @section GDB Data Files
18884
18885 @cindex prefix for data files
18886 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18887 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18888
18889 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18890 is currently using.
18891
18892 @table @code
18893 @kindex set data-directory
18894 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18895 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18896 to @var{directory}.
18897
18898 @kindex show data-directory
18899 @item show data-directory
18900 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18901 @end table
18902
18903 @cindex default data directory
18904 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18905 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18906 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18907 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18908 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18909 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18910 location.
18911
18912 The data directory may also be specified with the
18913 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18914 @xref{Mode Options}.
18915
18916 @node Targets
18917 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18918
18919 @cindex debugging target
18920 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18921
18922 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18923 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18924 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18925 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18926 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18927 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18928 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18929 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18930
18931 @cindex target architecture
18932 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18933 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18934 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18935 command.
18936
18937 @table @code
18938 @kindex set architecture
18939 @kindex show architecture
18940 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18941 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18942 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18943 supported architectures.
18944
18945 @item show architecture
18946 Show the current target architecture.
18947
18948 @item set processor
18949 @itemx processor
18950 @kindex set processor
18951 @kindex show processor
18952 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18953 and @code{show architecture}.
18954 @end table
18955
18956 @menu
18957 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18958 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18959 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18960 @end menu
18961
18962 @node Active Targets
18963 @section Active Targets
18964
18965 @cindex stacking targets
18966 @cindex active targets
18967 @cindex multiple targets
18968
18969 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18970 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18971 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18972 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18973 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18974 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18975 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18976 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18977 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18978
18979 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18980 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18981 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18982 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18983
18984 @node Target Commands
18985 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18986
18987 @table @code
18988 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18989 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18990 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18991 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18992 protocol of the target machine.
18993
18994 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18995 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18996 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18997
18998 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18999 after executing the command.
19000
19001 @kindex help target
19002 @item help target
19003 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19004 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19005 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19006
19007 @item help target @var{name}
19008 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19009 select it.
19010
19011 @kindex set gnutarget
19012 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19013 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19014 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19015 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19016 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19017 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19018
19019 @quotation
19020 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19021 you must know the actual BFD name.
19022 @end quotation
19023
19024 @noindent
19025 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19026
19027 @kindex show gnutarget
19028 @item show gnutarget
19029 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19030 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19031 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19032 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19033 @end table
19034
19035 @cindex common targets
19036 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19037 configuration):
19038
19039 @table @code
19040 @kindex target
19041 @item target exec @var{program}
19042 @cindex executable file target
19043 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19044 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19045
19046 @item target core @var{filename}
19047 @cindex core dump file target
19048 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19049 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19050
19051 @item target remote @var{medium}
19052 @cindex remote target
19053 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19054 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19055 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19056
19057 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19058 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19059
19060 @smallexample
19061 target remote /dev/ttya
19062 @end smallexample
19063
19064 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19065 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19066 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19067 clobbered by the download.
19068
19069 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19070 @cindex built-in simulator target
19071 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19072 In general,
19073 @smallexample
19074 target sim
19075 load
19076 run
19077 @end smallexample
19078 @noindent
19079 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19080 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19081 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19082 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19083 Processors}.
19084
19085 @item target native
19086 @cindex native target
19087 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19088 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19089 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19090 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19091
19092 @end table
19093
19094 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19095 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19096
19097 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19098 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19099 various aspects of this process.
19100
19101 @table @code
19102
19103 @item set hash
19104 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19105 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19106 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19107 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19108 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19109 monitor.
19110
19111 @item show hash
19112 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19113 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19114
19115 @item set debug monitor
19116 @kindex set debug monitor
19117 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19118 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19119 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19120
19121 @item show debug monitor
19122 @kindex show debug monitor
19123 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19124 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19125 @end table
19126
19127 @table @code
19128
19129 @kindex load @var{filename}
19130 @item load @var{filename}
19131 @anchor{load}
19132 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19133 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19134 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19135 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19136 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19137 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19138
19139 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19140 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19141 target is @dots{}}''
19142
19143 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19144 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19145 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19146 specifies a fixed address.
19147 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19148
19149 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19150 load programs into flash memory.
19151
19152 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19153 @end table
19154
19155 @node Byte Order
19156 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19157
19158 @cindex choosing target byte order
19159 @cindex target byte order
19160
19161 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19162 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19163 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19164 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19165 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19166 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19167
19168 @table @code
19169 @kindex set endian
19170 @item set endian big
19171 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19172
19173 @item set endian little
19174 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19175
19176 @item set endian auto
19177 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19178 executable.
19179
19180 @item show endian
19181 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19182
19183 @end table
19184
19185 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19186 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19187 target system.
19188
19189
19190 @node Remote Debugging
19191 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19192 @cindex remote debugging
19193
19194 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19195 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19196 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19197 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19198 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19199
19200 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19201 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19202 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19203 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19204 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19205 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19206
19207 Other remote targets may be available in your
19208 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19209
19210 @menu
19211 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19212 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19213 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19214 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19215 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19216 @end menu
19217
19218 @node Connecting
19219 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19220
19221 @value{GDBN} needs an unstripped copy of your program to access symbol
19222 and debugging information. Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer
19223 executable filename read}, and @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow
19224 @value{GDBN} to access program files over the same connection used to
19225 communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a target, if the remote
19226 program is unstripped, the only command you need is @code{target
19227 remote}. Otherwise, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19228 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19229 @code{file} command.
19230
19231 @cindex @code{target remote}
19232 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19233 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19234 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19235 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19236 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
19237 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
19238
19239 @table @code
19240
19241 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19242 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19243 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19244 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19245
19246 @smallexample
19247 target remote /dev/ttyb
19248 @end smallexample
19249
19250 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19251 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19252 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19253 @code{target} command.
19254
19255 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19256 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19257 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19258 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19259 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19260 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19261 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19262 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19263 target.
19264
19265 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19266 @code{manyfarms}:
19267
19268 @smallexample
19269 target remote manyfarms:2828
19270 @end smallexample
19271
19272 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19273 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19274 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19275 port 1234 on your local machine:
19276
19277 @smallexample
19278 target remote :1234
19279 @end smallexample
19280 @noindent
19281
19282 Note that the colon is still required here.
19283
19284 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19285 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19286 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19287 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19288
19289 @smallexample
19290 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19291 @end smallexample
19292
19293 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19294 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19295 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19296 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19297
19298 @item target remote | @var{command}
19299 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19300 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19301 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19302 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19303 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19304 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19305 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19306 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19307
19308 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19309 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19310 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19311
19312 @end table
19313
19314 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
19315 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
19316 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
19317 need to use @kbd{run}.
19318
19319 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19320 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19321 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19322 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19323 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19324 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19325 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19326
19327 @smallexample
19328 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19329 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19330 @end smallexample
19331
19332 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
19333 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
19334 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
19335 goes back to waiting.
19336
19337 @table @code
19338 @kindex detach (remote)
19339 @item detach
19340 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19341 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19342 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19343 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19344 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
19345
19346 @kindex disconnect
19347 @item disconnect
19348 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
19349 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19350 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19351 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19352 another target.
19353
19354 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19355 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19356 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19357 @kindex monitor
19358 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19359 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19360 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19361 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19362 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19363 and implement.
19364 @end table
19365
19366 @node File Transfer
19367 @section Sending files to a remote system
19368 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19369 @cindex file transfer
19370 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19371
19372 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19373 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19374 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19375 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19376 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19377 the only way to upload or download files.
19378
19379 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19380
19381 @table @code
19382 @kindex remote put
19383 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19384 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19385 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19386
19387 @kindex remote get
19388 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19389 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19390 on the host system.
19391
19392 @kindex remote delete
19393 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19394 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19395
19396 @end table
19397
19398 @node Server
19399 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19400
19401 @kindex gdbserver
19402 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19403 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19404 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19405 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
19406
19407 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19408 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19409 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19410 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19411 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19412 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19413 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19414 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19415 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19416 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19417 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19418 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19419 choice for debugging.
19420
19421 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19422 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19423 protocol.
19424
19425 @quotation
19426 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19427 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19428 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19429 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19430 @code{gdbserver}.
19431 @end quotation
19432
19433 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19434 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19435 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19436
19437 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19438 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19439 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19440 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19441 system does all the symbol handling.
19442
19443 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19444 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19445 syntax is:
19446
19447 @smallexample
19448 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19449 @end smallexample
19450
19451 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19452 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19453 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19454 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19455 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19456 @file{/dev/com1}:
19457
19458 @smallexample
19459 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19460 @end smallexample
19461
19462 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19463 with it.
19464
19465 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19466
19467 @smallexample
19468 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19469 @end smallexample
19470
19471 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19472 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19473 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19474 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19475 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19476 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19477 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19478 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19479 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19480 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19481 @code{target remote} command.
19482
19483 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19484 with ssh:
19485
19486 @smallexample
19487 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19488 @end smallexample
19489
19490 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19491 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19492 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19493 You could elide it if you want to.
19494
19495 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19496 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19497 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19498 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19499
19500 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19501 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19502 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19503
19504 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19505 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19506
19507 @smallexample
19508 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19509 @end smallexample
19510
19511 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19512 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19513
19514 @pindex pidof
19515 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19516 @code{pidof} utility:
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19520 @end smallexample
19521
19522 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19523 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19524 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19525
19526 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19527 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19528 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19529
19530 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19531 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19532 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19533 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19534
19535 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19536 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19537 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19538 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19539 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19540 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19541 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19542 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19543 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19544
19545 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19546 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19547 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19548 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19549 the program you want to debug.
19550
19551 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19552 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19553 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19554 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19555 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19556 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19557
19558 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19559
19560 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19561
19562 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19563 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19564 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19565 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19566 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19567 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19568 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19569 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19570
19571 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19572 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19573 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19574
19575 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19576 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19577 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19578 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19579 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19580 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19581 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19582 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19583 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19584 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19585 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19586 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19587
19588 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19589 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19590
19591 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19592 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19593 status information about the debugging process.
19594 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19595 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19596 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19597 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19598
19599 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19600 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19601 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19602 Possible options are:
19603
19604 @table @code
19605 @item none
19606 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19607 @item all
19608 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19609 @item timestamps
19610 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19611 @end table
19612
19613 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19614 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19615
19616 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19617 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19618 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19619 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19620 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19621
19622 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19623 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19624 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19625 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19626
19627 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19628 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19629 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19630 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19631
19632 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19633 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19634 environment:
19635
19636 @smallexample
19637 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19638 @end smallexample
19639
19640 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19641
19642 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19643
19644 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19645 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19646 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19647 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19648
19649 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19650 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19651 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19652 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19653 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19654 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19655 programs.
19656
19657 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19658 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19659 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19660 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19661 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19662 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19663 already on the target.
19664
19665 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19666 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19667 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19668
19669 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19670 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19671 Here are the available commands.
19672
19673 @table @code
19674 @item monitor help
19675 List the available monitor commands.
19676
19677 @item monitor set debug 0
19678 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19679 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19680
19681 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19682 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19683 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19684 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19685
19686 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19687 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19688 Possible options are:
19689
19690 @table @code
19691 @item none
19692 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19693 @item all
19694 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19695 @item timestamps
19696 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19697 @end table
19698
19699 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19700 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19701
19702 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19703 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19704 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19705 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19706 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19707 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19708
19709 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19710 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19711
19712 @item monitor exit
19713 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19714 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19715 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19716 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19717 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19718
19719 @end table
19720
19721 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19722 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19723
19724 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19725 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19726
19727 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19728 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19729 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19730 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19731 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19732 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19733 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19734 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19735 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19736 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19737 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19738 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19739
19740 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19741
19742 @table @code
19743 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19744
19745 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19746 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19747 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19748
19749 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19750
19751 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19752 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19753 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19754 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19755 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19756 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19757
19758 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19759
19760 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19761 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19762 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19763 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19764 command for that. For example:
19765
19766 @smallexample
19767 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19768 @end smallexample
19769
19770 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19771 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19772 @end table
19773
19774 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19775 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19776 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19777 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19778 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19779 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19780 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19781 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19782 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19783 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19784
19785 @smallexample
19786 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19787 @end smallexample
19788
19789 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19790
19791 @smallexample
19792 $ gdb myprogram
19793 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19794 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19795 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19796 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19797 @end smallexample
19798
19799 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19800 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19801 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19802 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19803 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19804 tracing.
19805
19806 @node Remote Configuration
19807 @section Remote Configuration
19808
19809 @kindex set remote
19810 @kindex show remote
19811 This section documents the configuration options available when
19812 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19813 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19814 system-call-allowed}.
19815
19816 @table @code
19817 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19818 @cindex address size for remote targets
19819 @cindex bits in remote address
19820 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19821 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19822 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19823 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19824
19825 @item show remoteaddresssize
19826 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19827
19828 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19829 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19830 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19831 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19832 remote targets.
19833
19834 @item show serial baud
19835 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19836
19837 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19838 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19839 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19840
19841 @item show serial parity
19842 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19843
19844 @item set remotebreak
19845 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19846 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19847 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19848 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19849 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19850 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19851 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19852 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19853
19854 @item show remotebreak
19855 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19856 interrupt the remote program.
19857
19858 @item set remoteflow on
19859 @itemx set remoteflow off
19860 @kindex set remoteflow
19861 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19862 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19863
19864 @item show remoteflow
19865 @kindex show remoteflow
19866 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19867
19868 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19869 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19870 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19871 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19872 @code{ascii}.
19873
19874 @item show remotelogbase
19875 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19876 protocol.
19877
19878 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19879 @cindex record serial communications on file
19880 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19881 default is not to record at all.
19882
19883 @item show remotelogfile.
19884 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19885 serial communications.
19886
19887 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19888 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19889 @cindex remote timeout
19890 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19891 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19892
19893 @item show remotetimeout
19894 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19895 responses.
19896
19897 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19898 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19899 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19900 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19901 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19902 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19903 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19904 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19905
19906 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19907 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19908 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19909 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19910 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19911 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19912 as unlimited.
19913
19914 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19915 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19916 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19917
19918 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19919 @itemx show remote exec-file
19920 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19921 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19922 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19923 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19924 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19925 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19926
19927 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19928 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19929 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19930 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19931 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19932 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19933 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19934 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19935 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19936 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19937
19938 @item show interrupt-sequence
19939 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19940 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19941 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19942 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19943
19944 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19945 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19946 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19947 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19948 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19949 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19950
19951 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19952 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19953 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19954
19955 @kindex set tcp
19956 @kindex show tcp
19957 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19958 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19959 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19960 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19961 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19962 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19963 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19964 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19965 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19966
19967 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19968 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19969
19970 @item show tcp auto-retry
19971 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19972
19973 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19974 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19975 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19976 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19977 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19978 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19979 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19980 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19981 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19982 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19983 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19984
19985 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19986 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19987 @end table
19988
19989 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19990 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19991 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19992 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19993 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19994 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19995 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19996 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19997 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19998
19999 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20000 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20001 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20002 @value{GDBN} developers.
20003
20004 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20005 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20006 are:
20007
20008 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20009 @item Command Name
20010 @tab Remote Packet
20011 @tab Related Features
20012
20013 @item @code{fetch-register}
20014 @tab @code{p}
20015 @tab @code{info registers}
20016
20017 @item @code{set-register}
20018 @tab @code{P}
20019 @tab @code{set}
20020
20021 @item @code{binary-download}
20022 @tab @code{X}
20023 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20024
20025 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20026 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20027 @tab @code{info auxv}
20028
20029 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20030 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20031 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20032
20033 @item @code{attach}
20034 @tab @code{vAttach}
20035 @tab @code{attach}
20036
20037 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20038 @tab @code{vCont}
20039 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20040
20041 @item @code{run}
20042 @tab @code{vRun}
20043 @tab @code{run}
20044
20045 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20046 @tab @code{Z0}
20047 @tab @code{break}
20048
20049 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20050 @tab @code{Z1}
20051 @tab @code{hbreak}
20052
20053 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20054 @tab @code{Z2}
20055 @tab @code{watch}
20056
20057 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20058 @tab @code{Z3}
20059 @tab @code{rwatch}
20060
20061 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20062 @tab @code{Z4}
20063 @tab @code{awatch}
20064
20065 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20066 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20067 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20068
20069 @item @code{target-features}
20070 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20071 @tab @code{set architecture}
20072
20073 @item @code{library-info}
20074 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20075 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20076
20077 @item @code{memory-map}
20078 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20079 @tab @code{info mem}
20080
20081 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20082 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20083 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20084
20085 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20086 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20087 @tab @code{info spu}
20088
20089 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20090 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20091 @tab @code{info spu}
20092
20093 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20094 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20095 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20096
20097 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20098 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20099 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20100
20101 @item @code{threads}
20102 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20103 @tab @code{info threads}
20104
20105 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20106 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20107 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20108
20109 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20110 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20111 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20112
20113 @item @code{search-memory}
20114 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20115 @tab @code{find}
20116
20117 @item @code{supported-packets}
20118 @tab @code{qSupported}
20119 @tab Remote communications parameters
20120
20121 @item @code{pass-signals}
20122 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20123 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20124
20125 @item @code{program-signals}
20126 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20127 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20128
20129 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20130 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20131 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20132
20133 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20134 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20135 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20136
20137 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20138 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20139 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20140
20141 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20142 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20143 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20144
20145 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20146 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20147 @tab @code{remote delete}
20148
20149 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20150 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20151 @tab Host I/O
20152
20153 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20154 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20155 @tab Host I/O
20156
20157 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20158 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20159 @tab Host I/O
20160
20161 @item @code{noack-packet}
20162 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20163 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20164
20165 @item @code{osdata}
20166 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20167 @tab @code{info os}
20168
20169 @item @code{query-attached}
20170 @tab @code{qAttached}
20171 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20172
20173 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20174 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20175 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20176
20177 @item @code{trace-status}
20178 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20179 @tab @code{tstatus}
20180
20181 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20182 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20183 @tab Traceframe info
20184
20185 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20186 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20187 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20188
20189 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20190 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20191 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20192
20193 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20194 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20195 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20196
20197 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20198 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20199 @tab @code{break}
20200
20201 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20202 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20203 @tab @code{hbreak}
20204
20205 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20206 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20207 @tab @code{fork}
20208
20209 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20210 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20211 @tab @code{vfork}
20212
20213 @end multitable
20214
20215 @node Remote Stub
20216 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20217
20218 @cindex debugging stub, example
20219 @cindex remote stub, example
20220 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20221 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20222 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20223 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20224 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20225 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20226 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20227 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20228
20229 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20230 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20231 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20232 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20233 program, you need:
20234
20235 @enumerate
20236 @item
20237 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20238 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20239 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20240
20241 @item
20242 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20243 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20244
20245 @item
20246 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20247 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20248 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20249 documentation.
20250 @end enumerate
20251
20252 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20253 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20254 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20255
20256 @table @emph
20257 @item On the host,
20258 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20259 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20260 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20261
20262 @item On the target,
20263 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20264 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20265 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20266
20267 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20268 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20269 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20270 @end table
20271
20272 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20273 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20274 @sc{sparc} boards.
20275
20276 @cindex remote serial stub list
20277 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20278
20279 @table @code
20280
20281 @item i386-stub.c
20282 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20283 @cindex Intel
20284 @cindex i386
20285 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20286
20287 @item m68k-stub.c
20288 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20289 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20290 @cindex m680x0
20291 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20292
20293 @item sh-stub.c
20294 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20295 @cindex Renesas
20296 @cindex SH
20297 For Renesas SH architectures.
20298
20299 @item sparc-stub.c
20300 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20301 @cindex Sparc
20302 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20303
20304 @item sparcl-stub.c
20305 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20306 @cindex Fujitsu
20307 @cindex SparcLite
20308 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20309
20310 @end table
20311
20312 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20313 recently added stubs.
20314
20315 @menu
20316 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20317 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20318 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20319 @end menu
20320
20321 @node Stub Contents
20322 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20323
20324 @cindex remote serial stub
20325 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20326 subroutines:
20327
20328 @table @code
20329 @item set_debug_traps
20330 @findex set_debug_traps
20331 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20332 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20333 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20334 program's startup code.
20335
20336 @item handle_exception
20337 @findex handle_exception
20338 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20339 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20340 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20341 run when a trap is triggered.
20342
20343 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20344 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20345 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20346 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20347 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20348 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20349 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20350 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20351 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20352 machine.
20353
20354 @item breakpoint
20355 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20356 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20357 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20358 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20359 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20360 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20361 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20362 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20363 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20364 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20365 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20366
20367 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20368 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20369 start of your debugging session.
20370 @end table
20371
20372 @node Bootstrapping
20373 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20374
20375 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20376 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20377 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20378 debugging target machine.
20379
20380 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20381 serial port.
20382
20383 @table @code
20384 @item int getDebugChar()
20385 @findex getDebugChar
20386 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20387 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20388 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20389
20390 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20391 @findex putDebugChar
20392 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20393 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20394 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20395 @end table
20396
20397 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20398 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20399 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20400 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20401 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20402 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20403 remote system to stop.
20404
20405 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20406 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20407 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20408 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20409
20410 Other routines you need to supply are:
20411
20412 @table @code
20413 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20414 @findex exceptionHandler
20415 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20416 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20417 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20418 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20419 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20420 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20421 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20422 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20423 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20424 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20425 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20426 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20427 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20428
20429 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20430 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20431 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20432 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20433 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20434
20435 @item void flush_i_cache()
20436 @findex flush_i_cache
20437 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20438 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20439 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20440
20441 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20442 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20443 @end table
20444
20445 @noindent
20446 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20447
20448 @table @code
20449 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20450 @findex memset
20451 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20452 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20453 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20454 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20455 @end table
20456
20457 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20458 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20459 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20460 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20461
20462
20463 @node Debug Session
20464 @subsection Putting it All Together
20465
20466 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20467 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20468 steps.
20469
20470 @enumerate
20471 @item
20472 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20473 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20474 @display
20475 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20476 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20477 @end display
20478
20479 @item
20480 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20481 procedure is called:
20482
20483 @smallexample
20484 set_debug_traps();
20485 breakpoint();
20486 @end smallexample
20487
20488 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20489 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20490 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20491 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20492 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20493 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20494 progress.
20495
20496 @item
20497 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20498 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20499
20500 @smallexample
20501 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20502 @end smallexample
20503
20504 @noindent
20505 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20506 function in your program, that function is called when
20507 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20508 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20509 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20510
20511 @item
20512 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20513 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20514
20515 @item
20516 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20517 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20518
20519 @item
20520 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20521 @c document that. FIXME.
20522 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20523 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20524
20525 @item
20526 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20527 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20528
20529 @end enumerate
20530
20531 @node Configurations
20532 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20533
20534 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20535 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20536 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20537
20538 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20539 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20540 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20541 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20542 are quite different from each other.
20543
20544 @menu
20545 * Native::
20546 * Embedded OS::
20547 * Embedded Processors::
20548 * Architectures::
20549 @end menu
20550
20551 @node Native
20552 @section Native
20553
20554 This section describes details specific to particular native
20555 configurations.
20556
20557 @menu
20558 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20559 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20560 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20561 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20562 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20563 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20564 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20565 @end menu
20566
20567 @node HP-UX
20568 @subsection HP-UX
20569
20570 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20571 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20572 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20573
20574
20575 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20576 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20577
20578 @cindex libkvm
20579 @cindex kernel memory image
20580 @cindex kernel crash dump
20581
20582 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20583 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20584 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20585 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20586 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20587 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20588 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20589 @code{kvm} target:
20590
20591 @smallexample
20592 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20593 @end smallexample
20594
20595 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20596 argument:
20597
20598 @smallexample
20599 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20600 @end smallexample
20601
20602 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20603 available:
20604
20605 @table @code
20606 @kindex kvm
20607 @item kvm pcb
20608 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20609
20610 @item kvm proc
20611 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20612 modern FreeBSD systems.
20613 @end table
20614
20615 @node SVR4 Process Information
20616 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20617 @cindex /proc
20618 @cindex examine process image
20619 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20620
20621 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20622 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20623 process using file-system subroutines.
20624
20625 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20626 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20627 information about the process running your program, or about any
20628 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20629 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20630
20631 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20632 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20633
20634 @table @code
20635 @kindex info proc
20636 @cindex process ID
20637 @item info proc
20638 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20639 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20640 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20641 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20642 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20643 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20644 executable file's absolute file name.
20645
20646 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20647 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20648 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20649 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20650 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20651 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20652
20653 @item info proc cmdline
20654 @cindex info proc cmdline
20655 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20656 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20657
20658 @item info proc cwd
20659 @cindex info proc cwd
20660 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20661 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20662
20663 @item info proc exe
20664 @cindex info proc exe
20665 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20666 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20667
20668 @item info proc mappings
20669 @cindex memory address space mappings
20670 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20671 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20672 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20673 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20674 memory access rights to that range.
20675
20676 @item info proc stat
20677 @itemx info proc status
20678 @cindex process detailed status information
20679 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20680 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20681 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20682 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20683 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20684 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20685 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20686
20687 @item info proc all
20688 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20689 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20690
20691 @ignore
20692 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20693 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20694 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20695 @kindex info proc times
20696 @item info proc times
20697 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20698 its children.
20699
20700 @kindex info proc id
20701 @item info proc id
20702 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20703 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20704 @end ignore
20705
20706 @item set procfs-trace
20707 @kindex set procfs-trace
20708 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20709 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20710
20711 @item show procfs-trace
20712 @kindex show procfs-trace
20713 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20714
20715 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20716 @kindex set procfs-file
20717 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20718 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20719 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20720 standard output.
20721
20722 @item show procfs-file
20723 @kindex show procfs-file
20724 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20725
20726 @item proc-trace-entry
20727 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20728 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20729 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20730 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20731 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20732 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20733 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20734 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20735 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20736
20737 @item info pidlist
20738 @kindex info pidlist
20739 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20740 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20741 processes and all the threads within each process.
20742
20743 @item info meminfo
20744 @kindex info meminfo
20745 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20746 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20747 @end table
20748
20749 @node DJGPP Native
20750 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20751 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20752 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20753 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20754
20755 @cindex DPMI
20756 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20757 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20758 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20759 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20760
20761 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20762 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20763 subsection describes those commands.
20764
20765 @table @code
20766 @kindex info dos
20767 @item info dos
20768 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20769 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20770
20771 @kindex sysinfo
20772 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20773 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20774 @item info dos sysinfo
20775 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20776 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20777 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20778
20779 @cindex GDT
20780 @cindex LDT
20781 @cindex IDT
20782 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20783 @cindex descriptor tables display
20784 @item info dos gdt
20785 @itemx info dos ldt
20786 @itemx info dos idt
20787 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20788 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20789 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20790 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20791 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20792 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20793 rights.
20794
20795 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20796 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20797 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20798 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20799 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20800
20801 @cindex garbled pointers
20802 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20803 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20804 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20805 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20806 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20807 debugged program's data segment:
20808
20809 @smallexample
20810 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20811 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20812 @end smallexample
20813
20814 @noindent
20815 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20816 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20817
20818 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20819 @item info dos pde
20820 @itemx info dos pte
20821 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20822 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20823 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20824 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20825 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20826 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20827 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20828 that is currently in use.
20829
20830 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20831 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20832 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20833 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20834 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20835 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20836 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20837
20838 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20839 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20840 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20841 controller.
20842
20843 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20844
20845 @cindex physical address from linear address
20846 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20847 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20848 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20849 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20850 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20851 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20852 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20853
20854 @smallexample
20855 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20856 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20857 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20858 @end smallexample
20859
20860 @noindent
20861 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20862 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20863 attributes of that page.
20864
20865 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20866 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20867 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20868 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20869 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20870 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20871
20872 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20873 transfer buffer:
20874
20875 @smallexample
20876 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20877 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20878 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20879 @end smallexample
20880
20881 @noindent
20882 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20883 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20884 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20885 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20886 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20887
20888 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20889 @end table
20890
20891 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20892 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20893 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20894 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20895
20896 @table @code
20897 @kindex set com1base
20898 @kindex set com1irq
20899 @kindex set com2base
20900 @kindex set com2irq
20901 @kindex set com3base
20902 @kindex set com3irq
20903 @kindex set com4base
20904 @kindex set com4irq
20905 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20906 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20907 port.
20908
20909 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20910 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20911 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20912
20913 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20914 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20915 other 3 COM ports.
20916
20917 @kindex show com1base
20918 @kindex show com1irq
20919 @kindex show com2base
20920 @kindex show com2irq
20921 @kindex show com3base
20922 @kindex show com3irq
20923 @kindex show com4base
20924 @kindex show com4irq
20925 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20926 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20927 lines used by the COM ports.
20928
20929 @item info serial
20930 @kindex info serial
20931 @cindex DOS serial port status
20932 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20933 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20934 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20935 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20936 @end table
20937
20938
20939 @node Cygwin Native
20940 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20941 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20942 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20943 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20944
20945 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20946 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20947
20948 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20949 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20950 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20951 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20952 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20953 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20954 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20955 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20956
20957 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20958 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20959 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20960
20961 @table @code
20962 @kindex info w32
20963 @item info w32
20964 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20965 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20966
20967 @item info w32 selector
20968 This command displays information returned by
20969 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20970 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20971 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20972 Without argument, this command displays information
20973 about the six segment registers.
20974
20975 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20976 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20977 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20978 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20979
20980 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20981 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20982 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20983 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20984 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20985 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20986 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20987 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20988 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20989 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20990 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20991
20992 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20993 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20994 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20995 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20996
20997 @kindex set new-console
20998 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20999 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21000 be started in a new console on next start.
21001 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21002 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21003
21004 @kindex show new-console
21005 @item show new-console
21006 Displays whether a new console is used
21007 when the debuggee is started.
21008
21009 @kindex set new-group
21010 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21011 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21012 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21013 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21014 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21015
21016 @kindex show new-group
21017 @item show new-group
21018 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21019
21020 @kindex set debugevents
21021 @item set debugevents
21022 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21023 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21024 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21025 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21026 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21027
21028 @kindex set debugexec
21029 @item set debugexec
21030 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21031 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21032
21033 @kindex set debugexceptions
21034 @item set debugexceptions
21035 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21036 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21037
21038 @kindex set debugmemory
21039 @item set debugmemory
21040 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21041 and writes by the debugger.
21042
21043 @kindex set shell
21044 @item set shell
21045 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21046 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21047
21048 @kindex show shell
21049 @item show shell
21050 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21051
21052 @end table
21053
21054 @menu
21055 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21056 @end menu
21057
21058 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21059 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21060 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21061 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21062
21063 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21064 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21065 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21066 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21067 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21068 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21069 ``minimal symbols''.
21070
21071 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21072 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21073 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21074 program run once to completion.
21075
21076 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21077
21078 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21079 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21080 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21081 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21082 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21083 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21084 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21085 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21086 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21087
21088 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21089 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21090 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21091 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21092 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21093 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21094
21095 @smallexample
21096 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21097 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21098
21099 Non-debugging symbols:
21100 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21101 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 @smallexample
21105 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21106 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21107
21108 Non-debugging symbols:
21109 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21110 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21111 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21112 [etc...]
21113 @end smallexample
21114
21115 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21116
21117 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21118 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21119 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21120 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21121 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21122 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21123 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21124
21125 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21126 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21127 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21128 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21129 problem:
21130
21131 @smallexample
21132 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21133 $1 = 268572168
21134 @end smallexample
21135
21136 @smallexample
21137 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21138 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21139 @end smallexample
21140
21141 And two possible solutions:
21142
21143 @smallexample
21144 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21145 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21146 @end smallexample
21147
21148 @smallexample
21149 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21150 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21151 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21152 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21153 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21154 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21155 @end smallexample
21156
21157 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21158 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21159 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21160 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21161 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21162
21163 @smallexample
21164 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21165 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21166 @end smallexample
21167
21168 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21169 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21170 safe.
21171
21172 @node Hurd Native
21173 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21174 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21175
21176 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21177 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21178
21179 @table @code
21180 @item set signals
21181 @itemx set sigs
21182 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21183 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21184 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21185 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21186 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21187 @code{signals}.
21188
21189 @item show signals
21190 @itemx show sigs
21191 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21192 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21193 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21194
21195 @item set signal-thread
21196 @itemx set sigthread
21197 @kindex set signal-thread
21198 @kindex set sigthread
21199 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21200 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21201 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21202 signal-thread}.
21203
21204 @item show signal-thread
21205 @itemx show sigthread
21206 @kindex show signal-thread
21207 @kindex show sigthread
21208 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21209 delivered a signal.
21210
21211 @item set stopped
21212 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21213 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21214 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21215 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21216
21217 @item show stopped
21218 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21219 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21220 stopped.
21221
21222 @item set exceptions
21223 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21224 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21225 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21226 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21227 trapping on.
21228
21229 @item show exceptions
21230 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21231 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21232
21233 @item set task pause
21234 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21235 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21236 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21237 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21238 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21239 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21240 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21241 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21242 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21243
21244 @item show task pause
21245 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21246 Show the current state of task suspension.
21247
21248 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21249 @cindex task suspend count
21250 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21251 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21252 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21253
21254 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21255 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21256
21257 @item set task exception-port
21258 @itemx set task excp
21259 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21260 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21261 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21262 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21263
21264 @item set noninvasive
21265 @cindex noninvasive task options
21266 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21267 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21268 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21269 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21270
21271 @item info send-rights
21272 @itemx info receive-rights
21273 @itemx info port-rights
21274 @itemx info port-sets
21275 @itemx info dead-names
21276 @itemx info ports
21277 @itemx info psets
21278 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21279 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21280 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21281 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21282 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21283 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21284 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21285 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21286 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21287
21288 @item set thread pause
21289 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21290 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21291 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21292 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21293 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21294 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21295 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21296 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21297 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21298 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21299 only the current thread.
21300
21301 @item show thread pause
21302 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21303 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21304
21305 @item set thread run
21306 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21307
21308 @item show thread run
21309 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21310
21311 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21312 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21313 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21314 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21315 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21316 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21317 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21318
21319 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21320 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21321 detaching.
21322
21323 @item set thread exception-port
21324 @itemx set thread excp
21325 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21326 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21327 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21328
21329 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21330 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21331 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21332 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21333
21334 @item set thread default
21335 @itemx show thread default
21336 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21337 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21338 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21339 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21340 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21341 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21342 the non-default commands.
21343 @end table
21344
21345 @node Darwin
21346 @subsection Darwin
21347 @cindex Darwin
21348
21349 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21350
21351 @table @code
21352 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21353 @kindex set debug darwin
21354 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21355 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21356
21357 @item show debug darwin
21358 @kindex show debug darwin
21359 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21360
21361 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21362 @kindex set debug mach-o
21363 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21364 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21365 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21366 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21367 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21368 usage.
21369
21370 @item show debug mach-o
21371 @kindex show debug mach-o
21372 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21373
21374 @item set mach-exceptions on
21375 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21376 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21377 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21378 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21379 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21380 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21381
21382 @item show mach-exceptions
21383 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21384 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21385 @end table
21386
21387
21388 @node Embedded OS
21389 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21390
21391 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21392 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21393 architectures.
21394
21395 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21396 various real-time operating systems.
21397
21398 @node Embedded Processors
21399 @section Embedded Processors
21400
21401 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21402 configurations.
21403
21404 @cindex send command to simulator
21405 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21406 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21407
21408 @table @code
21409 @item sim @var{command}
21410 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21411 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21412 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21413 acceptable commands.
21414 @end table
21415
21416
21417 @menu
21418 * ARM:: ARM RDI
21419 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
21420 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21421 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21422 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21423 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21424 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
21425 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
21426 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
21427 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
21428 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21429 * CRIS:: CRIS
21430 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21431 @end menu
21432
21433 @node ARM
21434 @subsection ARM
21435 @cindex ARM RDI
21436
21437 @table @code
21438 @kindex target rdi
21439 @item target rdi @var{dev}
21440 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
21441 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
21442 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
21443
21444 @kindex target rdp
21445 @item target rdp @var{dev}
21446 ARM Demon monitor.
21447
21448 @end table
21449
21450 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21451
21452 @table @code
21453 @item set arm disassembler
21454 @kindex set arm
21455 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21456 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21457
21458 @item show arm disassembler
21459 @kindex show arm
21460 Show the current disassembly style.
21461
21462 @item set arm apcs32
21463 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21464 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21465
21466 @item show arm apcs32
21467 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21468
21469 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21470 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21471 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21472
21473 @table @code
21474 @item auto
21475 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21476 @item softfpa
21477 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21478 processors.
21479 @item fpa
21480 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21481 @item softvfp
21482 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21483 @item vfp
21484 VFP co-processor.
21485 @end table
21486
21487 @item show arm fpu
21488 Show the current type of the FPU.
21489
21490 @item set arm abi
21491 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21492
21493 @item show arm abi
21494 Show the currently used ABI.
21495
21496 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21497 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21498 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21499 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21500 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21501 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21502 register).
21503
21504 @item show arm fallback-mode
21505 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21506
21507 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21508 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21509 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21510 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21511 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21512
21513 @item show arm force-mode
21514 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21515
21516 @item set debug arm
21517 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21518 target support subsystem.
21519
21520 @item show debug arm
21521 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21522 @end table
21523
21524 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21525 using the RDI interface:
21526
21527 @table @code
21528 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21529 @kindex rdilogfile
21530 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21531 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21532 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21533 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21534 @file{rdi.log}.
21535
21536 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21537 @kindex rdilogenable
21538 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21539 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21540 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21541 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21542 are logged to a file.
21543
21544 @item set rdiromatzero
21545 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21546 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21547 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21548 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21549 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21550 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21551
21552 @item show rdiromatzero
21553 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21554 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21555
21556 @item set rdiheartbeat
21557 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21558 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21559 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21560 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21561 well as the Angel monitor.
21562
21563 @item show rdiheartbeat
21564 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21565 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21566 @end table
21567
21568 @table @code
21569 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21570 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21571
21572 @table @code
21573 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21574 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21575 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21576 The default value is @code{all}.
21577
21578 @table @code
21579 @item none
21580 @item demon
21581 @item angel
21582 @item redboot
21583 @item all
21584 @end table
21585 @end table
21586 @end table
21587
21588 @node M32R/D
21589 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21590
21591 @table @code
21592 @kindex target m32r
21593 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21594 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21595
21596 @kindex target m32rsdi
21597 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21598 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21599 @end table
21600
21601 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21602
21603 @table @code
21604 @item set download-path @var{path}
21605 @kindex set download-path
21606 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21607 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21608
21609 @item show download-path
21610 @kindex show download-path
21611 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21612
21613 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21614 @kindex set board-address
21615 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21616 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21617
21618 @item show board-address
21619 @kindex show board-address
21620 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21621
21622 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21623 @kindex set server-address
21624 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21625 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21626 host machine.
21627
21628 @item show server-address
21629 @kindex show server-address
21630 Display the IP address of the download server.
21631
21632 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21633 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21634 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21635 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21636 executable file is uploaded.
21637
21638 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21639 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21640 Test the @code{upload} command.
21641 @end table
21642
21643 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21644
21645 @table @code
21646 @item sdireset
21647 @kindex sdireset
21648 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21649 This command resets the SDI connection.
21650
21651 @item sdistatus
21652 @kindex sdistatus
21653 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21654
21655 @item debug_chaos
21656 @kindex debug_chaos
21657 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21658 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21659
21660 @item use_debug_dma
21661 @kindex use_debug_dma
21662 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21663
21664 @item use_mon_code
21665 @kindex use_mon_code
21666 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21667
21668 @item use_ib_break
21669 @kindex use_ib_break
21670 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21671
21672 @item use_dbt_break
21673 @kindex use_dbt_break
21674 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21675 @end table
21676
21677 @node M68K
21678 @subsection M68k
21679
21680 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21681 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21682
21683 @table @code
21684
21685 @kindex target dbug
21686 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21687 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21688
21689 @end table
21690
21691 @node MicroBlaze
21692 @subsection MicroBlaze
21693 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21694 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21695
21696 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21697 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21698 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21699 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21700 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21701 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21702 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21703 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21704 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21705 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21706 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21707
21708 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21709
21710 @table @code
21711 @item target remote :1234
21712 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21713 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21714
21715 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21716 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21717 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21718
21719 @item load
21720 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21721
21722 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21723 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21724
21725 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21726 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21727 @end table
21728
21729 @node MIPS Embedded
21730 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21731
21732 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21733 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21734 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21735 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21736
21737 @need 1000
21738 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21739
21740 @table @code
21741 @item target mips @var{port}
21742 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21743 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21744 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21745 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21746 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21747 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21748 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21749
21750 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21751 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21752 debugger:
21753
21754 @smallexample
21755 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21756 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21757 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21758 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21759 (@value{GDBP}) run
21760 @end smallexample
21761
21762 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21763 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21764 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21765 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21766 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21767
21768 @item target pmon @var{port}
21769 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21770 PMON ROM monitor.
21771
21772 @item target ddb @var{port}
21773 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21774 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21775
21776 @item target lsi @var{port}
21777 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21778 LSI variant of PMON.
21779
21780 @kindex target r3900
21781 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21782 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21783
21784 @kindex target array
21785 @item target array @var{dev}
21786 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21787
21788 @end table
21789
21790
21791 @noindent
21792 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21793
21794 @table @code
21795 @item set mipsfpu double
21796 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21797 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21798 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21799 @itemx show mipsfpu
21800 @kindex set mipsfpu
21801 @kindex show mipsfpu
21802 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21803 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21804 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21805 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21806 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21807 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21808 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21809 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21810 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21811 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21812 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21813 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21814 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21815
21816 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21817 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21818 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21819
21820 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21821 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21822
21823 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21824 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21825 @itemx show timeout
21826 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21827 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21828 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21829 @kindex set timeout
21830 @kindex show timeout
21831 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21832 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21833 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21834 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21835 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21836 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21837 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21838 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21839 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21840 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21841
21842 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21843 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21844 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21845 to run before stopping.
21846
21847 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21848 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21849 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21850 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21851 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21852 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21853
21854 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21855 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21856 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21857 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21858
21859 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21860 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21861 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21862 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21863 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21864 @table @asis
21865 @item pmon target
21866 @samp{PMON}
21867 @item ddb target
21868 @samp{NEC010}
21869 @item lsi target
21870 @samp{PMON>}
21871 @end table
21872
21873 @item show monitor-prompt
21874 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21875 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21876 remote monitor.
21877
21878 @item set monitor-warnings
21879 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21880 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21881 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21882 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21883 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21884
21885 @item show monitor-warnings
21886 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21887 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21888
21889 @item pmon @var{command}
21890 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21891 @cindex send PMON command
21892 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21893 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21894 @end table
21895
21896 @node PowerPC Embedded
21897 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21898
21899 @cindex DVC register
21900 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21901 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21902
21903 @smallexample
21904 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21905 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21906 @end smallexample
21907
21908 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21909 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21910 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21911 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21912 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21913 or newer.
21914
21915 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21916 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21917 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21918 watching variables of scalar types.
21919
21920 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21921 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21922
21923 @smallexample
21924 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21925 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21926 @end smallexample
21927
21928 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21929 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21930
21931 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21932 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21933 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21934 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21935 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21936 use the @code{break-range} command.
21937
21938 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21939
21940 @table @code
21941 @kindex break-range
21942 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21943 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21944 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21945 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21946 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21947 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21948 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21949 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21950 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21951
21952 @kindex set powerpc
21953 @item set powerpc soft-float
21954 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21955 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21956 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21957 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21958
21959 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21960 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21961 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21962 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21963 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21964 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21965 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21966 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21967
21968 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21969 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21970 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21971 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21972 address of its first byte.
21973
21974 @kindex target dink32
21975 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21976 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21977
21978 @kindex target ppcbug
21979 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21980 @kindex target ppcbug1
21981 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21982 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21983
21984 @kindex target sds
21985 @item target sds @var{dev}
21986 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21987 @end table
21988
21989 @cindex SDS protocol
21990 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21991 by @value{GDBN}:
21992
21993 @table @code
21994 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21995 @kindex set sdstimeout
21996 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21997 default is 2 seconds.
21998
21999 @item show sdstimeout
22000 @kindex show sdstimeout
22001 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
22002
22003 @item sds @var{command}
22004 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
22005 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
22006 @end table
22007
22008
22009 @node PA
22010 @subsection HP PA Embedded
22011
22012 @table @code
22013
22014 @kindex target op50n
22015 @item target op50n @var{dev}
22016 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
22017
22018 @kindex target w89k
22019 @item target w89k @var{dev}
22020 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
22021
22022 @end table
22023
22024 @node Sparclet
22025 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
22026
22027 @cindex Sparclet
22028
22029 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
22030 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
22031 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
22032 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
22033 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
22034
22035 @table @code
22036 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
22037 @kindex remotetimeout
22038 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
22039 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
22040 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
22041 @end table
22042
22043 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
22044 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
22045 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
22046 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
22047 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
22048
22049 @smallexample
22050 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
22051 @end smallexample
22052
22053 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
22054
22055 @smallexample
22056 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
22057 @end smallexample
22058
22059 @cindex running, on Sparclet
22060 Once you have set
22061 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
22062 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
22063 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
22064
22065 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
22066
22067 @smallexample
22068 (gdbslet)
22069 @end smallexample
22070
22071 @menu
22072 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
22073 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
22074 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
22075 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
22076 @end menu
22077
22078 @node Sparclet File
22079 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
22080
22081 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
22082
22083 @smallexample
22084 (gdbslet) file prog
22085 @end smallexample
22086
22087 @need 1000
22088 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
22089 @value{GDBN} locates
22090 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
22091 path.
22092 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
22093 files will be searched as well.
22094 @value{GDBN} locates
22095 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
22096 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
22097 If it fails
22098 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
22099
22100 @smallexample
22101 prog: No such file or directory.
22102 @end smallexample
22103
22104 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
22105 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
22106 @code{target} command again.
22107
22108 @node Sparclet Connection
22109 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
22110
22111 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
22112 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
22113
22114 @smallexample
22115 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
22116 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
22117 main () at ../prog.c:3
22118 @end smallexample
22119
22120 @need 750
22121 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
22122
22123 @smallexample
22124 Connected to ttya.
22125 @end smallexample
22126
22127 @node Sparclet Download
22128 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
22129
22130 @cindex download to Sparclet
22131 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
22132 you can use the @value{GDBN}
22133 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
22134 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
22135 command.
22136 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
22137 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
22138 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
22139 of each of the file's sections.
22140 For instance, if the program
22141 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
22142 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
22143
22144 @smallexample
22145 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
22146 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
22147 @end smallexample
22148
22149 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
22150 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
22151 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
22152
22153 @node Sparclet Execution
22154 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
22155
22156 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
22157 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
22158 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
22159 manual for the list of commands.
22160
22161 @smallexample
22162 (gdbslet) b main
22163 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
22164 (gdbslet) run
22165 Starting program: prog
22166 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
22167 3 char *symarg = 0;
22168 (gdbslet) step
22169 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
22170 (gdbslet)
22171 @end smallexample
22172
22173 @node Sparclite
22174 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
22175
22176 @table @code
22177
22178 @kindex target sparclite
22179 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
22180 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
22181 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
22182 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
22183 remote protocol.
22184
22185 @end table
22186
22187 @node Z8000
22188 @subsection Zilog Z8000
22189
22190 @cindex Z8000
22191 @cindex simulator, Z8000
22192 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
22193
22194 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
22195 a Z8000 simulator.
22196
22197 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
22198 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
22199 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
22200 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
22201
22202 @table @code
22203 @item target sim @var{args}
22204 @kindex sim
22205 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
22206 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
22207 options, specify them via @var{args}.
22208 @end table
22209
22210 @noindent
22211 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
22212 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
22213 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
22214 to run your program, and so on.
22215
22216 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
22217 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
22218 additional items of information as specially named registers:
22219
22220 @table @code
22221
22222 @item cycles
22223 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
22224
22225 @item insts
22226 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
22227
22228 @item time
22229 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
22230
22231 @end table
22232
22233 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
22234 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
22235 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
22236 simulated clock ticks.
22237
22238 @node AVR
22239 @subsection Atmel AVR
22240 @cindex AVR
22241
22242 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22243 following AVR-specific commands:
22244
22245 @table @code
22246 @item info io_registers
22247 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22248 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22249 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22250 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22251 @end table
22252
22253 @node CRIS
22254 @subsection CRIS
22255 @cindex CRIS
22256
22257 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22258 following CRIS-specific commands:
22259
22260 @table @code
22261 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22262 @cindex CRIS version
22263 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22264 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22265 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22266
22267 @item show cris-version
22268 Show the current CRIS version.
22269
22270 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22271 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22272 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22273 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22274 @code{R59}.
22275
22276 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22277 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22278
22279 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22280 @cindex CRIS mode
22281 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22282 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22283 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22284
22285 @item show cris-mode
22286 Show the current CRIS mode.
22287 @end table
22288
22289 @node Super-H
22290 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22291 @cindex Super-H
22292
22293 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22294 commands:
22295
22296 @table @code
22297 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22298 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22299 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22300 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22301 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22302 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22303 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22304 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22305 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22306 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22307 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22308 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22309
22310 @item show sh calling-convention
22311 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22312 Show the current calling convention setting.
22313
22314 @end table
22315
22316
22317 @node Architectures
22318 @section Architectures
22319
22320 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22321 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22322
22323 @menu
22324 * AArch64::
22325 * i386::
22326 * Alpha::
22327 * MIPS::
22328 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22329 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22330 * PowerPC::
22331 * Nios II::
22332 @end menu
22333
22334 @node AArch64
22335 @subsection AArch64
22336 @cindex AArch64 support
22337
22338 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22339 following special commands:
22340
22341 @table @code
22342 @item set debug aarch64
22343 @kindex set debug aarch64
22344 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22345 messages are to be displayed.
22346
22347 @item show debug aarch64
22348 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22349
22350 @end table
22351
22352 @node i386
22353 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22354
22355 @table @code
22356 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22357 @kindex set struct-convention
22358 @cindex struct return convention
22359 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22360 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22361 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22362 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22363 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22364 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22365 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22366 be returned in a register.
22367
22368 @item show struct-convention
22369 @kindex show struct-convention
22370 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22371 from functions.
22372 @end table
22373
22374
22375 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22376 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22377
22378 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22379 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22380 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22381 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22382 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22383 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22384 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22385
22386 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22387 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22388 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22389 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22390 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22391 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22392
22393 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22394 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22395 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22396
22397 @smallexample
22398 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22399 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22400 @end smallexample
22401
22402 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22403 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22404 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22405 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22406 the pointer.
22407
22408 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22409 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22410 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22411 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22412 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22413
22414 @table @code
22415 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22416 @kindex show mpx bound
22417 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22418
22419 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22420 @kindex set mpx bound
22421 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22422 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22423 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22424 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22425 @end table
22426
22427 @node Alpha
22428 @subsection Alpha
22429
22430 See the following section.
22431
22432 @node MIPS
22433 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22434
22435 @cindex stack on Alpha
22436 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22437 @cindex Alpha stack
22438 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22439 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22440 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22441 find the beginning of a function.
22442
22443 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22444 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22445 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22446 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22447 commands:
22448
22449 @table @code
22450 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22451 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22452 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22453 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22454 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22455 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22456 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22457 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22458
22459 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22460 Display the current limit.
22461 @end table
22462
22463 @noindent
22464 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22465 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22466
22467 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22468 programs:
22469
22470 @table @code
22471 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22472 @kindex set mips abi
22473 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22474 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22475 values of @var{arg} are:
22476
22477 @table @samp
22478 @item auto
22479 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22480 default).
22481 @item o32
22482 @item o64
22483 @item n32
22484 @item n64
22485 @item eabi32
22486 @item eabi64
22487 @end table
22488
22489 @item show mips abi
22490 @kindex show mips abi
22491 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22492
22493 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22494 @kindex set mips compression
22495 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22496 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22497 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22498 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22499 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22500 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22501 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22502 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22503 provided by the executable.
22504
22505 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22506 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22507 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22508 identified as such.
22509
22510 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22511 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22512 implicitly from an executable.
22513
22514 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22515 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22516 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22517 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22518 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22519
22520 @item show mips compression
22521 @kindex show mips compression
22522 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22523 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22524
22525 @item set mipsfpu
22526 @itemx show mipsfpu
22527 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22528
22529 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22530 @kindex set mips mask-address
22531 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22532 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22533 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22534 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22535 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22536
22537 @item show mips mask-address
22538 @kindex show mips mask-address
22539 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22540 not.
22541
22542 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22543 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22544 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22545 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22546 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22547 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22548
22549 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22550 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22551 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22552
22553 @item set debug mips
22554 @kindex set debug mips
22555 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22556 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22557
22558 @item show debug mips
22559 @kindex show debug mips
22560 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22561 @end table
22562
22563
22564 @node HPPA
22565 @subsection HPPA
22566 @cindex HPPA support
22567
22568 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22569 following special commands:
22570
22571 @table @code
22572 @item set debug hppa
22573 @kindex set debug hppa
22574 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22575 messages are to be displayed.
22576
22577 @item show debug hppa
22578 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22579
22580 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22581 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22582 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22583 given @var{address}.
22584
22585 @end table
22586
22587
22588 @node SPU
22589 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22590 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22591 @cindex SPU
22592
22593 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22594 it provides the following special commands:
22595
22596 @table @code
22597 @item info spu event
22598 @kindex info spu
22599 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22600 and pending event status.
22601
22602 @item info spu signal
22603 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22604 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22605 notification channels.
22606
22607 @item info spu mailbox
22608 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22609 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22610 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22611
22612 @item info spu dma
22613 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22614 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22615 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22616
22617 @item info spu proxydma
22618 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22619 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22620 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22621
22622 @end table
22623
22624 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22625 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22626 special commands:
22627
22628 @table @code
22629 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22630 @kindex set spu
22631 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22632 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22633 function. The default is @code{off}.
22634
22635 @item show spu stop-on-load
22636 @kindex show spu
22637 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22638
22639 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22640 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22641 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22642 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22643 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22644 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22645
22646 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22647 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22648
22649 @end table
22650
22651 @node PowerPC
22652 @subsection PowerPC
22653 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22654
22655 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22656 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22657 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22658 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22659 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22660
22661 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22662 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22663 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22664
22665 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22666 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22667
22668 @node Nios II
22669 @subsection Nios II
22670 @cindex Nios II architecture
22671
22672 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22673 it provides the following special commands:
22674
22675 @table @code
22676
22677 @item set debug nios2
22678 @kindex set debug nios2
22679 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22680 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22681
22682 @item show debug nios2
22683 @kindex show debug nios2
22684 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22685 @end table
22686
22687 @node Controlling GDB
22688 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22689
22690 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22691 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22692 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22693 described here.
22694
22695 @menu
22696 * Prompt:: Prompt
22697 * Editing:: Command editing
22698 * Command History:: Command history
22699 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22700 * Numbers:: Numbers
22701 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22702 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22703 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22704 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22705 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22706 @end menu
22707
22708 @node Prompt
22709 @section Prompt
22710
22711 @cindex prompt
22712
22713 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22714 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22715 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22716 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22717 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22718 which one you are talking to.
22719
22720 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22721 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22722 or a prompt that does not.
22723
22724 @table @code
22725 @kindex set prompt
22726 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22727 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22728
22729 @kindex show prompt
22730 @item show prompt
22731 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22732 @end table
22733
22734 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22735 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22736 are:
22737
22738 @table @code
22739 @kindex set extended-prompt
22740 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22741 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22742 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22743 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22744 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22745 is displayed.
22746
22747 For example:
22748
22749 @smallexample
22750 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22751 @end smallexample
22752
22753 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22754 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22755
22756 @kindex show extended-prompt
22757 @item show extended-prompt
22758 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22759 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22760 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22761 @end table
22762
22763 @node Editing
22764 @section Command Editing
22765 @cindex readline
22766 @cindex command line editing
22767
22768 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22769 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22770 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22771 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22772 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22773 debugging sessions.
22774
22775 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22776 command @code{set}.
22777
22778 @table @code
22779 @kindex set editing
22780 @cindex editing
22781 @item set editing
22782 @itemx set editing on
22783 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22784
22785 @item set editing off
22786 Disable command line editing.
22787
22788 @kindex show editing
22789 @item show editing
22790 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22791 @end table
22792
22793 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22794 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22795 @end ifset
22796 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22797 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22798 @end ifclear
22799 for more details about the Readline
22800 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22801 encouraged to read that chapter.
22802
22803 @node Command History
22804 @section Command History
22805 @cindex command history
22806
22807 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22808 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22809 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22810 history facility.
22811
22812 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22813 package, to provide the history facility.
22814 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22815 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22816 @end ifset
22817 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22818 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22819 @end ifclear
22820 for the detailed description of the History library.
22821
22822 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22823 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22824 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22825 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22826 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22827 pressed on a line by itself.
22828
22829 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22830 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22831 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22832 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22833
22834 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22835 history.
22836
22837 @table @code
22838 @cindex history substitution
22839 @cindex history file
22840 @kindex set history filename
22841 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22842 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22843 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22844 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22845 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22846 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22847 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22848 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22849 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22850 is not set.
22851
22852 @cindex save command history
22853 @kindex set history save
22854 @item set history save
22855 @itemx set history save on
22856 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22857 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22858
22859 @item set history save off
22860 Stop recording command history in a file.
22861
22862 @cindex history size
22863 @kindex set history size
22864 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22865 @item set history size @var{size}
22866 @itemx set history size unlimited
22867 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22868 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22869 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22870 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22871 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22872 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22873
22874 @cindex remove duplicate history
22875 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22876 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22877 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22878 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22879 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22880 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22881 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22882 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22883 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22884
22885 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22886 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22887
22888 @end table
22889
22890 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22891 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22892 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22893 @end ifset
22894 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22895 @xref{Event Designators},
22896 @end ifclear
22897 for more details.
22898
22899 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22900 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22901 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22902 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22903 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22904 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22905 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22906 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22907
22908 The commands to control history expansion are:
22909
22910 @table @code
22911 @item set history expansion on
22912 @itemx set history expansion
22913 @kindex set history expansion
22914 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22915
22916 @item set history expansion off
22917 Disable history expansion.
22918
22919 @c @group
22920 @kindex show history
22921 @item show history
22922 @itemx show history filename
22923 @itemx show history save
22924 @itemx show history size
22925 @itemx show history expansion
22926 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22927 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22928 @c @end group
22929 @end table
22930
22931 @table @code
22932 @kindex show commands
22933 @cindex show last commands
22934 @cindex display command history
22935 @item show commands
22936 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22937
22938 @item show commands @var{n}
22939 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22940
22941 @item show commands +
22942 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22943 @end table
22944
22945 @node Screen Size
22946 @section Screen Size
22947 @cindex size of screen
22948 @cindex screen size
22949 @cindex pagination
22950 @cindex page size
22951 @cindex pauses in output
22952
22953 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22954 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22955 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22956 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22957 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22958 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22959 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22960 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22961
22962 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22963 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22964 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22965 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22966 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22967 width} commands:
22968
22969 @table @code
22970 @kindex set height
22971 @kindex set width
22972 @kindex show width
22973 @kindex show height
22974 @item set height @var{lpp}
22975 @itemx set height unlimited
22976 @itemx show height
22977 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22978 @itemx set width unlimited
22979 @itemx show width
22980 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22981 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22982 commands display the current settings.
22983
22984 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22985 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22986 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22987 buffer.
22988
22989 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22990 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22991
22992 @item set pagination on
22993 @itemx set pagination off
22994 @kindex set pagination
22995 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22996 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22997 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22998 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22999
23000 @item show pagination
23001 @kindex show pagination
23002 Show the current pagination mode.
23003 @end table
23004
23005 @node Numbers
23006 @section Numbers
23007 @cindex number representation
23008 @cindex entering numbers
23009
23010 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23011 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23012 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23013 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23014 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23015 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23016 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23017 both input and output with the commands described below.
23018
23019 @table @code
23020 @kindex set input-radix
23021 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23022 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23023 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23024 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23025 example, any of
23026
23027 @smallexample
23028 set input-radix 012
23029 set input-radix 10.
23030 set input-radix 0xa
23031 @end smallexample
23032
23033 @noindent
23034 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23035 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23036 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23037 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23038 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23039 change the radix.
23040
23041 @kindex set output-radix
23042 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23043 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23044 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23045 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23046
23047 @kindex show input-radix
23048 @item show input-radix
23049 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23050
23051 @kindex show output-radix
23052 @item show output-radix
23053 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23054
23055 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23056 @itemx show radix
23057 @kindex set radix
23058 @kindex show radix
23059 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23060 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23061 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23062 default value of 10.
23063
23064 @end table
23065
23066 @node ABI
23067 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23068
23069 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23070 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23071 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23072 current ABI.
23073
23074 @cindex OS ABI
23075 @kindex set osabi
23076 @kindex show osabi
23077 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23078
23079 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23080 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23081 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23082 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23083 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23084 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23085 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23086 platform provides.
23087
23088 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23089 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23090 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23091 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23092
23093 @table @code
23094 @item show osabi
23095 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23096
23097 @item set osabi
23098 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23099
23100 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23101 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23102 @end table
23103
23104 @cindex float promotion
23105
23106 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23107 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23108 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23109 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23110 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23111 @code{double} and then passed.
23112
23113 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23114 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23115 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23116
23117 @table @code
23118 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23119 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23120 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23121 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23122 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23123
23124 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23125 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23126 functions.
23127
23128 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23129 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23130 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23131 @end table
23132
23133 @kindex set cp-abi
23134 @kindex show cp-abi
23135 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23136 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23137 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23138 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23139 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23140 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23141 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23142 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23143 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23144 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23145 ``auto''.
23146
23147 @table @code
23148 @item show cp-abi
23149 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23150
23151 @item set cp-abi
23152 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23153
23154 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23155 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23156 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23157 @end table
23158
23159 @node Auto-loading
23160 @section Automatically loading associated files
23161 @cindex auto-loading
23162
23163 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23164 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23165 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23166 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23167 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23168 sources).
23169
23170 @menu
23171 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23172 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23173
23174 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23175 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23176 @end menu
23177
23178 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23179 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23180 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23181
23182 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23183 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23184 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23185
23186 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23187 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23188
23189 @table @code
23190 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23191 @kindex set auto-load off
23192 @item set auto-load off
23193 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23194 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23195 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23196 @smallexample
23197 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23198 @end smallexample
23199
23200 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23201 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23202 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23203 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23204 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23205 @code{set auto-load no}.
23206
23207 @anchor{show auto-load}
23208 @kindex show auto-load
23209 @item show auto-load
23210 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23211 or disabled.
23212
23213 @smallexample
23214 (gdb) show auto-load
23215 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23216 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23217 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23218 is on.
23219 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23220 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23221 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23222 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23223 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23224 @end smallexample
23225
23226 @anchor{info auto-load}
23227 @kindex info auto-load
23228 @item info auto-load
23229 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23230 not.
23231
23232 @smallexample
23233 (gdb) info auto-load
23234 gdb-scripts:
23235 Loaded Script
23236 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23237 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23238 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23239 loaded.
23240 python-scripts:
23241 Loaded Script
23242 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23243 @end smallexample
23244 @end table
23245
23246 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23247
23248 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23249 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23250 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23251 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23252 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23253 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23254 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23255 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23256 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23257 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23258 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23259 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23260 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23261 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23262 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23263 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23264 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23265 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23266 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23267 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23268 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23269 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23270 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23271 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23272 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23273 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23274 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23275 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23276 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23277 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23278 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23279 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23280 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23281 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23282 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23283 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23284 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23285 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23286 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23287 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23288 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23289 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23290 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23291 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23292 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23293 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23294 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23295 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23296 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23297 @end multitable
23298
23299 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23300 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23301 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23302
23303 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23304 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23305 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23306
23307 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23308 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23309
23310 @table @code
23311 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23312 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23313 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23314 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23315 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23316
23317 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23318 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23319 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23320 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23321 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23322
23323 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23324 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23325 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23326 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23327 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23328 @end table
23329
23330 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23331 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23332 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23333
23334 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23335
23336 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23337 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23338
23339 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23340 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23341 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23342 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23343 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23344 library.
23345
23346 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23347 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23348
23349 @table @code
23350 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23351 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23352 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23353 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23354
23355 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23356 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23357 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23358 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23359 enabled or disabled.
23360
23361 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23362 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23363 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23364 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23365 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23366 @end table
23367
23368 @node Auto-loading safe path
23369 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23370 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23371
23372 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23373 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23374 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23375 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23376 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23377
23378 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23379 get loaded:
23380
23381 @smallexample
23382 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23383 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23384 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23385 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23386 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23387 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23388 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23389 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23390 @end smallexample
23391
23392 @noindent
23393 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23394 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23395
23396 @smallexample
23397 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23398 @end smallexample
23399
23400 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23401
23402 @table @code
23403 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23404 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23405 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23406 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23407 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23408 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23409 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23410 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23411 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23412 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23413
23414 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23415 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23416 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23417
23418 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23419 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23420 @item show auto-load safe-path
23421 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23422 scripts.
23423
23424 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23425 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23426 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23427 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23428 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23429 by the host platform path separator in use.
23430 @end table
23431
23432 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23433 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23434 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23435 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23436 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23437
23438 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23439 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23440 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23441 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23442 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23443 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23444 init file in the current directory
23445 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23446
23447 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23448 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23449
23450 @table @asis
23451 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23452 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23453 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23454 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23455
23456 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23457 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23458 @value{GDBN} session.
23459
23460 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23461 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23462 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23463 from trusted sources.
23464
23465 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23466 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23467 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23468 trusted sources.
23469 @end table
23470
23471 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23472 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23473
23474 @table @asis
23475 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23476 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23477
23478 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23479 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23480 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23481 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23482 @end table
23483
23484 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23485 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23486 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23487 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23488 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23489 recommended to be entered.
23490
23491 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23492 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23493 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23494
23495 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23496 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23497 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23498 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23499 be printed.
23500
23501 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23502 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23503 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23504
23505 @smallexample
23506 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23507 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23508 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23509 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23510 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23511 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23512 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23513 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23514 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23515 @end smallexample
23516
23517 @table @code
23518 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23519 @kindex set debug auto-load
23520 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23521 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23522
23523 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23524 @kindex show debug auto-load
23525 @item show debug auto-load
23526 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23527 on or off.
23528 @end table
23529
23530 @node Messages/Warnings
23531 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23532
23533 @cindex verbose operation
23534 @cindex optional warnings
23535 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23536 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23537 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23538 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23539
23540 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23541 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23542 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23543
23544 @table @code
23545 @kindex set verbose
23546 @item set verbose on
23547 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23548
23549 @item set verbose off
23550 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23551
23552 @kindex show verbose
23553 @item show verbose
23554 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23555 @end table
23556
23557 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23558 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23559 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23560 Symbol Files}).
23561
23562 @table @code
23563
23564 @kindex set complaints
23565 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23566 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23567 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23568 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23569 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23570
23571 @kindex show complaints
23572 @item show complaints
23573 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23574
23575 @end table
23576
23577 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23578 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23579 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23580 you try to run a program which is already running:
23581
23582 @smallexample
23583 (@value{GDBP}) run
23584 The program being debugged has been started already.
23585 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23586 @end smallexample
23587
23588 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23589 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23590
23591 @table @code
23592
23593 @kindex set confirm
23594 @cindex flinching
23595 @cindex confirmation
23596 @cindex stupid questions
23597 @item set confirm off
23598 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23599 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23600 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23601
23602 @item set confirm on
23603 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23604
23605 @kindex show confirm
23606 @item show confirm
23607 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23608
23609 @end table
23610
23611 @cindex command tracing
23612 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23613 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23614 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23615 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23616
23617 @table @code
23618 @kindex set trace-commands
23619 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23620 @item set trace-commands on
23621 Enable command tracing.
23622 @item set trace-commands off
23623 Disable command tracing.
23624 @item show trace-commands
23625 Display the current state of command tracing.
23626 @end table
23627
23628 @node Debugging Output
23629 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23630 @cindex optional debugging messages
23631
23632 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23633 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23634 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23635 section documents those commands.
23636
23637 @table @code
23638 @kindex set exec-done-display
23639 @item set exec-done-display
23640 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23641 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23642 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23643 @kindex show exec-done-display
23644 @item show exec-done-display
23645 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23646 notification.
23647 @kindex set debug
23648 @cindex ARM AArch64
23649 @item set debug aarch64
23650 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23651 The default is off.
23652 @kindex show debug
23653 @item show debug aarch64
23654 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23655 ARM AArch64.
23656 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23657 @cindex architecture debugging info
23658 @item set debug arch
23659 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23660 @item show debug arch
23661 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23662 @item set debug aix-solib
23663 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23664 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23665 support module. The default is off.
23666 @item show debug aix-thread
23667 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23668 @item set debug aix-thread
23669 @cindex AIX threads
23670 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23671 module.
23672 @item show debug aix-thread
23673 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23674 @item set debug check-physname
23675 @cindex physname
23676 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23677 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23678 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23679 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23680 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23681 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23682 @item show debug check-physname
23683 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23684 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23685 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23686 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23687 exported symbols. The default is off.
23688 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23689 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23690 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23691 @item set debug dwarf-die
23692 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23693 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23694 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23695 A value of zero turns off the display.
23696 @item show debug dwarf-die
23697 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23698 @item set debug dwarf-line
23699 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23700 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23701 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23702 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23703 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23704 @item show debug dwarf-line
23705 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23706 @item set debug dwarf-read
23707 @cindex DWARF Reading
23708 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23709 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23710 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23711 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23712 @item show debug dwarf-read
23713 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23714 @item set debug displaced
23715 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23716 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23717 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23718 @item show debug displaced
23719 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23720 related to displaced stepping.
23721 @item set debug event
23722 @cindex event debugging info
23723 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23724 default is off.
23725 @item show debug event
23726 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23727 info.
23728 @item set debug expression
23729 @cindex expression debugging info
23730 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23731 expression parsing. The default is off.
23732 @item show debug expression
23733 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23734 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23735 @item set debug frame
23736 @cindex frame debugging info
23737 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23738 default is off.
23739 @item show debug frame
23740 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23741 info.
23742 @item set debug gnu-nat
23743 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23744 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23745 @item show debug gnu-nat
23746 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23747 @item set debug infrun
23748 @cindex inferior debugging info
23749 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23750 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23751 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23752 @item show debug infrun
23753 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23754 @item set debug jit
23755 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23756 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23757 @item show debug jit
23758 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23759 @item set debug lin-lwp
23760 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23761 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23762 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23763 @item show debug lin-lwp
23764 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23765 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23766 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23767 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23768 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23769 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23770 @item set debug mach-o
23771 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23772 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23773 processing. The default is off.
23774 @item show debug mach-o
23775 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23776 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23777 @item set debug notification
23778 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23779 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23780 The default is off.
23781 @item show debug notification
23782 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23783 @item set debug observer
23784 @cindex observer debugging info
23785 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23786 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23787 @item show debug observer
23788 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23789 @item set debug overload
23790 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23791 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23792 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23793 is off.
23794 @item show debug overload
23795 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23796 debugging info.
23797 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23798 @cindex debug expression parser
23799 @item set debug parser
23800 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23801 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23802 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23803 details. The default is off.
23804 @item show debug parser
23805 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23806 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23807 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23808 @cindex debug remote protocol
23809 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23810 @cindex display remote packets
23811 @item set debug remote
23812 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23813 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23814 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23815 @item show debug remote
23816 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23817 @item set debug serial
23818 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23819 default is off.
23820 @item show debug serial
23821 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23822 info.
23823 @item set debug solib-frv
23824 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23825 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23826 @item show debug solib-frv
23827 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23828 messages.
23829 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23830 @cindex symbol lookup
23831 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23832 The default is 0 (off).
23833 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23834 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23835 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23836 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23837 @item set debug symfile
23838 @cindex symbol file functions
23839 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23840 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23841 @item show debug symfile
23842 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23843 @item set debug symtab-create
23844 @cindex symbol table creation
23845 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23846 The default is 0 (off).
23847 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23848 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23849 @item show debug symtab-create
23850 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23851 @item set debug target
23852 @cindex target debugging info
23853 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23854 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23855 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23856 value of large memory transfers.
23857 @item show debug target
23858 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23859 info.
23860 @item set debug timestamp
23861 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23862 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23863 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23864 message.
23865 @item show debug timestamp
23866 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23867 debugging info.
23868 @item set debug varobj
23869 @cindex variable object debugging info
23870 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23871 info. The default is off.
23872 @item show debug varobj
23873 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23874 debugging info.
23875 @item set debug xml
23876 @cindex XML parser debugging
23877 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23878 @item show debug xml
23879 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23880 @end table
23881
23882 @node Other Misc Settings
23883 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23884 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23885
23886 @table @code
23887 @kindex set interactive-mode
23888 @item set interactive-mode
23889 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23890 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23891 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23892 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23893 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23894 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23895 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23896 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23897
23898 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23899 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23900 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23901 inside a cygwin window.
23902
23903 @kindex show interactive-mode
23904 @item show interactive-mode
23905 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23906 @end table
23907
23908 @node Extending GDB
23909 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23910 @cindex extending GDB
23911
23912 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23913 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23914 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23915 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23916 being debugged.
23917
23918 @menu
23919 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23920 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23921 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23922 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23923 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23924 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23925 @end menu
23926
23927 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23928 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23929 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23930 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23931 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23932 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23933
23934 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23935 setting:
23936
23937 @table @code
23938 @kindex set script-extension
23939 @kindex show script-extension
23940 @item set script-extension off
23941 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23942
23943 @item set script-extension soft
23944 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23945 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23946 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23947 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23948
23949 @item set script-extension strict
23950 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23951 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23952 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23953
23954 @item show script-extension
23955 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23956
23957 @end table
23958
23959 @node Sequences
23960 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23961
23962 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23963 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23964 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23965 files.
23966
23967 @menu
23968 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23969 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23970 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23971 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23972 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23973 @end menu
23974
23975 @node Define
23976 @subsection User-defined Commands
23977
23978 @cindex user-defined command
23979 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23980 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23981 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23982 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23983 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23984 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23985
23986 @smallexample
23987 define adder
23988 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23989 end
23990 @end smallexample
23991
23992 @noindent
23993 To execute the command use:
23994
23995 @smallexample
23996 adder 1 2 3
23997 @end smallexample
23998
23999 @noindent
24000 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24001 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24002 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24003 functions calls.
24004
24005 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24006 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24007 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24008 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
24009
24010 @smallexample
24011 define adder
24012 if $argc == 2
24013 print $arg0 + $arg1
24014 end
24015 if $argc == 3
24016 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24017 end
24018 end
24019 @end smallexample
24020
24021 @table @code
24022
24023 @kindex define
24024 @item define @var{commandname}
24025 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24026 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24027 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24028 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24029 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24030 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24031
24032 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24033 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24034 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24035
24036 @kindex document
24037 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24038 @item document @var{commandname}
24039 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24040 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24041 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24042 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24043 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24044 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24045
24046 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24047 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24048 does not change the documentation.
24049
24050 @kindex dont-repeat
24051 @cindex don't repeat command
24052 @item dont-repeat
24053 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24054 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24055 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24056
24057 @kindex help user-defined
24058 @item help user-defined
24059 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24060 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24061 included (if any).
24062
24063 @kindex show user
24064 @item show user
24065 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24066 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24067 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24068 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24069 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24070
24071 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24072 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24073 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24074 @item show max-user-call-depth
24075 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24076 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24077 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24078 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24079 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24080 @end table
24081
24082 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24083 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24084
24085 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24086 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24087 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24088
24089 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24090 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24091 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24092 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24093
24094 @node Hooks
24095 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24096 @cindex command hooks
24097 @cindex hooks, for commands
24098 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24099
24100 @kindex hook
24101 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24102 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24103 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24104 before that command.
24105
24106 @cindex hooks, post-command
24107 @kindex hookpost
24108 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24109 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24110 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24111 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24112 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24113
24114 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24115 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24116
24117 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24118 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24119
24120 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24121 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24122 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24123 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24124 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24125
24126 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24127 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24128 you could define:
24129
24130 @smallexample
24131 define hook-stop
24132 handle SIGALRM nopass
24133 end
24134
24135 define hook-run
24136 handle SIGALRM pass
24137 end
24138
24139 define hook-continue
24140 handle SIGALRM pass
24141 end
24142 @end smallexample
24143
24144 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24145 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24146 you could define:
24147
24148 @smallexample
24149 define hook-echo
24150 echo <<<---
24151 end
24152
24153 define hookpost-echo
24154 echo --->>>\n
24155 end
24156
24157 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24158 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24159 (@value{GDBP})
24160
24161 @end smallexample
24162
24163 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24164 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24165 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24166 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24167 @c or not?
24168 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24169 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24170 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24171
24172 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24173 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24174 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24175
24176 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24177 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24178
24179 @node Command Files
24180 @subsection Command Files
24181
24182 @cindex command files
24183 @cindex scripting commands
24184 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24185 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24186 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24187 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24188 terminal.
24189
24190 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24191 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24192 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24193 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24194 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24195
24196 @table @code
24197 @kindex source
24198 @cindex execute commands from a file
24199 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24200 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24201 @end table
24202
24203 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24204 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24205 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24206 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24207 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24208
24209 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24210 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24211 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24212 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24213 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24214 is not relevant to scripts.
24215
24216 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24217 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24218 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24219 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24220 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24221 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24222 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24223 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24224 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24225 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24226 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24227 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24228 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24229 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24230
24231 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24232 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24233 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24234
24235 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24236 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24237 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24238 when called from command files.
24239
24240 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24241 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24242 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24243 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24244 the next command.
24245
24246 @smallexample
24247 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24248 @end smallexample
24249
24250 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24251 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24252 would be directed to @file{log}.
24253
24254 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24255 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24256 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24257 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24258 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24259 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24260 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24261 conditionally, etc.
24262
24263 @table @code
24264 @kindex if
24265 @kindex else
24266 @item if
24267 @itemx else
24268 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24269 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24270 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24271 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24272 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24273 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24274 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24275
24276 @kindex while
24277 @item while
24278 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24279 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24280 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24281 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24282 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24283 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24284
24285 @kindex loop_break
24286 @item loop_break
24287 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24288 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24289 line.
24290
24291 @kindex loop_continue
24292 @item loop_continue
24293 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24294 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24295 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24296 the controlling expression.
24297
24298 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24299 @item end
24300 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24301 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24302 @end table
24303
24304
24305 @node Output
24306 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24307
24308 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24309 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24310 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24311 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24312 want.
24313
24314 @table @code
24315 @kindex echo
24316 @item echo @var{text}
24317 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24318 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24319 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24320 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24321 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24322 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24323 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24324 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24325 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24326 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24327 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24328
24329 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24330 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24331
24332 @smallexample
24333 echo This is some text\n\
24334 which is continued\n\
24335 onto several lines.\n
24336 @end smallexample
24337
24338 produces the same output as
24339
24340 @smallexample
24341 echo This is some text\n
24342 echo which is continued\n
24343 echo onto several lines.\n
24344 @end smallexample
24345
24346 @kindex output
24347 @item output @var{expression}
24348 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24349 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24350 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24351 on expressions.
24352
24353 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24354 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24355 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24356 Formats}, for more information.
24357
24358 @kindex printf
24359 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24360 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24361 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24362 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24363 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24364 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24365 executing the code below:
24366
24367 @smallexample
24368 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24369 @end smallexample
24370
24371 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24372 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24373 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24374 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24375 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24376 printed.
24377
24378 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24379
24380 @smallexample
24381 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24382 @end smallexample
24383
24384 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24385 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24386 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24387
24388 @itemize @bullet
24389 @item
24390 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24391
24392 @item
24393 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24394 width.
24395
24396 @item
24397 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24398 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24399
24400 @item
24401 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24402 supported.
24403
24404 @item
24405 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24406
24407 @item
24408 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24409 @end itemize
24410
24411 @noindent
24412 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24413 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24414 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24415 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24416
24417 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24418 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24419 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24420 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24421 supported.
24422
24423 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24424 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24425 together with a floating point specifier.
24426 letters:
24427
24428 @itemize @bullet
24429 @item
24430 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24431
24432 @item
24433 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24434
24435 @item
24436 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24437 @end itemize
24438
24439 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24440 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24441 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24442
24443 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24444 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24445
24446 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24447 @smallexample
24448 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24449 @end smallexample
24450
24451 @kindex eval
24452 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24453 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24454 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24455
24456 @end table
24457
24458 @node Auto-loading sequences
24459 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24460 @cindex native script auto-loading
24461
24462 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24463 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24464 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24465 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24466
24467 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24468 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24469
24470 @table @code
24471 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24472 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24473 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24474 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24475
24476 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24477 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24478 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24479 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24480 disabled.
24481
24482 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24483 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24484 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24485 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24486 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24487 auto-loaded.
24488 @end table
24489
24490 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24491 matching names are printed.
24492
24493 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24494 @include python.texi
24495
24496 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24497 @include guile.texi
24498
24499 @node Auto-loading extensions
24500 @section Auto-loading extensions
24501 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24502
24503 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24504 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24505 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24506 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24507 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24508
24509 @menu
24510 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24511 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24512 * Which flavor to choose?::
24513 @end menu
24514
24515 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24516 debugging commands and features.
24517
24518 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24519 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24520 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24521 for more information.
24522 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24523 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24524
24525 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24526 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24527
24528 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24529 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24530 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24531 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24532 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24533
24534 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24535 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24536 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24537 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24538
24539 @table @code
24540 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24541 GDB's own command language
24542 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24543 Python
24544 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24545 Guile
24546 @end table
24547
24548 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24549 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24550 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24551 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24552 script in the specified extension language.
24553
24554 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24555 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24556
24557 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24558 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24559
24560 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24561 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24562 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24563 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24564 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24565 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24566
24567 @table @code
24568 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24569 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24570 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24571 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24572 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24573 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24574
24575 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24576 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24577
24578 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24579 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24580 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24581 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24582
24583 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24584 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24585 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24586 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24587 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24588 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24589 platform.
24590
24591 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24592 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24593 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24594
24595 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24596 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24597 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24598 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24599
24600 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24601 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24602 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24603 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24604 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24605 @end table
24606
24607 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24608 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24609 @var{objfile} is opened.
24610 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24611 is evaluated more than once.
24612
24613 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24614 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24615 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24616
24617 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24618 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24619 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24620 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24621 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24622 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24623 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24624
24625 The following entries are supported:
24626
24627 @table @code
24628 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24629 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24630 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24631 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24632 @end table
24633
24634 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24635
24636 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24637 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24638 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24639 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24640 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24641
24642 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24643 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24644
24645 @example
24646 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24647 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24648 asm("\
24649 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24650 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24651 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24652 .popsection \n\
24653 ");
24654 @end example
24655
24656 @noindent
24657 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24658 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24659
24660 @example
24661 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24662 @end example
24663
24664 The script name may include directories if desired.
24665
24666 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24667 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24668
24669 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24670 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24671 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24672 will remove duplicates.
24673
24674 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24675
24676 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24677 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24678 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24679 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24680 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24681 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24682 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24683 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24684 on its name.
24685
24686 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24687 testsuite.
24688
24689 @example
24690 #include "symcat.h"
24691 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24692 asm(
24693 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24694 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24695 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24696 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24697 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24698 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24699 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24700 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24701 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24702 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24703 ".byte 0\n"
24704 ".popsection\n"
24705 );
24706 @end example
24707
24708 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24709 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24710 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24711 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24712
24713 @node Which flavor to choose?
24714 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24715
24716 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24717 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24718
24719 @noindent
24720 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24721
24722 @itemize @bullet
24723 @item
24724 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24725
24726 @item
24727 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24728
24729 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24730 in the source search path.
24731 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24732 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24733
24734 @item
24735 Doesn't require source code additions.
24736 @end itemize
24737
24738 @noindent
24739 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24740
24741 @itemize @bullet
24742 @item
24743 Works with static linking.
24744
24745 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24746 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24747 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24748 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24749 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24750
24751 @item
24752 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24753
24754 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24755 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24756
24757 @item
24758 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24759
24760 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24761 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24762 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24763 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24764 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24765 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24766 @end itemize
24767
24768 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24769 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24770
24771 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24772 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24773 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24774
24775 @subsection Python comes first
24776
24777 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24778 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24779 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24780 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24781 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24782 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24783 pretty-printed form of a value).
24784 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24785 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24786 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24787
24788 @node Aliases
24789 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24790 @cindex aliases for commands
24791
24792 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24793 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24794 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24795 that involves less typing.
24796
24797 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24798 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24799 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24800
24801 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24802 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24803 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24804
24805 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24806
24807 @table @code
24808
24809 @kindex alias
24810 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24811
24812 @end table
24813
24814 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24815 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24816 underscores.
24817
24818 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24819 that is being aliased.
24820
24821 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24822 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24823 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24824
24825 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24826 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24827
24828 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24829 of a command so that there is less to type.
24830 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24831 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24832 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24833 The following will accomplish this.
24834
24835 @smallexample
24836 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24837 @end smallexample
24838
24839 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24840 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24841 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24842 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24843
24844 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24845 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24846 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24847 of a command.
24848
24849 @smallexample
24850 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24851 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24852 (gdb) set p elms 20
24853 (gdb) show p elms
24854 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24855 @end smallexample
24856
24857 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24858 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24859 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24860
24861 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24862 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24863
24864 @smallexample
24865 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24866 @end smallexample
24867
24868 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24869 alias for a more complex command.
24870 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24871
24872 @smallexample
24873 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24874 (gdb) spe 20
24875 @end smallexample
24876
24877 @node Interpreters
24878 @chapter Command Interpreters
24879 @cindex command interpreters
24880
24881 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24882 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24883 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24884
24885 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24886 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24887 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24888 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24889
24890 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24891 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24892 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24893 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24894
24895 @table @code
24896 @item console
24897 @cindex console interpreter
24898 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24899 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24900 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24901
24902 @item mi
24903 @cindex mi interpreter
24904 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24905 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24906 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24907 Interface}.
24908
24909 @item mi2
24910 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24911 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24912
24913 @item mi1
24914 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24915 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24916
24917 @end table
24918
24919 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24920 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24921 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24922 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24923 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24924 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24925 the IDE inoperable!
24926
24927 @kindex interpreter-exec
24928 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24929 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24930 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24931 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24932
24933 @smallexample
24934 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24935 @end smallexample
24936
24937 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24938 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24939
24940 @node TUI
24941 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24942 @cindex TUI
24943 @cindex Text User Interface
24944
24945 @menu
24946 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24947 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24948 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24949 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24950 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24951 @end menu
24952
24953 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24954 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24955 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24956 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24957 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24958 is available.
24959
24960 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24961 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24962 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24963 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24964 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24965 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24966
24967 @node TUI Overview
24968 @section TUI Overview
24969
24970 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24971
24972 @table @emph
24973 @item command
24974 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24975 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24976 managed using readline.
24977
24978 @item source
24979 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24980 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24981
24982 @item assembly
24983 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24984
24985 @item register
24986 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24987 when their values change.
24988 @end table
24989
24990 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24991 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24992 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24993 indicates the breakpoint type:
24994
24995 @table @code
24996 @item B
24997 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24998
24999 @item b
25000 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25001
25002 @item H
25003 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25004
25005 @item h
25006 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25007 @end table
25008
25009 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25010
25011 @table @code
25012 @item +
25013 Breakpoint is enabled.
25014
25015 @item -
25016 Breakpoint is disabled.
25017 @end table
25018
25019 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25020 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25021 changes.
25022
25023 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25024 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25025 layouts:
25026
25027 @itemize @bullet
25028 @item
25029 source only,
25030
25031 @item
25032 assembly only,
25033
25034 @item
25035 source and assembly,
25036
25037 @item
25038 source and registers, or
25039
25040 @item
25041 assembly and registers.
25042 @end itemize
25043
25044 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25045
25046 @table @emph
25047 @item target
25048 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25049 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25050
25051 @item process
25052 Gives the current process or thread number.
25053 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25054
25055 @item function
25056 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25057 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25058 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25059 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25060
25061 @item line
25062 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25063 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25064
25065 @item pc
25066 Indicates the current program counter address.
25067 @end table
25068
25069 @node TUI Keys
25070 @section TUI Key Bindings
25071 @cindex TUI key bindings
25072
25073 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25074 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25075 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25076 @end ifset
25077 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25078 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25079 @end ifclear
25080 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25081 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25082
25083 @table @kbd
25084 @kindex C-x C-a
25085 @item C-x C-a
25086 @kindex C-x a
25087 @itemx C-x a
25088 @kindex C-x A
25089 @itemx C-x A
25090 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25091 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25092 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25093 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25094 The screen is then refreshed.
25095
25096 @kindex C-x 1
25097 @item C-x 1
25098 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25099 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25100 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25101
25102 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25103
25104 @kindex C-x 2
25105 @item C-x 2
25106 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25107 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25108 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25109 previous layout and the new one.
25110
25111 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25112
25113 @kindex C-x o
25114 @item C-x o
25115 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25116 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25117 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25118
25119 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25120
25121 @kindex C-x s
25122 @item C-x s
25123 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25124 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25125 @end table
25126
25127 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25128
25129 @table @asis
25130 @kindex PgUp
25131 @item @key{PgUp}
25132 Scroll the active window one page up.
25133
25134 @kindex PgDn
25135 @item @key{PgDn}
25136 Scroll the active window one page down.
25137
25138 @kindex Up
25139 @item @key{Up}
25140 Scroll the active window one line up.
25141
25142 @kindex Down
25143 @item @key{Down}
25144 Scroll the active window one line down.
25145
25146 @kindex Left
25147 @item @key{Left}
25148 Scroll the active window one column left.
25149
25150 @kindex Right
25151 @item @key{Right}
25152 Scroll the active window one column right.
25153
25154 @kindex C-L
25155 @item @kbd{C-L}
25156 Refresh the screen.
25157 @end table
25158
25159 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25160 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25161 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25162 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25163 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25164
25165 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25166 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25167 @cindex TUI single key mode
25168
25169 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25170 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25171 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25172
25173 @table @kbd
25174 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25175 @item c
25176 continue
25177
25178 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25179 @item d
25180 down
25181
25182 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25183 @item f
25184 finish
25185
25186 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25187 @item n
25188 next
25189
25190 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25191 @item q
25192 exit the SingleKey mode.
25193
25194 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25195 @item r
25196 run
25197
25198 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25199 @item s
25200 step
25201
25202 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25203 @item u
25204 up
25205
25206 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25207 @item v
25208 info locals
25209
25210 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25211 @item w
25212 where
25213 @end table
25214
25215 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25216 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25217 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25218 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25219 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25220 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25221
25222
25223 @node TUI Commands
25224 @section TUI-specific Commands
25225 @cindex TUI commands
25226
25227 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25228 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25229 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25230 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25231
25232 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25233 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25234 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25235 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25236 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25237
25238 @table @code
25239 @item tui enable
25240 @kindex tui enable
25241 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25242 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25243 otherwise a default layout is used.
25244
25245 @item tui disable
25246 @kindex tui disable
25247 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25248
25249 @item info win
25250 @kindex info win
25251 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25252
25253 @item layout @var{name}
25254 @kindex layout
25255 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25256 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25257 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25258
25259 @table @code
25260 @item next
25261 Display the next layout.
25262
25263 @item prev
25264 Display the previous layout.
25265
25266 @item src
25267 Display the source and command windows.
25268
25269 @item asm
25270 Display the assembly and command windows.
25271
25272 @item split
25273 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25274
25275 @item regs
25276 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25277 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25278 register, assembler, and command windows.
25279 @end table
25280
25281 @item focus @var{name}
25282 @kindex focus
25283 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25284 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25285
25286 @table @code
25287 @item next
25288 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25289
25290 @item prev
25291 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25292
25293 @item src
25294 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25295
25296 @item asm
25297 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25298
25299 @item regs
25300 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25301
25302 @item cmd
25303 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25304 @end table
25305
25306 @item refresh
25307 @kindex refresh
25308 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25309
25310 @item tui reg @var{group}
25311 @kindex tui reg
25312 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25313 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25314 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25315 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25316 following groups are available on most targets:
25317 @table @code
25318 @item next
25319 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25320 through all of the available register groups.
25321
25322 @item prev
25323 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25324 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25325 @var{next}.
25326
25327 @item general
25328 Display the general registers.
25329 @item float
25330 Display the floating point registers.
25331 @item system
25332 Display the system registers.
25333 @item vector
25334 Display the vector registers.
25335 @item all
25336 Display all registers.
25337 @end table
25338
25339 @item update
25340 @kindex update
25341 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25342
25343 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25344 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25345 @kindex winheight
25346 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25347 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25348 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25349 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25350 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25351
25352 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25353 @kindex tabset
25354 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25355 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25356 assembly windows.
25357 @end table
25358
25359 @node TUI Configuration
25360 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25361 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25362
25363 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25364
25365 @table @code
25366 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25367 @kindex set tui border-kind
25368 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25369 The possible values are the following:
25370 @table @code
25371 @item space
25372 Use a space character to draw the border.
25373
25374 @item ascii
25375 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25376
25377 @item acs
25378 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25379 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25380 @end table
25381
25382 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25383 @kindex set tui border-mode
25384 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25385 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25386 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25387 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25388 @table @code
25389 @item normal
25390 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25391
25392 @item standout
25393 Use standout mode.
25394
25395 @item reverse
25396 Use reverse video mode.
25397
25398 @item half
25399 Use half bright mode.
25400
25401 @item half-standout
25402 Use half bright and standout mode.
25403
25404 @item bold
25405 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25406
25407 @item bold-standout
25408 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25409 @end table
25410 @end table
25411
25412 @node Emacs
25413 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25414
25415 @cindex Emacs
25416 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25417 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25418 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25419 @value{GDBN}.
25420
25421 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25422 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25423 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25424 created Emacs buffer.
25425 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25426
25427 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25428 things:
25429
25430 @itemize @bullet
25431 @item
25432 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25433 the GUD buffer.
25434
25435 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25436 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25437
25438 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25439 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25440 in this way.
25441
25442 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25443 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25444 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25445 stop.
25446
25447 @item
25448 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25449
25450 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25451 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25452 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25453 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25454 and the source.
25455
25456 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25457 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25458 @end itemize
25459
25460 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25461 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25462 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25463 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25464
25465 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25466 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25467 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25468 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25469 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25470 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25471 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25472 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25473 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25474
25475 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25476 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25477 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25478 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25479
25480 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25481 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25482 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25483 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25484 one you want.
25485
25486 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25487 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25488
25489 @table @kbd
25490 @item C-h m
25491 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25492
25493 @item C-c C-s
25494 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25495 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25496
25497 @item C-c C-n
25498 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25499 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25500 to show the current file and location.
25501
25502 @item C-c C-i
25503 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25504 display window accordingly.
25505
25506 @item C-c C-f
25507 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25508 @code{finish} command.
25509
25510 @item C-c C-r
25511 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25512 command.
25513
25514 @item C-c <
25515 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25516 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25517 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25518
25519 @item C-c >
25520 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25521 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25522 @end table
25523
25524 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25525 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25526
25527 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25528 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25529 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25530 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25531 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25532 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25533 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25534
25535 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25536 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25537 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25538 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25539 frame.
25540
25541 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25542 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25543 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25544 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25545 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25546 to correspond properly with the code.
25547
25548 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25549 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25550 Emacs Manual}).
25551
25552 @node GDB/MI
25553 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25554
25555 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25556
25557 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25558 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25559 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25560 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25561 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25562 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25563
25564 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25565 in the form of a reference manual.
25566
25567 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25568 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25569 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25570
25571 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25572
25573 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25574 This chapter uses the following notation:
25575
25576 @itemize @bullet
25577 @item
25578 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25579
25580 @item
25581 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25582 it may or may not be given.
25583
25584 @item
25585 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25586 may repeat zero or more times.
25587
25588 @item
25589 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25590 may repeat one or more times.
25591
25592 @item
25593 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25594 @end itemize
25595
25596 @ignore
25597 @heading Dependencies
25598 @end ignore
25599
25600 @menu
25601 * GDB/MI General Design::
25602 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25603 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25604 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25605 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25606 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25607 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25608 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25609 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25610 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25611 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25612 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25613 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25614 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25615 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25616 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25617 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25618 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25619 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25620 @ignore
25621 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25622 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25623 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25624 @end ignore
25625 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25626 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25627 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25628 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25629 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25630 @end menu
25631
25632 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25633 @node GDB/MI General Design
25634 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25635 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25636
25637 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25638 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25639 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25640 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25641 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25642 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25643 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25644 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25645 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25646 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25647
25648 The important examples of notifications are:
25649 @itemize @bullet
25650
25651 @item
25652 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25653 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25654 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25655 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25656 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25657 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25658 command itself was successfully executed.
25659
25660 @item
25661 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25662 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25663 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25664 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25665 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25666 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25667
25668 @item
25669 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25670 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25671 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25672 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25673 orthogonal frontend design.
25674
25675 @end itemize
25676
25677 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25678 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25679 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25680 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25681 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25682 the user interface.
25683
25684
25685 @menu
25686 * Context management::
25687 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25688 * Thread groups::
25689 @end menu
25690
25691 @node Context management
25692 @subsection Context management
25693
25694 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25695
25696 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25697 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25698 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25699 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25700 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25701 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25702 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25703 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25704 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25705
25706 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25707 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25708 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25709 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25710 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25711 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25712 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25713 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25714 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25715 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25716 for thread and frame to operate on.
25717
25718 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25719 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25720 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25721 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25722 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25723 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25724 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25725 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25726 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25727 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25728
25729 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25730 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25731 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25732 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25733 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25734 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25735 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25736 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25737 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25738 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25739 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25740 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25741 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25742 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25743 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25744 @samp{--frame} options.
25745
25746 @subsubsection Language
25747
25748 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25749 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25750 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25751 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25752 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25753 For instance:
25754
25755 @smallexample
25756 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25757 ^done,value="4"
25758 (gdb)
25759 @end smallexample
25760
25761 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25762 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25763 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25764
25765 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25766 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25767
25768 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25769 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25770 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25771 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25772 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25773 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25774 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25775 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25776 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25777
25778 @table @code
25779 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25780 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25781 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25782
25783 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25784 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25785 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25786
25787 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25788 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25789 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25790 MI commands even while the target is running.
25791
25792 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25793 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25794 @end table
25795
25796 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25797 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25798 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25799 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25800 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25801 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25802
25803 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25804 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25805 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25806 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25807 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25808 are running.
25809
25810 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25811 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25812 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25813 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25814 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25815 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25816 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25817 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25818 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25819 @samp{--thread} option).
25820
25821 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25822 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25823 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25824 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25825
25826 @node Thread groups
25827 @subsection Thread groups
25828 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25829 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25830 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25831 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25832 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25833
25834 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25835 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25836 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25837 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25838 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25839 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25840 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25841 into processes.
25842
25843 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25844 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25845 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25846 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25847 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25848 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25849 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25850 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25851 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25852 the members of specific thread group.
25853
25854 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25855 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25856 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25857 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25858 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25859 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25860 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25861 after attaching to that thread group.
25862
25863 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25864 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25865 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25866 such thread groups.
25867
25868 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25869 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25870 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25871
25872 @menu
25873 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25874 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25875 @end menu
25876
25877 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25878 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25879
25880 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25881 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25882 @table @code
25883 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25884 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25885
25886 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25887 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25888 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25889
25890 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25891 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25892 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25893
25894 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25895 "any sequence of digits"
25896
25897 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25898 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25899
25900 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25901 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25902
25903 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25904 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25905
25906 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25907 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25908 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25909
25910 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25911 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25912
25913 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25914 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25915 @end table
25916
25917 @noindent
25918 Notes:
25919
25920 @itemize @bullet
25921 @item
25922 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25923 output is described below.
25924
25925 @item
25926 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25927 finishes.
25928
25929 @item
25930 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25931 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25932 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25933 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25934 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25935 @end itemize
25936
25937 Pragmatics:
25938
25939 @itemize @bullet
25940 @item
25941 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25942
25943 @item
25944 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25945 @end itemize
25946
25947 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25948 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25949
25950 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25951 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25952 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25953 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25954 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25955 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25956
25957 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25958 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25959 @var{token}.
25960
25961 @table @code
25962 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25963 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25964
25965 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25966 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25967
25968 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25969 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25970
25971 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25972 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25973
25974 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25975 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25976
25977 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25978 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25979
25980 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25981 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25982
25983 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25984 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25985
25986 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25987 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25988
25989 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25990 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25991 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25992
25993 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25994 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25995
25996 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25997 @code{ @var{string} }
25998
25999 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26000 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26001
26002 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26003 @code{@var{c-string}}
26004
26005 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26006 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26007
26008 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26009 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26010 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26011
26012 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26013 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26014
26015 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26016 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26017
26018 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26019 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26020
26021 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26022 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26023
26024 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26025 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26026
26027 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26028 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26029 @end table
26030
26031 @noindent
26032 Notes:
26033
26034 @itemize @bullet
26035 @item
26036 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26037
26038 @item
26039 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26040 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26041 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26042 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26043 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26044 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26045 prior command.
26046
26047 @item
26048 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26049 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26050 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26051 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26052
26053 @item
26054 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26055 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26056 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26057 @samp{*}.
26058
26059 @item
26060 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26061 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26062 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26063 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26064
26065 @item
26066 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26067 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26068 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26069 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26070
26071 @item
26072 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26073 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26074 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26075
26076 @item
26077 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26078 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26079 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26080 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26081
26082 @item
26083 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26084 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26085 @var{values}.
26086
26087
26088 @end itemize
26089
26090 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26091 details about the various output records.
26092
26093 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26094 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26095 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26096
26097 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26098 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26099
26100 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26101 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26102 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26103 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26104 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26105 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26106
26107 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26108 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26109 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26110
26111 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26112 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26113 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26114 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26115
26116 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26117 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26118
26119 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26120 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26121 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26122 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26123 might change.
26124
26125 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26126 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26127 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26128 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26129
26130 @itemize @bullet
26131 @item
26132 New MI commands may be added.
26133
26134 @item
26135 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26136
26137 @item
26138 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26139 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26140
26141 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26142 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26143
26144 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26145 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26146 @end itemize
26147
26148 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26149 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26150 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26151 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26152 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26153
26154 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26155 @c version?
26156
26157 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26158 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26159 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26160 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26161 @cindex mailing lists
26162
26163 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26164 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26165 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26166
26167 @menu
26168 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26169 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26170 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26171 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26172 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26173 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26174 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26175 @end menu
26176
26177 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26178 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26179
26180 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26181 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26182 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26183 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26184
26185 @table @code
26186 @findex ^done
26187 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26188 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26189 values.
26190
26191 @item "^running"
26192 @findex ^running
26193 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26194 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26195 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26196 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26197 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26198 which threads are resumed.
26199
26200 @item "^connected"
26201 @findex ^connected
26202 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26203
26204 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26205 @findex ^error
26206 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26207 the corresponding error message.
26208
26209 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26210 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26211 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26212
26213 @table @samp
26214 @item "undefined-command"
26215 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26216 @end table
26217
26218 @item "^exit"
26219 @findex ^exit
26220 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26221
26222 @end table
26223
26224 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26225 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26226
26227 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26228 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26229 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26230 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26231 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26232
26233 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26234 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26235 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26236 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26237 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26238
26239 @table @code
26240 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26241 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26242 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26243
26244 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26245 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26246 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26247 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26248
26249 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26250 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26251 internals.
26252 @end table
26253
26254 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26255 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26256
26257 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26258 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26259 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26260 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26261 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26262 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26263
26264 The following is the list of possible async records:
26265
26266 @table @code
26267
26268 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26269 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
26270 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
26271 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
26272 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
26273 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
26274 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
26275 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
26276 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
26277 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
26278
26279 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26280 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26281 following values:
26282
26283 @table @code
26284 @item breakpoint-hit
26285 A breakpoint was reached.
26286 @item watchpoint-trigger
26287 A watchpoint was triggered.
26288 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26289 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26290 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26291 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26292 @item function-finished
26293 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26294 @item location-reached
26295 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26296 @item watchpoint-scope
26297 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26298 @item end-stepping-range
26299 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26300 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26301 @item exited-signalled
26302 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26303 @item exited
26304 The inferior exited.
26305 @item exited-normally
26306 The inferior exited normally.
26307 @item signal-received
26308 A signal was received by the inferior.
26309 @item solib-event
26310 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26311 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26312 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26313 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26314 @item fork
26315 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26316 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26317 @item vfork
26318 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26319 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26320 @item syscall-entry
26321 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26322 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26323 @item syscall-return
26324 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26325 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26326 @item exec
26327 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26328 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26329 @end table
26330
26331 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
26332 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
26333 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26334 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26335 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26336 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26337 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26338 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26339 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26340 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26341 if such information is not available.
26342
26343 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26344 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26345 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26346 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26347 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26348 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26349 cannot be used in any way.
26350
26351 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26352 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26353 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26354 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26355 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26356 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26357
26358 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26359 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26360 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26361 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26362 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26363 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26364
26365 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26366 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26367 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26368 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26369 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26370
26371 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26372 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26373 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26374 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26375 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26376 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26377 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26378
26379 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26380 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26381 that thread.
26382
26383 @item =library-loaded,...
26384 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26385 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26386 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26387 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26388 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26389 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26390 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26391 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26392 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26393 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26394 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26395 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26396 thread groups.
26397
26398 @item =library-unloaded,...
26399 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26400 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26401 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26402 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26403 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26404 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26405 thread groups.
26406
26407 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26408 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26409 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26410 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26411 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26412
26413 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26414 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26415 initial value @var{initial}.
26416
26417 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26418 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26419 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26420 trace state variables are deleted.
26421
26422 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26423 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26424 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26425 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26426 value of trace state variable is known.
26427
26428 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26429 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26430 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26431 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26432 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26433 user.
26434
26435 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26436 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26437 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26438
26439 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26440 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26441
26442 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26443 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26444 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26445 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26446 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26447
26448 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26449 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26450 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26451 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26452 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26453 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26454
26455 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26456 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26457 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26458 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26459 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26460 executable code.
26461 @end table
26462
26463 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26464 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26465
26466 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26467 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26468 following fields:
26469
26470 @table @code
26471 @item number
26472 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26473 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26474 @samp{1.2}.
26475
26476 @item type
26477 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26478 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26479
26480 @item catch-type
26481 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26482 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26483
26484 @item disp
26485 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26486 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26487 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26488
26489 @item enabled
26490 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26491 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26492 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26493
26494 @item addr
26495 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26496 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26497 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26498 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26499 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26500
26501 @item func
26502 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26503 If not known, this field is not present.
26504
26505 @item filename
26506 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26507 If not known, this field is not present.
26508
26509 @item fullname
26510 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26511 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26512
26513 @item line
26514 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26515 If not known, this field is not present.
26516
26517 @item at
26518 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26519 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26520 by a symbol name.
26521
26522 @item pending
26523 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26524 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26525
26526 @item evaluated-by
26527 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26528 @samp{target}.
26529
26530 @item thread
26531 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26532 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26533
26534 @item task
26535 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26536 field will hold the task identifier.
26537
26538 @item cond
26539 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26540
26541 @item ignore
26542 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26543
26544 @item enable
26545 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26546
26547 @item traceframe-usage
26548 FIXME.
26549
26550 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26551 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26552
26553 @item mask
26554 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26555
26556 @item pass
26557 A tracepoint's pass count.
26558
26559 @item original-location
26560 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26561 This field is optional.
26562
26563 @item times
26564 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26565
26566 @item installed
26567 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26568 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26569 is not.
26570
26571 @item what
26572 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26573
26574 @end table
26575
26576 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26577 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26578
26579 @smallexample
26580 -> -break-insert main
26581 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26582 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26583 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26584 times="0"@}
26585 <- (gdb)
26586 @end smallexample
26587
26588 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26589 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26590
26591 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26592 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26593 fields:
26594
26595 @table @code
26596 @item level
26597 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26598 zero. This field is always present.
26599
26600 @item func
26601 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26602 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26603
26604 @item addr
26605 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26606
26607 @item file
26608 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26609 address. This field may be absent.
26610
26611 @item line
26612 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26613 may be absent.
26614
26615 @item from
26616 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26617 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26618
26619 @end table
26620
26621 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26622 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26623
26624 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26625 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26626
26627 @table @code
26628 @item id
26629 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26630 always present.
26631
26632 @item target-id
26633 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26634
26635 @item details
26636 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26637 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26638 frontend. This field is optional.
26639
26640 @item state
26641 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26642 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26643
26644 @item core
26645 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26646 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26647 @end table
26648
26649 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26650 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26651
26652 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26653 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26654 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26655 the @code{exception-name} field.
26656
26657 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26658 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26659 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26660 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26661
26662 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26663 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26664 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26665 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26666
26667 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26668 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26669
26670 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26671
26672 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26673 information of the breakpoint.
26674
26675 @smallexample
26676 -> -break-insert main
26677 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26678 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26679 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26680 times="0"@}
26681 <- (gdb)
26682 @end smallexample
26683
26684 @subheading Program Execution
26685
26686 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26687 reason that execution stopped.
26688
26689 @smallexample
26690 -> -exec-run
26691 <- ^running
26692 <- (gdb)
26693 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26694 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26695 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26696 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26697 <- (gdb)
26698 -> -exec-continue
26699 <- ^running
26700 <- (gdb)
26701 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26702 <- (gdb)
26703 @end smallexample
26704
26705 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26706
26707 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26708
26709 @smallexample
26710 -> (gdb)
26711 <- -gdb-exit
26712 <- ^exit
26713 @end smallexample
26714
26715 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26716 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26717 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26718 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26719 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26720 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26721
26722 @subheading A Bad Command
26723
26724 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26725
26726 @smallexample
26727 -> -rubbish
26728 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26729 <- (gdb)
26730 @end smallexample
26731
26732
26733 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26734 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26735 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26736
26737 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26738 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26739
26740 @subheading Motivation
26741
26742 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26743
26744 @subheading Introduction
26745
26746 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26747
26748 @subheading Commands
26749
26750 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26751
26752 @subsubheading Synopsis
26753
26754 @smallexample
26755 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26756 @end smallexample
26757
26758 @subsubheading Result
26759
26760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26761
26762 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26763
26764 @subsubheading Example
26765
26766 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26767 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26768
26769
26770 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26771 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26772 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26773
26774 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26775 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26776 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26777 breakpoints.
26778
26779 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26780 @findex -break-after
26781
26782 @subsubheading Synopsis
26783
26784 @smallexample
26785 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26786 @end smallexample
26787
26788 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26789 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26790 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26791 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26792
26793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26794
26795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26796
26797 @subsubheading Example
26798
26799 @smallexample
26800 (gdb)
26801 -break-insert main
26802 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26803 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26804 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26805 times="0"@}
26806 (gdb)
26807 -break-after 1 3
26808 ~
26809 ^done
26810 (gdb)
26811 -break-list
26812 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26813 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26814 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26815 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26816 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26817 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26818 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26819 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26820 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26821 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26822 (gdb)
26823 @end smallexample
26824
26825 @ignore
26826 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26827 @findex -break-catch
26828 @end ignore
26829
26830 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26831 @findex -break-commands
26832
26833 @subsubheading Synopsis
26834
26835 @smallexample
26836 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26837 @end smallexample
26838
26839 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26840 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26841 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26842 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26843 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26844 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26845
26846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26847
26848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26849
26850 @subsubheading Example
26851
26852 @smallexample
26853 (gdb)
26854 -break-insert main
26855 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26856 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26857 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26858 times="0"@}
26859 (gdb)
26860 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26861 ^done
26862 (gdb)
26863 @end smallexample
26864
26865 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26866 @findex -break-condition
26867
26868 @subsubheading Synopsis
26869
26870 @smallexample
26871 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26872 @end smallexample
26873
26874 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26875 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26876 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26877 command below).
26878
26879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26880
26881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26882
26883 @subsubheading Example
26884
26885 @smallexample
26886 (gdb)
26887 -break-condition 1 1
26888 ^done
26889 (gdb)
26890 -break-list
26891 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26892 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26893 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26894 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26895 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26896 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26897 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26898 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26899 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26900 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26901 (gdb)
26902 @end smallexample
26903
26904 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26905 @findex -break-delete
26906
26907 @subsubheading Synopsis
26908
26909 @smallexample
26910 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26911 @end smallexample
26912
26913 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26914 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26915
26916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26917
26918 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26919
26920 @subsubheading Example
26921
26922 @smallexample
26923 (gdb)
26924 -break-delete 1
26925 ^done
26926 (gdb)
26927 -break-list
26928 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26929 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26930 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26931 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26932 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26933 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26934 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26935 body=[]@}
26936 (gdb)
26937 @end smallexample
26938
26939 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26940 @findex -break-disable
26941
26942 @subsubheading Synopsis
26943
26944 @smallexample
26945 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26946 @end smallexample
26947
26948 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26949 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26950
26951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26952
26953 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26954
26955 @subsubheading Example
26956
26957 @smallexample
26958 (gdb)
26959 -break-disable 2
26960 ^done
26961 (gdb)
26962 -break-list
26963 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26964 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26965 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26966 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26967 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26968 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26969 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26970 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26971 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26972 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26973 (gdb)
26974 @end smallexample
26975
26976 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26977 @findex -break-enable
26978
26979 @subsubheading Synopsis
26980
26981 @smallexample
26982 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26983 @end smallexample
26984
26985 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26986
26987 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26988
26989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26990
26991 @subsubheading Example
26992
26993 @smallexample
26994 (gdb)
26995 -break-enable 2
26996 ^done
26997 (gdb)
26998 -break-list
26999 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27000 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27001 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27002 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27003 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27004 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27005 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27006 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27007 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27008 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27009 (gdb)
27010 @end smallexample
27011
27012 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27013 @findex -break-info
27014
27015 @subsubheading Synopsis
27016
27017 @smallexample
27018 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27019 @end smallexample
27020
27021 @c REDUNDANT???
27022 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27023
27024 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27025 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27026 table.
27027
27028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27029
27030 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27031
27032 @subsubheading Example
27033 N.A.
27034
27035 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27036 @findex -break-insert
27037 @anchor{-break-insert}
27038
27039 @subsubheading Synopsis
27040
27041 @smallexample
27042 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27043 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27044 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27045 @end smallexample
27046
27047 @noindent
27048 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27049
27050 @table @var
27051 @item linespec location
27052 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27053
27054 @item explicit location
27055 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27056 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27057 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27058
27059 @table @samp
27060 @item --source @var{filename}
27061 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27062 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27063
27064 @item --function @var{function}
27065 The name of a function or method.
27066
27067 @item --label @var{label}
27068 The name of a label.
27069
27070 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27071 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27072 @end table
27073
27074 @item address location
27075 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27076 @end table
27077
27078 @noindent
27079 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27080
27081 @table @samp
27082 @item -t
27083 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27084 @item -h
27085 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27086 @item -f
27087 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27088 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27089 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27090 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27091 cannot be parsed.
27092 @item -d
27093 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27094 @item -a
27095 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27096 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27097 @item -c @var{condition}
27098 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27099 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27100 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27101 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27102 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
27103 @end table
27104
27105 @subsubheading Result
27106
27107 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27108 resulting breakpoint.
27109
27110 Note: this format is open to change.
27111 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27112
27113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27114
27115 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27116 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27117
27118 @subsubheading Example
27119
27120 @smallexample
27121 (gdb)
27122 -break-insert main
27123 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27124 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27125 times="0"@}
27126 (gdb)
27127 -break-insert -t foo
27128 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27129 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27130 times="0"@}
27131 (gdb)
27132 -break-list
27133 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27134 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27135 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27136 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27137 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27138 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27139 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27140 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27141 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27142 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27143 times="0"@},
27144 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27145 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27146 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27147 times="0"@}]@}
27148 (gdb)
27149 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27150 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27151 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27152 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27153 @c times="0"@}
27154 @c (gdb)
27155 @end smallexample
27156
27157 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27158 @findex -dprintf-insert
27159
27160 @subsubheading Synopsis
27161
27162 @smallexample
27163 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27164 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27165 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27166 [ @var{argument} ]
27167 @end smallexample
27168
27169 @noindent
27170 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27171 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27172
27173 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27174
27175 @table @samp
27176 @item -t
27177 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27178 @item -f
27179 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27180 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27181 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27182 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27183 cannot be parsed.
27184 @item -d
27185 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27186 @item -c @var{condition}
27187 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27188 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27189 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27190 to @var{ignore-count}.
27191 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27192 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
27193 @end table
27194
27195 @subsubheading Result
27196
27197 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27198 resulting breakpoint.
27199
27200 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27201
27202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27203
27204 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27205
27206 @subsubheading Example
27207
27208 @smallexample
27209 (gdb)
27210 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27211 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27212 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27213 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27214 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27215 original-location="foo"@}
27216 (gdb)
27217 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27218 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27219 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27220 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27221 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27222 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27223 (gdb)
27224 @end smallexample
27225
27226 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27227 @findex -break-list
27228
27229 @subsubheading Synopsis
27230
27231 @smallexample
27232 -break-list
27233 @end smallexample
27234
27235 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27236
27237 @table @samp
27238 @item Number
27239 number of the breakpoint
27240 @item Type
27241 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27242 @item Disposition
27243 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27244 or @samp{nokeep}
27245 @item Enabled
27246 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27247 @item Address
27248 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27249 @item What
27250 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27251 name, line number
27252 @item Thread-groups
27253 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27254 @item Times
27255 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27256 @end table
27257
27258 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27259 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27260
27261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27262
27263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27264
27265 @subsubheading Example
27266
27267 @smallexample
27268 (gdb)
27269 -break-list
27270 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27271 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27272 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27273 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27274 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27275 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27276 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27277 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27278 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27279 times="0"@},
27280 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27281 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27282 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27283 (gdb)
27284 @end smallexample
27285
27286 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27287
27288 @smallexample
27289 (gdb)
27290 -break-list
27291 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27292 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27293 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27294 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27295 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27296 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27297 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27298 body=[]@}
27299 (gdb)
27300 @end smallexample
27301
27302 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27303 @findex -break-passcount
27304
27305 @subsubheading Synopsis
27306
27307 @smallexample
27308 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27309 @end smallexample
27310
27311 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27312 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27313 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27314 command @samp{passcount}.
27315
27316 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27317 @findex -break-watch
27318
27319 @subsubheading Synopsis
27320
27321 @smallexample
27322 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27323 @end smallexample
27324
27325 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27326 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27327 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27328 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27329 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27330 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27331 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27332 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27333
27334 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27335 breakpoints inserted.
27336
27337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27338
27339 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27340 @samp{rwatch}.
27341
27342 @subsubheading Example
27343
27344 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27345
27346 @smallexample
27347 (gdb)
27348 -break-watch x
27349 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27350 (gdb)
27351 -exec-continue
27352 ^running
27353 (gdb)
27354 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27355 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27356 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27357 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27358 (gdb)
27359 @end smallexample
27360
27361 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27362 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27363 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27364
27365 @smallexample
27366 (gdb)
27367 -break-watch C
27368 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27369 (gdb)
27370 -exec-continue
27371 ^running
27372 (gdb)
27373 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27374 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27375 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27376 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27377 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27378 (gdb)
27379 -exec-continue
27380 ^running
27381 (gdb)
27382 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27383 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27384 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27385 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27386 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27387 (gdb)
27388 @end smallexample
27389
27390 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27391 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27392 deleted.
27393
27394 @smallexample
27395 (gdb)
27396 -break-watch C
27397 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27398 (gdb)
27399 -break-list
27400 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27401 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27402 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27403 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27404 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27405 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27406 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27407 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27408 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27409 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27410 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27411 times="1"@},
27412 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27413 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27414 (gdb)
27415 -exec-continue
27416 ^running
27417 (gdb)
27418 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27419 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27420 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27421 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27422 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27423 (gdb)
27424 -break-list
27425 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27426 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27427 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27428 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27429 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27430 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27431 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27432 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27433 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27434 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27435 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27436 times="1"@},
27437 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27438 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27439 (gdb)
27440 -exec-continue
27441 ^running
27442 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27443 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27444 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27445 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27446 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27447 (gdb)
27448 -break-list
27449 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27450 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27451 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27452 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27453 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27454 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27455 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27456 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27457 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27458 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27459 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27460 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27461 (gdb)
27462 @end smallexample
27463
27464
27465 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27466 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27467 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27468
27469 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27470 catchpoints.
27471
27472 @menu
27473 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27474 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27475 @end menu
27476
27477 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27478 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27479
27480 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27481 @findex -catch-load
27482
27483 @subsubheading Synopsis
27484
27485 @smallexample
27486 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27487 @end smallexample
27488
27489 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27490 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27491 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27492 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27493 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27494
27495
27496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27497
27498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27499
27500 @subsubheading Example
27501
27502 @smallexample
27503 -catch-load -t foo.so
27504 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27505 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27506 (gdb)
27507 @end smallexample
27508
27509
27510 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27511 @findex -catch-unload
27512
27513 @subsubheading Synopsis
27514
27515 @smallexample
27516 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27517 @end smallexample
27518
27519 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27520 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27521 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27522 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27523 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27524
27525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27526
27527 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27528
27529 @subsubheading Example
27530
27531 @smallexample
27532 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27533 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27534 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27535 (gdb)
27536 @end smallexample
27537
27538 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27539 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27540
27541 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27542 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27543
27544 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27545 @findex -catch-assert
27546
27547 @subsubheading Synopsis
27548
27549 @smallexample
27550 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27551 @end smallexample
27552
27553 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27554
27555 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27556
27557 @table @samp
27558 @item -c @var{condition}
27559 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27560 @item -d
27561 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27562 @item -t
27563 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27564 @end table
27565
27566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27567
27568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27569
27570 @subsubheading Example
27571
27572 @smallexample
27573 -catch-assert
27574 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27575 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27576 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27577 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27578 (gdb)
27579 @end smallexample
27580
27581 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27582 @findex -catch-exception
27583
27584 @subsubheading Synopsis
27585
27586 @smallexample
27587 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27588 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27589 @end smallexample
27590
27591 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27592 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27593 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27594 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27595 catchpoints.
27596
27597 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27598
27599 @table @samp
27600 @item -c @var{condition}
27601 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27602 @item -d
27603 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27604 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27605 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27606 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27607 @item -t
27608 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27609 @item -u
27610 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27611 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27612 @end table
27613
27614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27615
27616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27617 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27618
27619 @subsubheading Example
27620
27621 @smallexample
27622 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27623 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27624 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27625 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27626 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27627 (gdb)
27628 @end smallexample
27629
27630 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27631 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27632 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27633
27634 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27635 @findex -exec-arguments
27636
27637
27638 @subsubheading Synopsis
27639
27640 @smallexample
27641 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27642 @end smallexample
27643
27644 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27645 @samp{-exec-run}.
27646
27647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27648
27649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27650
27651 @subsubheading Example
27652
27653 @smallexample
27654 (gdb)
27655 -exec-arguments -v word
27656 ^done
27657 (gdb)
27658 @end smallexample
27659
27660
27661 @ignore
27662 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27663 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27664
27665 @subsubheading Synopsis
27666
27667 @smallexample
27668 -exec-show-arguments
27669 @end smallexample
27670
27671 Print the arguments of the program.
27672
27673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27674
27675 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27676
27677 @subsubheading Example
27678 N.A.
27679 @end ignore
27680
27681
27682 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27683 @findex -environment-cd
27684
27685 @subsubheading Synopsis
27686
27687 @smallexample
27688 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27689 @end smallexample
27690
27691 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27692
27693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27694
27695 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27696
27697 @subsubheading Example
27698
27699 @smallexample
27700 (gdb)
27701 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27702 ^done
27703 (gdb)
27704 @end smallexample
27705
27706
27707 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27708 @findex -environment-directory
27709
27710 @subsubheading Synopsis
27711
27712 @smallexample
27713 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27714 @end smallexample
27715
27716 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27717 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27718 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27719 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27720 occurs as normal.
27721 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27722 multiple directories in a single command
27723 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27724 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27725 If blanks are needed as
27726 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27727 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27728 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27729 character must not be used
27730 in any directory name.
27731 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27732
27733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27734
27735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27736
27737 @subsubheading Example
27738
27739 @smallexample
27740 (gdb)
27741 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27742 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27743 (gdb)
27744 -environment-directory ""
27745 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27746 (gdb)
27747 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27748 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27749 (gdb)
27750 -environment-directory -r
27751 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27752 (gdb)
27753 @end smallexample
27754
27755
27756 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27757 @findex -environment-path
27758
27759 @subsubheading Synopsis
27760
27761 @smallexample
27762 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27763 @end smallexample
27764
27765 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27766 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27767 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27768 supplied in addition to the
27769 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27770 occurs as normal.
27771 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27772 multiple directories in a single command
27773 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27774 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27775 If blanks are needed as
27776 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27777 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27778 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27779 character must not be used
27780 in any directory name.
27781 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27782
27783
27784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27785
27786 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27787
27788 @subsubheading Example
27789
27790 @smallexample
27791 (gdb)
27792 -environment-path
27793 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27794 (gdb)
27795 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27796 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27797 (gdb)
27798 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27799 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27800 (gdb)
27801 @end smallexample
27802
27803
27804 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27805 @findex -environment-pwd
27806
27807 @subsubheading Synopsis
27808
27809 @smallexample
27810 -environment-pwd
27811 @end smallexample
27812
27813 Show the current working directory.
27814
27815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27816
27817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27818
27819 @subsubheading Example
27820
27821 @smallexample
27822 (gdb)
27823 -environment-pwd
27824 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27825 (gdb)
27826 @end smallexample
27827
27828 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27829 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27830 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27831
27832
27833 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27834 @findex -thread-info
27835
27836 @subsubheading Synopsis
27837
27838 @smallexample
27839 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27840 @end smallexample
27841
27842 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27843 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27844 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27845 also reports the current thread.
27846
27847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27848
27849 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27850 about all threads.
27851
27852 @subsubheading Result
27853
27854 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27855 defined for a given thread:
27856
27857 @table @samp
27858 @item current
27859 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27860
27861 @item id
27862 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27863
27864 @item target-id
27865 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27866
27867 @item details
27868 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27869 field is optional.
27870
27871 @item name
27872 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27873 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27874 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27875 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27876 field is omitted.
27877
27878 @item frame
27879 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27880
27881 @item state
27882 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27883 values:
27884
27885 @table @code
27886 @item stopped
27887 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27888 threads.
27889
27890 @item running
27891 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27892 threads.
27893
27894 @end table
27895
27896 @item core
27897 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27898 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27899
27900 @end table
27901
27902 @subsubheading Example
27903
27904 @smallexample
27905 -thread-info
27906 ^done,threads=[
27907 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27908 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27909 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27910 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27911 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27912 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27913 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27914 state="running"@}],
27915 current-thread-id="1"
27916 (gdb)
27917 @end smallexample
27918
27919 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27920 @findex -thread-list-ids
27921
27922 @subsubheading Synopsis
27923
27924 @smallexample
27925 -thread-list-ids
27926 @end smallexample
27927
27928 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27929 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27930
27931 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27932 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27933
27934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27935
27936 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27937
27938 @subsubheading Example
27939
27940 @smallexample
27941 (gdb)
27942 -thread-list-ids
27943 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27944 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27945 (gdb)
27946 @end smallexample
27947
27948
27949 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27950 @findex -thread-select
27951
27952 @subsubheading Synopsis
27953
27954 @smallexample
27955 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27956 @end smallexample
27957
27958 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27959 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27960
27961 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27962 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27963
27964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27965
27966 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27967
27968 @subsubheading Example
27969
27970 @smallexample
27971 (gdb)
27972 -exec-next
27973 ^running
27974 (gdb)
27975 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27976 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27977 (gdb)
27978 -thread-list-ids
27979 ^done,
27980 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27981 number-of-threads="3"
27982 (gdb)
27983 -thread-select 3
27984 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27985 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27986 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27987 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27988 (gdb)
27989 @end smallexample
27990
27991 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27992 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27993 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27994
27995 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27996 @findex -ada-task-info
27997
27998 @subsubheading Synopsis
27999
28000 @smallexample
28001 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28002 @end smallexample
28003
28004 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28005 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28006
28007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28008
28009 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28010 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28011
28012 @subsubheading Result
28013
28014 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28015 defined for each Ada task:
28016
28017 @table @samp
28018 @item current
28019 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28020
28021 @item id
28022 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28023
28024 @item task-id
28025 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28026
28027 @item thread-id
28028 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
28029
28030 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28031 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28032 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28033
28034 @item parent-id
28035 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28036 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28037
28038 @item priority
28039 The base priority of the task.
28040
28041 @item state
28042 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28043 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28044
28045 @item name
28046 The name of the task.
28047
28048 @end table
28049
28050 @subsubheading Example
28051
28052 @smallexample
28053 -ada-task-info
28054 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28055 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28056 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28057 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28058 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28059 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28060 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28061 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28062 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28063 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28064 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28065 (gdb)
28066 @end smallexample
28067
28068 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28069 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28070 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28071
28072 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28073 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28074 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28075 other cases.
28076
28077 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28078 @findex -exec-continue
28079
28080 @subsubheading Synopsis
28081
28082 @smallexample
28083 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28084 @end smallexample
28085
28086 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28087 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28088 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28089 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28090 @itemize @bullet
28091 @item
28092 breakpoints or watchpoints
28093 @item
28094 signals or exceptions
28095 @item
28096 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28097 @item
28098 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28099 @end itemize
28100 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28101 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28102 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28103 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28104 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28105 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28106
28107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28108
28109 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28110
28111 @subsubheading Example
28112
28113 @smallexample
28114 -exec-continue
28115 ^running
28116 (gdb)
28117 @@Hello world
28118 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28119 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28120 line="13"@}
28121 (gdb)
28122 @end smallexample
28123
28124
28125 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28126 @findex -exec-finish
28127
28128 @subsubheading Synopsis
28129
28130 @smallexample
28131 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28132 @end smallexample
28133
28134 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28135 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28136 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28137 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28138 function was called.
28139
28140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28141
28142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28143
28144 @subsubheading Example
28145
28146 Function returning @code{void}.
28147
28148 @smallexample
28149 -exec-finish
28150 ^running
28151 (gdb)
28152 @@hello from foo
28153 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28154 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28155 (gdb)
28156 @end smallexample
28157
28158 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28159 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28160 value itself.
28161
28162 @smallexample
28163 -exec-finish
28164 ^running
28165 (gdb)
28166 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28167 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28168 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28169 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28170 (gdb)
28171 @end smallexample
28172
28173
28174 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28175 @findex -exec-interrupt
28176
28177 @subsubheading Synopsis
28178
28179 @smallexample
28180 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28181 @end smallexample
28182
28183 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28184 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28185 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28186 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28187 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28188
28189 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28190 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28191 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28192 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28193
28194 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28195 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28196 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28197 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28198
28199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28200
28201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28202
28203 @subsubheading Example
28204
28205 @smallexample
28206 (gdb)
28207 111-exec-continue
28208 111^running
28209
28210 (gdb)
28211 222-exec-interrupt
28212 222^done
28213 (gdb)
28214 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28215 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28216 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28217 (gdb)
28218
28219 (gdb)
28220 -exec-interrupt
28221 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28222 (gdb)
28223 @end smallexample
28224
28225 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28226 @findex -exec-jump
28227
28228 @subsubheading Synopsis
28229
28230 @smallexample
28231 -exec-jump @var{location}
28232 @end smallexample
28233
28234 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28235 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28236 different forms of @var{location}.
28237
28238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28239
28240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28241
28242 @subsubheading Example
28243
28244 @smallexample
28245 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28246 *running,thread-id="all"
28247 ^running
28248 @end smallexample
28249
28250
28251 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28252 @findex -exec-next
28253
28254 @subsubheading Synopsis
28255
28256 @smallexample
28257 -exec-next [--reverse]
28258 @end smallexample
28259
28260 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28261 of the next source line is reached.
28262
28263 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28264 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28265 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28266 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28267 source line where the function was called.
28268
28269
28270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28271
28272 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28273
28274 @subsubheading Example
28275
28276 @smallexample
28277 -exec-next
28278 ^running
28279 (gdb)
28280 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28281 (gdb)
28282 @end smallexample
28283
28284
28285 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28286 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28287
28288 @subsubheading Synopsis
28289
28290 @smallexample
28291 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28292 @end smallexample
28293
28294 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28295 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28296 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28297 printed as well.
28298
28299 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28300 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28301 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28302 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28303 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28304
28305 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28306
28307 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28308
28309 @subsubheading Example
28310
28311 @smallexample
28312 (gdb)
28313 -exec-next-instruction
28314 ^running
28315
28316 (gdb)
28317 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28318 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28319 (gdb)
28320 @end smallexample
28321
28322
28323 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28324 @findex -exec-return
28325
28326 @subsubheading Synopsis
28327
28328 @smallexample
28329 -exec-return
28330 @end smallexample
28331
28332 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28333 Displays the new current frame.
28334
28335 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28336
28337 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28338
28339 @subsubheading Example
28340
28341 @smallexample
28342 (gdb)
28343 200-break-insert callee4
28344 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28345 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28346 (gdb)
28347 000-exec-run
28348 000^running
28349 (gdb)
28350 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28351 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28352 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28353 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28354 (gdb)
28355 205-break-delete
28356 205^done
28357 (gdb)
28358 111-exec-return
28359 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28360 args=[@{name="strarg",
28361 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28362 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28363 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28364 (gdb)
28365 @end smallexample
28366
28367
28368 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28369 @findex -exec-run
28370
28371 @subsubheading Synopsis
28372
28373 @smallexample
28374 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28375 @end smallexample
28376
28377 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28378 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28379 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28380 the program has exited exceptionally.
28381
28382 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28383 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28384 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28385 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28386 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28387
28388 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28389 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28390 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28391 (@pxref{Starting}).
28392
28393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28394
28395 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28396
28397 @subsubheading Examples
28398
28399 @smallexample
28400 (gdb)
28401 -break-insert main
28402 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28403 (gdb)
28404 -exec-run
28405 ^running
28406 (gdb)
28407 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28408 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28409 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28410 (gdb)
28411 @end smallexample
28412
28413 @noindent
28414 Program exited normally:
28415
28416 @smallexample
28417 (gdb)
28418 -exec-run
28419 ^running
28420 (gdb)
28421 x = 55
28422 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28423 (gdb)
28424 @end smallexample
28425
28426 @noindent
28427 Program exited exceptionally:
28428
28429 @smallexample
28430 (gdb)
28431 -exec-run
28432 ^running
28433 (gdb)
28434 x = 55
28435 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28436 (gdb)
28437 @end smallexample
28438
28439 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28440 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28441
28442 @smallexample
28443 (gdb)
28444 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28445 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28446 @end smallexample
28447
28448
28449 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28450
28451
28452 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28453 @findex -exec-step
28454
28455 @subsubheading Synopsis
28456
28457 @smallexample
28458 -exec-step [--reverse]
28459 @end smallexample
28460
28461 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28462 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28463 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28464 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28465 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28466 previously executed source line.
28467
28468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28469
28470 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28471
28472 @subsubheading Example
28473
28474 Stepping into a function:
28475
28476 @smallexample
28477 -exec-step
28478 ^running
28479 (gdb)
28480 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28481 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28482 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28483 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28484 (gdb)
28485 @end smallexample
28486
28487 Regular stepping:
28488
28489 @smallexample
28490 -exec-step
28491 ^running
28492 (gdb)
28493 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28494 (gdb)
28495 @end smallexample
28496
28497
28498 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28499 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28500
28501 @subsubheading Synopsis
28502
28503 @smallexample
28504 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28505 @end smallexample
28506
28507 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28508 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28509 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28510 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28511 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28512 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28513 as well.
28514
28515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28516
28517 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28518
28519 @subsubheading Example
28520
28521 @smallexample
28522 (gdb)
28523 -exec-step-instruction
28524 ^running
28525
28526 (gdb)
28527 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28528 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28529 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28530 (gdb)
28531 -exec-step-instruction
28532 ^running
28533
28534 (gdb)
28535 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28536 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28537 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28538 (gdb)
28539 @end smallexample
28540
28541
28542 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28543 @findex -exec-until
28544
28545 @subsubheading Synopsis
28546
28547 @smallexample
28548 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28549 @end smallexample
28550
28551 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28552 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28553 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28554 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28555
28556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28557
28558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28559
28560 @subsubheading Example
28561
28562 @smallexample
28563 (gdb)
28564 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28565 ^running
28566 (gdb)
28567 x = 55
28568 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28569 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28570 (gdb)
28571 @end smallexample
28572
28573 @ignore
28574 @subheading -file-clear
28575 Is this going away????
28576 @end ignore
28577
28578 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28579 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28580 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28581
28582 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28583 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28584
28585 @smallexample
28586 -enable-frame-filters
28587 @end smallexample
28588
28589 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28590 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28591 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28592 request that this functionality be enabled.
28593
28594 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28595
28596 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28597 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28598
28599 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28600 @findex -stack-info-frame
28601
28602 @subsubheading Synopsis
28603
28604 @smallexample
28605 -stack-info-frame
28606 @end smallexample
28607
28608 Get info on the selected frame.
28609
28610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28611
28612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28613 (without arguments).
28614
28615 @subsubheading Example
28616
28617 @smallexample
28618 (gdb)
28619 -stack-info-frame
28620 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28621 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28622 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28623 (gdb)
28624 @end smallexample
28625
28626 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28627 @findex -stack-info-depth
28628
28629 @subsubheading Synopsis
28630
28631 @smallexample
28632 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28633 @end smallexample
28634
28635 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28636 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28637
28638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28639
28640 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28641
28642 @subsubheading Example
28643
28644 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28645
28646 @smallexample
28647 (gdb)
28648 -stack-info-depth
28649 ^done,depth="12"
28650 (gdb)
28651 -stack-info-depth 4
28652 ^done,depth="4"
28653 (gdb)
28654 -stack-info-depth 12
28655 ^done,depth="12"
28656 (gdb)
28657 -stack-info-depth 11
28658 ^done,depth="11"
28659 (gdb)
28660 -stack-info-depth 13
28661 ^done,depth="12"
28662 (gdb)
28663 @end smallexample
28664
28665 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28666 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28667 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28668
28669 @subsubheading Synopsis
28670
28671 @smallexample
28672 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28673 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28674 @end smallexample
28675
28676 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28677 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28678 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28679 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28680 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28681 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28682 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28683 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28684
28685 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28686 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28687 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28688 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28689 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28690 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28691
28692 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28693 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28694 are still displayed, however.
28695
28696 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28697 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28698
28699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28700
28701 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28702 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28703 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28704
28705 @subsubheading Example
28706
28707 @smallexample
28708 (gdb)
28709 -stack-list-frames
28710 ^done,
28711 stack=[
28712 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28713 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28714 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28715 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28716 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28717 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28718 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28719 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28720 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28721 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28722 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28723 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28724 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28725 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28726 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28727 (gdb)
28728 -stack-list-arguments 0
28729 ^done,
28730 stack-args=[
28731 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28732 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28733 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28734 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28735 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28736 (gdb)
28737 -stack-list-arguments 1
28738 ^done,
28739 stack-args=[
28740 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28741 frame=@{level="1",
28742 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28743 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28744 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28745 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28746 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28747 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28748 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28749 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28750 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28751 (gdb)
28752 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28753 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28754 (gdb)
28755 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28756 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28757 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28758 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28759 (gdb)
28760 @end smallexample
28761
28762 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28763
28764
28765 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28766 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28767 @findex -stack-list-frames
28768
28769 @subsubheading Synopsis
28770
28771 @smallexample
28772 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28773 @end smallexample
28774
28775 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28776 following info:
28777
28778 @table @samp
28779 @item @var{level}
28780 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28781 @item @var{addr}
28782 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28783 @item @var{func}
28784 Function name.
28785 @item @var{file}
28786 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28787 @item @var{fullname}
28788 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28789 @item @var{line}
28790 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28791 @item @var{from}
28792 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28793 if the frame's function is not known.
28794 @end table
28795
28796 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28797 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28798 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28799 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28800 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28801 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28802 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28803 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28804 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28805
28806 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28807
28808 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28809
28810 @subsubheading Example
28811
28812 Full stack backtrace:
28813
28814 @smallexample
28815 (gdb)
28816 -stack-list-frames
28817 ^done,stack=
28818 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28819 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28820 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28821 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28822 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28823 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28824 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28825 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28826 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28827 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28828 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28829 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28830 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28831 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28832 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28833 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28834 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28835 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28836 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28837 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28838 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28839 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28840 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28841 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28842 (gdb)
28843 @end smallexample
28844
28845 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28846
28847 @smallexample
28848 (gdb)
28849 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28850 ^done,stack=
28851 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28852 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28853 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28854 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28855 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28856 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28857 (gdb)
28858 @end smallexample
28859
28860 Show a single frame:
28861
28862 @smallexample
28863 (gdb)
28864 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28865 ^done,stack=
28866 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28867 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28868 (gdb)
28869 @end smallexample
28870
28871
28872 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28873 @findex -stack-list-locals
28874 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28875
28876 @subsubheading Synopsis
28877
28878 @smallexample
28879 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28880 @end smallexample
28881
28882 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28883 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28884 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28885 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28886 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28887 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28888 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28889 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28890 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28891 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28892
28893 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28894 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28895 variables are still displayed, however.
28896
28897 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28898 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28899
28900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28901
28902 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28903
28904 @subsubheading Example
28905
28906 @smallexample
28907 (gdb)
28908 -stack-list-locals 0
28909 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28910 (gdb)
28911 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28912 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28913 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28914 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28915 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28916 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28917 (gdb)
28918 @end smallexample
28919
28920 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28921 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28922 @findex -stack-list-variables
28923
28924 @subsubheading Synopsis
28925
28926 @smallexample
28927 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28928 @end smallexample
28929
28930 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28931 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28932 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28933 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28934 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28935 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28936 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28937
28938 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28939 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28940 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28941
28942 @subsubheading Example
28943
28944 @smallexample
28945 (gdb)
28946 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28947 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28948 (gdb)
28949 @end smallexample
28950
28951
28952 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28953 @findex -stack-select-frame
28954
28955 @subsubheading Synopsis
28956
28957 @smallexample
28958 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28959 @end smallexample
28960
28961 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28962 the stack.
28963
28964 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28965 option to every command.
28966
28967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28968
28969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28970 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28971
28972 @subsubheading Example
28973
28974 @smallexample
28975 (gdb)
28976 -stack-select-frame 2
28977 ^done
28978 (gdb)
28979 @end smallexample
28980
28981 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28982 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28983 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28984
28985 @ignore
28986
28987 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28988
28989 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28990 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28991 used by @code{Insight}.
28992
28993 The two main reasons for that are:
28994
28995 @enumerate 1
28996 @item
28997 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28998
28999 @item
29000 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29001 now).
29002 @end enumerate
29003
29004 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29005 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29006 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29007 hints about their use.
29008
29009 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29010 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29011 least, the following operations:
29012
29013 @itemize @bullet
29014 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29015 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29016 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29017 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29018 @end itemize
29019
29020 @end ignore
29021
29022 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29023
29024 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29025
29026 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29027 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29028 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29029 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29030 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29031 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29032 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29033 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29034 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29035 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29036 object, or to change display format.
29037
29038 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29039 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29040 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29041 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29042 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29043 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29044 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29045 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29046 child will be created.
29047
29048 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29049 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29050 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29051 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29052 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29053
29054 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29055 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29056 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29057 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29058 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29059 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29060 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29061 variables that frontend has created.
29062
29063 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29064 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29065 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29066 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29067 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29068 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29069 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29070 implicitly updated.
29071
29072 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29073 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29074 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29075 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29076 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29077 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29078 frame. Consider this example:
29079
29080 @smallexample
29081 void do_work(...)
29082 @{
29083 struct work_state state;
29084
29085 if (...)
29086 do_work(...);
29087 @}
29088 @end smallexample
29089
29090 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29091 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29092 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29093 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29094 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29095
29096 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29097 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29098 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29099 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29100 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29101 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29102
29103 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29104 access this functionality:
29105
29106 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29107 @item @strong{Operation}
29108 @tab @strong{Description}
29109
29110 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29111 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29112 @item @code{-var-create}
29113 @tab create a variable object
29114 @item @code{-var-delete}
29115 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29116 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29117 @tab set the display format of this variable
29118 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29119 @tab show the display format of this variable
29120 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29121 @tab tells how many children this object has
29122 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29123 @tab return a list of the object's children
29124 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29125 @tab show the type of this variable object
29126 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29127 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29128 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29129 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29130 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29131 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29132 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29133 @tab get the value of this variable
29134 @item @code{-var-assign}
29135 @tab set the value of this variable
29136 @item @code{-var-update}
29137 @tab update the variable and its children
29138 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29139 @tab set frozeness attribute
29140 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29141 @tab set range of children to display on update
29142 @end multitable
29143
29144 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29145 how it can be used.
29146
29147 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29148
29149 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29150 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29151
29152 @smallexample
29153 -enable-pretty-printing
29154 @end smallexample
29155
29156 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29157 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29158 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29159 request that this functionality be enabled.
29160
29161 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29162
29163 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29164 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29165
29166 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29167 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29168
29169 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29170 @findex -var-create
29171
29172 @subsubheading Synopsis
29173
29174 @smallexample
29175 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29176 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29177 @end smallexample
29178
29179 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29180 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29181 register.
29182
29183 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29184 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29185 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29186 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29187 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29188
29189 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29190 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29191 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29192 object must be created.
29193
29194 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29195 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29196
29197 @itemize @bullet
29198 @item
29199 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29200
29201 @item
29202 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29203
29204 @item
29205 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29206 @end itemize
29207
29208 @cindex dynamic varobj
29209 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29210 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29211 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29212 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29213 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29214 compatibility for existing clients.
29215
29216 @subsubheading Result
29217
29218 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29219 are:
29220
29221 @table @samp
29222 @item name
29223 The name of the varobj.
29224
29225 @item numchild
29226 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29227 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29228 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29229
29230 @item value
29231 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29232 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29233 will not be interesting.
29234
29235 @item type
29236 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29237 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29238 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29239 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29240 @emph{declared} one.
29241
29242 @item thread-id
29243 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29244 thread's identifier.
29245
29246 @item has_more
29247 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29248 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29249
29250 @item dynamic
29251 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29252 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29253 then this attribute will not be present.
29254
29255 @item displayhint
29256 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29257 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29258 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29259 @end table
29260
29261 Typical output will look like this:
29262
29263 @smallexample
29264 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29265 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29266 @end smallexample
29267
29268
29269 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29270 @findex -var-delete
29271
29272 @subsubheading Synopsis
29273
29274 @smallexample
29275 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29276 @end smallexample
29277
29278 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29279 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29280
29281 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29282
29283
29284 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29285 @findex -var-set-format
29286
29287 @subsubheading Synopsis
29288
29289 @smallexample
29290 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29291 @end smallexample
29292
29293 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29294 @var{format-spec}.
29295
29296 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29297 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29298
29299 @smallexample
29300 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29301 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
29302 @end smallexample
29303
29304 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29305 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29306 for pointers, etc.).
29307
29308 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29309 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29310
29311 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29312 @findex -var-show-format
29313
29314 @subsubheading Synopsis
29315
29316 @smallexample
29317 -var-show-format @var{name}
29318 @end smallexample
29319
29320 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29321
29322 @smallexample
29323 @var{format} @expansion{}
29324 @var{format-spec}
29325 @end smallexample
29326
29327
29328 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29329 @findex -var-info-num-children
29330
29331 @subsubheading Synopsis
29332
29333 @smallexample
29334 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29335 @end smallexample
29336
29337 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29338
29339 @smallexample
29340 numchild=@var{n}
29341 @end smallexample
29342
29343 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29344 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29345 be available.
29346
29347
29348 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29349 @findex -var-list-children
29350
29351 @subsubheading Synopsis
29352
29353 @smallexample
29354 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29355 @end smallexample
29356 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29357
29358 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29359 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29360 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29361 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29362 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29363 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29364 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29365 and unions.
29366
29367 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29368 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29369 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29370 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29371 reported.
29372
29373 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29374 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29375 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29376 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29377 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29378 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29379 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29380 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29381 the visible items.
29382
29383 For each child the following results are returned:
29384
29385 @table @var
29386
29387 @item name
29388 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29389
29390 @item exp
29391 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29392 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29393
29394 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29395 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29396
29397 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29398 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29399 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29400 type and value are not present.
29401
29402 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29403 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29404 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29405
29406 @item numchild
29407 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29408 0.
29409
29410 @item type
29411 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29412 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29413 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29414 @emph{declared} one.
29415
29416 @item value
29417 If values were requested, this is the value.
29418
29419 @item thread-id
29420 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29421 Otherwise this result is not present.
29422
29423 @item frozen
29424 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29425
29426 @item displayhint
29427 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29428 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29429 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29430
29431 @item dynamic
29432 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29433 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29434 then this attribute will not be present.
29435
29436 @end table
29437
29438 The result may have its own attributes:
29439
29440 @table @samp
29441 @item displayhint
29442 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29443 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29444 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29445
29446 @item has_more
29447 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29448 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29449 @end table
29450
29451 @subsubheading Example
29452
29453 @smallexample
29454 (gdb)
29455 -var-list-children n
29456 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29457 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29458 (gdb)
29459 -var-list-children --all-values n
29460 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29461 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29462 @end smallexample
29463
29464
29465 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29466 @findex -var-info-type
29467
29468 @subsubheading Synopsis
29469
29470 @smallexample
29471 -var-info-type @var{name}
29472 @end smallexample
29473
29474 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29475 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29476 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29477
29478 @smallexample
29479 type=@var{typename}
29480 @end smallexample
29481
29482
29483 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29484 @findex -var-info-expression
29485
29486 @subsubheading Synopsis
29487
29488 @smallexample
29489 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29490 @end smallexample
29491
29492 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29493 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29494 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29495
29496 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29497 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29498
29499 @smallexample
29500 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29501 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29502 @end smallexample
29503
29504 @noindent
29505 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29506 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29507
29508 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29509 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29510 is of limited use.
29511
29512 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29513 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29514
29515 @subsubheading Synopsis
29516
29517 @smallexample
29518 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29519 @end smallexample
29520
29521 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29522 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29523 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29524 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29525 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29526 watchpoint from a variable object.
29527
29528 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29529 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29530
29531 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29532 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29533 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29534 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29535 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29536 @smallexample
29537 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29538 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29539 @end smallexample
29540
29541 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29542 @findex -var-show-attributes
29543
29544 @subsubheading Synopsis
29545
29546 @smallexample
29547 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29548 @end smallexample
29549
29550 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29551
29552 @smallexample
29553 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29554 @end smallexample
29555
29556 @noindent
29557 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29558
29559 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29560 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29561
29562 @subsubheading Synopsis
29563
29564 @smallexample
29565 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29566 @end smallexample
29567
29568 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29569 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29570 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29571 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29572 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29573 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29574 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29575
29576 @smallexample
29577 value=@var{value}
29578 @end smallexample
29579
29580 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29581 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29582
29583 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29584 @findex -var-assign
29585
29586 @subsubheading Synopsis
29587
29588 @smallexample
29589 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29590 @end smallexample
29591
29592 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29593 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29594 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29595 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29596
29597 @subsubheading Example
29598
29599 @smallexample
29600 (gdb)
29601 -var-assign var1 3
29602 ^done,value="3"
29603 (gdb)
29604 -var-update *
29605 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29606 (gdb)
29607 @end smallexample
29608
29609 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29610 @findex -var-update
29611
29612 @subsubheading Synopsis
29613
29614 @smallexample
29615 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29616 @end smallexample
29617
29618 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29619 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29620 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29621 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29622 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29623 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29624 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29625 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29626 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29627 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29628 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29629 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29630 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29631
29632 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29633 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29634 diagnostic.
29635
29636 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29637 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29638
29639 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29640 @samp{changelist}.
29641
29642 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29643
29644 @table @samp
29645 @item name
29646 The name of the varobj.
29647
29648 @item value
29649 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29650 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29651
29652 @item in_scope
29653 @anchor{-var-update}
29654 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29655
29656 @table @code
29657 @item "true"
29658 The variable object's current value is valid.
29659
29660 @item "false"
29661 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29662 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29663 scope.
29664
29665 @item "invalid"
29666 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29667 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29668 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29669 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29670 objects.
29671 @end table
29672
29673 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29674 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29675
29676 @item type_changed
29677 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29678 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29679 be @samp{false}.
29680
29681 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29682 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29683 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29684 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29685 unset.
29686
29687 @item new_type
29688 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29689 hold the new type.
29690
29691 @item new_num_children
29692 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29693 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29694
29695 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29696 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29697 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29698 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29699 children which may be available.
29700
29701 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29702 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29703 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29704 only happen at the end of the update range).
29705
29706 @item displayhint
29707 The display hint, if any.
29708
29709 @item has_more
29710 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29711 available outside the varobj's update range.
29712
29713 @item dynamic
29714 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29715 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29716 then this attribute will not be present.
29717
29718 @item new_children
29719 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29720 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29721 be listed in this attribute.
29722 @end table
29723
29724 @subsubheading Example
29725
29726 @smallexample
29727 (gdb)
29728 -var-assign var1 3
29729 ^done,value="3"
29730 (gdb)
29731 -var-update --all-values var1
29732 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29733 type_changed="false"@}]
29734 (gdb)
29735 @end smallexample
29736
29737 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29738 @findex -var-set-frozen
29739 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29740
29741 @subsubheading Synopsis
29742
29743 @smallexample
29744 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29745 @end smallexample
29746
29747 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29748 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29749 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29750 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29751 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29752 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29753 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29754 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29755 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29756 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29757 @code{-var-update} does.
29758
29759 @subsubheading Example
29760
29761 @smallexample
29762 (gdb)
29763 -var-set-frozen V 1
29764 ^done
29765 (gdb)
29766 @end smallexample
29767
29768 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29769 @findex -var-set-update-range
29770 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29771
29772 @subsubheading Synopsis
29773
29774 @smallexample
29775 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29776 @end smallexample
29777
29778 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29779 @code{-var-update}.
29780
29781 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29782 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29783 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29784 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29785
29786 @subsubheading Example
29787
29788 @smallexample
29789 (gdb)
29790 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29791 ^done
29792 @end smallexample
29793
29794 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29795 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29796 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29797
29798 @subsubheading Synopsis
29799
29800 @smallexample
29801 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29802 @end smallexample
29803
29804 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29805
29806 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29807 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29808
29809 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29810 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29811 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29812 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29813 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29814 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29815 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29816
29817 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29818 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29819 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29820 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29821
29822 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29823 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29824 can be used to check this.
29825
29826 @subsubheading Example
29827
29828 Resetting the visualizer:
29829
29830 @smallexample
29831 (gdb)
29832 -var-set-visualizer V None
29833 ^done
29834 @end smallexample
29835
29836 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29837
29838 @smallexample
29839 (gdb)
29840 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29841 ^done
29842 @end smallexample
29843
29844 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29845 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29846
29847 @smallexample
29848 (gdb)
29849 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29850 ^done
29851 @end smallexample
29852
29853 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29854 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29855 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29856
29857 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29858 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29859 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29860 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29861
29862 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29863 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29864
29865 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29866 @c @subheading -data-assign
29867 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29868 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29869 @c set variable
29870 @c @subsubheading Example
29871 @c N.A.
29872
29873 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29874 @findex -data-disassemble
29875
29876 @subsubheading Synopsis
29877
29878 @smallexample
29879 -data-disassemble
29880 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29881 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29882 -- @var{mode}
29883 @end smallexample
29884
29885 @noindent
29886 Where:
29887
29888 @table @samp
29889 @item @var{start-addr}
29890 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29891 @item @var{end-addr}
29892 is the end address
29893 @item @var{filename}
29894 is the name of the file to disassemble
29895 @item @var{linenum}
29896 is the line number to disassemble around
29897 @item @var{lines}
29898 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29899 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29900 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29901 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29902 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29903 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29904 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29905 are displayed.
29906 @item @var{mode}
29907 is one of:
29908 @itemize @bullet
29909 @item 0 disassembly only
29910 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29911 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29912 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29913 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29914 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29915 @end itemize
29916
29917 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29918 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29919 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29920 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29921 @end table
29922
29923 @subsubheading Result
29924
29925 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29926 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29927 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29928
29929 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29930 following fields:
29931
29932 @table @code
29933 @item address
29934 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29935
29936 @item func-name
29937 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29938
29939 @item offset
29940 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29941
29942 @item inst
29943 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29944
29945 @item opcodes
29946 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
29947 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29948
29949 @end table
29950
29951 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29952 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29953
29954 @table @code
29955 @item line
29956 The line number within @samp{file}.
29957
29958 @item file
29959 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29960 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29961 used.
29962
29963 @item fullname
29964 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29965 using the source file search path
29966 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29967 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29968
29969 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29970 present in the debug information.
29971
29972 @item line_asm_insn
29973 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29974 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29975 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29976 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29977 @samp{opcodes}.
29978
29979 @end table
29980
29981 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29982 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29983 adjust its format.
29984
29985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29986
29987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29988
29989 @subsubheading Example
29990
29991 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29992
29993 @smallexample
29994 (gdb)
29995 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29996 ^done,
29997 asm_insns=[
29998 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29999 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30000 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30001 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30002 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30003 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30004 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30005 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30006 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30007 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30008 (gdb)
30009 @end smallexample
30010
30011 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30012 @code{main}.
30013
30014 @smallexample
30015 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30016 ^done,asm_insns=[
30017 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30018 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30019 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30020 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30021 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30022 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30023 [@dots{}]
30024 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30025 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30026 (gdb)
30027 @end smallexample
30028
30029 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30030
30031 @smallexample
30032 (gdb)
30033 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30034 ^done,asm_insns=[
30035 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30036 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30037 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30038 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30039 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30040 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30041 (gdb)
30042 @end smallexample
30043
30044 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30045
30046 @smallexample
30047 (gdb)
30048 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30049 ^done,asm_insns=[
30050 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30051 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30052 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30053 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30054 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30055 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30056 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30057 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30058 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30059 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30060 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30061 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30062 (gdb)
30063 @end smallexample
30064
30065
30066 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30067 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30068
30069 @subsubheading Synopsis
30070
30071 @smallexample
30072 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30073 @end smallexample
30074
30075 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30076 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30077 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30078
30079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30080
30081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30082 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30083 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30084
30085 @subsubheading Example
30086
30087 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30088 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30089 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30090 output.
30091
30092 @smallexample
30093 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30094 211^done,value="1"
30095 (gdb)
30096 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30097 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30098 (gdb)
30099 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30100 411^done,value="4"
30101 (gdb)
30102 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30103 511^done,value="4"
30104 (gdb)
30105 @end smallexample
30106
30107
30108 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30109 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30110
30111 @subsubheading Synopsis
30112
30113 @smallexample
30114 -data-list-changed-registers
30115 @end smallexample
30116
30117 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30118
30119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30120
30121 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30122 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30123
30124 @subsubheading Example
30125
30126 On a PPC MBX board:
30127
30128 @smallexample
30129 (gdb)
30130 -exec-continue
30131 ^running
30132
30133 (gdb)
30134 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30135 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30136 line="5"@}
30137 (gdb)
30138 -data-list-changed-registers
30139 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30140 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30141 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30142 (gdb)
30143 @end smallexample
30144
30145
30146 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30147 @findex -data-list-register-names
30148
30149 @subsubheading Synopsis
30150
30151 @smallexample
30152 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30153 @end smallexample
30154
30155 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30156 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30157 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30158 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30159 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30160 include empty register names.
30161
30162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30163
30164 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30165 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30166 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30167
30168 @subsubheading Example
30169
30170 For the PPC MBX board:
30171 @smallexample
30172 (gdb)
30173 -data-list-register-names
30174 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30175 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30176 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30177 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30178 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30179 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30180 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30181 (gdb)
30182 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30183 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30184 (gdb)
30185 @end smallexample
30186
30187 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30188 @findex -data-list-register-values
30189
30190 @subsubheading Synopsis
30191
30192 @smallexample
30193 -data-list-register-values
30194 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30195 @end smallexample
30196
30197 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30198 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30199 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30200 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30201 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30202 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30203
30204 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30205
30206 @table @code
30207 @item x
30208 Hexadecimal
30209 @item o
30210 Octal
30211 @item t
30212 Binary
30213 @item d
30214 Decimal
30215 @item r
30216 Raw
30217 @item N
30218 Natural
30219 @end table
30220
30221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30222
30223 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30224 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30225
30226 @subsubheading Example
30227
30228 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30229 don't appear in the actual output):
30230
30231 @smallexample
30232 (gdb)
30233 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30234 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30235 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30236 (gdb)
30237 -data-list-register-values x
30238 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30239 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30240 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30241 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30242 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30243 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30244 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30245 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30246 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30247 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30248 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30249 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30250 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30251 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30252 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30253 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30254 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30255 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30256 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30257 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30258 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30259 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30260 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30261 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30262 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30263 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30264 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30265 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30266 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30267 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30268 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30269 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30270 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30271 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30272 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30273 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30274 (gdb)
30275 @end smallexample
30276
30277
30278 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30279 @findex -data-read-memory
30280
30281 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30282
30283 @subsubheading Synopsis
30284
30285 @smallexample
30286 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30287 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30288 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30289 @end smallexample
30290
30291 @noindent
30292 where:
30293
30294 @table @samp
30295 @item @var{address}
30296 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30297 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30298 quoted using the C convention.
30299
30300 @item @var{word-format}
30301 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30302 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30303 ,Output Formats}).
30304
30305 @item @var{word-size}
30306 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30307
30308 @item @var{nr-rows}
30309 The number of rows in the output table.
30310
30311 @item @var{nr-cols}
30312 The number of columns in the output table.
30313
30314 @item @var{aschar}
30315 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30316 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30317 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30318 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30319
30320 @item @var{byte-offset}
30321 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30322 @end table
30323
30324 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30325 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30326 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30327 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30328 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30329 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30330 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30331 @samp{addr}.
30332
30333 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30334 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30335 @samp{prev-page}.
30336
30337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30338
30339 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30340 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30341
30342 @subsubheading Example
30343
30344 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30345 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30346 word. Display each word in hex.
30347
30348 @smallexample
30349 (gdb)
30350 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30351 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30352 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30353 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30354 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30355 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30356 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30357 (gdb)
30358 @end smallexample
30359
30360 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30361 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30362
30363 @smallexample
30364 (gdb)
30365 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30366 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30367 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30368 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30369 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30370 (gdb)
30371 @end smallexample
30372
30373 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30374 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30375 used as the non-printable character.
30376
30377 @smallexample
30378 (gdb)
30379 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30380 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30381 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30382 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30383 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30384 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30385 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30386 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30387 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30388 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30389 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30390 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30391 (gdb)
30392 @end smallexample
30393
30394 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30395 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30396
30397 @subsubheading Synopsis
30398
30399 @smallexample
30400 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30401 @var{address} @var{count}
30402 @end smallexample
30403
30404 @noindent
30405 where:
30406
30407 @table @samp
30408 @item @var{address}
30409 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30410 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30411 quoted using the C convention.
30412
30413 @item @var{count}
30414 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30415 literal.
30416
30417 @item @var{offset}
30418 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30419 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30420 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30421 arithmetics itself.
30422
30423 @end table
30424
30425 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30426 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30427 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30428 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30429 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30430 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30431
30432 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30433 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30434 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30435 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30436 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30437 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30438 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30439 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30440
30441 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30442 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30443 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30444 and has the following fields:
30445
30446 @table @code
30447 @item begin
30448 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30449
30450 @item end
30451 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30452
30453 @item offset
30454 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30455 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30456
30457 @item contents
30458 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30459
30460 @end table
30461
30462
30463
30464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30465
30466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30467
30468 @subsubheading Example
30469
30470 @smallexample
30471 (gdb)
30472 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30473 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30474 end="0xbffff15e",
30475 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30476 (gdb)
30477 @end smallexample
30478
30479
30480 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30481 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30482
30483 @subsubheading Synopsis
30484
30485 @smallexample
30486 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30487 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30488 @end smallexample
30489
30490 @noindent
30491 where:
30492
30493 @table @samp
30494 @item @var{address}
30495 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30496 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30497 be quoted using the C convention.
30498
30499 @item @var{contents}
30500 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30501 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30502
30503 @item @var{count}
30504 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30505 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30506 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30507 @var{count} memory units.
30508
30509 @end table
30510
30511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30512
30513 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30514
30515 @subsubheading Example
30516
30517 @smallexample
30518 (gdb)
30519 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30520 ^done
30521 (gdb)
30522 @end smallexample
30523
30524 @smallexample
30525 (gdb)
30526 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30527 ^done
30528 (gdb)
30529 @end smallexample
30530
30531 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30532 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30533 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30534
30535 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30536 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30537
30538 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30539 @findex -trace-find
30540
30541 @subsubheading Synopsis
30542
30543 @smallexample
30544 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30545 @end smallexample
30546
30547 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30548 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30549 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30550
30551 @table @samp
30552
30553 @item none
30554 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30555
30556 @item frame-number
30557 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30558 that index.
30559
30560 @item tracepoint-number
30561 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30562 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30563
30564 @item pc
30565 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30566 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30567 address.
30568
30569 @item pc-inside-range
30570 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30571 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30572 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30573
30574 @item pc-outside-range
30575 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30576 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30577 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30578
30579 @item line
30580 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30581 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30582 the specified location.
30583
30584 @end table
30585
30586 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30587 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30588
30589 @table @samp
30590 @item found
30591 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30592 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30593
30594 @item traceframe
30595 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30596 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30597
30598 @item tracepoint
30599 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30600 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30601
30602 @item frame
30603 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30604 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30605 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30606
30607 @end table
30608
30609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30610
30611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30612
30613 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30614 @findex -trace-define-variable
30615
30616 @subsubheading Synopsis
30617
30618 @smallexample
30619 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30620 @end smallexample
30621
30622 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30623 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30624 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30625 with the @samp{$} character.
30626
30627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30628
30629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30630
30631 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30632 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30633
30634 @subsubheading Synopsis
30635
30636 @smallexample
30637 -trace-frame-collected
30638 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30639 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30640 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30641 [--memory-contents]
30642 @end smallexample
30643
30644 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30645 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30646 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30647 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30648 See the output description table below for more details.
30649
30650 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30651 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30652 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30653 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30654 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30655
30656 For instance, if the actions were
30657 @smallexample
30658 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30659 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30660 @end smallexample
30661
30662 @noindent
30663 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30664 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30665 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30666 objects would be computed expressions.
30667
30668 An example output would be:
30669
30670 @smallexample
30671 (gdb)
30672 -trace-frame-collected
30673 ^done,
30674 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30675 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30676 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30677 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30678 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30679 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30680 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30681 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30682 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30683 ...
30684 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30685 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30686 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30687 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30688 (gdb)
30689 @end smallexample
30690
30691 Where:
30692
30693 @table @code
30694 @item explicit-variables
30695 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30696 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30697 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30698 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30699 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30700 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30701 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30702 arrays, structures and unions.
30703
30704 @item computed-expressions
30705 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30706 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30707 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30708 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30709
30710 @item registers
30711 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30712 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30713 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30714 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30715 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30716
30717 @item tvars
30718 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30719 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30720 current value are returned.
30721
30722 @item memory
30723 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30724 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30725 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30726
30727 @table @code
30728 @item address
30729 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30730
30731 @item length
30732 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30733
30734 @item contents
30735 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30736 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30737
30738 @end table
30739
30740 @end table
30741
30742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30743
30744 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30745
30746 @subsubheading Example
30747
30748 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30749 @findex -trace-list-variables
30750
30751 @subsubheading Synopsis
30752
30753 @smallexample
30754 -trace-list-variables
30755 @end smallexample
30756
30757 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30758 table has the following fields:
30759
30760 @table @samp
30761 @item name
30762 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30763
30764 @item initial
30765 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30766 field is always present.
30767
30768 @item current
30769 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30770 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30771 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30772 presently running.
30773
30774 @end table
30775
30776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30777
30778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30779
30780 @subsubheading Example
30781
30782 @smallexample
30783 (gdb)
30784 -trace-list-variables
30785 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30786 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30787 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30788 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30789 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30790 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30791 (gdb)
30792 @end smallexample
30793
30794 @subheading -trace-save
30795 @findex -trace-save
30796
30797 @subsubheading Synopsis
30798
30799 @smallexample
30800 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30801 @end smallexample
30802
30803 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30804 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30805 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30806 to perform the save.
30807
30808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30809
30810 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30811
30812
30813 @subheading -trace-start
30814 @findex -trace-start
30815
30816 @subsubheading Synopsis
30817
30818 @smallexample
30819 -trace-start
30820 @end smallexample
30821
30822 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30823 have any fields.
30824
30825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30826
30827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30828
30829 @subheading -trace-status
30830 @findex -trace-status
30831
30832 @subsubheading Synopsis
30833
30834 @smallexample
30835 -trace-status
30836 @end smallexample
30837
30838 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30839 the following fields:
30840
30841 @table @samp
30842
30843 @item supported
30844 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30845 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30846 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30847 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30848 started. This field is always present.
30849
30850 @item running
30851 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30852 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30853 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30854
30855 @item stop-reason
30856 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30857 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30858 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30859 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30860 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30861 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30862 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30863 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30864 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30865
30866 @item stopping-tracepoint
30867 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30868 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30869 @samp{passcount}.
30870
30871 @item frames
30872 @itemx frames-created
30873 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30874 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30875 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30876 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30877
30878 @item buffer-size
30879 @itemx buffer-free
30880 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30881 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30882
30883 @item circular
30884 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30885 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30886 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30887 and may fill up.
30888
30889 @item disconnected
30890 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30891 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30892 that the trace run will stop.
30893
30894 @item trace-file
30895 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30896 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30897
30898 @end table
30899
30900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30901
30902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30903
30904 @subheading -trace-stop
30905 @findex -trace-stop
30906
30907 @subsubheading Synopsis
30908
30909 @smallexample
30910 -trace-stop
30911 @end smallexample
30912
30913 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30914 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30915 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30916
30917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30918
30919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30920
30921
30922 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30923 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30924 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30925
30926
30927 @ignore
30928 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30929 @findex -symbol-info-address
30930
30931 @subsubheading Synopsis
30932
30933 @smallexample
30934 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30935 @end smallexample
30936
30937 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30938
30939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30940
30941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30942
30943 @subsubheading Example
30944 N.A.
30945
30946
30947 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30948 @findex -symbol-info-file
30949
30950 @subsubheading Synopsis
30951
30952 @smallexample
30953 -symbol-info-file
30954 @end smallexample
30955
30956 Show the file for the symbol.
30957
30958 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30959
30960 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30961 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30962
30963 @subsubheading Example
30964 N.A.
30965
30966
30967 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30968 @findex -symbol-info-function
30969
30970 @subsubheading Synopsis
30971
30972 @smallexample
30973 -symbol-info-function
30974 @end smallexample
30975
30976 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30977
30978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30979
30980 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30981
30982 @subsubheading Example
30983 N.A.
30984
30985
30986 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30987 @findex -symbol-info-line
30988
30989 @subsubheading Synopsis
30990
30991 @smallexample
30992 -symbol-info-line
30993 @end smallexample
30994
30995 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30996
30997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30998
30999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31000 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31001
31002 @subsubheading Example
31003 N.A.
31004
31005
31006 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31007 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31008
31009 @subsubheading Synopsis
31010
31011 @smallexample
31012 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31013 @end smallexample
31014
31015 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31016
31017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31018
31019 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31020
31021 @subsubheading Example
31022 N.A.
31023
31024
31025 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31026 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31027
31028 @subsubheading Synopsis
31029
31030 @smallexample
31031 -symbol-list-functions
31032 @end smallexample
31033
31034 List the functions in the executable.
31035
31036 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31037
31038 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31039 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31040
31041 @subsubheading Example
31042 N.A.
31043 @end ignore
31044
31045
31046 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31047 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31048
31049 @subsubheading Synopsis
31050
31051 @smallexample
31052 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31053 @end smallexample
31054
31055 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31056 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31057 ascending PC order.
31058
31059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31060
31061 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31062
31063 @subsubheading Example
31064 @smallexample
31065 (gdb)
31066 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31067 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31068 (gdb)
31069 @end smallexample
31070
31071
31072 @ignore
31073 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31074 @findex -symbol-list-types
31075
31076 @subsubheading Synopsis
31077
31078 @smallexample
31079 -symbol-list-types
31080 @end smallexample
31081
31082 List all the type names.
31083
31084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31085
31086 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31087 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31088
31089 @subsubheading Example
31090 N.A.
31091
31092
31093 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31094 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31095
31096 @subsubheading Synopsis
31097
31098 @smallexample
31099 -symbol-list-variables
31100 @end smallexample
31101
31102 List all the global and static variable names.
31103
31104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31105
31106 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31107
31108 @subsubheading Example
31109 N.A.
31110
31111
31112 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31113 @findex -symbol-locate
31114
31115 @subsubheading Synopsis
31116
31117 @smallexample
31118 -symbol-locate
31119 @end smallexample
31120
31121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31122
31123 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31124
31125 @subsubheading Example
31126 N.A.
31127
31128
31129 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31130 @findex -symbol-type
31131
31132 @subsubheading Synopsis
31133
31134 @smallexample
31135 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31136 @end smallexample
31137
31138 Show type of @var{variable}.
31139
31140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31141
31142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31143 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31144
31145 @subsubheading Example
31146 N.A.
31147 @end ignore
31148
31149
31150 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31151 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31152 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31153
31154 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31155 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31156
31157 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31158 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31159
31160 @subsubheading Synopsis
31161
31162 @smallexample
31163 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31164 @end smallexample
31165
31166 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31167 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31168 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31169 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31170 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31171 notification.
31172
31173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31174
31175 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31176
31177 @subsubheading Example
31178
31179 @smallexample
31180 (gdb)
31181 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31182 ^done
31183 (gdb)
31184 @end smallexample
31185
31186
31187 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31188 @findex -file-exec-file
31189
31190 @subsubheading Synopsis
31191
31192 @smallexample
31193 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31194 @end smallexample
31195
31196 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31197 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31198 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31199 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31200 notification.
31201
31202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31203
31204 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31205
31206 @subsubheading Example
31207
31208 @smallexample
31209 (gdb)
31210 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31211 ^done
31212 (gdb)
31213 @end smallexample
31214
31215
31216 @ignore
31217 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31218 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31219
31220 @subsubheading Synopsis
31221
31222 @smallexample
31223 -file-list-exec-sections
31224 @end smallexample
31225
31226 List the sections of the current executable file.
31227
31228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31229
31230 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31231 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31232 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31233
31234 @subsubheading Example
31235 N.A.
31236 @end ignore
31237
31238
31239 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31240 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31241
31242 @subsubheading Synopsis
31243
31244 @smallexample
31245 -file-list-exec-source-file
31246 @end smallexample
31247
31248 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31249 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31250 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31251 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31252
31253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31254
31255 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31256
31257 @subsubheading Example
31258
31259 @smallexample
31260 (gdb)
31261 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31262 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31263 (gdb)
31264 @end smallexample
31265
31266
31267 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31268 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31269
31270 @subsubheading Synopsis
31271
31272 @smallexample
31273 -file-list-exec-source-files
31274 @end smallexample
31275
31276 List the source files for the current executable.
31277
31278 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31279 name) of a source file.
31280
31281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31282
31283 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31284 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31285
31286 @subsubheading Example
31287 @smallexample
31288 (gdb)
31289 -file-list-exec-source-files
31290 ^done,files=[
31291 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31292 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31293 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31294 (gdb)
31295 @end smallexample
31296
31297 @ignore
31298 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31299 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31300
31301 @subsubheading Synopsis
31302
31303 @smallexample
31304 -file-list-shared-libraries
31305 @end smallexample
31306
31307 List the shared libraries in the program.
31308
31309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31310
31311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31312
31313 @subsubheading Example
31314 N.A.
31315
31316
31317 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31318 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31319
31320 @subsubheading Synopsis
31321
31322 @smallexample
31323 -file-list-symbol-files
31324 @end smallexample
31325
31326 List symbol files.
31327
31328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31329
31330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31331
31332 @subsubheading Example
31333 N.A.
31334 @end ignore
31335
31336
31337 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31338 @findex -file-symbol-file
31339
31340 @subsubheading Synopsis
31341
31342 @smallexample
31343 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31344 @end smallexample
31345
31346 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31347 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31348 produced, except for a completion notification.
31349
31350 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31351
31352 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31353
31354 @subsubheading Example
31355
31356 @smallexample
31357 (gdb)
31358 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31359 ^done
31360 (gdb)
31361 @end smallexample
31362
31363 @ignore
31364 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31365 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31366 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31367
31368 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31369
31370 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31371
31372 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31373
31374 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31375
31376 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31377
31378 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31379
31380 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31381
31382 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31383
31384 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31385 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31386 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31387
31388 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31389
31390 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31391
31392 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31393
31394 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31395 @end ignore
31396
31397
31398 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31399 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31400 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31401
31402
31403 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31404 @findex -target-attach
31405
31406 @subsubheading Synopsis
31407
31408 @smallexample
31409 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31410 @end smallexample
31411
31412 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31413 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31414 group, the id previously returned by
31415 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31416
31417 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31418
31419 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31420
31421 @subsubheading Example
31422 @smallexample
31423 (gdb)
31424 -target-attach 34
31425 =thread-created,id="1"
31426 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31427 ^done
31428 (gdb)
31429 @end smallexample
31430
31431 @ignore
31432 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31433 @findex -target-compare-sections
31434
31435 @subsubheading Synopsis
31436
31437 @smallexample
31438 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31439 @end smallexample
31440
31441 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31442 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31443
31444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31445
31446 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31447
31448 @subsubheading Example
31449 N.A.
31450 @end ignore
31451
31452
31453 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31454 @findex -target-detach
31455
31456 @subsubheading Synopsis
31457
31458 @smallexample
31459 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31460 @end smallexample
31461
31462 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31463 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31464 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31465
31466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31467
31468 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31469
31470 @subsubheading Example
31471
31472 @smallexample
31473 (gdb)
31474 -target-detach
31475 ^done
31476 (gdb)
31477 @end smallexample
31478
31479
31480 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31481 @findex -target-disconnect
31482
31483 @subsubheading Synopsis
31484
31485 @smallexample
31486 -target-disconnect
31487 @end smallexample
31488
31489 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31490 generally not resumed.
31491
31492 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31493
31494 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31495
31496 @subsubheading Example
31497
31498 @smallexample
31499 (gdb)
31500 -target-disconnect
31501 ^done
31502 (gdb)
31503 @end smallexample
31504
31505
31506 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31507 @findex -target-download
31508
31509 @subsubheading Synopsis
31510
31511 @smallexample
31512 -target-download
31513 @end smallexample
31514
31515 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31516 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31517
31518 @table @samp
31519 @item section
31520 The name of the section.
31521 @item section-sent
31522 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31523 @item section-size
31524 The size of the section.
31525 @item total-sent
31526 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31527 @item total-size
31528 The size of the overall executable to download.
31529 @end table
31530
31531 @noindent
31532 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31533 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31534
31535 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31536 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31537
31538 @table @samp
31539 @item section
31540 The name of the section.
31541 @item section-size
31542 The size of the section.
31543 @item total-size
31544 The size of the overall executable to download.
31545 @end table
31546
31547 @noindent
31548 At the end, a summary is printed.
31549
31550 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31551
31552 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31553
31554 @subsubheading Example
31555
31556 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31557 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31558
31559 @smallexample
31560 (gdb)
31561 -target-download
31562 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31563 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31564 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31565 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31566 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31567 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31568 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31569 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31570 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31571 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31572 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31573 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31574 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31575 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31576 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31577 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31578 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31579 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31580 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31581 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31582 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31583 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31584 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31585 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31586 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31587 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31588 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31589 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31590 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31591 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31592 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31593 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31594 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31595 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31596 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31597 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31598 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31599 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31600 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31601 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31602 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31603 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31604 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31605 write-rate="429"
31606 (gdb)
31607 @end smallexample
31608
31609
31610 @ignore
31611 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31612 @findex -target-exec-status
31613
31614 @subsubheading Synopsis
31615
31616 @smallexample
31617 -target-exec-status
31618 @end smallexample
31619
31620 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31621 not, for instance).
31622
31623 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31624
31625 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31626
31627 @subsubheading Example
31628 N.A.
31629
31630
31631 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31632 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31633
31634 @subsubheading Synopsis
31635
31636 @smallexample
31637 -target-list-available-targets
31638 @end smallexample
31639
31640 List the possible targets to connect to.
31641
31642 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31643
31644 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31645
31646 @subsubheading Example
31647 N.A.
31648
31649
31650 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31651 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31652
31653 @subsubheading Synopsis
31654
31655 @smallexample
31656 -target-list-current-targets
31657 @end smallexample
31658
31659 Describe the current target.
31660
31661 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31662
31663 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31664 other things).
31665
31666 @subsubheading Example
31667 N.A.
31668
31669
31670 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31671 @findex -target-list-parameters
31672
31673 @subsubheading Synopsis
31674
31675 @smallexample
31676 -target-list-parameters
31677 @end smallexample
31678
31679 @c ????
31680 @end ignore
31681
31682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31683
31684 No equivalent.
31685
31686 @subsubheading Example
31687 N.A.
31688
31689
31690 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31691 @findex -target-select
31692
31693 @subsubheading Synopsis
31694
31695 @smallexample
31696 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31697 @end smallexample
31698
31699 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31700
31701 @table @samp
31702 @item @var{type}
31703 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31704 @item @var{parameters}
31705 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31706 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31707 @end table
31708
31709 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31710 which the target program is, in the following form:
31711
31712 @smallexample
31713 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31714 args=[@var{arg list}]
31715 @end smallexample
31716
31717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31718
31719 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31720
31721 @subsubheading Example
31722
31723 @smallexample
31724 (gdb)
31725 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31726 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31727 (gdb)
31728 @end smallexample
31729
31730 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31731 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31732 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31733
31734
31735 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31736 @findex -target-file-put
31737
31738 @subsubheading Synopsis
31739
31740 @smallexample
31741 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31742 @end smallexample
31743
31744 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31745 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31746
31747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31748
31749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31750
31751 @subsubheading Example
31752
31753 @smallexample
31754 (gdb)
31755 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31756 ^done
31757 (gdb)
31758 @end smallexample
31759
31760
31761 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31762 @findex -target-file-get
31763
31764 @subsubheading Synopsis
31765
31766 @smallexample
31767 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31768 @end smallexample
31769
31770 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31771 on the host system.
31772
31773 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31774
31775 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31776
31777 @subsubheading Example
31778
31779 @smallexample
31780 (gdb)
31781 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31782 ^done
31783 (gdb)
31784 @end smallexample
31785
31786
31787 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31788 @findex -target-file-delete
31789
31790 @subsubheading Synopsis
31791
31792 @smallexample
31793 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31794 @end smallexample
31795
31796 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31797
31798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31799
31800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31801
31802 @subsubheading Example
31803
31804 @smallexample
31805 (gdb)
31806 -target-file-delete remotefile
31807 ^done
31808 (gdb)
31809 @end smallexample
31810
31811
31812 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31813 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31814 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31815
31816 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31817 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31818
31819 @subsubheading Synopsis
31820
31821 @smallexample
31822 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31823 @end smallexample
31824
31825 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31826 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31827 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31828
31829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31830
31831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31832
31833 @subsubheading Result
31834
31835 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31836 defined for each exception:
31837
31838 @table @samp
31839 @item name
31840 The name of the exception.
31841
31842 @item address
31843 The address of the exception.
31844
31845 @end table
31846
31847 @subsubheading Example
31848
31849 @smallexample
31850 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31851 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31852 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31853 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31854 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31855 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31856 @end smallexample
31857
31858 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31859
31860 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31861 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31862 Catchpoint Commands}.
31863
31864
31865 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31866 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31867 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31868
31869 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31870 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31871 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31872 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31873
31874 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31875 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31876 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31877
31878 @subsubheading Synopsis
31879
31880 @smallexample
31881 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31882 @end smallexample
31883
31884 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31885
31886 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31887 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31888 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31889 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31890 dash.
31891
31892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31893
31894 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31895
31896 @subsubheading Result
31897
31898 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31899
31900 @table @samp
31901 @item exists
31902 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31903 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31904
31905 @end table
31906
31907 @subsubheading Example
31908
31909 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31910
31911 @smallexample
31912 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31913 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31914 @end smallexample
31915
31916 @noindent
31917 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31918 to the debugger:
31919
31920 @smallexample
31921 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31922 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31923 @end smallexample
31924
31925 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31926 @findex -list-features
31927 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31928
31929 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31930 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31931 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31932 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31933 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31934 startup.
31935
31936 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31937 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31938 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31939 is given below.
31940
31941 Example output:
31942
31943 @smallexample
31944 (gdb) -list-features
31945 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31946 @end smallexample
31947
31948 The current list of features is:
31949
31950 @ftable @samp
31951 @item frozen-varobjs
31952 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31953 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31954 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31955 @item pending-breakpoints
31956 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31957 command.
31958 @item python
31959 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31960 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31961 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31962 @item thread-info
31963 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31964 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31965 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31966 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31967 @item breakpoint-notifications
31968 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31969 CLI will be announced via async records.
31970 @item ada-task-info
31971 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31972 @item language-option
31973 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31974 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31975 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31976 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31977 @item undefined-command-error-code
31978 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31979 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31980 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31981 @item exec-run-start-option
31982 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31983 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31984 @end ftable
31985
31986 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31987 @findex -list-target-features
31988
31989 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31990 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31991 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31992 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31993 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31994 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31995 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31996 Example output:
31997
31998 @smallexample
31999 (gdb) -list-target-features
32000 ^done,result=["async"]
32001 @end smallexample
32002
32003 The current list of features is:
32004
32005 @table @samp
32006 @item async
32007 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32008 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32009 while the target is running.
32010
32011 @item reverse
32012 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32013 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32014
32015 @end table
32016
32017 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32018 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32019 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32020
32021 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32022
32023 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32024 @findex -gdb-exit
32025
32026 @subsubheading Synopsis
32027
32028 @smallexample
32029 -gdb-exit
32030 @end smallexample
32031
32032 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32033
32034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32035
32036 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32037
32038 @subsubheading Example
32039
32040 @smallexample
32041 (gdb)
32042 -gdb-exit
32043 ^exit
32044 @end smallexample
32045
32046
32047 @ignore
32048 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32049 @findex -exec-abort
32050
32051 @subsubheading Synopsis
32052
32053 @smallexample
32054 -exec-abort
32055 @end smallexample
32056
32057 Kill the inferior running program.
32058
32059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32060
32061 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32062
32063 @subsubheading Example
32064 N.A.
32065 @end ignore
32066
32067
32068 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32069 @findex -gdb-set
32070
32071 @subsubheading Synopsis
32072
32073 @smallexample
32074 -gdb-set
32075 @end smallexample
32076
32077 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32078 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32079
32080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32081
32082 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32083
32084 @subsubheading Example
32085
32086 @smallexample
32087 (gdb)
32088 -gdb-set $foo=3
32089 ^done
32090 (gdb)
32091 @end smallexample
32092
32093
32094 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32095 @findex -gdb-show
32096
32097 @subsubheading Synopsis
32098
32099 @smallexample
32100 -gdb-show
32101 @end smallexample
32102
32103 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32104
32105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32106
32107 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32108
32109 @subsubheading Example
32110
32111 @smallexample
32112 (gdb)
32113 -gdb-show annotate
32114 ^done,value="0"
32115 (gdb)
32116 @end smallexample
32117
32118 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32119
32120
32121 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32122 @findex -gdb-version
32123
32124 @subsubheading Synopsis
32125
32126 @smallexample
32127 -gdb-version
32128 @end smallexample
32129
32130 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32131
32132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32133
32134 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32135 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32136
32137 @subsubheading Example
32138
32139 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32140 @c box in TeX.
32141 @smallexample
32142 (gdb)
32143 -gdb-version
32144 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32145 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32146 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32147 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32148 ~ certain conditions.
32149 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32150 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32151 ~ details.
32152 ~This GDB was configured as
32153 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32154 ^done
32155 (gdb)
32156 @end smallexample
32157
32158 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32159 @findex -list-thread-groups
32160
32161 @subheading Synopsis
32162
32163 @smallexample
32164 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32165 @end smallexample
32166
32167 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32168 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32169 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32170 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32171 top-level thread groups.
32172
32173 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32174 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32175 available on the target.
32176
32177 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32178 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32179 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32180 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32181 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32182 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32183 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32184 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32185
32186 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32187 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32188 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32189 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32190 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32191 @samp{threads} field.
32192
32193 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32194 the following caveats:
32195
32196 @itemize @bullet
32197 @item
32198 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32199 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32200 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32201
32202 @item
32203 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32204 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32205 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32206 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32207 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32208 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32209
32210 @end itemize
32211
32212 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32213 have the following fields:
32214
32215 @table @code
32216 @item id
32217 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32218 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32219 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32220
32221 @item type
32222 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32223 valid type.
32224
32225 @item pid
32226 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32227 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32228
32229 @item exit-code
32230 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32231 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32232 only if the process is not running.
32233
32234 @item num_children
32235 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32236 absent for an available thread group.
32237
32238 @item threads
32239 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32240 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32241 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32242
32243 @item cores
32244 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32245 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32246 such information is not available.
32247
32248 @item executable
32249 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32250 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32251 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32252
32253 @end table
32254
32255 @subheading Example
32256
32257 @smallexample
32258 @value{GDBP}
32259 -list-thread-groups
32260 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32261 -list-thread-groups 17
32262 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32263 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32264 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32265 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32266 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32267 -list-thread-groups --available
32268 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32269 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32270 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32271 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32272 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32273 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32274 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32275 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32276 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32277 @end smallexample
32278
32279 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32280 @findex -info-os
32281
32282 @subsubheading Synopsis
32283
32284 @smallexample
32285 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32286 @end smallexample
32287
32288 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32289 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32290 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32291 of data of that type.
32292
32293 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32294 system.
32295
32296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32297
32298 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32299
32300 @subsubheading Example
32301
32302 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32303 like this:
32304
32305 @smallexample
32306 @value{GDBP}
32307 -info-os
32308 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32309 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32310 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32311 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32312 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32313 col2="CPUs"@},
32314 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32315 col2="File descriptors"@},
32316 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32317 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32318 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32319 col2="Message queues"@},
32320 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32321 col2="Processes"@},
32322 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32323 col2="Process groups"@},
32324 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32325 col2="Semaphores"@},
32326 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32327 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32328 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32329 col2="Sockets"@},
32330 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32331 col2="Threads"@}]
32332 @value{GDBP}
32333 -info-os processes
32334 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32335 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32336 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32337 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32338 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32339 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32340 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32341 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32342 ...
32343 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32344 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32345 (gdb)
32346 @end smallexample
32347
32348 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32349 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32350 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32351 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32352 @code{info os} omits it.)
32353
32354 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32355 @findex -add-inferior
32356
32357 @subheading Synopsis
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 -add-inferior
32361 @end smallexample
32362
32363 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32364 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32365 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32366 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32367 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32368 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32369
32370 @subheading Example
32371
32372 @smallexample
32373 @value{GDBP}
32374 -add-inferior
32375 ^done,inferior="i3"
32376 @end smallexample
32377
32378 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32379 @findex -interpreter-exec
32380
32381 @subheading Synopsis
32382
32383 @smallexample
32384 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32385 @end smallexample
32386 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32387
32388 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32389
32390 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32391
32392 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32393
32394 @subheading Example
32395
32396 @smallexample
32397 (gdb)
32398 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32399 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32400 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32401 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32402 ^done
32403 (gdb)
32404 @end smallexample
32405
32406 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32407 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32408
32409 @subheading Synopsis
32410
32411 @smallexample
32412 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32413 @end smallexample
32414
32415 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32416
32417 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32418
32419 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32420
32421 @subheading Example
32422
32423 @smallexample
32424 (gdb)
32425 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32426 ^done
32427 (gdb)
32428 @end smallexample
32429
32430 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32431 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32432
32433 @subheading Synopsis
32434
32435 @smallexample
32436 -inferior-tty-show
32437 @end smallexample
32438
32439 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32440
32441 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32442
32443 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32444
32445 @subheading Example
32446
32447 @smallexample
32448 (gdb)
32449 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32450 ^done
32451 (gdb)
32452 -inferior-tty-show
32453 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32454 (gdb)
32455 @end smallexample
32456
32457 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32458 @findex -enable-timings
32459
32460 @subheading Synopsis
32461
32462 @smallexample
32463 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32464 @end smallexample
32465
32466 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32467 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32468 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32469 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32470
32471 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32472
32473 No equivalent.
32474
32475 @subheading Example
32476
32477 @smallexample
32478 (gdb)
32479 -enable-timings
32480 ^done
32481 (gdb)
32482 -break-insert main
32483 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32484 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32485 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32486 times="0"@},
32487 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32488 (gdb)
32489 -enable-timings no
32490 ^done
32491 (gdb)
32492 -exec-run
32493 ^running
32494 (gdb)
32495 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32496 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32497 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32498 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32499 (gdb)
32500 @end smallexample
32501
32502 @node Annotations
32503 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32504
32505 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32506 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32507 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32508 relatively high level.
32509
32510 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32511 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32512
32513 @ignore
32514 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32515 @end ignore
32516
32517 @menu
32518 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32519 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32520 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32521 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32522 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32523 * Annotations for Running::
32524 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32525 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32526 @end menu
32527
32528 @node Annotations Overview
32529 @section What is an Annotation?
32530 @cindex annotations
32531
32532 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32533 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32534 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32535 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32536 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32537 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32538 cannot contain newline characters.
32539
32540 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32541 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32542 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32543 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32544 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32545 means those three characters as output.
32546
32547 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32548 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32549 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32550 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32551 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32552 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32553 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32554 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32555 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32556
32557 @table @code
32558 @kindex set annotate
32559 @item set annotate @var{level}
32560 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32561 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32562
32563 @item show annotate
32564 @kindex show annotate
32565 Show the current annotation level.
32566 @end table
32567
32568 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32569
32570 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32571
32572 @smallexample
32573 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32574 GNU gdb 6.0
32575 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32576 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32577 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32578 under certain conditions.
32579 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32580 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32581 for details.
32582 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32583
32584 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32585 (@value{GDBP})
32586 ^Z^Zprompt
32587 @kbd{quit}
32588
32589 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32590 $
32591 @end smallexample
32592
32593 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32594 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32595 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32596 output from @value{GDBN}.
32597
32598 @node Server Prefix
32599 @section The Server Prefix
32600 @cindex server prefix
32601
32602 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32603 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32604 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32605 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32606 a transparent manner.
32607
32608 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32609 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32610 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32611 @code{print} command.
32612
32613 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32614 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32615
32616 @node Prompting
32617 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32618
32619 @cindex annotations for prompts
32620 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32621 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32622 over, etc.
32623
32624 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32625 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32626 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32627 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32628 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32629 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32630 features the following annotations:
32631
32632 @smallexample
32633 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32634 ^Z^Zprompt
32635 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32636 @end smallexample
32637
32638 The input types are
32639
32640 @table @code
32641 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32642 @findex prompt annotation
32643 @findex post-prompt annotation
32644 @item prompt
32645 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32646
32647 @findex pre-commands annotation
32648 @findex commands annotation
32649 @findex post-commands annotation
32650 @item commands
32651 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32652 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32653
32654 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32655 @findex overload-choice annotation
32656 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32657 @item overload-choice
32658 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32659
32660 @findex pre-query annotation
32661 @findex query annotation
32662 @findex post-query annotation
32663 @item query
32664 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32665
32666 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32667 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32668 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32669 @item prompt-for-continue
32670 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32671 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32672 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32673 presence of annotations.
32674 @end table
32675
32676 @node Errors
32677 @section Errors
32678 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32679
32680 @findex quit annotation
32681 @smallexample
32682 ^Z^Zquit
32683 @end smallexample
32684
32685 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32686
32687 @findex error annotation
32688 @smallexample
32689 ^Z^Zerror
32690 @end smallexample
32691
32692 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32693
32694 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32695 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32696 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32697 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32698 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32699 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32700 to the top level.
32701
32702 @findex error-begin annotation
32703 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32704
32705 @smallexample
32706 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32707 @end smallexample
32708
32709 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32710 message.
32711
32712 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32713 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32714 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32715
32716 @node Invalidation
32717 @section Invalidation Notices
32718
32719 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32720 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32721 changed.
32722
32723 @table @code
32724 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32725 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32726
32727 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32728 have changed.
32729
32730 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32731 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32732
32733 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32734 deleted a breakpoint.
32735 @end table
32736
32737 @node Annotations for Running
32738 @section Running the Program
32739 @cindex annotations for running programs
32740
32741 @findex starting annotation
32742 @findex stopping annotation
32743 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32744 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32745
32746 @smallexample
32747 ^Z^Zstarting
32748 @end smallexample
32749
32750 is output. When the program stops,
32751
32752 @smallexample
32753 ^Z^Zstopped
32754 @end smallexample
32755
32756 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32757 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32758
32759 @table @code
32760 @findex exited annotation
32761 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32762 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32763 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32764
32765 @findex signalled annotation
32766 @findex signal-name annotation
32767 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32768 @findex signal-string annotation
32769 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32770 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32771 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32772 annotation continues:
32773
32774 @smallexample
32775 @var{intro-text}
32776 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32777 @var{name}
32778 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32779 @var{middle-text}
32780 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32781 @var{string}
32782 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32783 @var{end-text}
32784 @end smallexample
32785
32786 @noindent
32787 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32788 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32789 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32790 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32791 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32792
32793 @findex signal annotation
32794 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32795 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32796 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32797 terminated with it.
32798
32799 @findex breakpoint annotation
32800 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32801 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32802
32803 @findex watchpoint annotation
32804 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32805 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32806 @end table
32807
32808 @node Source Annotations
32809 @section Displaying Source
32810 @cindex annotations for source display
32811
32812 @findex source annotation
32813 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32814
32815 @smallexample
32816 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32817 @end smallexample
32818
32819 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32820 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32821 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32822 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32823 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32824 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32825 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32826 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32827 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32828 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32829 depend on the language).
32830
32831 @node JIT Interface
32832 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32833 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32834 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32835
32836 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32837 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32838 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32839 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32840
32841 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32842 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32843 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32844 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32845 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32846 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32847
32848 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32849 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32850 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32851 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32852 LLVM JIT.
32853
32854 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32855 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32856 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32857 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32858 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32859 out about additional code.
32860
32861 @menu
32862 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32863 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32864 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32865 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32866 @end menu
32867
32868 @node Declarations
32869 @section JIT Declarations
32870
32871 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32872 implement the interface:
32873
32874 @smallexample
32875 typedef enum
32876 @{
32877 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32878 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32879 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32880 @} jit_actions_t;
32881
32882 struct jit_code_entry
32883 @{
32884 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32885 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32886 const char *symfile_addr;
32887 uint64_t symfile_size;
32888 @};
32889
32890 struct jit_descriptor
32891 @{
32892 uint32_t version;
32893 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32894 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32895 uint32_t action_flag;
32896 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32897 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32898 @};
32899
32900 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32901 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32902
32903 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32904 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32905 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32906 @end smallexample
32907
32908 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32909 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32910 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32911
32912 @node Registering Code
32913 @section Registering Code
32914
32915 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32916
32917 @itemize @bullet
32918 @item
32919 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32920 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32921
32922 @item
32923 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32924 file.
32925
32926 @item
32927 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32928
32929 @item
32930 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32931
32932 @item
32933 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32934 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32935 @end itemize
32936
32937 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32938 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32939 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32940 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32941
32942 @node Unregistering Code
32943 @section Unregistering Code
32944
32945 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32946
32947 @itemize @bullet
32948 @item
32949 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32950
32951 @item
32952 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32953
32954 @item
32955 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32956 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32957 @end itemize
32958
32959 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32960 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32961
32962 @node Custom Debug Info
32963 @section Custom Debug Info
32964 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32965 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32966
32967 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32968 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32969 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32970 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32971 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32972 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32973 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32974 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32975 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32976
32977 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32978 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32979 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32980 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32981 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32982 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32983 compiler.
32984
32985 @menu
32986 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32987 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32988 @end menu
32989
32990 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32991 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32992 @kindex jit-reader-load
32993 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32994
32995 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32996 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32997
32998 @table @code
32999 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33000 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33001 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33002 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33003 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33004 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33005 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33006
33007 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33008 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33009 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33010 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33011 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33012
33013 @item jit-reader-unload
33014 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33015
33016 @end table
33017
33018 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33019 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33020 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33021
33022 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33023 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33024
33025 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33026 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33027 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33028 the system include directory.
33029
33030 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33031 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33032 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33033
33034 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33035 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33036
33037 @findex gdb_init_reader
33038 @smallexample
33039 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33040 @end smallexample
33041
33042 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33043
33044 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33045 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33046 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33047 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33048 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33049 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33050
33051 @smallexample
33052 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33053 @{
33054 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33055 int reader_version;
33056
33057 /* For use by the reader. */
33058 void *priv_data;
33059
33060 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33061 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33062 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33063 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33064 @};
33065 @end smallexample
33066
33067 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33068 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33069
33070 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33071 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33072 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33073 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33074 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33075 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33076 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33077 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33078 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33079 target's address space.
33080
33081 @node In-Process Agent
33082 @chapter In-Process Agent
33083 @cindex debugging agent
33084 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33085 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33086 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33087 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33088 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33089 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33090 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33091 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33092 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33093 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33094 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33095 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33096 behavior without interrupting it.
33097
33098 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33099 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33100 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33101 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33102 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33103 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33104 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33105 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33106 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33107
33108 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33109 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33110 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33111 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33112
33113 @anchor{Control Agent}
33114 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33115 debugging with the following commands:
33116
33117 @table @code
33118 @kindex set agent on
33119 @item set agent on
33120 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33121 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33122 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33123 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33124 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33125 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33126
33127 @kindex set agent off
33128 @item set agent off
33129 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33130 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33131
33132 @kindex show agent
33133 @item show agent
33134 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33135 the in-process agent.
33136 @end table
33137
33138 @menu
33139 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33140 @end menu
33141
33142 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33143 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33144 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33145
33146 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33147 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33148 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33149 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33150 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33151 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33152 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33153 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33154 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33155
33156 @menu
33157 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33158 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33159 @end menu
33160
33161 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33162 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33163 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33164
33165 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33166 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33167
33168 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33169 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33170 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33171 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33172
33173 @enumerate
33174 @item
33175 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33176 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33177 @item
33178 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33179 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33180 the other one.
33181 @end enumerate
33182
33183 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33184
33185 @enumerate
33186 @item
33187 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33188 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33189 @anchor{agent expression object}
33190 @item
33191 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33192 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33193 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33194 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33195 @item
33196 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33197 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33198
33199 @end enumerate
33200
33201 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33202 object:
33203
33204 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33205 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33206 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33207 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33208 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33209 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33210 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33211 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33212 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33213 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33214 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33215 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33216 memory address for collecting.
33217 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33218 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33219 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33220 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33221 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33222 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33223 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33224 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33225 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33226 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33227 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33228 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33229 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33230 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33231 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33232 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33233 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33234 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33235 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33236 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33237 @ref{agent expression object}
33238 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33239 @ref{agent expression object}
33240 @item actions @tab variable
33241 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33242 @end multitable
33243
33244 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33245 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33246 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33247
33248 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33249 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33250
33251 @table @samp
33252
33253 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33254 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33255 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33256 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33257 in IPA finally.
33258
33259 Replies:
33260 @table @samp
33261 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33262 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33263 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33264 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33265 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33266 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33267 @item E @var{NN}
33268 for an error
33269
33270 @end table
33271
33272 @item close
33273 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33274 is about to kill inferiors.
33275
33276 @item qTfSTM
33277 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33278 @item qTsSTM
33279 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33280 @item qTSTMat
33281 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33282 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33283 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33284
33285 Replies:
33286 @table @samp
33287 @item E @var{NN}
33288 for an error
33289 @end table
33290 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33291 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33292 @end table
33293
33294 @node GDB Bugs
33295 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33296 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33297 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33298
33299 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33300
33301 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33302 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33303 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33304 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33305
33306 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33307 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33308
33309 @menu
33310 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33311 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33312 @end menu
33313
33314 @node Bug Criteria
33315 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33316 @cindex bug criteria
33317
33318 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33319
33320 @itemize @bullet
33321 @cindex fatal signal
33322 @cindex debugger crash
33323 @cindex crash of debugger
33324 @item
33325 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33326 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33327
33328 @cindex error on valid input
33329 @item
33330 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33331 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33332 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33333
33334 @cindex invalid input
33335 @item
33336 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33337 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33338 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33339 for traditional practice''.
33340
33341 @item
33342 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33343 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33344 @end itemize
33345
33346 @node Bug Reporting
33347 @section How to Report Bugs
33348 @cindex bug reports
33349 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33350
33351 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33352 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33353 contact that organization first.
33354
33355 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33356 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33357 distribution.
33358 @c should add a web page ref...
33359
33360 @ifset BUGURL
33361 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33362 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33363 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33364 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33365 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33366 be used.
33367
33368 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33369 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33370 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33371 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33372
33373 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33374 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33375 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33376 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33377 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33378 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33379 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33380 bug reports to the mailing list.
33381 @end ifset
33382 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33383 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33384 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33385 @end ifclear
33386 @end ifset
33387
33388 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33389 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33390 fact or leave it out, state it!
33391
33392 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33393 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33394 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33395 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33396 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33397 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33398 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33399 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33400 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33401
33402 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33403 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33404 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33405 self-contained.
33406
33407 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33408 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33409 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33410 bugs properly.
33411
33412 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33413
33414 @itemize @bullet
33415 @item
33416 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33417 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33418 version}.
33419
33420 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33421 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33422
33423 @item
33424 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33425 version number.
33426
33427 @item
33428 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33429 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33430 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33431 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33432
33433 @item
33434 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33435 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33436
33437 @item
33438 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33439 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33440 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33441 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33442 those compilers.
33443
33444 @item
33445 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33446 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33447 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33448 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33449
33450 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33451 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33452
33453 @item
33454 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33455 reproduce the bug.
33456
33457 @item
33458 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33459 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33460
33461 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33462 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33463 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33464 a chance to make a mistake.
33465
33466 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33467 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33468 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33469 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33470 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33471 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33472 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33473 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33474
33475 @pindex script
33476 @cindex recording a session script
33477 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33478 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33479 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33480 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33481
33482 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33483 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33484
33485 @item
33486 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33487 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33488 it by context, not by line number.
33489
33490 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33491 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33492
33493 @end itemize
33494
33495 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33496
33497 @itemize @bullet
33498 @item
33499 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33500
33501 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33502 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33503 changes will not affect it.
33504
33505 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33506 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33507 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33508 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33509
33510 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33511 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33512 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33513 less time, and so on.
33514
33515 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33516 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33517
33518 @item
33519 A patch for the bug.
33520
33521 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33522 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33523 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33524 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33525
33526 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33527 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33528 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33529 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33530
33531 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33532 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33533 help us to understand.
33534
33535 @item
33536 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33537
33538 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33539 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33540 @end itemize
33541
33542 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33543 @c and consists of the two following files:
33544 @c rluser.texi
33545 @c hsuser.texi
33546 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33547 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33548 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33549 @include rluser.texi
33550 @include hsuser.texi
33551 @end ifclear
33552
33553 @node In Memoriam
33554 @appendix In Memoriam
33555
33556 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33557 contributors:
33558
33559 @table @code
33560 @item Fred Fish
33561 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33562 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33563 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33564
33565 @item Michael Snyder
33566 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33567 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33568 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33569 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33570 @end table
33571
33572 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33573 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33574
33575 @node Formatting Documentation
33576 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33577
33578 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33579 @cindex reference card
33580 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33581 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33582 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33583 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33584 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33585 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33586
33587 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33588 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33589
33590 @smallexample
33591 make refcard.dvi
33592 @end smallexample
33593
33594 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33595 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33596 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33597 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33598 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33599
33600 @cindex documentation
33601
33602 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33603 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33604 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33605 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33606 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33607 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33608
33609 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33610 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33611 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33612 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33613 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33614 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33615 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33616 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33617
33618 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33619 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33620 @code{makeinfo}.
33621
33622 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33623 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33624 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33625
33626 @smallexample
33627 cd gdb
33628 make gdb.info
33629 @end smallexample
33630
33631 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33632 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33633 Texinfo definitions file.
33634
33635 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33636 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33637 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33638 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33639 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33640 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33641 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33642
33643 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33644 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33645 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33646 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33647 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33648 directory.
33649
33650 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33651 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33652 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33653 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33654
33655 @smallexample
33656 make gdb.dvi
33657 @end smallexample
33658
33659 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33660
33661 @node Installing GDB
33662 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33663 @cindex installation
33664
33665 @menu
33666 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33667 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33668 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33669 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33670 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33671 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33672 @end menu
33673
33674 @node Requirements
33675 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33676 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33677
33678 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33679 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33680
33681 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33682 @table @asis
33683 @item ISO C90 compiler
33684 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33685 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33686
33687 @end table
33688
33689 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33690 @table @asis
33691 @item Expat
33692 @anchor{Expat}
33693 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33694 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33695 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33696 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33697 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33698 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33699
33700 Expat is used for:
33701
33702 @itemize @bullet
33703 @item
33704 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33705 @item
33706 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33707 @item
33708 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33709 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33710 @item
33711 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33712 @item
33713 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33714 @item
33715 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33716 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33717 @end itemize
33718
33719 @item zlib
33720 @cindex compressed debug sections
33721 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33722 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33723 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33724 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33725 information in such binaries.
33726
33727 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33728 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33729 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33730
33731 @item iconv
33732 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33733 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33734 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33735 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33736
33737 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33738 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33739 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33740 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33741
33742 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33743 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33744 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33745
33746 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33747 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33748 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33749 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33750 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33751 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33752 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33753 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33754 @end table
33755
33756 @node Running Configure
33757 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33758 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33759 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33760 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33761 build the @code{gdb} program.
33762 @iftex
33763 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33764 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33765 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33766 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33767 @end iftex
33768
33769 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33770 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33771 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33772
33773 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33774 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33775
33776 @table @code
33777 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33778 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33779
33780 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33781 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33782
33783 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33784 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33785
33786 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33787 @sc{gnu} include files
33788
33789 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33790 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33791
33792 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33793 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33794
33795 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33796 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33797
33798 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33799 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33800
33801 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33802 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33803 @end table
33804
33805 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33806 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33807 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33808
33809 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33810 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33811 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33812 argument.
33813
33814 For example:
33815
33816 @smallexample
33817 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33818 ./configure @var{host}
33819 make
33820 @end smallexample
33821
33822 @noindent
33823 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33824 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33825 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33826 correct value by examining your system.)
33827
33828 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33829 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33830 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33831 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33832
33833 @need 750
33834 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33835 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33836 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33837
33838 @smallexample
33839 sh configure @var{host}
33840 @end smallexample
33841
33842 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33843 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33844 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33845 @file{configure}
33846 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33847 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33848
33849 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33850 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33851 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33852 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33853 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33854 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33855 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33856 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33857 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33858
33859 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33860 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33861 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33862 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33863 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33864
33865 @node Separate Objdir
33866 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33867
33868 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33869 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33870 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33871 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33872 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33873 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33874 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33875 program specified there.
33876
33877 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33878 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33879 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33880 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33881 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33882 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33883
33884 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33885 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33886
33887 @smallexample
33888 @group
33889 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33890 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33891 cd ../gdb-sun4
33892 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33893 make
33894 @end group
33895 @end smallexample
33896
33897 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33898 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33899 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33900 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33901 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33902 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33903
33904 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33905 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33906 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33907 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33908 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33909
33910 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33911 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33912 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33913 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33914 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33915 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33916
33917 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33918 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33919 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33920
33921 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33922 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33923 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33924 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33925 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33926
33927 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33928 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33929 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33930 with each other.
33931
33932 @node Config Names
33933 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33934
33935 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33936 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33937 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33938 of information in the following pattern:
33939
33940 @smallexample
33941 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33942 @end smallexample
33943
33944 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33945 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33946 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33947
33948 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33949 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33950 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33951 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33952 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33953 abbreviations---for example:
33954
33955 @smallexample
33956 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33957 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33958 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33959 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33960 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33961 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33962 % sh config.sub sun4
33963 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33964 % sh config.sub sun3
33965 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33966 % sh config.sub i986v
33967 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33968 @end smallexample
33969
33970 @noindent
33971 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33972 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33973
33974 @node Configure Options
33975 @section @file{configure} Options
33976
33977 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33978 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33979 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33980 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33981
33982 @smallexample
33983 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33984 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33985 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33986 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33987 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33988 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33989 @var{host}
33990 @end smallexample
33991
33992 @noindent
33993 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33994 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33995 @samp{--}.
33996
33997 @table @code
33998 @item --help
33999 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34000
34001 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34002 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34003 @file{@var{dir}}.
34004
34005 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34006 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34007 @file{@var{dir}}.
34008
34009 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34010 @need 2000
34011 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34012 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34013 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34014 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34015 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34016 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34017 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34018 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34019 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34020 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34021 @var{dirname}.
34022
34023 @item --norecursion
34024 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34025 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34026
34027 @item --target=@var{target}
34028 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34029 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34030 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34031
34032 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34033
34034 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34035 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34036
34037 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34038 @end table
34039
34040 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34041 needed for special purposes only.
34042
34043 @node System-wide configuration
34044 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34045 @cindex system-wide init file
34046
34047 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34048 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34049 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34050
34051 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34052
34053 @table @code
34054 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34055 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34056 @var{file}.
34057 @end table
34058
34059 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34060 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34061
34062 @itemize @bullet
34063 @item
34064 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34065 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34066 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34067 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34068 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34069 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34070
34071 @item
34072 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34073 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34074 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34075 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34076 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34077 @end itemize
34078
34079 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34080 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34081 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34082 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34083 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34084 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34085 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34086 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34087 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34088 reread.
34089
34090 @menu
34091 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34092 @end menu
34093
34094 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34095 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34096 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34097
34098 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34099 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34100 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34101 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34102 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34103 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34104
34105 The following scripts are currently available:
34106 @itemize @bullet
34107
34108 @item @file{elinos.py}
34109 @pindex elinos.py
34110 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34111 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34112 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34113 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34114 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34115 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34116
34117 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34118 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34119 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34120 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34121 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34122 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34123
34124 @end itemize
34125
34126 @node Maintenance Commands
34127 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34128 @cindex maintenance commands
34129 @cindex internal commands
34130
34131 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34132 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34133 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34134 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34135 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34136
34137 @table @code
34138 @kindex maint agent
34139 @kindex maint agent-eval
34140 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34141 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34142 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34143 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34144 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34145 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34146 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34147 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34148 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34149 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34150 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34151 addition and return the sum.
34152 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34153 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34154
34155 @kindex maint agent-printf
34156 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34157 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34158 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34159 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34160 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34161
34162 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34163 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34164 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34165 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34166 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34167 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34168 is shown:
34169
34170 @table @code
34171 @item breakpoint
34172 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34173
34174 @item watchpoint
34175 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34176
34177 @item longjmp
34178 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34179 @code{longjmp} calls.
34180
34181 @item longjmp resume
34182 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34183
34184 @item until
34185 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34186
34187 @item finish
34188 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34189
34190 @item shlib events
34191 Shared library events.
34192
34193 @end table
34194
34195 @kindex maint info btrace
34196 @item maint info btrace
34197 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34198
34199 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34200 @item maint btrace packet-history
34201 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34202 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34203 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34204 recording format.
34205
34206 @table @code
34207 @item bts
34208 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34209 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34210
34211 @table @asis
34212 @item Block number
34213 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34214 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34215 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34216 @end table
34217
34218 @item pt
34219 For the Intel(R) Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34220 Intel(R) Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34221 information is printed:
34222
34223 @table @asis
34224 @item Packet number
34225 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34226 @item Trace offset
34227 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34228 @item Packet opcode and payload
34229 @end table
34230 @end table
34231
34232 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34233 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34234 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34235 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34236 needed.
34237
34238 @kindex maint btrace clear
34239 @item maint btrace clear
34240 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34241 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34242
34243 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34244 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34245 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34246 buffer.
34247
34248 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34249 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34250 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34251 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34252 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34253 packet history.
34254
34255 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34256 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34257 @cindex displaced stepping support
34258 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34259 @item set displaced-stepping
34260 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34261 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34262 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34263 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34264 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34265 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34266
34267 @table @code
34268 @item set displaced-stepping on
34269 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34270 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34271
34272 @item set displaced-stepping off
34273 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34274 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34275
34276 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34277 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34278 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34279 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34280 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34281 @end table
34282
34283 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34284 @item maint check-psymtabs
34285 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34286 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34287
34288 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34289 @item maint check-symtabs
34290 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34291
34292 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34293 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34294 Expand symbol tables.
34295 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34296 names matching @var{regexp}.
34297
34298 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34299 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34300 @cindex demangler crashes
34301 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34302 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34303 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34304 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34305 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34306 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34307 option to terminate the current session.
34308
34309 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34310 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34311 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34312
34313 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34314 @item maint cplus namespace
34315 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34316
34317 @kindex maint deprecate
34318 @kindex maint undeprecate
34319 @cindex deprecated commands
34320 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34321 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34322 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34323 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34324 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34325 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34326 the replacement as part of the warning.
34327
34328 @kindex maint dump-me
34329 @item maint dump-me
34330 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34331 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34332 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34333 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34334
34335 @kindex maint internal-error
34336 @kindex maint internal-warning
34337 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34338 @cindex demangler crashes
34339 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34340 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34341 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34342
34343 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34344 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34345 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34346 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34347 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34348 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34349 @value{GDBN} session.
34350
34351 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34352 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34353
34354 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34355
34356 @smallexample
34357 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34358 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34359 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34360 debugging may prove unreliable.
34361 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34362 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34363 (@value{GDBP})
34364 @end smallexample
34365
34366 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34367 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34368 @cindex demangler crashes
34369
34370 @kindex maint set internal-error
34371 @kindex maint show internal-error
34372 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34373 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34374 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34375 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34376 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34377 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34378 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34379 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34380 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34381 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34382 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34383 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34384 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34385 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34386 described in the table below.
34387
34388 @table @samp
34389 @item quit
34390 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34391 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34392
34393 @item corefile
34394 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34395 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34396 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34397 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34398 disabled.
34399 @end table
34400
34401 @kindex maint packet
34402 @item maint packet @var{text}
34403 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34404 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34405 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34406 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34407 checksum.
34408
34409 @kindex maint print architecture
34410 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34411 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34412 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34413
34414 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34415 @item maint print c-tdesc
34416 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34417 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34418 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34419
34420 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34421 @item maint print dummy-frames
34422 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34423
34424 @smallexample
34425 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34426 @dots{}
34427 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34428 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34429 58 return (a + b);
34430 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34431 @dots{}
34432 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34433 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34434 (@value{GDBP})
34435 @end smallexample
34436
34437 Takes an optional file parameter.
34438
34439 @kindex maint print registers
34440 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34441 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34442 @kindex maint print register-groups
34443 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34444 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34445 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34446 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34447 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34448 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34449 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34450
34451 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34452 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34453 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34454 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34455 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34456 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34457 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34458 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34459
34460 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34461 write the information.
34462
34463 @kindex maint print reggroups
34464 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34465 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34466 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34467 information.
34468
34469 The register groups info looks like this:
34470
34471 @smallexample
34472 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34473 Group Type
34474 general user
34475 float user
34476 all user
34477 vector user
34478 system user
34479 save internal
34480 restore internal
34481 @end smallexample
34482
34483 @kindex flushregs
34484 @item flushregs
34485 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34486
34487 @kindex maint print objfiles
34488 @cindex info for known object files
34489 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34490 Print a dump of all known object files.
34491 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34492 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34493 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34494
34495 @kindex maint print user-registers
34496 @cindex user registers
34497 @item maint print user-registers
34498 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34499 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34500 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34501 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34502 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34503 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34504 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34505
34506 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34507 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34508 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34509 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34510 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34511 matching @var{regexp}.
34512 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34513 and the full path if known.
34514 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34515
34516 @kindex maint print statistics
34517 @cindex bcache statistics
34518 @item maint print statistics
34519 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34520 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34521 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34522 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34523 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34524 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34525 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34526 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34527 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34528 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34529 lengths.
34530
34531 @kindex maint print target-stack
34532 @cindex target stack description
34533 @item maint print target-stack
34534 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34535 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34536 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34537 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34538 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34539 address.
34540
34541 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34542 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34543
34544 @kindex maint print type
34545 @cindex type chain of a data type
34546 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34547 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34548 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34549 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34550 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34551 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34552
34553 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34554 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34555 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34556 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34557 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34558 information.
34559
34560 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34561 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34562 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34563 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34564 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34565 always see the disassembly form.
34566
34567 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34568
34569 @smallexample
34570 (gdb) info addr argc
34571 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34572 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34573 @end smallexample
34574
34575 For more information on these expressions, see
34576 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34577
34578 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34579 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34580 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34581 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34582 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34583
34584 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34585 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34586 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34587 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34588 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34589 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34590 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34591 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34592 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34593
34594 @kindex maint set profile
34595 @kindex maint show profile
34596 @cindex profiling GDB
34597 @item maint set profile
34598 @itemx maint show profile
34599 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34600
34601 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34602 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34603 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34604 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34605 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34606 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34607 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34608
34609 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34610 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34611
34612 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34613 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34614 @cindex hardware debug registers
34615 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34616 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34617 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34618 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34619 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34620 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34621 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34622
34623 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34624 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34625 @item maint set show-all-tib
34626 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34627 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34628 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34629 command.
34630
34631 @kindex maint set target-async
34632 @kindex maint show target-async
34633 @item maint set target-async
34634 @itemx maint show target-async
34635 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34636 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34637 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34638 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34639
34640 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34641 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34642 @item maint set target-non-stop
34643 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34644
34645 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34646 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34647 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34648 if supported by the target.
34649
34650 @table @code
34651 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34652 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34653 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34654
34655 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34656 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34657 does not indicate support.
34658
34659 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34660 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34661 target supports it.
34662 @end table
34663
34664 @kindex maint set per-command
34665 @kindex maint show per-command
34666 @item maint set per-command
34667 @itemx maint show per-command
34668 @cindex resources used by commands
34669
34670 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34671 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34672
34673 @table @code
34674 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34675 @itemx maint show per-command space
34676 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34677 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34678 took, following the command's own output.
34679 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34680 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34681
34682 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34683 @itemx maint show per-command time
34684 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34685 for each command.
34686 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34687 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34688 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34689 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34690 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34691 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34692 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34693 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34694 spent by the program been debugged.
34695 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34696 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34697
34698 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34699 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34700 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34701 for each command.
34702 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34703
34704 @enumerate a
34705 @item
34706 number of symbol tables
34707 @item
34708 number of primary symbol tables
34709 @item
34710 number of blocks in the blockvector
34711 @end enumerate
34712 @end table
34713
34714 @kindex maint space
34715 @cindex memory used by commands
34716 @item maint space @var{value}
34717 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34718 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34719
34720 @kindex maint time
34721 @cindex time of command execution
34722 @item maint time @var{value}
34723 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34724 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34725
34726 @kindex maint translate-address
34727 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34728 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34729 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34730 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34731 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34732 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34733 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34734
34735 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34736 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34737 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34738
34739 @end table
34740
34741 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34742 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34743
34744 @table @code
34745 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34746 @kindex set watchdog
34747 @cindex watchdog timer
34748 @cindex timeout for commands
34749 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34750 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34751 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34752
34753 @item show watchdog
34754 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34755 @end table
34756
34757 @node Remote Protocol
34758 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34759
34760 @menu
34761 * Overview::
34762 * Packets::
34763 * Stop Reply Packets::
34764 * General Query Packets::
34765 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34766 * Tracepoint Packets::
34767 * Host I/O Packets::
34768 * Interrupts::
34769 * Notification Packets::
34770 * Remote Non-Stop::
34771 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34772 * Examples::
34773 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34774 * Library List Format::
34775 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34776 * Memory Map Format::
34777 * Thread List Format::
34778 * Traceframe Info Format::
34779 * Branch Trace Format::
34780 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34781 @end menu
34782
34783 @node Overview
34784 @section Overview
34785
34786 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34787 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34788 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34789 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34790
34791 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34792 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34793
34794 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34795 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34796 @cindex remote serial protocol
34797 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34798 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34799 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34800 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34801 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34802
34803 @smallexample
34804 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34805 @end smallexample
34806 @noindent
34807
34808 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34809 @noindent
34810 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34811 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34812 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34813
34814 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34815 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34816
34817 @smallexample
34818 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34819 @end smallexample
34820
34821 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34822 @noindent
34823 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34824 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34825 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34826
34827 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34828 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34829 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34830 retransmission):
34831
34832 @smallexample
34833 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34834 <- @code{+}
34835 @end smallexample
34836 @noindent
34837
34838 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34839 once a connection is established.
34840 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34841
34842 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34843 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34844 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34845 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34846 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34847 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34848 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34849
34850 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34851 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34852 exceptions).
34853
34854 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34855 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34856 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34857 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34858
34859 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34860 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34861 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34862
34863 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34864 @anchor{Binary Data}
34865 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34866 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34867 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34868 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34869 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34870 binary data.
34871
34872 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34873 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34874 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34875 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34876 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34877 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34878 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34879 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34880 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34881 (described next).
34882
34883 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34884 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34885 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34886 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34887 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34888 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34889 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34890 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34891 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34892 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34893 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34894 3}} more times.
34895
34896 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34897 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34898 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34899 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34900 @samp{0*"00}.
34901
34902 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34903 error number. That number is not well defined.
34904
34905 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34906 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34907 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34908 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34909 on that response.
34910
34911 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34912 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34913 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34914 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34915 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34916 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34917
34918 @node Packets
34919 @section Packets
34920
34921 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34922 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34923 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34924 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34925
34926 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34927 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34928 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34929 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34930 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34931 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34932 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34933 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34934 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34935 @var{baz}.
34936
34937 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34938 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34939 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34940 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34941 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34942 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34943 pick any thread.
34944
34945 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34946 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34947 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34948 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34949 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34950 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34951 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34952 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34953 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34954 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34955 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34956 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34957 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34958
34959 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34960 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34961 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34962 more information.
34963
34964 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34965 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34966
34967 Here are the packet descriptions.
34968
34969 @table @samp
34970
34971 @item !
34972 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34973 @anchor{extended mode}
34974 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34975 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34976 debugged.
34977
34978 Reply:
34979 @table @samp
34980 @item OK
34981 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34982 @end table
34983
34984 @item ?
34985 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34986 @anchor{? packet}
34987 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34988 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34989 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34990
34991 Reply:
34992 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34993
34994 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34995 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34996 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34997 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34998 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34999
35000 Reply:
35001 @table @samp
35002 @item OK
35003 The arguments were set.
35004 @item E @var{NN}
35005 An error occurred.
35006 @end table
35007
35008 @item b @var{baud}
35009 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35010 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35011 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35012
35013 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35014 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35015 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35016
35017 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35018 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35019 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35020 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35021 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35022
35023 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35024 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35025 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35026 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35027
35028 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35029 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35030
35031 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35032 @anchor{bc}
35033 @item bc
35034 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35035 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35036
35037 Reply:
35038 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35039
35040 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35041 @anchor{bs}
35042 @item bs
35043 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35044 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35045
35046 Reply:
35047 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35048
35049 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35050 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35051 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35052 is omitted, resume at current address.
35053
35054 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35055 packet}.
35056
35057 Reply:
35058 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35059
35060 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35061 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35062 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35063 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35064
35065 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35066 packet}.
35067
35068 Reply:
35069 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35070
35071 @item d
35072 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35073 Toggle debug flag.
35074
35075 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35076 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35077
35078 @item D
35079 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35080 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35081 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35082 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35083 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35084
35085 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35086 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35087 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35088 big-endian hex string.
35089
35090 Reply:
35091 @table @samp
35092 @item OK
35093 for success
35094 @item E @var{NN}
35095 for an error
35096 @end table
35097
35098 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35099 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35100 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35101 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35102 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35103
35104 @item g
35105 @anchor{read registers packet}
35106 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35107 Read general registers.
35108
35109 Reply:
35110 @table @samp
35111 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35112 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35113 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35114 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35115 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35116 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
35117 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35118
35119 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35120 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35121 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35122 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35123 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35124 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35125 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35126 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35127
35128 @smallexample
35129 -> @code{g}
35130 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35131 @end smallexample
35132
35133 @item E @var{NN}
35134 for an error.
35135 @end table
35136
35137 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35138 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35139 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35140 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35141
35142 Reply:
35143 @table @samp
35144 @item OK
35145 for success
35146 @item E @var{NN}
35147 for an error
35148 @end table
35149
35150 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35151 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35152 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35153 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35154 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35155 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35156 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35157 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35158 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35159
35160 Reply:
35161 @table @samp
35162 @item OK
35163 for success
35164 @item E @var{NN}
35165 for an error
35166 @end table
35167
35168 @c FIXME: JTC:
35169 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35170 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35171 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35172 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35173 @c described. For example:
35174 @c
35175 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35176 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35177 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35178 @c
35179 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35180 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35181 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35182
35183 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35184 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35185 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35186 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35187 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35188 step starting at that address.
35189
35190 @item I
35191 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35192 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35193 step packet}.
35194
35195 @item k
35196 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35197 Kill request.
35198
35199 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35200
35201 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35202 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35203
35204 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35205
35206 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35207 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35208 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35209
35210 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35211 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35212 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35213
35214 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35215 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35216 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35217 (@pxref{? packet}).
35218
35219 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35220 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35221 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35222 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35223 any particular boundary.
35224
35225 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35226 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35227 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35228 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35229 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35230 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35231 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35232 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35233
35234 Reply:
35235 @table @samp
35236 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35237 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35238 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35239 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35240 @item E @var{NN}
35241 @var{NN} is errno
35242 @end table
35243
35244 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35245 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35246 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35247 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35248 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35249
35250 Reply:
35251 @table @samp
35252 @item OK
35253 for success
35254 @item E @var{NN}
35255 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35256 written).
35257 @end table
35258
35259 @item p @var{n}
35260 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35261 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35262 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35263 register value is encoded.
35264
35265 Reply:
35266 @table @samp
35267 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35268 the register's value
35269 @item E @var{NN}
35270 for an error
35271 @item @w{}
35272 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35273 @end table
35274
35275 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35276 @anchor{write register packet}
35277 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35278 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35279 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35280 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35281
35282 Reply:
35283 @table @samp
35284 @item OK
35285 for success
35286 @item E @var{NN}
35287 for an error
35288 @end table
35289
35290 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35291 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35292 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35293 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35294 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35295 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35296
35297 @item r
35298 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35299 Reset the entire system.
35300
35301 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35302
35303 @item R @var{XX}
35304 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35305 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35306 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35307
35308 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35309
35310 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35311 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35312 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35313 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35314
35315 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35316 packet}.
35317
35318 Reply:
35319 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35320
35321 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35322 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35323 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35324 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35325 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35326
35327 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35328 packet}.
35329
35330 Reply:
35331 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35332
35333 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35334 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35335 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35336 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35337 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35338
35339 @item T @var{thread-id}
35340 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35341 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35342
35343 Reply:
35344 @table @samp
35345 @item OK
35346 thread is still alive
35347 @item E @var{NN}
35348 thread is dead
35349 @end table
35350
35351 @item v
35352 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35353 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35354
35355 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35356 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35357 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35358 The process ID is a
35359 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35360 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35361 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35362
35363 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35364 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35365 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35366 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35367 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35368 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35369 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35370 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35371
35372 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35373
35374 Reply:
35375 @table @samp
35376 @item E @var{nn}
35377 for an error
35378 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35379 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35380 @item OK
35381 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35382 @end table
35383
35384 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35385 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35386 @anchor{vCont packet}
35387 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35388 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35389 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35390 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35391 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35392 Specifying multiple
35393 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35394 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35395
35396 Currently supported actions are:
35397
35398 @table @samp
35399 @item c
35400 Continue.
35401 @item C @var{sig}
35402 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35403 @item s
35404 Step.
35405 @item S @var{sig}
35406 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35407 @item t
35408 Stop.
35409 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35410 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35411 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35412 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35413 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35414 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35415
35416 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35417 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35418 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35419 jumps to @var{start}).
35420
35421 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35422 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35423 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35424
35425 @end table
35426
35427 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35428 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35429 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35430
35431 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35432 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35433 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35434 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35435 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35436 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35437 as an implementation detail.
35438
35439 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35440 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35441 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35442 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35443 @var{thread-id}.
35444
35445 Reply:
35446 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35447
35448 @item vCont?
35449 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35450 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35451
35452 Reply:
35453 @table @samp
35454 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35455 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35456 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35457 @item @w{}
35458 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35459 @end table
35460
35461 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35462 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35463 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35464 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35465
35466 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35467 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35468 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35469 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35470 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35471 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35472 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35473 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35474 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35475 packet is received.
35476
35477 Reply:
35478 @table @samp
35479 @item OK
35480 for success
35481 @item E @var{NN}
35482 for an error
35483 @end table
35484
35485 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35486 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35487 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35488 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35489 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35490 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35491 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35492 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35493 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35494 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35495 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35496 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35497
35498
35499 Reply:
35500 @table @samp
35501 @item OK
35502 for success
35503 @item E.memtype
35504 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35505 @item E @var{NN}
35506 for an error
35507 @end table
35508
35509 @item vFlashDone
35510 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35511 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35512 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35513 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35514 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35515 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35516 request is completed.
35517
35518 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35519 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35520 @anchor{vKill packet}
35521 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35522 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35523 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35524 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35525
35526 Reply:
35527 @table @samp
35528 @item E @var{nn}
35529 for an error
35530 @item OK
35531 for success
35532 @end table
35533
35534 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35535 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35536 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35537 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35538 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35539 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35540 state.
35541
35542 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35543
35544 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35545
35546 Reply:
35547 @table @samp
35548 @item E @var{nn}
35549 for an error
35550 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35551 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35552 @end table
35553
35554 @item vStopped
35555 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35556 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35557
35558 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35559 @anchor{X packet}
35560 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35561 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35562 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35563 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35564 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35565
35566 Reply:
35567 @table @samp
35568 @item OK
35569 for success
35570 @item E @var{NN}
35571 for an error
35572 @end table
35573
35574 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35575 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35576 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35577 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35578 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35579 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35580 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35581
35582 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35583 separately.
35584
35585 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35586 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35587 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35588 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35589 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35590 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35591
35592 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35593 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35594 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35595 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35596 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35597 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35598
35599 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35600 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35601 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35602 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35603 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35604 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35605 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35606 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35607 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35608 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35609
35610 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35611 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35612
35613 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35614 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35615
35616 @table @samp
35617
35618 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35619 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35620 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35621
35622 @end table
35623
35624 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35625 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35626 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35627 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35628 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35629 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35630 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35631
35632 @table @samp
35633
35634 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35635 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35636 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35637
35638 @end table
35639
35640 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35641
35642 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35643 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35644 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35645 target, is not defined.}
35646
35647 Reply:
35648 @table @samp
35649 @item OK
35650 success
35651 @item @w{}
35652 not supported
35653 @item E @var{NN}
35654 for an error
35655 @end table
35656
35657 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35658 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35659 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35660 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35661 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35662 address @var{addr}.
35663
35664 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35665 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35666 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35667
35668 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35669 movement.}
35670
35671 Reply:
35672 @table @samp
35673 @item OK
35674 success
35675 @item @w{}
35676 not supported
35677 @item E @var{NN}
35678 for an error
35679 @end table
35680
35681 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35682 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35683 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35684 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35685 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35686 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35687
35688 Reply:
35689 @table @samp
35690 @item OK
35691 success
35692 @item @w{}
35693 not supported
35694 @item E @var{NN}
35695 for an error
35696 @end table
35697
35698 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35699 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35700 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35701 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35702 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35703 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35704
35705 Reply:
35706 @table @samp
35707 @item OK
35708 success
35709 @item @w{}
35710 not supported
35711 @item E @var{NN}
35712 for an error
35713 @end table
35714
35715 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35716 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35717 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35718 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35719 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35720 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35721
35722 Reply:
35723 @table @samp
35724 @item OK
35725 success
35726 @item @w{}
35727 not supported
35728 @item E @var{NN}
35729 for an error
35730 @end table
35731
35732 @end table
35733
35734 @node Stop Reply Packets
35735 @section Stop Reply Packets
35736 @cindex stop reply packets
35737
35738 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35739 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35740 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35741 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35742 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35743 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35744 @value{GDBN} source code.
35745
35746 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35747 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35748 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35749 components.
35750
35751 @table @samp
35752
35753 @item S @var{AA}
35754 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35755 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35756 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35757
35758 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35759 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35760 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35761 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35762 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35763 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35764 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35765 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35766
35767 @itemize @bullet
35768 @item
35769 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35770 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35771 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35772 two-digit hex number.
35773
35774 @item
35775 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35776 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35777
35778 @item
35779 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35780 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35781
35782 @item
35783 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35784 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35785 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35786 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35787
35788 @item
35789 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35790 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35791 future.
35792 @end itemize
35793
35794 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35795
35796 @table @samp
35797 @item watch
35798 @itemx rwatch
35799 @itemx awatch
35800 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35801 hex.
35802
35803 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35804 @item library
35805 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35806 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35807 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35808
35809 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35810 @item replaylog
35811 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35812 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35813 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35814 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35815 for more information.
35816
35817 @item swbreak
35818 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35819 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35820 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35821 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35822 part must be left empty.
35823
35824 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35825 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35826 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35827 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35828 address.
35829
35830 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35831 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35832 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35833 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35834 indicating support.
35835
35836 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35837
35838 @item hwbreak
35839 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35840 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35841
35842 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35843 apply.
35844
35845 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35846 @item fork
35847 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35848 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35849 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35850 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35851 fork events.
35852
35853 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35854 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35855 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35856 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35857 indicating support.
35858
35859 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35860 @item vfork
35861 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35862 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35863 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35864 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35865 vfork events.
35866
35867 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35868 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35869 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35870 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35871 indicating support.
35872
35873 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35874 @item vforkdone
35875 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35876 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35877 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35878 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35879 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35880
35881 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35882 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35883 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35884 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35885 indicating support.
35886
35887 @end table
35888
35889 @item W @var{AA}
35890 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35891 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35892 applicable to certain targets.
35893
35894 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35895 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35896 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35897 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35898
35899 @item X @var{AA}
35900 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35901 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35902
35903 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35904 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35905 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35906 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35907
35908 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35909 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35910 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35911 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35912 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35913
35914 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35915 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35916 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35917 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35918 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35919 system calls.
35920
35921 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35922 this very system call.
35923
35924 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35925 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35926 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35927 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35928 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35929 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35930
35931 @end table
35932
35933 @node General Query Packets
35934 @section General Query Packets
35935 @cindex remote query requests
35936
35937 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35938 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35939 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35940 sending information to and from the stub.
35941
35942 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35943 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35944 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35945 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35946 conventions:
35947
35948 @itemize @bullet
35949 @item
35950 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35951 @item
35952 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35953 letter.
35954 @item
35955 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35956 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35957 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35958 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35959 @end itemize
35960
35961 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35962 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35963 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35964 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35965 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35966 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35967 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35968 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35969 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35970 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35971 packet.}.
35972
35973 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35974 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35975 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35976 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35977 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35978
35979 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35980
35981 @table @samp
35982
35983 @item QAgent:1
35984 @itemx QAgent:0
35985 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35986 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35987
35988 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35989 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35990 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35991 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35992 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35993 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35994 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35995 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35996 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35997 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35998 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35999
36000 @item qC
36001 @cindex current thread, remote request
36002 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36003 Return the current thread ID.
36004
36005 Reply:
36006 @table @samp
36007 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36008 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36009 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36010 @item @r{(anything else)}
36011 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36012 @end table
36013
36014 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36015 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36016 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36017 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36018 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36019 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36020 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36021 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36022
36023 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36024 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36025 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36026 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36027 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36028 detect trailing zeros.
36029
36030 Reply:
36031 @table @samp
36032 @item E @var{NN}
36033 An error (such as memory fault)
36034 @item C @var{crc32}
36035 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36036 @end table
36037
36038 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36039 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36040 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36041 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36042 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36043 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36044 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36045 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36046 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36047 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36048 randomization.
36049
36050 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36051
36052 Reply:
36053 @table @samp
36054 @item OK
36055 The request succeeded.
36056
36057 @item E @var{nn}
36058 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36059
36060 @item @w{}
36061 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36062 by the stub.
36063 @end table
36064
36065 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36066 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36067 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36068 address space randomization.
36069
36070 @item qfThreadInfo
36071 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36072 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36073 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36074 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36075 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36076 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36077 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36078 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36079 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36080 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36081
36082 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36083
36084 Reply:
36085 @table @samp
36086 @item m @var{thread-id}
36087 A single thread ID
36088 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36089 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36090 @item l
36091 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36092 @end table
36093
36094 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36095 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36096 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36097 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36098 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36099 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36100 fields.
36101
36102 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36103 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36104 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36105 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36106 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36107
36108 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36109 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36110 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36111 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36112 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36113
36114 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36115 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36116
36117 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36118 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36119 information associated with the variable.)
36120
36121 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36122 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36123 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36124 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36125 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36126 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36127
36128 Reply:
36129 @table @samp
36130 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36131 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36132 local storage requested.
36133
36134 @item E @var{nn}
36135 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36136
36137 @item @w{}
36138 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36139 @end table
36140
36141 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36142 @cindex get thread information block address
36143 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36144 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36145
36146 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36147
36148 Reply:
36149 @table @samp
36150 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36151 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36152 thread information block.
36153
36154 @item E @var{nn}
36155 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36156 address could not be retrieved.
36157
36158 @item @w{}
36159 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36160 @end table
36161
36162 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36163 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36164 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36165 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36166 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36167 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36168 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36169
36170 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36171
36172 Reply:
36173 @table @samp
36174 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36175 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36176 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36177 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36178 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36179 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36180 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36181 @end table
36182
36183 @item qOffsets
36184 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36185 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36186 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36187 image.
36188
36189 Reply:
36190 @table @samp
36191 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36192 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36193 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36194 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36195 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36196 segments by the supplied offsets.
36197
36198 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36199 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36200 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36201
36202 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36203 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36204 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36205 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36206 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36207 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36208 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36209 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36210 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36211 @end table
36212
36213 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36214 @cindex thread information, remote request
36215 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36216 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36217 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36218 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36219
36220 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36221 (see below).
36222
36223 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36224
36225 @item QNonStop:1
36226 @itemx QNonStop:0
36227 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36228 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36229 @anchor{QNonStop}
36230 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36231 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36232
36233 Reply:
36234 @table @samp
36235 @item OK
36236 The request succeeded.
36237
36238 @item E @var{nn}
36239 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36240
36241 @item @w{}
36242 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36243 the stub.
36244 @end table
36245
36246 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36247 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36248 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36249 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36250
36251 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36252 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36253 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36254 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36255 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36256 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36257 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36258 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36259 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36260 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36261 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36262 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36263 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36264
36265 Reply:
36266 @table @samp
36267 @item OK
36268 The request succeeded.
36269
36270 @item E @var{nn}
36271 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36272
36273 @item @w{}
36274 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36275 the stub.
36276 @end table
36277
36278 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36279 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36280 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36281 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36282
36283 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36284 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36285 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36286 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36287 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36288 Others should be silently discarded.
36289
36290 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36291 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36292 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36293 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36294 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36295 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36296 signals.
36297
36298 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36299 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36300
36301 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36302 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36303 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36304 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36305 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36306
36307 Reply:
36308 @table @samp
36309 @item OK
36310 The request succeeded.
36311
36312 @item E @var{nn}
36313 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36314
36315 @item @w{}
36316 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36317 by the stub.
36318 @end table
36319
36320 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36321 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36322 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36323 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36324
36325 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36326 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36327 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36328 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36329 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36330 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36331 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36332 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36333 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36334
36335 Reply:
36336 @table @samp
36337 @item OK
36338 A command response with no output.
36339 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36340 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36341 @item E @var{NN}
36342 Indicate a badly formed request.
36343 @item @w{}
36344 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36345 @end table
36346
36347 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36348 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36349 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36350 packets.)
36351
36352 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36353 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36354 @ifnotinfo
36355 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36356 @end ifnotinfo
36357 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36358 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36359 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36360 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36361 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36362
36363 Reply:
36364 @table @samp
36365 @item 0
36366 The pattern was not found.
36367 @item 1,address
36368 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36369 @item E @var{NN}
36370 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36371 @item @w{}
36372 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36373 @end table
36374
36375 @item QStartNoAckMode
36376 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36377 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36378 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36379 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36380
36381 Reply:
36382 @table @samp
36383 @item OK
36384 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36385 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36386 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36387 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36388 @item @w{}
36389 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36390 @end table
36391
36392 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36393 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36394 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36395 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36396 @anchor{qSupported}
36397 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36398 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36399 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36400 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36401 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36402 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36403 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36404 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36405 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36406 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36407 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36408 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36409 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36410 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36411
36412 Reply:
36413 @table @samp
36414 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36415 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36416 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36417 possible forms).
36418 @item @w{}
36419 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36420 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36421 @end table
36422
36423 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36424 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36425 are:
36426
36427 @table @samp
36428 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36429 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36430 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36431 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36432 @item @var{name}+
36433 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36434 need an associated value.
36435 @item @var{name}-
36436 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36437 @item @var{name}?
36438 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36439 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36440 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36441 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36442 @end table
36443
36444 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36445 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36446 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36447 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36448 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36449
36450 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36451 are defined:
36452
36453 @table @samp
36454 @item multiprocess
36455 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36456 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36457 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36458 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36459 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36460
36461 @item xmlRegisters
36462 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36463 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36464 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36465 description.
36466
36467 @item qRelocInsn
36468 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36469 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36470 instruction reply packet}).
36471
36472 @item swbreak
36473 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36474 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36475
36476 @item hwbreak
36477 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36478 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36479
36480 @item fork-events
36481 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36482 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36483 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36484 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36485
36486 @item vfork-events
36487 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36488 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36489 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36490 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36491 @end table
36492
36493 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36494 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36495 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36496 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36497 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36498 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36499 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36500 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36501 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36502 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36503 all the features it supports.
36504
36505 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36506 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36507
36508 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36509 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36510 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36511 form response.
36512
36513 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36514 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36515 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36516 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36517
36518 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36519 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36520 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36521 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36522 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36523
36524 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36525
36526 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36527 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36528 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36529 @item Feature Name
36530 @tab Value Required
36531 @tab Default
36532 @tab Probe Allowed
36533
36534 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36535 @tab Yes
36536 @tab @samp{-}
36537 @tab No
36538
36539 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36540 @tab No
36541 @tab @samp{-}
36542 @tab Yes
36543
36544 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36545 @tab No
36546 @tab @samp{-}
36547 @tab Yes
36548
36549 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36550 @tab No
36551 @tab @samp{-}
36552 @tab Yes
36553
36554 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36555 @tab No
36556 @tab @samp{-}
36557 @tab Yes
36558
36559 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36560 @tab No
36561 @tab @samp{-}
36562 @tab Yes
36563
36564 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36565 @tab No
36566 @tab @samp{-}
36567 @tab Yes
36568
36569 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36570 @tab No
36571 @tab @samp{-}
36572 @tab Yes
36573
36574 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36575 @tab No
36576 @tab @samp{-}
36577 @tab No
36578
36579 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36580 @tab No
36581 @tab @samp{-}
36582 @tab Yes
36583
36584 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36585 @tab No
36586 @tab @samp{-}
36587 @tab Yes
36588
36589 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36590 @tab No
36591 @tab @samp{-}
36592 @tab Yes
36593
36594 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36595 @tab No
36596 @tab @samp{-}
36597 @tab Yes
36598
36599 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36600 @tab No
36601 @tab @samp{-}
36602 @tab Yes
36603
36604 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36605 @tab No
36606 @tab @samp{-}
36607 @tab Yes
36608
36609 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36610 @tab No
36611 @tab @samp{-}
36612 @tab Yes
36613
36614 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36615 @tab No
36616 @tab @samp{-}
36617 @tab Yes
36618
36619 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36620 @tab No
36621 @tab @samp{-}
36622 @tab Yes
36623
36624 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36625 @tab No
36626 @tab @samp{-}
36627 @tab Yes
36628
36629 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36630 @tab Yes
36631 @tab @samp{-}
36632 @tab Yes
36633
36634 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36635 @tab Yes
36636 @tab @samp{-}
36637 @tab Yes
36638
36639 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36640 @tab Yes
36641 @tab @samp{-}
36642 @tab Yes
36643
36644 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36645 @tab Yes
36646 @tab @samp{-}
36647 @tab Yes
36648
36649 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36650 @tab Yes
36651 @tab @samp{-}
36652 @tab Yes
36653
36654 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36655 @tab No
36656 @tab @samp{-}
36657 @tab Yes
36658
36659 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36660 @tab No
36661 @tab @samp{-}
36662 @tab Yes
36663
36664 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36665 @tab No
36666 @tab @samp{-}
36667 @tab Yes
36668
36669 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36670 @tab No
36671 @tab @samp{-}
36672 @tab No
36673
36674 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36675 @tab No
36676 @tab @samp{-}
36677 @tab No
36678
36679 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36680 @tab No
36681 @tab @samp{-}
36682 @tab No
36683
36684 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36685 @tab No
36686 @tab @samp{-}
36687 @tab No
36688
36689 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36690 @tab No
36691 @tab @samp{-}
36692 @tab No
36693
36694 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36695 @tab No
36696 @tab @samp{-}
36697 @tab No
36698
36699 @item @samp{QAgent}
36700 @tab No
36701 @tab @samp{-}
36702 @tab No
36703
36704 @item @samp{QAllow}
36705 @tab No
36706 @tab @samp{-}
36707 @tab No
36708
36709 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36710 @tab No
36711 @tab @samp{-}
36712 @tab No
36713
36714 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36715 @tab No
36716 @tab @samp{-}
36717 @tab No
36718
36719 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36720 @tab No
36721 @tab @samp{-}
36722 @tab No
36723
36724 @item @samp{tracenz}
36725 @tab No
36726 @tab @samp{-}
36727 @tab No
36728
36729 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36730 @tab No
36731 @tab @samp{-}
36732 @tab No
36733
36734 @item @samp{swbreak}
36735 @tab No
36736 @tab @samp{-}
36737 @tab No
36738
36739 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36740 @tab No
36741 @tab @samp{-}
36742 @tab No
36743
36744 @item @samp{fork-events}
36745 @tab No
36746 @tab @samp{-}
36747 @tab No
36748
36749 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36750 @tab No
36751 @tab @samp{-}
36752 @tab No
36753
36754 @end multitable
36755
36756 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36757
36758 @table @samp
36759 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36760 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36761 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36762 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36763 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36764 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36765 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36766 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36767 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36768 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36769
36770 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36771 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36772 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36773
36774 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36775 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36776 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36777
36778 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36779 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36780 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36781
36782 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36783 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36784 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36785
36786 @item qXfer:features:read
36787 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36788 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36789
36790 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36791 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36792 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36793
36794 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36795 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36796 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36797
36798 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36799 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36800 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36801 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36802
36803 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36804 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36805 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36806
36807 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36808 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36809 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36810
36811 @item qXfer:spu:read
36812 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36813 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36814
36815 @item qXfer:spu:write
36816 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36817 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36818
36819 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36820 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36821 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36822
36823 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36824 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36825 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36826
36827 @item qXfer:threads:read
36828 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36829 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36830
36831 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36832 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36833 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36834
36835 @item qXfer:uib:read
36836 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36837 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36838
36839 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36840 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36841 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36842
36843 @item QNonStop
36844 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36845 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36846
36847 @item QPassSignals
36848 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36849 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36850
36851 @item QStartNoAckMode
36852 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36853 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36854
36855 @item multiprocess
36856 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36857 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36858 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36859 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36860 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36861 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36862 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36863 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36864 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36865 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36866 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36867
36868 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36869 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36870 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36871
36872 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36873 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36874 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36875 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36876
36877 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36878 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36879 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36880
36881 @item ReverseContinue
36882 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36883 (@pxref{bc}).
36884
36885 @item ReverseStep
36886 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36887 (@pxref{bs}).
36888
36889 @item TracepointSource
36890 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36891 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36892
36893 @item QAgent
36894 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36895
36896 @item QAllow
36897 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36898
36899 @item QDisableRandomization
36900 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36901
36902 @item StaticTracepoint
36903 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36904 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36905
36906 @item InstallInTrace
36907 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36908 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36909
36910 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36911 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36912 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36913 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36914
36915 @item QTBuffer:size
36916 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36917 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36918
36919 @item tracenz
36920 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36921 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36922 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36923
36924 @item BreakpointCommands
36925 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36926 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36927 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36928
36929 @item Qbtrace:off
36930 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36931
36932 @item Qbtrace:bts
36933 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36934
36935 @item Qbtrace:pt
36936 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
36937
36938 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36939 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36940
36941 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
36942 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
36943
36944 @item swbreak
36945 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36946 breakpoints.
36947
36948 @item hwbreak
36949 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36950 breakpoints.
36951
36952 @item fork-events
36953 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
36954
36955 @item vfork-events
36956 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
36957 and vforkdone events.
36958
36959 @end table
36960
36961 @item qSymbol::
36962 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36963 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36964 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36965 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36966
36967 Reply:
36968 @table @samp
36969 @item OK
36970 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36971 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36972 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36973 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36974 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36975 below.
36976 @end table
36977
36978 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36979 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36980
36981 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36982 target has previously requested.
36983
36984 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36985 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36986 will be empty.
36987
36988 Reply:
36989 @table @samp
36990 @item OK
36991 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36992 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36993 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36994 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36995 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36996 @end table
36997
36998 @item qTBuffer
36999 @itemx QTBuffer
37000 @itemx QTDisconnected
37001 @itemx QTDP
37002 @itemx QTDPsrc
37003 @itemx QTDV
37004 @itemx qTfP
37005 @itemx qTfV
37006 @itemx QTFrame
37007 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37008
37009 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37010
37011 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37012 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37013 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37014 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37015 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37016 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37017 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37018 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37019 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37020 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37021 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37022
37023 Reply:
37024 @table @samp
37025 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37026 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37027 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37028 the thread's attributes.
37029 @end table
37030
37031 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37032 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37033 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37034 packets.)
37035
37036 @item QTNotes
37037 @itemx qTP
37038 @itemx QTSave
37039 @itemx qTsP
37040 @itemx qTsV
37041 @itemx QTStart
37042 @itemx QTStop
37043 @itemx QTEnable
37044 @itemx QTDisable
37045 @itemx QTinit
37046 @itemx QTro
37047 @itemx qTStatus
37048 @itemx qTV
37049 @itemx qTfSTM
37050 @itemx qTsSTM
37051 @itemx qTSTMat
37052 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37053
37054 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37055 @cindex read special object, remote request
37056 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37057 @anchor{qXfer read}
37058 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37059 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37060 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37061 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37062 additional details about what data to access.
37063
37064 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37065 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37066 formats, listed below.
37067
37068 @table @samp
37069 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37070 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37071 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37072 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37073
37074 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37075 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37076
37077 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37078 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37079
37080 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37081 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37082 packet may have one of the following values:
37083
37084 @table @code
37085 @item all
37086 Returns all available branch trace.
37087
37088 @item new
37089 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37090 the last read request.
37091
37092 @item delta
37093 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37094 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37095 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37096 used to stitch traces together.
37097
37098 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37099 @end table
37100
37101 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37102 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37103
37104 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37105 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37106
37107 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37108 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37109
37110 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37111 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37112
37113 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37114 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37115 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37116 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37117 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37118 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37119 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37120
37121 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37122 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37123
37124 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37125 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37126 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37127 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37128 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37129
37130 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37131 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37132
37133 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37134 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37135 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37136 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37137 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37138
37139 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37140 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37141 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37142
37143 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37144 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37145
37146 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37147 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37148 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37149 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37150 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37151 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37152 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37153 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37154
37155 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37156 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37157
37158 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37159 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37160
37161 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37162 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37163 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37164 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37165
37166 @table @code
37167 @item start=@var{address}
37168 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37169 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37170 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37171 chosen as the starting point.
37172
37173 @item prev=@var{address}
37174 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37175 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37176 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37177 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37178 exists prior to the starting point.
37179
37180 @end table
37181
37182 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37183 ignored.
37184
37185 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37186 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37187 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37188 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37189 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37190
37191 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37192 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37193
37194 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37195 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37196
37197 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37198 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37199 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37200 Action Lists}.
37201
37202 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37203 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37204 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37205
37206 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37207 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37208 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37209 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37210 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37211
37212 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37213 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37214 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37215
37216 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37217 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37218 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37219 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37220 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37221 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37222 in that context to be accessed.
37223
37224 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37225 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37226 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37227
37228 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37229 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37230 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37231 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37232 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37233
37234 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37235 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37236
37237 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37238 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37239
37240 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37241 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37242 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37243
37244 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37245 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37246
37247 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37248 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37249
37250 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37251 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37252
37253 This packet is not probed by default.
37254
37255 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37256 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37257 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37258 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37259 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37260
37261 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37262 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37263
37264 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37265 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37266 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37267 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37268
37269 @end table
37270
37271 Reply:
37272 @table @samp
37273 @item m @var{data}
37274 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37275 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37276 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37277 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37278 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37279 request.
37280
37281 @item l @var{data}
37282 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37283 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37284 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37285
37286 @item l
37287 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37288 There is no more data to be read.
37289
37290 @item E00
37291 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37292
37293 @item E @var{nn}
37294 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37295 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37296
37297 @item @w{}
37298 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37299 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37300 @end table
37301
37302 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37303 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37304 @anchor{qXfer write}
37305 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37306 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37307 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37308 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37309 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37310 to access.
37311
37312 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37313 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37314 formats, listed below.
37315
37316 @table @samp
37317 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37318 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37319 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37320 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37321 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37322
37323 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37324 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37325 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37326
37327 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37328 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37329 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37330 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37331 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37332 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37333 in that context to be accessed.
37334
37335 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37336 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37337 @end table
37338
37339 Reply:
37340 @table @samp
37341 @item @var{nn}
37342 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37343 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37344
37345 @item E00
37346 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37347
37348 @item E @var{nn}
37349 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37350 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37351
37352 @item @w{}
37353 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37354 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37355 @end table
37356
37357 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37358 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37359 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37360 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37361 must respond with an empty packet.
37362
37363 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37364 @cindex query attached, remote request
37365 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37366 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37367 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37368 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37369 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37370 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37371 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37372
37373 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37374 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37375 the @code{quit} command.
37376
37377 Reply:
37378 @table @samp
37379 @item 1
37380 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37381 @item 0
37382 The remote server created a new process.
37383 @item E @var{NN}
37384 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37385 @end table
37386
37387 @item Qbtrace:bts
37388 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37389
37390 Reply:
37391 @table @samp
37392 @item OK
37393 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37394 @item E.errtext
37395 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37396 @end table
37397
37398 @item Qbtrace:pt
37399 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel(R) Processor Trace.
37400
37401 Reply:
37402 @table @samp
37403 @item OK
37404 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37405 @item E.errtext
37406 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37407 @end table
37408
37409 @item Qbtrace:off
37410 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37411
37412 Reply:
37413 @table @samp
37414 @item OK
37415 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37416 @item E.errtext
37417 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37418 @end table
37419
37420 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37421 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37422 btrace recording method in bts format.
37423
37424 Reply:
37425 @table @samp
37426 @item OK
37427 The ring buffer size has been set.
37428 @item E.errtext
37429 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37430 @end table
37431
37432 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37433 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37434 btrace recording method in pt format.
37435
37436 Reply:
37437 @table @samp
37438 @item OK
37439 The ring buffer size has been set.
37440 @item E.errtext
37441 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37442 @end table
37443
37444 @end table
37445
37446 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37447 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37448
37449 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37450 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37451 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37452
37453 @menu
37454 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37455 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37456 @end menu
37457
37458 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37459 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37460
37461 @menu
37462 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37463 @end menu
37464
37465 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37466 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37467 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37468
37469 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37470
37471 @table @r
37472
37473 @item 2
37474 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37475
37476 @item 3
37477 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37478
37479 @item 4
37480 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37481
37482 @end table
37483
37484 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37485 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37486
37487 @menu
37488 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37489 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37490 @end menu
37491
37492 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37493 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37494 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37495
37496 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37497 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37498 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37499 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37500 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37501 most-significant -- least-significant.
37502
37503 @table @r
37504
37505 @item MIPS32
37506 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37507 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37508 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37509
37510 @item MIPS64
37511 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37512 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37513 as @code{MIPS32}.
37514
37515 @end table
37516
37517 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37518 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37519 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37520
37521 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37522
37523 @table @r
37524
37525 @item 2
37526 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37527
37528 @item 3
37529 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37530
37531 @item 4
37532 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37533
37534 @item 5
37535 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37536
37537 @end table
37538
37539 @node Tracepoint Packets
37540 @section Tracepoint Packets
37541 @cindex tracepoint packets
37542 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37543
37544 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37545 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37546
37547 @table @samp
37548
37549 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37550 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37551 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37552 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37553 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37554 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37555 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37556 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37557 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37558 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37559 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37560 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37561 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37562 actions.
37563
37564 Replies:
37565 @table @samp
37566 @item OK
37567 The packet was understood and carried out.
37568 @item qRelocInsn
37569 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37570 @item @w{}
37571 The packet was not recognized.
37572 @end table
37573
37574 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37575 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37576 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37577 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37578 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37579 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37580 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37581
37582 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37583 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37584 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37585 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37586 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37587 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37588 tracepoint actions.
37589
37590 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37591 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37592 following forms:
37593
37594 @table @samp
37595
37596 @item R @var{mask}
37597 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37598 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37599 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37600 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37601 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37602
37603 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37604 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37605 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37606 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37607 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37608 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37609 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37610
37611 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37612 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37613 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37614 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37615 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37616 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37617 packet).
37618
37619 @end table
37620
37621 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37622 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37623 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37624 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37625 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37626 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37627 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37628 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37629
37630 Replies:
37631 @table @samp
37632 @item OK
37633 The packet was understood and carried out.
37634 @item qRelocInsn
37635 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37636 @item @w{}
37637 The packet was not recognized.
37638 @end table
37639
37640 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37641 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37642 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37643 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37644 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37645 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37646 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37647 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37648
37649 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37650 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37651 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37652 fit in a single packet.
37653 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37654 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37655
37656 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37657 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37658 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37659 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37660
37661 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37662 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37663 query packets.
37664
37665 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37666 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37667 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37668 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37669 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37670 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37671 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37672 be found.
37673
37674 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37675 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37676 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37677 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37678 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37679 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37680 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37681 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37682 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37683 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37684 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37685 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37686 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37687 variable.
37688
37689 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37690 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37691 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37692 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37693 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37694
37695 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37696 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37697 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37698 one of the following forms:
37699
37700 @table @samp
37701 @item F @var{f}
37702 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37703 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37704 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37705
37706 @item T @var{t}
37707 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37708 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37709
37710 @end table
37711
37712 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37713 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37714 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37715 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37716
37717 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37718 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37719 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37720 is a hexadecimal number.
37721
37722 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37723 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37724 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37725 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37726 numbers.
37727
37728 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37729 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37730 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37731
37732 @item qTMinFTPILen
37733 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37734 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37735 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37736 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37737 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37738 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37739 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37740 arrange for that.
37741
37742 Replies:
37743
37744 @table @samp
37745 @item 0
37746 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37747 @item @var{length}
37748 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37749 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37750 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37751 regardless of size.
37752 @item E
37753 An error has occurred.
37754 @item @w{}
37755 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37756 @end table
37757
37758 @item QTStart
37759 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37760 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37761 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37762 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37763 instruction reply packet}).
37764
37765 @item QTStop
37766 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37767 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37768
37769 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37770 @anchor{QTEnable}
37771 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37772 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37773 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37774 of data from it will resume.
37775
37776 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37777 @anchor{QTDisable}
37778 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37779 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37780 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37781 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37782
37783 @item QTinit
37784 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37785 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37786
37787 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37788 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37789 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37790 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37791 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37792
37793 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37794 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37795 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37796 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37797
37798 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37799 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37800 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37801 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37802 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37803 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37804
37805 @item qTStatus
37806 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37807 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37808
37809 The reply has the form:
37810
37811 @table @samp
37812
37813 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37814 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37815 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37816 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37817
37818 @end table
37819
37820 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37821 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37822
37823 @table @samp
37824
37825 @item tnotrun:0
37826 No trace has been run yet.
37827
37828 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37829 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37830 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37831 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37832 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37833
37834 @item tfull:0
37835 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37836
37837 @item tdisconnected:0
37838 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37839
37840 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37841 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37842
37843 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37844 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37845 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37846 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37847 is hex encoded.
37848
37849 @item tunknown:0
37850 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37851
37852 @end table
37853
37854 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37855 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37856 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37857 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37858 trace.
37859
37860 @table @samp
37861
37862 @item tframes:@var{n}
37863 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37864
37865 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37866 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37867 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37868
37869 @item tsize:@var{n}
37870 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37871
37872 @item tfree:@var{n}
37873 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37874
37875 @item circular:@var{n}
37876 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37877 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37878 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37879 and may fill up.
37880
37881 @item disconn:@var{n}
37882 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37883 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37884 that the trace run will stop.
37885
37886 @end table
37887
37888 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37889 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37890 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37891 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37892 address @var{addr}.
37893
37894 Replies:
37895 @table @samp
37896 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37897 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37898 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37899 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37900 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37901
37902 @end table
37903
37904 @item qTV:@var{var}
37905 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37906 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37907 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37908
37909 Replies:
37910 @table @samp
37911 @item V@var{value}
37912 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37913 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37914 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37915 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37916 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37917 program is running.
37918
37919 @item U
37920 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37921 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37922 was not collected.
37923 @end table
37924
37925 @item qTfP
37926 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37927 @itemx qTsP
37928 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37929 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37930 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37931 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37932 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37933 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37934
37935 @item qTfV
37936 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37937 @itemx qTsV
37938 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37939 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37940 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37941 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37942 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37943 trace state variables.
37944
37945 @item qTfSTM
37946 @itemx qTsSTM
37947 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37948 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37949 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37950 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37951 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37952 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37953 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37954 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37955
37956 Reply:
37957 @table @samp
37958 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37959 A single marker
37960 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37961 a comma-separated list of markers
37962 @item l
37963 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37964 @item E @var{nn}
37965 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37966 @item @w{}
37967 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37968 stub.
37969 @end table
37970
37971 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37972 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37973
37974 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37975 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37976 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37977 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37978 @dfn{last}).
37979
37980 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37981 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37982 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37983 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37984 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37985 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37986 tracepoint markers.
37987
37988 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37989 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37990 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37991 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37992 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37993 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37994
37995 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37996 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37997 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37998 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37999 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38000 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38001 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38002 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38003 available.
38004
38005 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38006 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38007 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38008
38009 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38010 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38011 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38012 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38013 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38014 use whatever size it prefers.
38015
38016 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38017 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38018 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38019 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38020 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38021
38022 @end table
38023
38024 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38025 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38026 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38027 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38028 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38029 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38030 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38031 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38032 it had executed in the original location.
38033
38034 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38035 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38036 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38037 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38038 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38039 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38040 format of the request is:
38041
38042 @table @samp
38043 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38044
38045 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38046 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38047 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38048 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38049 memory starting at @var{to}.
38050 @end table
38051
38052 Replies:
38053 @table @samp
38054 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38055 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38056 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38057 @item E @var{NN}
38058 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38059 relocating the instruction.
38060 @end table
38061
38062 @node Host I/O Packets
38063 @section Host I/O Packets
38064 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38065 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38066
38067 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38068 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38069 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38070 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38071 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38072 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38073 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38074 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38075 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38076 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38077
38078 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38079 its arguments. They have this format:
38080
38081 @table @samp
38082
38083 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38084 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38085 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38086 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38087 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38088 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38089 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38090 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38091 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38092
38093 @end table
38094
38095 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38096
38097 @table @samp
38098
38099 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38100 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38101 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38102 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38103 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38104 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38105 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38106 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38107 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38108 @var{attachment}.
38109
38110 @item @w{}
38111 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38112
38113 @end table
38114
38115 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38116
38117 @table @samp
38118 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38119 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38120 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38121 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38122 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38123 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38124 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38125
38126 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38127 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38128 -1 if an error occurs.
38129
38130 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38131 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38132 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38133 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38134 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38135 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38136 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38137 @var{count} was zero.
38138
38139 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38140 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38141 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38142 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38143 some characters were escaped.
38144
38145 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38146 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38147 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38148 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38149 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38150 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38151 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38152 error occurred.
38153
38154 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38155 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38156 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38157 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38158 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38159 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38160
38161 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38162 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38163 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38164
38165 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38166 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38167 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38168
38169 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38170 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38171 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38172 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38173 some characters were escaped.
38174
38175 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38176 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38177 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38178 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38179 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38180 inferior(s).
38181
38182 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38183 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38184 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38185 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38186 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38187 operation.
38188
38189 @end table
38190
38191 @node Interrupts
38192 @section Interrupts
38193 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38194
38195 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
38196 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
38197 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
38198 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38199
38200 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38201 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38202 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38203 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38204 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38205
38206 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38207 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38208 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38209 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38210 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38211 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38212 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38213 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38214
38215 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38216 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38217 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38218
38219 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38220 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38221 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38222 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38223 currently-executing threads and processes.
38224 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38225 running program, it should send one of the stop
38226 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38227 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38228 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38229 Interrupts received while the
38230 program is stopped are discarded.
38231
38232 @node Notification Packets
38233 @section Notification Packets
38234 @cindex notification packets
38235 @cindex packets, notification
38236
38237 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38238 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38239 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38240 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38241 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38242 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38243 is not a problem.
38244
38245 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38246 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38247 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38248 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38249 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38250 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38251 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38252
38253 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38254 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38255
38256 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38257 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38258 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38259 not they understand it.
38260
38261 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38262 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38263 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38264 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38265 recipients.
38266
38267 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38268 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38269 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38270 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38271 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38272
38273 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38274 @table @samp
38275 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38276 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38277 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38278 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38279 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38280 @item @var{ack}
38281 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38282 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38283 @end table
38284
38285 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38286 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38287
38288 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38289 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38290 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38291 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38292 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38293 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38294 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38295 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38296 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38297 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38298
38299 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38300 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38301 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38302 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38303 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38304 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38305
38306 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38307 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38308 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38309 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38310 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38311
38312 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38313 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38314 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38315 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38316 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38317 normally.
38318
38319 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38320 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38321 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38322 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38323 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38324 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38325 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38326 the process shall be repeated.
38327
38328 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38329 following example:
38330 @smallexample
38331 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38332 @code{...}
38333 -> @code{vStopped}
38334 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38335 -> @code{vStopped}
38336 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38337 -> @code{vStopped}
38338 <- @code{OK}
38339 @end smallexample
38340
38341 The following notifications are defined:
38342 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38343
38344 @item Notification
38345 @tab Ack
38346 @tab Event
38347 @tab Description
38348
38349 @item Stop
38350 @tab vStopped
38351 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38352 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38353 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38354 @value{GDBN}.
38355 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38356
38357 @end multitable
38358
38359 @node Remote Non-Stop
38360 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38361
38362 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38363 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38364 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38365 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38366
38367 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38368 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38369 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38370 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38371 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38372 probe the target state after a mode change.
38373
38374 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38375 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38376 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38377 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38378 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38379 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38380 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38381 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38382 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38383 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38384 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38385
38386 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38387 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38388 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38389 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38390 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38391 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38392 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38393 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38394 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38395 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38396 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38397 @samp{OK}.
38398
38399 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38400 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38401 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38402 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38403 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38404 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38405 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38406 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38407 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38408 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38409 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38410 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38411 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38412
38413 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38414 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38415
38416 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38417 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38418 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38419 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38420 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38421 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38422 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38423
38424 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38425 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38426 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38427 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38428 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38429
38430 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38431 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38432 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38433 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38434
38435 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38436 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38437 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38438 @pxref{qSupported}.
38439 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38440 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38441 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38442 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38443 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38444 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38445 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38446
38447 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38448 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38449 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38450 connection.
38451 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38452 new connection is established,
38453 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38454 for the current connection, once disabled.
38455
38456 @node Examples
38457 @section Examples
38458
38459 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38460 does not get any direct output:
38461
38462 @smallexample
38463 -> @code{R00}
38464 <- @code{+}
38465 @emph{target restarts}
38466 -> @code{?}
38467 <- @code{+}
38468 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38469 -> @code{+}
38470 @end smallexample
38471
38472 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38473
38474 @smallexample
38475 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38476 <- @code{+}
38477 -> @code{s}
38478 <- @code{+}
38479 @emph{time passes}
38480 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38481 -> @code{+}
38482 -> @code{g}
38483 <- @code{+}
38484 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38485 -> @code{+}
38486 @end smallexample
38487
38488 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38489 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38490 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38491
38492 @menu
38493 * File-I/O Overview::
38494 * Protocol Basics::
38495 * The F Request Packet::
38496 * The F Reply Packet::
38497 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38498 * Console I/O::
38499 * List of Supported Calls::
38500 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38501 * Constants::
38502 * File-I/O Examples::
38503 @end menu
38504
38505 @node File-I/O Overview
38506 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38507 @cindex file-i/o overview
38508
38509 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38510 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38511 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38512 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38513 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38514 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38515
38516 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38517 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38518 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38519 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38520 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38521
38522 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38523 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38524 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38525 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38526 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38527 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38528 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38529
38530 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38531 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38532 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38533 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38534 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38535
38536 @smallexample
38537 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38538 <- target requests 'system call X'
38539 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38540 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38541 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38542 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38543 @end smallexample
38544
38545 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38546 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38547 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38548 system are not supported by this protocol.
38549
38550 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38551
38552 @node Protocol Basics
38553 @subsection Protocol Basics
38554 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38555
38556 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38557 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38558 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38559 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38560 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38561 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38562 to call the appropriate host system call:
38563
38564 @itemize @bullet
38565 @item
38566 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38567
38568 @item
38569 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38570 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38571 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38572 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38573
38574 @end itemize
38575
38576 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38577
38578 @itemize @bullet
38579 @item
38580 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38581 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38582 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38583 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38584 packet.
38585
38586 @item
38587 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38588 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38589
38590 @item
38591 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38592
38593 @item
38594 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38595
38596 @item
38597 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38598 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38599 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38600 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38601 packet.
38602
38603 @end itemize
38604
38605 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38606 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38607
38608 @itemize @bullet
38609 @item
38610 Return value.
38611
38612 @item
38613 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38614
38615 @item
38616 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38617
38618 @end itemize
38619
38620 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38621 the latest continue or step action.
38622
38623 @node The F Request Packet
38624 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38625 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38626 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38627
38628 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38629
38630 @table @samp
38631 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38632
38633 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38634 This is just the name of the function.
38635
38636 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38637 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38638 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38639 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38640 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38641 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38642 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38643
38644 @end table
38645
38646
38647
38648 @node The F Reply Packet
38649 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38650 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38651 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38652
38653 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38654
38655 @table @samp
38656
38657 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38658
38659 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38660
38661 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38662 representation.
38663 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38664
38665 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38666 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38667 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38668
38669 @smallexample
38670 F0,0,C
38671 @end smallexample
38672
38673 @noindent
38674 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38675
38676 @smallexample
38677 F-1,4,C
38678 @end smallexample
38679
38680 @noindent
38681 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38682
38683 @end table
38684
38685
38686 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38687 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38688 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38689
38690 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38691 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38692 the target should behave as if it had
38693 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38694 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38695 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38696 packet.
38697
38698 It's important for the target to know in which
38699 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38700
38701 @itemize @bullet
38702 @item
38703 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38704
38705 @item
38706 The system call on the host has been finished.
38707
38708 @end itemize
38709
38710 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38711 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38712 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38713 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38714 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38715 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38716
38717 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38718 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38719 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38720 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38721 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38722 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38723 or the full action has been completed.
38724
38725 @node Console I/O
38726 @subsection Console I/O
38727 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38728
38729 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38730 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38731 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38732 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38733 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38734 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38735 conditions is met:
38736
38737 @itemize @bullet
38738 @item
38739 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38740 @code{read}
38741 system call is treated as finished.
38742
38743 @item
38744 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38745 newline.
38746
38747 @item
38748 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38749 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38750
38751 @end itemize
38752
38753 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38754 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38755 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38756 is stopped at the user's request.
38757
38758
38759 @node List of Supported Calls
38760 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38761 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38762
38763 @menu
38764 * open::
38765 * close::
38766 * read::
38767 * write::
38768 * lseek::
38769 * rename::
38770 * unlink::
38771 * stat/fstat::
38772 * gettimeofday::
38773 * isatty::
38774 * system::
38775 @end menu
38776
38777 @node open
38778 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38779 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38780
38781 @table @asis
38782 @item Synopsis:
38783 @smallexample
38784 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38785 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38786 @end smallexample
38787
38788 @item Request:
38789 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38790
38791 @noindent
38792 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38793
38794 @table @code
38795 @item O_CREAT
38796 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38797 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38798 are concerned.
38799
38800 @item O_EXCL
38801 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38802 an error and open() fails.
38803
38804 @item O_TRUNC
38805 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38806 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38807 truncated to zero length.
38808
38809 @item O_APPEND
38810 The file is opened in append mode.
38811
38812 @item O_RDONLY
38813 The file is opened for reading only.
38814
38815 @item O_WRONLY
38816 The file is opened for writing only.
38817
38818 @item O_RDWR
38819 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38820 @end table
38821
38822 @noindent
38823 Other bits are silently ignored.
38824
38825
38826 @noindent
38827 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38828
38829 @table @code
38830 @item S_IRUSR
38831 User has read permission.
38832
38833 @item S_IWUSR
38834 User has write permission.
38835
38836 @item S_IRGRP
38837 Group has read permission.
38838
38839 @item S_IWGRP
38840 Group has write permission.
38841
38842 @item S_IROTH
38843 Others have read permission.
38844
38845 @item S_IWOTH
38846 Others have write permission.
38847 @end table
38848
38849 @noindent
38850 Other bits are silently ignored.
38851
38852
38853 @item Return value:
38854 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38855 occurred.
38856
38857 @item Errors:
38858
38859 @table @code
38860 @item EEXIST
38861 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38862
38863 @item EISDIR
38864 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38865
38866 @item EACCES
38867 The requested access is not allowed.
38868
38869 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38870 @var{pathname} was too long.
38871
38872 @item ENOENT
38873 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38874
38875 @item ENODEV
38876 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38877
38878 @item EROFS
38879 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38880 write access was requested.
38881
38882 @item EFAULT
38883 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38884
38885 @item ENOSPC
38886 No space on device to create the file.
38887
38888 @item EMFILE
38889 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38890
38891 @item ENFILE
38892 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38893 has been reached.
38894
38895 @item EINTR
38896 The call was interrupted by the user.
38897 @end table
38898
38899 @end table
38900
38901 @node close
38902 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38903 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38904
38905 @table @asis
38906 @item Synopsis:
38907 @smallexample
38908 int close(int fd);
38909 @end smallexample
38910
38911 @item Request:
38912 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38913
38914 @item Return value:
38915 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38916
38917 @item Errors:
38918
38919 @table @code
38920 @item EBADF
38921 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38922
38923 @item EINTR
38924 The call was interrupted by the user.
38925 @end table
38926
38927 @end table
38928
38929 @node read
38930 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38931 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38932
38933 @table @asis
38934 @item Synopsis:
38935 @smallexample
38936 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38937 @end smallexample
38938
38939 @item Request:
38940 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38941
38942 @item Return value:
38943 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38944 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38945 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38946
38947 @item Errors:
38948
38949 @table @code
38950 @item EBADF
38951 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38952 reading.
38953
38954 @item EFAULT
38955 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38956
38957 @item EINTR
38958 The call was interrupted by the user.
38959 @end table
38960
38961 @end table
38962
38963 @node write
38964 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38965 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38966
38967 @table @asis
38968 @item Synopsis:
38969 @smallexample
38970 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38971 @end smallexample
38972
38973 @item Request:
38974 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38975
38976 @item Return value:
38977 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38978 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38979 is returned.
38980
38981 @item Errors:
38982
38983 @table @code
38984 @item EBADF
38985 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38986 writing.
38987
38988 @item EFAULT
38989 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38990
38991 @item EFBIG
38992 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38993 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38994
38995 @item ENOSPC
38996 No space on device to write the data.
38997
38998 @item EINTR
38999 The call was interrupted by the user.
39000 @end table
39001
39002 @end table
39003
39004 @node lseek
39005 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39006 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39007
39008 @table @asis
39009 @item Synopsis:
39010 @smallexample
39011 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39012 @end smallexample
39013
39014 @item Request:
39015 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39016
39017 @var{flag} is one of:
39018
39019 @table @code
39020 @item SEEK_SET
39021 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39022
39023 @item SEEK_CUR
39024 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39025 bytes.
39026
39027 @item SEEK_END
39028 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39029 bytes.
39030 @end table
39031
39032 @item Return value:
39033 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39034 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39035 value of -1 is returned.
39036
39037 @item Errors:
39038
39039 @table @code
39040 @item EBADF
39041 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39042
39043 @item ESPIPE
39044 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39045
39046 @item EINVAL
39047 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39048
39049 @item EINTR
39050 The call was interrupted by the user.
39051 @end table
39052
39053 @end table
39054
39055 @node rename
39056 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39057 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39058
39059 @table @asis
39060 @item Synopsis:
39061 @smallexample
39062 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39063 @end smallexample
39064
39065 @item Request:
39066 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39067
39068 @item Return value:
39069 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39070
39071 @item Errors:
39072
39073 @table @code
39074 @item EISDIR
39075 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39076 directory.
39077
39078 @item EEXIST
39079 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39080
39081 @item EBUSY
39082 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39083 process.
39084
39085 @item EINVAL
39086 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39087 of itself.
39088
39089 @item ENOTDIR
39090 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39091 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39092 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39093
39094 @item EFAULT
39095 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39096
39097 @item EACCES
39098 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39099
39100 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39101
39102 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39103
39104 @item ENOENT
39105 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39106
39107 @item EROFS
39108 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39109
39110 @item ENOSPC
39111 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39112 directory entry.
39113
39114 @item EINTR
39115 The call was interrupted by the user.
39116 @end table
39117
39118 @end table
39119
39120 @node unlink
39121 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39122 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39123
39124 @table @asis
39125 @item Synopsis:
39126 @smallexample
39127 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39128 @end smallexample
39129
39130 @item Request:
39131 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39132
39133 @item Return value:
39134 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39135
39136 @item Errors:
39137
39138 @table @code
39139 @item EACCES
39140 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39141
39142 @item EPERM
39143 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39144
39145 @item EBUSY
39146 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39147 being used by another process.
39148
39149 @item EFAULT
39150 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39151
39152 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39153 @var{pathname} was too long.
39154
39155 @item ENOENT
39156 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39157
39158 @item ENOTDIR
39159 A component of the path is not a directory.
39160
39161 @item EROFS
39162 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39163
39164 @item EINTR
39165 The call was interrupted by the user.
39166 @end table
39167
39168 @end table
39169
39170 @node stat/fstat
39171 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39172 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39173 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39174
39175 @table @asis
39176 @item Synopsis:
39177 @smallexample
39178 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39179 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39180 @end smallexample
39181
39182 @item Request:
39183 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39184 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39185
39186 @item Return value:
39187 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39188
39189 @item Errors:
39190
39191 @table @code
39192 @item EBADF
39193 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39194
39195 @item ENOENT
39196 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39197 path is an empty string.
39198
39199 @item ENOTDIR
39200 A component of the path is not a directory.
39201
39202 @item EFAULT
39203 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39204
39205 @item EACCES
39206 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39207
39208 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39209 @var{pathname} was too long.
39210
39211 @item EINTR
39212 The call was interrupted by the user.
39213 @end table
39214
39215 @end table
39216
39217 @node gettimeofday
39218 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39219 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39220
39221 @table @asis
39222 @item Synopsis:
39223 @smallexample
39224 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39225 @end smallexample
39226
39227 @item Request:
39228 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39229
39230 @item Return value:
39231 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39232
39233 @item Errors:
39234
39235 @table @code
39236 @item EINVAL
39237 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39238
39239 @item EFAULT
39240 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39241 @end table
39242
39243 @end table
39244
39245 @node isatty
39246 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39247 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39248
39249 @table @asis
39250 @item Synopsis:
39251 @smallexample
39252 int isatty(int fd);
39253 @end smallexample
39254
39255 @item Request:
39256 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39257
39258 @item Return value:
39259 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39260
39261 @item Errors:
39262
39263 @table @code
39264 @item EINTR
39265 The call was interrupted by the user.
39266 @end table
39267
39268 @end table
39269
39270 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39271 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39272 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39273 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39274 needed.
39275
39276
39277 @node system
39278 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39279 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39280
39281 @table @asis
39282 @item Synopsis:
39283 @smallexample
39284 int system(const char *command);
39285 @end smallexample
39286
39287 @item Request:
39288 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39289
39290 @item Return value:
39291 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39292 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39293 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39294 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39295 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39296 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39297 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39298
39299 @item Errors:
39300
39301 @table @code
39302 @item EINTR
39303 The call was interrupted by the user.
39304 @end table
39305
39306 @end table
39307
39308 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39309 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39310 the host is simplified before it's returned
39311 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39312 is discarded, and the return value consists
39313 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39314
39315 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39316 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39317 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39318
39319 @table @code
39320 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39321 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39322 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39323 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39324
39325 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39326 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39327 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39328 protocol.
39329 @end table
39330
39331 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39332 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39333 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39334
39335 @menu
39336 * Integral Datatypes::
39337 * Pointer Values::
39338 * Memory Transfer::
39339 * struct stat::
39340 * struct timeval::
39341 @end menu
39342
39343 @node Integral Datatypes
39344 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39345 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39346
39347 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39348 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39349 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39350
39351 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39352 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39353
39354 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39355
39356 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39357 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39358
39359 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39360
39361 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39362 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39363 byte order.
39364
39365 @node Pointer Values
39366 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39367 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39368
39369 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39370 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39371 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39372 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39373
39374 @smallexample
39375 @code{1aaf/12}
39376 @end smallexample
39377
39378 @noindent
39379 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39380 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39381 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39382 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39383
39384 @smallexample
39385 @code{123456/d}
39386 @end smallexample
39387
39388 @node Memory Transfer
39389 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39390 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39391
39392 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39393 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39394 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39395 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39396 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39397 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39398 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39399
39400
39401 @node struct stat
39402 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39403 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39404
39405 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39406 is defined as follows:
39407
39408 @smallexample
39409 struct stat @{
39410 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39411 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39412 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39413 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39414 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39415 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39416 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39417 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39418 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39419 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39420 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39421 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39422 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39423 @};
39424 @end smallexample
39425
39426 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39427 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39428 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39429
39430 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39431 range of values.
39432
39433 @table @code
39434
39435 @item st_dev
39436 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39437
39438 @item st_ino
39439 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39440
39441 @item st_mode
39442 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39443 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39444
39445 @item st_uid
39446 @itemx st_gid
39447 @itemx st_rdev
39448 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39449
39450 @item st_atime
39451 @itemx st_mtime
39452 @itemx st_ctime
39453 These values have a host and file system dependent
39454 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39455 support exact timing values.
39456 @end table
39457
39458 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39459 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39460 continuing.
39461
39462 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39463 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39464 get truncated on the target.
39465
39466 @node struct timeval
39467 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39468 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39469
39470 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39471 is defined as follows:
39472
39473 @smallexample
39474 struct timeval @{
39475 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39476 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39477 @};
39478 @end smallexample
39479
39480 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39481 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39482 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39483
39484 @node Constants
39485 @subsection Constants
39486 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39487
39488 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39489 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39490 values before and after the call as needed.
39491
39492 @menu
39493 * Open Flags::
39494 * mode_t Values::
39495 * Errno Values::
39496 * Lseek Flags::
39497 * Limits::
39498 @end menu
39499
39500 @node Open Flags
39501 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39502 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39503
39504 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39505
39506 @smallexample
39507 O_RDONLY 0x0
39508 O_WRONLY 0x1
39509 O_RDWR 0x2
39510 O_APPEND 0x8
39511 O_CREAT 0x200
39512 O_TRUNC 0x400
39513 O_EXCL 0x800
39514 @end smallexample
39515
39516 @node mode_t Values
39517 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39518 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39519
39520 All values are given in octal representation.
39521
39522 @smallexample
39523 S_IFREG 0100000
39524 S_IFDIR 040000
39525 S_IRUSR 0400
39526 S_IWUSR 0200
39527 S_IXUSR 0100
39528 S_IRGRP 040
39529 S_IWGRP 020
39530 S_IXGRP 010
39531 S_IROTH 04
39532 S_IWOTH 02
39533 S_IXOTH 01
39534 @end smallexample
39535
39536 @node Errno Values
39537 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39538 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39539
39540 All values are given in decimal representation.
39541
39542 @smallexample
39543 EPERM 1
39544 ENOENT 2
39545 EINTR 4
39546 EBADF 9
39547 EACCES 13
39548 EFAULT 14
39549 EBUSY 16
39550 EEXIST 17
39551 ENODEV 19
39552 ENOTDIR 20
39553 EISDIR 21
39554 EINVAL 22
39555 ENFILE 23
39556 EMFILE 24
39557 EFBIG 27
39558 ENOSPC 28
39559 ESPIPE 29
39560 EROFS 30
39561 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39562 EUNKNOWN 9999
39563 @end smallexample
39564
39565 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39566 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39567
39568 @node Lseek Flags
39569 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39570 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39571
39572 @smallexample
39573 SEEK_SET 0
39574 SEEK_CUR 1
39575 SEEK_END 2
39576 @end smallexample
39577
39578 @node Limits
39579 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39580 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39581
39582 All values are given in decimal representation.
39583
39584 @smallexample
39585 INT_MIN -2147483648
39586 INT_MAX 2147483647
39587 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39588 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39589 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39590 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39591 @end smallexample
39592
39593 @node File-I/O Examples
39594 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39595 @cindex file-i/o examples
39596
39597 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39598 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39599
39600 @smallexample
39601 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39602 @emph{request memory read from target}
39603 -> @code{m1234,6}
39604 <- XXXXXX
39605 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39606 -> @code{F6}
39607 @end smallexample
39608
39609 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39610 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39611
39612 @smallexample
39613 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39614 @emph{request memory write to target}
39615 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39616 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39617 -> @code{F6}
39618 @end smallexample
39619
39620 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39621 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39622
39623 @smallexample
39624 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39625 -> @code{F-1,9}
39626 @end smallexample
39627
39628 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39629 host is called:
39630
39631 @smallexample
39632 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39633 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39634 <- @code{T02}
39635 @end smallexample
39636
39637 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39638 host is called:
39639
39640 @smallexample
39641 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39642 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39643 <- @code{T02}
39644 @end smallexample
39645
39646 @node Library List Format
39647 @section Library List Format
39648 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39649
39650 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39651 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39652 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39653 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39654 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39655 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39656 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39657 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39658 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39659 are loaded.
39660
39661 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39662 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39663 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39664 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39665
39666 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39667 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39668 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39669 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39670 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39671 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39672
39673 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39674 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39675
39676 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39677 offset, looks like this:
39678
39679 @smallexample
39680 <library-list>
39681 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39682 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39683 </library>
39684 </library-list>
39685 @end smallexample
39686
39687 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39688 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39689
39690 @smallexample
39691 <library-list>
39692 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39693 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39694 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39695 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39696 </library>
39697 </library-list>
39698 @end smallexample
39699
39700 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39701
39702 @smallexample
39703 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39704 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39705 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39706 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39707 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39708 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39709 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39710 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39711 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39712 @end smallexample
39713
39714 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39715 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39716 section for each library.
39717
39718 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39719 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39720 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39721
39722 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39723 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39724 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39725 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39726
39727 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39728 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39729 target, the following parameters are reported:
39730
39731 @itemize @minus
39732 @item
39733 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39734 @code{struct link_map}.
39735 @item
39736 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39737 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39738 @item
39739 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39740 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39741 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39742 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39743 @item
39744 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39745 @end itemize
39746
39747 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39748 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39749 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39750
39751 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39752 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39753
39754 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39755 looks like this:
39756
39757 @smallexample
39758 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39759 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39760 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39761 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39762 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39763 </library-list-svr>
39764 @end smallexample
39765
39766 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39767
39768 @smallexample
39769 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39770 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39771 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39772 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39773 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39774 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39775 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39776 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39777 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39778 @end smallexample
39779
39780 @node Memory Map Format
39781 @section Memory Map Format
39782 @cindex memory map format
39783
39784 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39785 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39786 memory map.
39787
39788 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39789 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39790 lists memory regions.
39791
39792 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39793 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39794
39795 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39796
39797 @smallexample
39798 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39799 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39800 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39801 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39802 <memory-map>
39803 region...
39804 </memory-map>
39805 @end smallexample
39806
39807 Each region can be either:
39808
39809 @itemize
39810
39811 @item
39812 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39813 bytes from there:
39814
39815 @smallexample
39816 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39817 @end smallexample
39818
39819
39820 @item
39821 A region of read-only memory:
39822
39823 @smallexample
39824 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39825 @end smallexample
39826
39827
39828 @item
39829 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39830 bytes in length:
39831
39832 @smallexample
39833 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39834 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39835 </memory>
39836 @end smallexample
39837
39838 @end itemize
39839
39840 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39841 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39842 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39843
39844 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39845
39846 @smallexample
39847 <!-- ................................................... -->
39848 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39849 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39850 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39851 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39852 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39853 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39854 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39855 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39856 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39857 and its type, or device. -->
39858 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39859 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39860 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39861 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39862 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39863 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39864 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39865 @end smallexample
39866
39867 @node Thread List Format
39868 @section Thread List Format
39869 @cindex thread list format
39870
39871 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39872 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39873 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39874 the following structure:
39875
39876 @smallexample
39877 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39878 <threads>
39879 <thread id="id" core="0">
39880 ... description ...
39881 </thread>
39882 </threads>
39883 @end smallexample
39884
39885 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39886 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39887 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39888 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39889 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39890
39891 @node Traceframe Info Format
39892 @section Traceframe Info Format
39893 @cindex traceframe info format
39894
39895 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39896 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39897 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39898 collected in a traceframe.
39899
39900 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39901 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39902
39903 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39904 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39905
39906 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39907
39908 @smallexample
39909 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39910 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39911 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39912 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39913 <traceframe-info>
39914 block...
39915 </traceframe-info>
39916 @end smallexample
39917
39918 Each traceframe block can be either:
39919
39920 @itemize
39921
39922 @item
39923 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39924 @var{length} bytes from there:
39925
39926 @smallexample
39927 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39928 @end smallexample
39929
39930 @item
39931 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39932 collected:
39933
39934 @smallexample
39935 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39936 @end smallexample
39937
39938 @end itemize
39939
39940 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39941
39942 @smallexample
39943 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39944 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39945
39946 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39947 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39948 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39949 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39950 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39951 @end smallexample
39952
39953 @node Branch Trace Format
39954 @section Branch Trace Format
39955 @cindex branch trace format
39956
39957 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39958 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39959 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39960 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39961
39962 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39963 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39964
39965 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39966 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39967
39968 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39969
39970 @smallexample
39971 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39972 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39973 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39974 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39975 <btrace>
39976 block...
39977 </btrace>
39978 @end smallexample
39979
39980 @itemize
39981
39982 @item
39983 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39984 and ending at @var{end}:
39985
39986 @smallexample
39987 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39988 @end smallexample
39989
39990 @end itemize
39991
39992 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39993
39994 @smallexample
39995 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
39996 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39997
39998 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39999 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40000 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40001
40002 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40003
40004 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40005
40006 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40007 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40008 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40009 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40010 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40011
40012 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40013 @end smallexample
40014
40015 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40016 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40017 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40018
40019 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40020 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40021 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40022
40023 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40024 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40025
40026 @table @code
40027 @item bts
40028 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40029 @table @code
40030 @item size
40031 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40032 @end table
40033 @item pt
40034 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel(R) Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel(R)
40035 PT}) format.
40036 @table @code
40037 @item size
40038 The size of the @acronym{Intel(R) PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40039 @end table
40040 @end table
40041
40042 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40043 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40044
40045 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40046
40047 @smallexample
40048 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40049 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40050
40051 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40052 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40053
40054 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40055 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40056 @end smallexample
40057
40058 @include agentexpr.texi
40059
40060 @node Target Descriptions
40061 @appendix Target Descriptions
40062 @cindex target descriptions
40063
40064 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40065 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40066 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40067 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40068 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40069 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40070 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40071
40072 @itemize @bullet
40073 @item
40074 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40075 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40076 @item
40077 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40078 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40079 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40080 @item
40081 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40082 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40083 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40084 @end itemize
40085
40086 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40087 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40088 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40089 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40090 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40091
40092 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40093 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40094
40095 @menu
40096 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40097 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40098 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40099 descriptions.
40100 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40101 @end menu
40102
40103 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40104 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40105
40106 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40107 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40108 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40109 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40110 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40111 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40112 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40113 Format}.
40114
40115 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40116 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40117 specify a file are:
40118
40119 @table @code
40120 @cindex set tdesc filename
40121 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40122 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40123
40124 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40125 @item unset tdesc filename
40126 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40127 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40128
40129 @cindex show tdesc filename
40130 @item show tdesc filename
40131 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40132 @end table
40133
40134
40135 @node Target Description Format
40136 @section Target Description Format
40137 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40138
40139 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40140 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40141 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40142 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40143 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40144 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40145 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40146
40147 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40148 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40149 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40150 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40151 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40152
40153 Here is a simple target description:
40154
40155 @smallexample
40156 <target version="1.0">
40157 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40158 </target>
40159 @end smallexample
40160
40161 @noindent
40162 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40163 the x86-64 architecture.
40164
40165 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40166 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40167 are explained further below.
40168
40169 @smallexample
40170 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40171 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40172 <target version="1.0">
40173 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40174 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40175 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40176 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40177 </target>
40178 @end smallexample
40179
40180 @noindent
40181 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40182 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40183 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40184 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40185 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40186 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40187 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40188 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40189 the version mismatch.
40190
40191 @subsection Inclusion
40192 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40193 @cindex XInclude
40194 @ifnotinfo
40195 @cindex <xi:include>
40196 @end ifnotinfo
40197
40198 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40199 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40200 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40201 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40202 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40203
40204 @smallexample
40205 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40206 @end smallexample
40207
40208 @noindent
40209 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40210 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40211 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40212 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40213 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40214 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40215 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40216 original description.
40217
40218 @subsection Architecture
40219 @cindex <architecture>
40220
40221 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40222
40223 @smallexample
40224 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40225 @end smallexample
40226
40227 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40228 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40229
40230 @subsection OS ABI
40231 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40232
40233 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40234 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40235
40236 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40237
40238 @smallexample
40239 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40240 @end smallexample
40241
40242 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40243 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40244
40245 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40246 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40247
40248 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40249 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40250
40251 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40252
40253 @smallexample
40254 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40255 @end smallexample
40256
40257 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40258 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40259
40260 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40261 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40262 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40263 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40264 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40265 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40266 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40267
40268 @smallexample
40269 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40270 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40271 @end smallexample
40272
40273 @subsection Features
40274 @cindex <feature>
40275
40276 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40277 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40278 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40279 has this form:
40280
40281 @smallexample
40282 <feature name="@var{name}">
40283 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40284 @var{reg}@dots{}
40285 </feature>
40286 @end smallexample
40287
40288 @noindent
40289 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40290 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40291 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40292 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40293
40294 @subsection Types
40295
40296 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40297 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40298 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40299 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40300 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40301
40302 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40303 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40304 Types must be defined before they are used.
40305
40306 @cindex <vector>
40307 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40308 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40309 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40310 @var{count}:
40311
40312 @smallexample
40313 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40314 @end smallexample
40315
40316 @cindex <union>
40317 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40318 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40319 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40320 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40321
40322 @smallexample
40323 <union id="@var{id}">
40324 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40325 @dots{}
40326 </union>
40327 @end smallexample
40328
40329 @cindex <struct>
40330 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40331 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40332 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40333 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40334 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40335 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40336 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40337 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40338
40339 @smallexample
40340 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40341 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40342 @dots{}
40343 </struct>
40344 @end smallexample
40345
40346 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40347 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40348
40349 @smallexample
40350 <struct id="@var{id}">
40351 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40352 @dots{}
40353 </struct>
40354 @end smallexample
40355
40356 @cindex <flags>
40357 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40358 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40359 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40360 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40361 are supported.
40362
40363 @smallexample
40364 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40365 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40366 @dots{}
40367 </flags>
40368 @end smallexample
40369
40370 @subsection Registers
40371 @cindex <reg>
40372
40373 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40374
40375 @smallexample
40376 <reg name="@var{name}"
40377 bitsize="@var{size}"
40378 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40379 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40380 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40381 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40382 @end smallexample
40383
40384 @noindent
40385 The components are as follows:
40386
40387 @table @var
40388
40389 @item name
40390 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40391
40392 @item bitsize
40393 The register's size, in bits.
40394
40395 @item regnum
40396 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40397 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40398 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40399 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40400 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40401 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40402 in order of increasing register number.
40403
40404 @item save-restore
40405 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40406 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40407 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40408 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40409 ABI.
40410
40411 @item type
40412 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40413 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40414 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40415 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40416 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40417 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40418
40419 @item group
40420 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40421 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40422 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40423 in @code{info registers}.
40424
40425 @end table
40426
40427 @node Predefined Target Types
40428 @section Predefined Target Types
40429 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40430
40431 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40432 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40433 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40434 types. The currently supported types are:
40435
40436 @table @code
40437
40438 @item int8
40439 @itemx int16
40440 @itemx int32
40441 @itemx int64
40442 @itemx int128
40443 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40444
40445 @item uint8
40446 @itemx uint16
40447 @itemx uint32
40448 @itemx uint64
40449 @itemx uint128
40450 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40451
40452 @item code_ptr
40453 @itemx data_ptr
40454 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40455 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40456 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40457 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40458 may be marked as data pointers.
40459
40460 @item ieee_single
40461 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40462
40463 @item ieee_double
40464 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40465
40466 @item arm_fpa_ext
40467 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40468
40469 @item i387_ext
40470 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40471
40472 @item i386_eflags
40473 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40474
40475 @item i386_mxcsr
40476 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40477
40478 @end table
40479
40480 @node Standard Target Features
40481 @section Standard Target Features
40482 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40483
40484 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40485 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40486 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40487 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40488 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40489 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40490 can recognize them.
40491
40492 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40493 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40494 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40495 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40496 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40497 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40498 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40499 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40500
40501 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40502 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40503 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40504
40505 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40506 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40507 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40508 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40509
40510 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40511 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40512 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40513
40514 @menu
40515 * AArch64 Features::
40516 * ARM Features::
40517 * i386 Features::
40518 * MicroBlaze Features::
40519 * MIPS Features::
40520 * M68K Features::
40521 * Nios II Features::
40522 * PowerPC Features::
40523 * S/390 and System z Features::
40524 * TIC6x Features::
40525 @end menu
40526
40527
40528 @node AArch64 Features
40529 @subsection AArch64 Features
40530 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40531
40532 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40533 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40534 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40535
40536 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40537 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40538 and @samp{fpcr}.
40539
40540 @node ARM Features
40541 @subsection ARM Features
40542 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40543
40544 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40545 ARM targets.
40546 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40547 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40548
40549 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40550 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40551 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40552 and @samp{xpsr}.
40553
40554 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40555 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40556
40557 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40558 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40559 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40560 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40561
40562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40563 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40564 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40565 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40566 halves of the double-precision registers.
40567
40568 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40569 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40570 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40571 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40572 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40573 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40574
40575 @node i386 Features
40576 @subsection i386 Features
40577 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40578
40579 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40580 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40581
40582 @itemize @minus
40583 @item
40584 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40585 @item
40586 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40587 @item
40588 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40589 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40590 @item
40591 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40592 @item
40593 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40594 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40595 @end itemize
40596
40597 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40598
40599 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40600 describe registers:
40601
40602 @itemize @minus
40603 @item
40604 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40605 @item
40606 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40607 @item
40608 @samp{mxcsr}
40609 @end itemize
40610
40611 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40612 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40613 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40614
40615 @itemize @minus
40616 @item
40617 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40618 @item
40619 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40620 @end itemize
40621
40622 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
40623 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40624
40625 @itemize @minus
40626 @item
40627 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40628 @item
40629 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40630 @end itemize
40631
40632 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40633 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40634
40635 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40636 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40637 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40638
40639 @itemize @minus
40640 @item
40641 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40642 @end itemize
40643
40644 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40645
40646 @itemize @minus
40647 @item
40648 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40649 @end itemize
40650
40651 It should
40652 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40653
40654 @itemize @minus
40655 @item
40656 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40657 @item
40658 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40659 @end itemize
40660
40661 It should
40662 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40663
40664 @itemize @minus
40665 @item
40666 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40667 @end itemize
40668
40669 @node MicroBlaze Features
40670 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40671 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40672
40673 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40674 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40675 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40676 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40677 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40678
40679 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40680 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40681
40682 @node MIPS Features
40683 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40684 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40685
40686 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40687 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40688 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40689 on the target.
40690
40691 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40692 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40693 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40694
40695 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40696 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40697 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40698 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40699
40700 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40701 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40702 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40703 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40704
40705 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40706 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40707 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40708
40709 @node M68K Features
40710 @subsection M68K Features
40711 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40712
40713 @table @code
40714 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40715 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40716 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40717 One of those features must be always present.
40718 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40719 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40720 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40721 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40722
40723 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40724 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40725 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40726 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40727 @end table
40728
40729 @node Nios II Features
40730 @subsection Nios II Features
40731 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40732
40733 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40734 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40735 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40736 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40737 @samp{mpuacc}).
40738
40739 @node PowerPC Features
40740 @subsection PowerPC Features
40741 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40742
40743 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40744 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40745 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40746 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40747
40748 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40749 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40750
40751 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40752 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40753 and @samp{vrsave}.
40754
40755 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40756 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40757 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40758 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40759 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40760 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40761
40762 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40763 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40764 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40765 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40766 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40767 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40768 user.
40769
40770 @node S/390 and System z Features
40771 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40772 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40773 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40774
40775 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40776 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40777 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40778 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40779 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40780 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40781 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40782 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40783 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40784
40785 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40786 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40787 @samp{fpc}.
40788
40789 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40790 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40791
40792 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40793 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40794 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40795 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40796 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40797 32-bit wide.
40798
40799 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40800 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40801 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40802
40803 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40804 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40805 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40806 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40807 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40808 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40809 @samp{v31}.
40810
40811 @node TIC6x Features
40812 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40813 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40814 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40815 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40816 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40817 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40818
40819 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40820 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40821 through @samp{B31}.
40822
40823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40824 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40825
40826 @node Operating System Information
40827 @appendix Operating System Information
40828 @cindex operating system information
40829
40830 @menu
40831 * Process list::
40832 @end menu
40833
40834 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40835 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40836 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40837 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40838 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40839 on a different aspect of target.
40840
40841 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40842 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40843 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40844 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40845
40846 @node Process list
40847 @appendixsection Process list
40848 @cindex operating system information, process list
40849
40850 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40851 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40852 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40853 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40854
40855 An example document is:
40856
40857 @smallexample
40858 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40859 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40860 <osdata type="processes">
40861 <item>
40862 <column name="pid">1</column>
40863 <column name="user">root</column>
40864 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40865 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40866 </item>
40867 </osdata>
40868 @end smallexample
40869
40870 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40871 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40872 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40873 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40874 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40875 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40876 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40877
40878 @node Trace File Format
40879 @appendix Trace File Format
40880 @cindex trace file format
40881
40882 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40883 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40884
40885 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40886 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40887 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40888 in the future.
40889
40890 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40891 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40892 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40893 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40894 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40895 of this section.
40896
40897 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40898
40899 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40900 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40901 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40902 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40903 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40904 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40905 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40906 endianness.
40907
40908 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40909
40910 @table @code
40911 @item R @var{bytes}
40912 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40913 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40914 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40915 hexadecimal encoding.
40916
40917 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40918 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40919 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40920 @var{length} bytes.
40921
40922 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40923 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40924 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40925
40926 @end table
40927
40928 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40929 of blocks.
40930
40931 @node Index Section Format
40932 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40933 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40934 @cindex index section format
40935
40936 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40937 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40938 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40939 description.
40940
40941 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40942 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40943 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40944 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40945 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40946 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40947
40948 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40949
40950 @enumerate
40951 @item
40952 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40953 unless otherwise noted:
40954
40955 @enumerate
40956 @item
40957 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40958 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40959 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40960 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40961 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40962 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40963 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40964
40965 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40966 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40967 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40968 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40969
40970 @item
40971 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40972
40973 @item
40974 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40975 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40976 to the next offset.
40977
40978 @item
40979 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40980
40981 @item
40982 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40983
40984 @item
40985 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40986 @end enumerate
40987
40988 @item
40989 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40990 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40991 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40992 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40993 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40994 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40995 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40996 CU indices.
40997
40998 @item
40999 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41000 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41001 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41002 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41003
41004 @item
41005 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41006 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41007
41008 @enumerate
41009 @item
41010 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41011
41012 @item
41013 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41014 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41015
41016 @item
41017 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41018 @end enumerate
41019
41020 @item
41021 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41022 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41023
41024 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41025 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41026 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41027 constant pool.
41028
41029 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41030 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41031 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41032
41033 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41034 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41035 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41036 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41037 index version:
41038
41039 @table @asis
41040 @item Version 4
41041 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41042
41043 @item Versions 5 to 7
41044 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41045 @end table
41046
41047 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41048
41049 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41050 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41051 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41052 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41053 collision.
41054
41055 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41056 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41057 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41058 the code.
41059
41060 @item
41061 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41062 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41063 strings.
41064
41065 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41066 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41067 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41068 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41069 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41070 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41071
41072 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41073 @end enumerate
41074
41075 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41076 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41077 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41078
41079 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41080 (bit 0 = LSB):
41081
41082 @table @asis
41083
41084 @item Bits 0-23
41085 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41086 @item Bits 24-27
41087 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41088 @item Bits 28-30
41089 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41090
41091 @table @asis
41092 @item 0
41093 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41094 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41095 with previous versions of the index.
41096 @item 1
41097 The symbol is a type.
41098 @item 2
41099 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41100 @item 3
41101 The symbol is a function.
41102 @item 4
41103 Any other kind of symbol.
41104 @item 5,6,7
41105 These values are reserved.
41106 @end table
41107
41108 @item Bit 31
41109 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41110
41111 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41112 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41113 @value{GDBN} sources.
41114
41115 @end table
41116
41117 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41118 global/static attributes in the index.
41119
41120 @smallexample
41121 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41122 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41123 switch (die->tag)
41124 @{
41125 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41126 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41127 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41128 kind = TYPE;
41129 is_static = 1;
41130 break;
41131 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41132 kind = VARIABLE;
41133 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41134 break;
41135 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41136 kind = FUNCTION;
41137 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41138 break;
41139 case DW_TAG_constant:
41140 kind = VARIABLE;
41141 is_static = ! is_external;
41142 break;
41143 case DW_TAG_variable:
41144 kind = VARIABLE;
41145 is_static = ! is_external;
41146 break;
41147 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41148 kind = TYPE;
41149 is_static = 0;
41150 break;
41151 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41152 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41153 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41154 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41155 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41156 kind = TYPE;
41157 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41158 break;
41159 default:
41160 assert (0);
41161 @}
41162 @end smallexample
41163
41164 @node Man Pages
41165 @appendix Manual pages
41166 @cindex Man pages
41167
41168 @menu
41169 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41170 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41171 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41172 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41173 @end menu
41174
41175 @node gdb man
41176 @heading gdb man
41177
41178 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41179
41180 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41181 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41182 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41183 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41184 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41185 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41186 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41187 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41188 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41189 @c man end
41190
41191 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41192 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41193 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41194 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41195
41196 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41197 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41198
41199 @itemize @bullet
41200 @item
41201 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41202
41203 @item
41204 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41205
41206 @item
41207 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41208
41209 @item
41210 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41211 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41212 @end itemize
41213
41214 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41215 Modula-2.
41216
41217 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41218 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41219 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41220 by using the command @code{help}.
41221
41222 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41223 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41224 executable program as the argument:
41225
41226 @smallexample
41227 gdb program
41228 @end smallexample
41229
41230 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41231
41232 @smallexample
41233 gdb program core
41234 @end smallexample
41235
41236 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41237 to debug a running process:
41238
41239 @smallexample
41240 gdb program 1234
41241 gdb -p 1234
41242 @end smallexample
41243
41244 @noindent
41245 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41246 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41247 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41248
41249 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41250
41251 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41252 @table @env
41253 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41254 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41255
41256 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41257 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41258
41259 @item bt
41260 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41261
41262 @item print @var{expr}
41263 Display the value of an expression.
41264
41265 @item c
41266 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41267
41268 @item next
41269 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41270 function calls in the line.
41271
41272 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41273 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41274
41275 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41276 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41277
41278 @item step
41279 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41280 function calls in the line.
41281
41282 @item help [@var{name}]
41283 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41284 about using @value{GDBN}.
41285
41286 @item quit
41287 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41288 @end table
41289
41290 @ifset man
41291 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41292 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41293 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41294 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41295 @end ifset
41296 @c man end
41297
41298 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41299 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41300 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41301 encountered with no
41302 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41303 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41304 Many options have
41305 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41306 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41307 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41308 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41309 more usual convention.)
41310
41311 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41312 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41313 option is used.
41314
41315 @table @env
41316 @item -help
41317 @itemx -h
41318 List all options, with brief explanations.
41319
41320 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41321 @itemx -s @var{file}
41322 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41323
41324 @item -write
41325 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41326
41327 @item -exec=@var{file}
41328 @itemx -e @var{file}
41329 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41330 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41331 dump.
41332
41333 @item -se=@var{file}
41334 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41335 file.
41336
41337 @item -core=@var{file}
41338 @itemx -c @var{file}
41339 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41340
41341 @item -command=@var{file}
41342 @itemx -x @var{file}
41343 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41344
41345 @item -ex @var{command}
41346 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41347
41348 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41349 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41350 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41351
41352 @item -nh
41353 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41354
41355 @item -nx
41356 @itemx -n
41357 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41358
41359 @item -quiet
41360 @itemx -q
41361 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41362 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41363
41364 @item -batch
41365 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41366 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41367 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41368 commands in the command files.
41369
41370 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41371 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41372 more useful, the message
41373
41374 @smallexample
41375 Program exited normally.
41376 @end smallexample
41377
41378 @noindent
41379 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41380 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41381
41382 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41383 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41384 instead of the current directory.
41385
41386 @item -fullname
41387 @itemx -f
41388 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41389 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41390 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41391 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41392 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41393 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41394 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41395 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41396
41397 @item -b @var{bps}
41398 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41399 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41400
41401 @item -tty=@var{device}
41402 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41403 @end table
41404 @c man end
41405
41406 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41407 @ifset man
41408 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41409 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41410 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41411
41412 @smallexample
41413 info gdb
41414 @end smallexample
41415
41416 @noindent
41417 should give you access to the complete manual.
41418
41419 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41420 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41421 @end ifset
41422 @c man end
41423
41424 @node gdbserver man
41425 @heading gdbserver man
41426
41427 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41428 @format
41429 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41430 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41431
41432 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41433
41434 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41435 @c man end
41436 @end format
41437
41438 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41439 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41440 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41441
41442 @ifclear man
41443 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41444 @end ifclear
41445 @ifset man
41446 Usage (server (target) side):
41447 @end ifset
41448
41449 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41450 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41451 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41452 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41453
41454 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41455 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41456 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41457
41458 @smallexample
41459 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41460 @end smallexample
41461
41462 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41463
41464 @smallexample
41465 @ifset man
41466 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41467 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41468 @end ifset
41469 @ifclear man
41470 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41471 @end ifclear
41472 @end smallexample
41473
41474 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41475 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41476 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41477
41478 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41479
41480 @smallexample
41481 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41482 @end smallexample
41483
41484 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41485 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41486 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41487 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41488 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41489 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41490 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41491 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41492 print an error message and exit.
41493
41494 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41495 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41496
41497 @smallexample
41498 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41499 @end smallexample
41500
41501 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41502 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41503
41504 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41505 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41506 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41507 the program you want to debug.
41508
41509 @smallexample
41510 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41511 @end smallexample
41512
41513 @ifclear man
41514 @subheading Usage (host side)
41515 @end ifclear
41516 @ifset man
41517 Usage (host side):
41518 @end ifset
41519
41520 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41521 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41522 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41523 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41524 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41525 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41526 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41527 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41528 descriptor. For example:
41529
41530 @smallexample
41531 @ifset man
41532 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41533 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41534 @end ifset
41535 @ifclear man
41536 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41537 @end ifclear
41538 @end smallexample
41539
41540 @noindent
41541 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41542
41543 @smallexample
41544 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41545 @end smallexample
41546
41547 @noindent
41548 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41549 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41550 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41551 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41552 `Connection refused'.
41553
41554 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41555 described in
41556 @ifset man
41557 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41558 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41559 @end ifset
41560 @ifclear man
41561 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41562 @end ifclear
41563 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41564
41565 @smallexample
41566 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41567 @end smallexample
41568
41569 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41570 case.
41571 @c man end
41572
41573 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41574 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41575
41576 @itemize @bullet
41577
41578 @item
41579 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41580
41581 @smallexample
41582 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41583 @end smallexample
41584
41585 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41586 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41587 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41588 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41589 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41590 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41591 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41592
41593 @item
41594 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41595 program:
41596
41597 @smallexample
41598 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41599 @end smallexample
41600
41601 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41602 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41603 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41604 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41605
41606 @item
41607 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41608
41609 @smallexample
41610 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41611 @end smallexample
41612
41613 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41614 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41615 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41616 debug several processes in the same session.
41617 @end itemize
41618
41619 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41620
41621 @table @env
41622
41623 @item --help
41624 List all options, with brief explanations.
41625
41626 @item --version
41627 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41628
41629 @item --attach
41630 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41631
41632 @smallexample
41633 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41634 @end smallexample
41635
41636 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41637 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41638
41639 @item --multi
41640 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41641 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41642 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41643 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41644
41645 @smallexample
41646 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41647 @end smallexample
41648
41649 @item --debug
41650 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41651 process.
41652 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41653 the developers.
41654
41655 @item --remote-debug
41656 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41657 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41658 the developers.
41659
41660 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41661 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41662 of debugging output.
41663 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41664
41665 @item --wrapper
41666 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41667 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41668 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41669 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41670
41671 @item --once
41672 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41673 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41674 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41675 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41676
41677 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41678
41679 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41680 @c QDisableRandomization.
41681
41682 @end table
41683 @c man end
41684
41685 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41686 @ifset man
41687 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41688 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41689 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41690
41691 @smallexample
41692 info gdb
41693 @end smallexample
41694
41695 should give you access to the complete manual.
41696
41697 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41698 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41699 @end ifset
41700 @c man end
41701
41702 @node gcore man
41703 @heading gcore
41704
41705 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41706
41707 @format
41708 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41709 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41710 @c man end
41711 @end format
41712
41713 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41714 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41715 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41716 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41717 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41718 running without any change.
41719 @c man end
41720
41721 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41722 @table @env
41723 @item -o @var{filename}
41724 The optional argument
41725 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41726 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41727 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41728 @end table
41729 @c man end
41730
41731 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41732 @ifset man
41733 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41734 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41735 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41736
41737 @smallexample
41738 info gdb
41739 @end smallexample
41740
41741 @noindent
41742 should give you access to the complete manual.
41743
41744 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41745 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41746 @end ifset
41747 @c man end
41748
41749 @node gdbinit man
41750 @heading gdbinit
41751
41752 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41753
41754 @format
41755 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41756 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41757 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41758 @end ifset
41759
41760 ~/.gdbinit
41761
41762 ./.gdbinit
41763 @c man end
41764 @end format
41765
41766 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41767 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41768 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41769 described in
41770 @ifset man
41771 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41772 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41773 @end ifset
41774 @ifclear man
41775 @ref{Sequences}.
41776 @end ifclear
41777
41778 Please read more in
41779 @ifset man
41780 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41781 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41782 @end ifset
41783 @ifclear man
41784 @ref{Startup}.
41785 @end ifclear
41786
41787 @table @env
41788 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41789 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41790 @end ifset
41791 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41792 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41793 @end ifclear
41794 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41795 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41796 See more in
41797 @ifset man
41798 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41799 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41800 @end ifset
41801 @ifclear man
41802 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41803 @end ifclear
41804
41805 @item ~/.gdbinit
41806 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41807 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41808
41809 @item ./.gdbinit
41810 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41811 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41812 See more in
41813 @ifset man
41814 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41815 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41816 @end ifset
41817 @ifclear man
41818 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41819 @end ifclear
41820 @end table
41821 @c man end
41822
41823 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41824 @ifset man
41825 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41826
41827 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41828 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41829 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41830
41831 @smallexample
41832 info gdb
41833 @end smallexample
41834
41835 should give you access to the complete manual.
41836
41837 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41838 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41839 @end ifset
41840 @c man end
41841
41842 @include gpl.texi
41843
41844 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41845 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41846 @include fdl.texi
41847
41848 @node Concept Index
41849 @unnumbered Concept Index
41850
41851 @printindex cp
41852
41853 @node Command and Variable Index
41854 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41855
41856 @printindex fn
41857
41858 @tex
41859 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41860 % meantime:
41861 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41862 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41863 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41864 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41865 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41866 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41867 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41868 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41869 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41870 \page\colophon
41871 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41872 @end tex
41873
41874 @bye